Annual Report (ESEF) • Mar 7, 2024
Preview not available for this file type.
Download Source File8SVCSVKSGDWMW2QHOH832023-01-012023-12-31iso4217:GBPxbrli:sharesiso4217:GBP8SVCSVKSGDWMW2QHOH832022-01-012022-12-318SVCSVKSGDWMW2QHOH832023-01-012023-12-31baesystemsplc:ComprehensiveIncomeOtherReservesMember8SVCSVKSGDWMW2QHOH832023-01-012023-12-31baesystemsplc:ComprehensiveIncomeRetainedEarningsMember8SVCSVKSGDWMW2QHOH832022-01-012022-12-31baesystemsplc:ComprehensiveIncomeOtherReservesMember8SVCSVKSGDWMW2QHOH832022-01-012022-12-31baesystemsplc:ComprehensiveIncomeRetainedEarningsMember8SVCSVKSGDWMW2QHOH832021-12-31ifrs-full:IssuedCapitalMember8SVCSVKSGDWMW2QHOH832021-12-31ifrs-full:SharePremiumMember8SVCSVKSGDWMW2QHOH832021-12-31ifrs-full:OtherReservesMember8SVCSVKSGDWMW2QHOH832021-12-31ifrs-full:RetainedEarningsMember8SVCSVKSGDWMW2QHOH832021-12-31ifrs-full:EquityAttributableToOwnersOfParentMember8SVCSVKSGDWMW2QHOH832021-12-31ifrs-full:NoncontrollingInterestsMember8SVCSVKSGDWMW2QHOH832021-12-318SVCSVKSGDWMW2QHOH832022-01-012022-12-31ifrs-full:IssuedCapitalMember8SVCSVKSGDWMW2QHOH832022-01-012022-12-31ifrs-full:SharePremiumMember8SVCSVKSGDWMW2QHOH832022-01-012022-12-31ifrs-full:OtherReservesMember8SVCSVKSGDWMW2QHOH832022-01-012022-12-31ifrs-full:RetainedEarningsMember8SVCSVKSGDWMW2QHOH832022-01-012022-12-31ifrs-full:EquityAttributableToOwnersOfParentMember8SVCSVKSGDWMW2QHOH832022-01-012022-12-31ifrs-full:NoncontrollingInterestsMember8SVCSVKSGDWMW2QHOH832022-12-31ifrs-full:IssuedCapitalMember8SVCSVKSGDWMW2QHOH832022-12-31ifrs-full:SharePremiumMember8SVCSVKSGDWMW2QHOH832022-12-31ifrs-full:OtherReservesMember8SVCSVKSGDWMW2QHOH832022-12-31ifrs-full:RetainedEarningsMember8SVCSVKSGDWMW2QHOH832022-12-31ifrs-full:EquityAttributableToOwnersOfParentMember8SVCSVKSGDWMW2QHOH832022-12-31ifrs-full:NoncontrollingInterestsMember8SVCSVKSGDWMW2QHOH832022-12-318SVCSVKSGDWMW2QHOH832023-01-012023-12-31ifrs-full:IssuedCapitalMember8SVCSVKSGDWMW2QHOH832023-01-012023-12-31ifrs-full:SharePremiumMember8SVCSVKSGDWMW2QHOH832023-01-012023-12-31ifrs-full:OtherReservesMember8SVCSVKSGDWMW2QHOH832023-01-012023-12-31ifrs-full:RetainedEarningsMember8SVCSVKSGDWMW2QHOH832023-01-012023-12-31ifrs-full:EquityAttributableToOwnersOfParentMember8SVCSVKSGDWMW2QHOH832023-01-012023-12-31ifrs-full:NoncontrollingInterestsMember8SVCSVKSGDWMW2QHOH832023-12-31ifrs-full:IssuedCapitalMember8SVCSVKSGDWMW2QHOH832023-12-31ifrs-full:SharePremiumMember8SVCSVKSGDWMW2QHOH832023-12-31ifrs-full:OtherReservesMember8SVCSVKSGDWMW2QHOH832023-12-31ifrs-full:RetainedEarningsMember8SVCSVKSGDWMW2QHOH832023-12-31ifrs-full:EquityAttributableToOwnersOfParentMember8SVCSVKSGDWMW2QHOH832023-12-31ifrs-full:NoncontrollingInterestsMember8SVCSVKSGDWMW2QHOH832023-12-31 Annual Report 2023 BAE Systems plc baesystems.com In this report Our vision To be the premier international defence, aerospace and security company. Our mission To provide a vital advantage to help our customers to protect what really matters. Our purpose To serve, supply and protect those who serve and protect us, in a corporate culture that is performance driven and values led. Through careful long-term sustainable management and governance of our business we will continue tocreate value for our stakeholders. Strategic report Overview 01–11 Our 2023 financial highlights 01 Our business at a glance 02 Our key programmes and franchises 04 Chair’s letter 06 Chief Executive’s review 08 Strategy and performance 12–45 Our strategic framework 12 Our business model 14 Our investment proposition 16 Our markets 18 Our investment in technology 20 Our stakeholders 24 Key performance indicators 26 Our financial review 28 Guidance for 2024 34 Segmental review 35 Sustainability 46–66 Our sustainability agenda 46 Environment and climate 48 Social 56 Responsible business practices 62 Non-financial and sustainability informationstatement 66 Risk 67–79 How we manage risk 67 Our risk management framework 69 Our principal risks 70 Viability statement 78 Governance Chair’s governance letter 80 Board of directors 81 Board and Executive Committee diversity information 84 Governance framework 86 Applying the2018 UK Corporate Governance CodePrinciples 88 Compliance with the 2018 UK Corporate Governance Code provisions 90 The work of the board (s.172) 91 Nominations Committee report 94 Audit Committee report 97 Environmental, Socialand Governance Committee report 102 Innovation and Technology Committee report 105 Remuneration Committee report 107 Quick read summary 110 Annual remuneration report 115 Statutory and other regulatory information 135 Financial statements Independent Auditor’s report 142 Consolidated financial statements 152 Company financial statements 218 Additional information Alternative performance measures 227 Other sustainability information 232 How our purpose connects to our strategy Our strategic framework Page 12 How our purpose connects to our culture Our stakeholders Page 24 The work of the Board Page 91 This document comprises BAE Systems plc’s annual accounts and report for the purposes of Section 423 oftheCompanies Act 2006. The information in this Annual Report, which was approved by the Board of directors on 20 February 2024, doesnot comprise statutory accounts within the meaning of Section 434 of the Companies Act 2006. Statutory accounts for the year ended 31 December 2023, which contain an unmodified audit report under Section 495 of the Companies Act 2006 (which does not make any statements under Section 498 of the Companies Act 2006), will be delivered to the Registrar of Companies in accordance with Section 441 of the Companies Act 2006. Please note that throughout this document graphical representation of component parts may not cast due torounding. BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategic report Overview 01–11 Our 2023 financial highlights 01 Our business at a glance 02 Our key programmes and franchises 04 Chair’s letter 06 Chief Executive’s review 08 Strategy and performance 12–45 Our strategic framework 12 Our business model 14 Our investment proposition 16 Our markets 18 Our investment in technology 20 Our stakeholders 24 Key performance indicators 26 Our financial review 28 Guidance for 2024 34 Segmental review 35 Sustainability 46–66 Our sustainability agenda 46 Environment and climate 48 Social 56 Responsible business practices 62 Non-financial and sustainability informationstatement 66 Risk 67–79 How we manage risk 67 Our risk management framework 69 Our principal risks 70 Viability statement 78 Governance Chair’s governance letter 80 Board of directors 81 Board and Executive Committee diversity information 84 Governance framework 86 Applying the2018 UK Corporate Governance CodePrinciples 88 Compliance with the 2018 UK Corporate Governance Code provisions 90 The work of the board (s.172) 91 Nominations Committee report 94 Audit Committee report 97 Environmental, Socialand Governance Committee report 102 Innovation and Technology Committee report 105 Remuneration Committee report 107 Quick read summary 110 Annual remuneration report 115 Statutory and other regulatory information 135 Financial statements Independent Auditor’s report 142 Consolidated financial statements 152 Company financial statements 218 Additional information Alternative performance measures 227 Other sustainability information 232 Shareholder information 236 Independent Auditor’s reasonable assuranceReport on ESEF prepared AnnualFinancial Report 239 Our 2023 financial highlights Financial performance measures defined by the Group 1 Sales KPI £25,284m 9% growth 2 20222021 2023 21,310 23,256 25,284 Underlying earnings before interest and tax (EBIT) KPI £2,682m 9% growth 2 20222021 2023 2,205 2,479 2,682 Underlying earnings per share (EPS) BONUS KPI 63.2p 14% growth 2 20222021 2023 47.8 4 55.5 63.2 Free cash flow KPI £2,593m £643m higher 20222021 2023 1,864 1,950 2,593 Order intake BONUS KPI £37.7bn £0.6bn increase 20222021 2023 21.5 37.1 37.7 Order backlog £69.8bn £10.9bn increase 20222021 2023 44.0 58.9 69.8 Financial performance measures derived from IFRS 3 Revenue £23,078m 9% growth 20222021 2023 19,521 21,258 23,078 Operating profit £2,573m 8% growth 20222021 2023 2,389 2,384 2,573 Basic EPS 61.3p 20% growth 20222021 2023 55.2 51.1 61.3 Net cash flow from operating activities £3,760m £921m higher 20222021 2023 2,447 2,839 3,760 Order book £58.0bn £9.1bn increase 20222021 2023 35.5 48.9 58.0 Dividend per share 30.0p 11.1% growth 20222021 2023 25.1 27.0 30.0 BONUS 75% of the UK executive directors’ annual bonuses are based ontheachievement of financial KPIs (see page 26). KPI References to key performance indicators (KPIs) throughout the Annual Report. 1. The definition and purpose of all performance measures defined by the Group is provided in the Alternative performance measures section on page 227. 2. Growth rates for Sales, Underlying EBIT and Underlying EPS are on a constant currency basis (i.e. current year compared with prior year translated at current year exchange rates). The comparatives have not been restated. All other growth rates and year-on-year movements are ona reported currency basis. 3. International Financial Reporting Standards. 4. For 2021, underlying EPS was 50.7p including a one-off tax benefit of £94m resulting from agreements reached regarding the exposure arising from the April 2019 European Commission decision regarding the UK’s Controlled Foreign Company Regime and the impact of the UK tax rate adjustment. 01 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategic report Financial statements Additional informationGovernance At BAE Systems, we provide some of the world’smost advanced, technology-led defence, aerospace and security solutions. We are aworkforce of 99,800 1 highly skilled people in more than 40 countries. Workingwith our customers and local partners, wedevelop, engineer, manufacture andsupport products and systems that deliver military capability, protect national security, and keep critical information and infrastructure secure. We maintain leading positions in major defenceand security markets around the world– including the US, UK, the Kingdom of Saudi Arabia and Australia – as well asestablished positions in a number of other international markets. We focus our operations in five 3 key sectors: Our business at a glance 1. As at 31 December 2023 and including share of equity accounted investments. 2. Sales is defined in the Alternative performance measures section on page 227. 3. The Group has five operating sectors which, together with HQ, make itssixoperating segments as defined by IFRS 8 Operating Segments. 2023 sales 2 £25,284m Total employees 1 99,800 Sales 2 by destination A US 42% B UK 26% C Kingdom of Saudi Arabia 11% D Australia 4% E Other international markets 17% Employees 1 by location A US 31,600 31% B UK 45,700 46% C Kingdom of Saudi Arabia 6,700 7% D Australia 5,700 6% E Other 10,100 10% Sales 2 by sector 1 Electronic Systems 22% 2 Platforms & Services 15% 3 Air 32% 4 Maritime 22% 5 Cyber & Intelligence 9% Employees 1 by sector 1 Electronic Systems 17,500 17% 2 Platforms & Services 11 ,900 12% 3 Air 26,000 26% 4 Maritime 27,500 28% 5 Cyber & Intelligence 11,000 11% 6 HQ/Other 5,900 6% 2023 revenue £23,078m A B C D E Our key programmes and franchises Page 04 2 SALES 3 4 5 1 2 EMPLOYEES 3 4 5 6 1 02 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Overview Our markets Page 18 Our sustainability agenda Page 46 Our financial review Page 28 Segmental review Page 35 Electronic Systems Electronic Systems comprises the Group’s US- and UK-based electronic solutions, including electronic warfare systems, navigation systems, electro-optical sensors, military and commercial digital engine andflight controls, precision guidance and seeker solutions, next-generation military communications systems and data links, persistent surveillance capabilities, space electronics and electric drive propulsion systems. Segmental review Page 36 Platforms & Services Platforms & Services, with operations in the US, Sweden and the UK, manufactures and upgrades combat vehicles, weapons and munitions, and delivers services and sustainment activities, including naval ship repair and the management and operation oftwo government-owned ammunition plants. Segmental review Page 38 Maritime Maritime comprises the Group’s UK-based maritime and land activities, including major submarine, ship build and support programmes, as well as our Australian business. Segmental review Page 42 Cyber & Intelligence Cyber & Intelligence comprises the US-basedIntelligence & Security business andUK-headquartered Digital Intelligence business and covers the Group’s cyber security activities for National Security, Central Government and Government Enterprises. Segmental review Page 44 Air Air comprises the Group’s UK-based air build and support activities forEuropean and international markets, US programmes, development of Future Combat AirSystems and FalconWorks ® , alongside our business in the Kingdom ofSaudi Arabia and interests in our European joint ventures: Eurofighter and MBDA. Segmental review Page 40 03 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategic report Financial statements Additional informationGovernance We have strong technological and programme diversity across our sectors. Our key programmes and franchises Defence electronics Design, manufacture and support of electronic systems across a range of US and other allied nations’ military programmes, including a leadership position in the electronic warfare market. Our presence on awide range of US fixed and rotary wing platforms, a number of which are coming into service, and a strong demand for capability and solutions to defeat increasingly sophisticated threats, are expected to provide this franchise with a solid platform for the coming years. Commercial avionics equipment Design, manufacture and support of avionicsequipment across multiple commercial aircraftplatforms, including engine and flightcontrols, and cabin and cockpit systems, as well as aftermarket support services. We are a leading supplier ofengine controls for General Electric and amajor supplierof flight control electronics forBoeing and other manufacturers. Weapon systems andmunitions Design and manufacture of naval gun systems, munitions, torpedoes, radars, navalcommand and combat systems, artillery systems, missile launchers and, through our 37.5% interest in MBDA, missiles and missile systems. We operate and manage two complex US Army ammunition plants that produce energetics for insensitive munitions and propellant grains. Aircraft Prime contracting, systems integration, rapid engineering, manufacturing, maintenance, repair and upgrade, and military training foradvanced combat and trainer aircraft. BAESystems has a significant workshare onthe world’s largest defence programme, F-35 Lightning II, which includes design andmanufacture of sub-assemblies in theUK, including the aft fuselage and empennage, and provision of equipment inthe US, including the electronic warfare suite. Production levels are at full-rate and expected to be maintained for over a decade, based on a programme of record of more than 3,000 aircraft. Manufacture of Typhoon major units and final assembly of aircraft. Expansion of the capabilities of the aircraft with the E-Scan radar and ongoing development of new technologies aligned with the UK Combat AirStrategy and capabilities required for theGlobal Combat Air Programme (GCAP).Typhoon manufacturing is currentlyunderpinned by orders from Qatar,Germany and Spain which will ensurecontinuity of production. Air support and training Provision of support to operational capability, including maintenance, support and training for Typhoon aircraft in service with air forces in the UK, Kingdom of Saudi Arabia, Qatar and Oman. Under the Saudi British Defence Co-operation Programme, delivery of contracts for labour, logistics and training, training aircraft (including Hawk) and upgrades to Tornado aircraft. Contracts to support Hawk aircraft across 14 countries and support for the F-35 Lightning II fleet around the globe, including in-country support in the UK and Australia. Space Leading capabilities in radiation-hardened electronics for spacecraft and satellites. Ourorbital expertise, combined withnext-generation ground resiliency anddata analytics solutions, helps to keep assets performing effectively in the harsh environments of space. Following the acquisition of In-Space Missions in 2021, weare one of a small number of British companies with the capability to design, buildand operate Low Earth Orbit satellites. The acquisition of Ball Aerospace will add significant additional capabilities inthe design, build and operation of satellites andsatellite systems. Ball Aerospace In August, we announced aStock Purchase Agreement to acquire the US-based Ball Aerospace business, aleading provider of spacecraft, mission payloads, optical and antenna systems, from Ball Corporation for $5.5bn (£4.4bn).The acquisition completed inFebruary 2024. www.baesystems.com/article Sales 1 by key programme (%) Electronic Systems E D B A C A Defence electronics 65% B F-35 Lightning II 15% C Commercial avionics equipment 11% D Commercial other 6% E Space 3% Platforms & Services D B A C A Combat vehicles 52% B US naval ship repair 18% C Munitions 15% D Weapon systems 15% Air D E B A C A Typhoon 36% B Tornado 22% C Weapons Systems 19% D F-35 Lightning II 14% E Other 9% Maritime D E B A C A Submarines 47% B Complex warships 22% C UK naval support 12% D Munitions 5% E Other 14% Cyber & Intelligence D B A C A US Government 68% B UK and other governments 30% C Commercial 1% D Other 1% 1. Sales is defined in the Alternative performance measures section on page 227. 04 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Overview Submarines Design and manufacture of seven Astute Class nuclear-powered attack submarines forthe Royal Navy. The first four Astute Class submarines are in operational service with theRoyal Navy, while the fifth boat exited ourBarrow shipyard to commence sea trials in February 2023. The remaining two boats are atan advanced stage of build and the final boat is expected to enter service in the mid-2020s. Design and manufacture of fourDreadnought Class nuclear-powered submarines to carry the UK’s Trident ballistic missiles. Manufacture of the first three Dreadnought Class boats is underway, with production on the programme to continue into the 2030s. Early design and mobilisation activities are underway on the SSN-AUKUS programme, which will deliver a replacement for the Astute Class. Naval ship repair and support Provision of naval ship repair and modernisation services in the US and UK, together with support to the navies of the US, UK and Australia, at home and on deployment. In the US, we have facilities located on the Atlantic and Pacific coasts. Inthe UK, we support the operation of HMNaval Base Portsmouth on behalf of the UK Ministry of Defence. Our key customers in the US, UK, Australia and Canada are looking to extend and modernise their fleets in the coming years. Complex warships Design and manufacture of eight Type 26 frigates for the Royal Navy. The first four frigates are under construction, with the firstType 26 expected to be delivered in themid-2020s. Contract signed in 2018 with the Australian Government that provides the framework for the design and manufacture of Hunter Class Frigates, with construction commencing during 2023 on the first schedule protection block following successful completion of the Preliminary Design Review. Provider of the warship design for the Canadian Surface Combatant programme. Sustainable technology Recognised provider of electric drive systems for lowand zero emission propulsion systems with an extensive installed base on urban transit buses. We are leveraging our existing product portfolio and advancing sustainable vehicle mobility, efficiency and capability for arange of applications in public transit, maritime, air and military markets. Uncrewed and future airsystem capabilities Development of future air system capabilities,including joint investment withthe UK Government and industry inanext-generation combat air system underthe Tempest programme, which waslaunched in 2018 in support of the UKCombat Air Strategy. The Tempest programme is progressing, with the development of a new flying combat air demonstrator, set to fly within the next fouryears. Together with our partners, wearecurrently working on more than 60technology demonstrations under aninitial Concept and Assessment Phase contract. In 2022, The governments of theUK, Italy and Japan announced their intention to work together to build on the progress ofthe Team Tempest partnership under GCAP. Combat vehicles In the US, we build and upgrade a number oftracked combat vehicles including: the Bradley Fighting vehicles, M109 self-propelled howitzers, Armored Multi-Purpose Vehicles (AMPVs) and M88 recovery vehicles, and wemanufacture amphibious combat vehicles(ACVs) for the US Marine Corps andinternational customers. The Hägglunds business in Sweden builds, upgrades and supports the CV90 and BvS10 tracked combat vehicles. In the UK, weupgrade, buildand support vehicles for the British Army through our joint venture with Rheinmetall, RBSL. Cyber security andintelligence Delivery of a broad range of intelligence, security and synthetic training services to enable military, intelligence and civilian branches of the US Government to recognise, manage and defeat threats. Support to UK and overseas governments and government agencies in their intelligence missions. The heightened threat environment and more sophisticated technology are leading to increased government cyber spending in markets including the US, UK and Australia, and we are well placed to support our customers in these markets. AUKUS In March 2023, further announcements were made as part of the AUKUS trilateralagreement between Australia, the UK and the US. Australia and the UK will operate SSN-AUKUS as their submarines of the future, with funding of £3.95bn awarded from the UK Ministry of Defencefor the next phase of the UK’snext-generation nuclear-powered attack submarine programme. www.baesystems.com/article Global Combat Air Programme Ministers from Italy, Japan and the UK signedan international treaty to develop an innovative stealth fighter under GCAP inDecember and confirmed that the joint GCAP government headquarters will be based in the UK. Following the industry collaboration agreement announced in September, as the UK’s industry lead, wecontinue to work closely with our partners Mitsubishi Heavy Industries inJapan, and Leonardo in Italy, to determine the future joint business construct, which will also be headquartered in the UK. www.baesystems.com/article Armored Multi-Purpose Vehicle moves to full-rate production Following prior funding for early order materials, in August, the US Army moved forward on the AMPV programme, with cumulative funding of $797m (£641m) tobegin full-rate production. We look forward to continuing to partner with theUS Army on this critical programme. www.baesystems.com/article Photo: US Army 05 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategic report Financial statements Additional informationGovernance Chair’ s letter Dear Shareholders This is my first letter to you as Chair since taking over from Sir Roger Carr after the AGM in May last year. It has been a dynamic and rewarding year in which the Company has continued to perform strongly, both financially and operationally. During 2023, wehave sadly seen geopolitical instability increase and, as one of the world’s largest defence contractors, BAE Systems has continued to play a leading role in supporting our government customers in the elevated threat environment. First impressions I have very much enjoyed getting to know thebusiness better, visiting many sites and meeting colleagues across the business. It is a privilege to chair such an important Company that, in my view, has often understated its achievements and unique qualities. One of my strongest impressions has been the incredible sense of purpose that our people have across the Company. They understand the importance of the role that we play in national defence. “To serve, supply and protect those who serve and protect us” is aphrase I have heard often and it clearly defines what we do. This purpose is integral to our culture and values. BAE Systems has a critical role to play in defence and cyber security in our core markets in the UK, US, Australia and the Kingdom ofSaudi Arabia and in other countries where we operate through government relationships, such as in Ukraine. The case for defence is very clear; investment in defence is required to help to grow geopolitical stability and prosperity, and it is also needed to protect countries and citizens from threats, and protect free trade. Thedefence sector also delivers economic prosperity, through creating jobs, building skills and investing incommunities, as well asdeveloping new technologies with variedapplications. Technology is at the heart of much of what we do; we continue to build on our portfolio of products for air, sea and land and also develop cutting-edge technologies fit for thechallenges of a digital world where multi-platform communication is key. Under the strong leadership of Charles Woodburn and the rest of the executive team, BAE Systems has evolved into a forward-looking, technology-led defence Company, with a unique international customer base. We have a strong base fromwhich we are driving what we expect tobe a period of sustained top-line growth. Our management continues to focus intently on operational excellence, especially in the execution of our key programmes. Progressing our strategy 2023 has been a busy year for the business with significant agreements on SSN-AUKUS andGCAP that will underpin the Company’s long-term prospects. We announced the deal for Ball Aerospace, a leading company in the military and civil space domain, our largest ever M&Atransaction. This acquisition will enable us to accelerate our growth in the expanding space market. We have also continued to support our key customers intheir response to the invasion of Ukraine, and in their other activities. Against this backdrop of strategic progress, we have delivered another year of strong financial performance with a record order book, 9% sales growth and profitability underpinned by good operational performance across all sectors, and strong cash flow. This has continued our good trackrecord and is delivering on our value-compounding model. As we expand to deliver new programmes, like SSN-AUKUS and GCAP, it is critical that we develop the right skills in our employee base. Iam proud that, in 2023, we had c.5,500 graduates and apprentices in training in the UKalone, and we are one of the largest private sector apprentice and graduate hirers in the UK. We continue to develop new engineering, manufacturing and training facilities for our expanding workforce, and toinvest in the local communities where wehave major operations. We remain focused on developing world- class future technologies to support our customers’ needs, with total R&D spending increasing year-on-year. Our ESG priorities dovetail with our overall mission. We are aware of the impact that our activities have on the environment, backed upby data we gather, and we remain focused on our journey to Net Zero. As one of the UK’s largest manufacturers, and with operations inover 30 states in the US, we have a major social and economic impact in both countries. All of our activities take place within a clear governance framework led by the Board. As one of the world’s largestdefence contractors, our technology, capabilities and global footprint ensure weplay a leading role in supporting our government customers in meeting the elevated threat environment. 06 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Overview A fundamental responsibility for any Board is planning for orderly management succession. I am very much enjoying working with Charles and his management team. However, all companies must have resilience and be able to maintain momentum through management change. I am working with theBoard to refresh our succession planning processes to ensure we identify potential andtalent internally and externally. Board changes The composition and evolution of our Board are important and activity is focused on ensuring we continue to be well positioned tosupport the business in what should be aperiod of sustained growth, even as the Board evolves. Sir Roger Carr, who retired as Chair in May 2023, had led the Board for over nine years. There have already been many tributes paid to Sir Roger and the legacy he has left here. Iwould like to thank him again on behalf ofthe Company for all he achieved. His experience, knowledge and passion for whatwe do were evident to all who met himand we wish him the best for the future. We also sadly said farewell to Chris Grigg, ourSenior Independent Director (SID), at theend of 2023 after nearly a decade on theBoard. I am personally grateful to Chris for extending his tenure to provide continuity through the Chair transition, and would like to thank him for the outstanding contribution he has made on our Board. I am pleased thatNicole Piasecki has agreed to take on therole of SID in addition to chairing the Remuneration Committee. As a significant proportion of our turnover and shareholder base is in the US, it seems timely to have a UScitizen as SID. I am delighted that Angus Cockburn joined the Board at the end of 2023. Angus brings deep financial and commercial expertise tothe Board from his executive career (seepage 82 for more detail). Finally, I would like to thank all of our colleaguesfor their contribution to our strongperformance this year. The dedication and skills of our workforce are at the heart ofthe Company’s culture and success. Cressida Hogg CBE Chair Capital allocation Financial and operational discipline has contributed to strong performance and allowed the Board to balance investing for long-term growth with allocating capital for shareholder returns. The ongoing share buyback programme and dividend payments distributed significant capital to shareholders through the year. Capital allocation remains akey focus for the Board and is regularly discussed in our strategic planning and budget approval sessions. With the business well positioned for the future, the Board has recommended a final dividend of 18.5 pence per share, making atotal dividend of 30.0 pence per share forthefull year. This is anincrease of 11.1% on last year and represents the 20th year ofdividend growthfor the Company. Governance Good governance is fundamental to the long-term success of the Company and is covered in more detail in the annual report onpages 80 to 140. A change of Chair allows for a proper reviewof the governance structures and processes already in place. Overall, our existinggovernance practices are robust andcontinue to evolve. A key ongoing project is refreshing our approach to risk management and assurance, in line with changes in governance standards. Across my site visits, I have been impressed bythesense of mission and purpose amongst our employees, and the positive role we play in the communities we operate in. Cressida Hogg CBE Chair 07 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategic report Financial statements Additional informationGovernance Chief Executive’s review 2023 saw another stand-out year of order flow on newand existing programmes, renewals on incumbent positions and a strong opportunity pipeline. These underpin our confidence and visibility for good top-line growth in the coming years, while we continue reinforcing our value-compounding model with a sharpfocus on operational performance and disciplined capital allocation. Overview I am pleased to report that BAE Systems delivered another year of strong operational and financial performance in 2023, despite continued global supply chain disruptions andhighinflation. These pressures are starting to recede and wehave entered 2024 with a compelling competitive position, thanks to our portfolio and geographic diversity, and multiple new business opportunities, including the acquisition of Ball Aerospace – all of which point toanother productive year for BAE Systems andour shareholders. 2023’s successes were undoubtedly driven byour people, their unwavering focus on ourpurpose of protecting those who protect us, and a values-led culture, committed to sustainable business practices, inclusion, a robust governance structure and high ethical standards. The global events of recent years have reinforced the essential role of the defence industry in helping governments protect their countries and citizens. 2023 operational performance Overall, we have made strong operational progress and advanced the strategic objectives we have been pursuing for thepastseveral years. Our focus on operational excellence continues to benefit our customers and shareholders, especially as we execute on complex, long-duration programmes like Dreadnought, Type26and Hunter Class frigates, Typhoon and F-35 jets, electronic warfare systems, combat vehicles, and many other programmes. This relentless focus on delivering for our customers has positioned the Group as a trusted supplier of advanced technology solutions and industrial capabilities to help customers achieve their criticalnational and global security missions. 2023 financial performance Our key financial measures of order intake,sales, underlying EBIT, underlying EPS and free cash flow all increased, amidst ahigh inflation environment. This was only possible because of the excellent work of ouremployees on programme execution, ourdiscipline on contracting and meaningful internal efficiency efforts. On a constant currency basis, we grew orderbacklog by 21%, sales by 9% and underlying EPS by 14%. We delivered a record free cash flow of £2.6bn for the year and, as a result, exceeded our stated three-year free cash flow target for 2021 to2023. This strong set of results was enhanced byour ongoing share buyback programme. In2023, we repurchased £561m worth of ourshares, or 1.9% of our outstanding sharecapital. Building an operational andfinancialtrack record In 2021, we laid out how we would build ona period of transition and our good performance from 2018 to 2020. It centred around building a track record of good quality operational and financial performance on which customers and shareholders could consistently rely. We delivered against all theoperational areas in the scorecard, whichhas led to strong financial performance over the three years from 2021 to 2023 with sales growth of 20%, margin expansion of 80bps, cash conversion of 100% and total shareholder returns of £4.2bn. With strong momentum behind us from our last three years of delivery, a record order backlog and our largest ever acquisition completed, we look forward to the next three years with confidence. In many aspects, our ambitions for the coming years are a continuation of the strategy we have been 08 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Overview executing, with the foundations for delivery built on: • strong operational performance and contracting discipline; • investing appropriately to support growth and our customers’ priorities; and • looking to deepen partnerships and collaborations. Delivery against these ambitions, coupled with the acquisition of Ball Aerospace whichis set to be additive to our top-line growth, margin expansion and cash conversion outlook, means we are well positioned to deliver a compelling and predictable value-compounding model forour stakeholders. Balance sheet strength We ended 2023 with a strong balance sheet,featuring a cash position of £4.1bn, netdebt (excluding lease liabilities) of £1.0bn, and a net pension position that remains in anaccounting surplus. Our capital allocation remains consistent and is focused on underpinning the Group’s long-term strength and expected growth. We prioritise investing in the business for the long term through research and development (R&D), aswell asacquisitions in high-growth and high- returnparts of the business. Our capital expenditure (capex) is targeted to ensure oursystems and facilities are modern, deliveran effective working environment andprovide the capacity needed to support our growth outlook. I am pleased toreportthat BAESystems deliveredanother year of strongoperational andfinancial performance in 2023. Charles Woodburn CBE Chief Executive Returns to shareholders 1 £1,418m Total shareholder returns since 2021 £4.2bn Order backlog £69.8bn Strong consistent programme performance Top-line growth Since 2021, we have grown sales by 20% onaconstant currency basis. Margin expansion We have increased margins from 10.3% in2021to10.6% in 2023, driven by: – Improvement in programme performance acrossthe portfolio. – Inflation management and strong supply chainperformance. – Operational efficiencies andsimplification. Strong cash conversion We have generated £6.4bn of free cash flow inthethree years to December 2023. We anticipate strong cash conversion to continue, forecasting free cashflow of in excess of £5bn for the next threeyears from 2024 to 2026. Higher return on capital employed(ROCE) We have increased profitability, with underlying EBITincreasing 30% on a constant currency basis over three years since 2021. We have boosted efficiency through our careful capital allocation, resulting in a higher ROCE for our investors. ROCE is a key metric in driving executive remuneration. Focused capital allocation We have applied a clear, consistent and careful capital allocation across the business. – We have continued to invest in our people, growing to 99,800 employees at the end of 2023from 89,600 inJanuary 2021, including ourshare of equity accounted investments. – We have applied significant investment in upgrading and improving facilities across our sitesto ensure our processes are efficient and weare able to deliver operational excellence. – We continue to invest in future technologies. Ourtotal R&D spend across the three years totheend of 2023 was £5.9bn. – We continue to identify and pursue value- enhancing acquisitions in alignment with our Groupstrategy. Following ratings upgrades from S&P Global and Fitch in 2022, as well as being placed on positive outlook by Moody’s, we have maintained our stronginvestment grade credit ratings. Rating Outlook Category Moody’s Investors Service Baa2 Positive Investment grade Standard & Poor’s Ratings Services BBB+ Stable Investment grade Fitch Ratings BBB+ Stable Investment grade Efficiency and simplification in working Secure further opportunities and wider market base Further investment in technology Portfolio shaping forvalue creation Accelerate our sustainability agenda Our ambitions 2021–2023 Financial outcome from delivery against our ambitions Attractive shareholder returns – As at 31 December 2023, we have returned £4.2bn through dividends and sharerepurchases under announced share buyback programmes since 2021. – We continue to target paying dividends in line with the Group’s policy of long-term sustainable cover of around two times underlyingearnings. 1. See calculation on page 32. 09 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategic report Financial statements Additional informationGovernance 1. Backlog for Cyber & Intelligence is generally for one year with an incumbency position following. Pipeline/incumbent positionOrder backlog Opportunity Electronic Systems (ES) Electronic Combat (including F-35) ES Defence other ES Commercial Platforms & Services M109 AMPV ACV US Ship Repair US Ordnance & Weapons Hägglunds & Bofors Air Tempest/GCAP F-35 build and support Typhoon production UK Typhoon support Kingdom of Saudi Arabia support MBDA Maritime Dreadnought SSN-AUKUS Type 26 Australia Hunter Class Munitions (UK) Dates reflect position at 1 January each year 2024 2025 2026 2027 2028 2029 2030 2040 Chief Executive’s review continued We are also committed to returning valuetoshareholders in accordance with ourcapital allocation policy through a dividend, which has increased for 20 years ina row, and share buybacks. Reflecting this,in August, we announced a further three-year share buyback programme ofupto £1.5bn to commence after the completion of the current programme. Highly relevant capabilities As one of the world’s largest defence companies, our technologies, capabilities andglobal footprint position BAE Systems asa leader in helping customers meet the elevated threat environment of today and tomorrow. Executing on our ambitious product and technology strategy, the Groupcontinues to design, develop and manufacture cutting-edge products – acrossthe domains of air, sea, land, cyber andspace – that our customers count on. Ourexceptional portfolio is enhanced by enabling technologies including artificial intelligence, autonomy, synthetic environments and cyber defence, ensuring we remain at the forefront of national security-related innovation. In addition to our defence portfolio, our commercial aviation product lines are recovering as more passengers return to flying. Demand for our low and zero emission propulsion systems also grew, with opportunities to take these applications into the defence arena, as well asmaritime and air. Our market differentiation Our diverse product and services portfolio, combined with our global footprint and engagement in many of the world’s largest national defence markets, are key and differentiating strengths. We see good long-term growth and significant opportunities inour US, UK, European, Middle Eastern, Australian and Asia- Pacificbusinesses. Most of the countries where we operate haveeither announced budget increases orare planning increased spending to addressthe elevated threat environment. While governments continue to face global economic and fiscal pressures, commitment to defence spending in our major markets remains robust. Please read more about our markets on page18. Our multi-decade programmes and growing global opportunity pipeline 1 10 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Overview Our long-term visibility With our record order backlog and programme positions, as illustrated inthechart on page 10, we have a high level ofvisibility of our revenues for many years tocome. The order backlog is, in many cases,just a subset of the true programme length and value, with many of our key programmes running well into the next decade. The current visibility has the potential to be even further enhanced as we have a growing global opportunity pipeline, driven by our capabilities and marketdifferentiation. Portfolio evolution to support thelongterm During the year, three significant events have positively enhanced thebusiness portfolio relevance for the longterm. • Firstly, further detail on the AUKUS trilateralagreement between Australia, theUK and the US was announced in March 2023 and has significant future potential for BAE Systems. We have already secured £3.95bn offunding intheyear for the next phase of the UK’snext-generation attack submarineprogramme. • Secondly, GCAP, formed in 2022, saw ministers from Japan, the UK and Italy sign an important treaty in December 2023 inthe shared design and development of next-generation fighter aircraft, reinforcing momentum and the strong trilateral co-operation between the partners. • Thirdly, in August 2023, we announced theacquisition of Ball Aerospace, a leading space, defence technology andtactical missiles company, which webelieve has highly relevant mission-critical capabilities for our customers’ futureneeds. The acquisition completed in February 2024. Investing for growth To meet the business’s growth outlook, we areincreasing our investments in people, technologies and facilities. We boosted our global workforce by 6,700 employees compared to 2022. Given the longduration of many of our programmes, we put a special emphasis on early careers and community outreach to ensure we hire, develop and retain the best talent. In 2023, we increased recruitment of UK apprentices and graduates by 37% compared to 2022. We also continue to develop and modernise our facilities, making progress in building capacity for the future in munitions, shipbuilding, submarines, combat vehicles and electronics. Technology and innovation are central to ourstrategy and we increased Group R&D expenditure by 14% compared to 2022. Our investments in core franchises and ournext-generation priorities, such as: space;autonomy; sustainability; advanced manufacturing; and multi-domain and digitalintegration, are driven by the evolving threat landscape. At a tactical level, the conflict in Ukraine ishighlighting the importance of a number ofthese key technologies, especially autonomy, synthetic training, digital andmulti-domain capabilities, while also reinforcing the critical need for munitions andmaintaining legacy capabilities. We are driving innovation through the research labs embedded in our business sectors, including FASTLabs ™ in the US, RedOchre Labs in Australia, and now via the FalconWorks ® organisation in our Air sector. These hubs are agile innovation engines aimed at delivering bold breakthrough technologies to keep our customers ahead ofthe challenges they face. They also foster collaborative partnerships with academia andother organisations to bring even greater levels of creative and diverse thinking into BAESystems. Read more about our investment in technology on page 20. Our sustainability agenda Recent global events continue to demonstratethe need for strong defence andsecurity in the face of aggression by nation states. At BAE Systems, we provide critical capabilities and support to our government customers and their allies tofulfil their primary obligations to keep citizenssafe, as well as enabling important economic and social contributions through the provision of sustainable high-quality jobs. In line with our Group strategic business priorities, we put a significant focus on recruitment, skills and education to ensurethe future talent pipeline. A key enabler to this is a positive and inclusive workplace and we continued employee engagement through our employee resourcegroups and introduced new wellbeing programmes. Please read more on pages 46 to 66. Sustainability is one of our focus areas fortechnology innovation in the Group. Ourambition is to improve the sustainability of our products without compromising performance, even enhancing it wherepossible. Executive Committee changes After long and successful careers with theCompany, two Executive Committee members retiredat the end of the year. OurAir SectorManaging Director, Cliff Robson, has been succeeded by Simon Barnes, who previously led our business in theKingdom of Saudi Arabia. Inour Digital Intelligence business, Managing Director David Armstrong hasbeensucceeded byAndrea Thompson, who previously ledourAir Sector’s Europe and Internationalbusiness. Summary As you’ll see throughout the pages of thisreport, 2023 has been a year of real progress for theGroup. We delivered a strongoperational and financial performance, moved forward on highly significant long-term strategic programmes with GCAPandAUKUS, increased R&D spend andcapex, grew our workforce by a net 6,700 employees and announced the $5.5bnacquisition of Ball Aerospace to enhance our space portfolio, which completed in February 2024. On behalf of all of my BAE Systems colleagues, I’m proud to report that the fundamentals of the business are strong, theoutlook is positive and our team is focusedon our values and purpose – “toserve, supply and protect those who serve and protect us”. We are well positioned to help our national government customers keeptheir citizens safe and secure in an uncertain world. For shareholders, our record order backlog, position on major programmes and our continued focus on operational excellence and financial discipline, provide a high level of visibility for sales growth, margin expansion, cash generation and capital returns in the years to come. Thank you for your support of the Group andour strategy for value creation. We look forward to another productive and rewarding year in 2024 for all our stakeholders. Charles Woodburn CBE Chief Executive 11 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategic report Financial statements Additional informationGovernance Our strategic framework Our vision ... is to be the premier international defence, aerospace and security company. Our mission ... is to provide a vital advantage to help our customers to protect what really matters. Our strategy ... is comprised of six key long-term areas of focus that will help us to achieve our vision and mission. Itiscentred on maintaining and growing our core franchises and securing growth opportunities through advancing our three strategic priorities whilst demonstrating our Company Behaviours in all that we do. Our strategic priorities ... provide the link between our longer-term strategy and near-term businessobjectivesforallouremployees. Our sectors Our values: Trusted, Innovative and Bold Drive operational excellence Electronic Systems Page 36 Platforms &Services Page 38 Air Page 40 Maritime Page 42 Cyber & Intelligence Page 44 Continuously improve competitiveness and efficiency Advance and further leverageour technology 1 Sustain and grow our defencebusiness • Deliver on our commitments effectively and efficiently • Develop our offerings to meet the future defence and security needs 2 Continue to grow our business inadjacentmarkets • Take our capabilities into adjacent attractive markets • Develop dual-use opportunities delivering civil solutions to leverage back to meet challenges for our defence customers 3 Develop and expand our international business • Mature our international activities, broadening our offerings to our established customers • Develop relations with additional customers 4 Inspire and develop adiverse workforce to drive success • Ensure we diversify our thinking andharness the full potential of ourpeople • Create an environment and proposition in which our people willthrive 5 Enhance financial performance and deliver sustainable growth in shareholder value • Seek opportunities to drive efficiency,standardisation andsynergies • Identify opportunities for higher- margin offerings 6 Advance and integrate our sustainability agenda • Emphasise the vital role we play in protecting countries and civilians andsupporting our communities • Progress the delivery of our decarbonisation strategy 12 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategy and performance Our strategy in action BAE Systems Hägglunds With over 60 years of experience in tracked vehicles, BAE Systems Hägglunds has built an enviable portfolio of combat vehicles. Asatrusted supplier, we have experienced accelerated demand from European nations for vehicles and upgrades in our Sweden- based business. In recent years, Hägglunds has secured notable awards including winning Slovakia’s Infantry Fighting Vehicle competition with the CV90, the Czech Republic contract for CV90s in seven variants, a three-nation joint procurement for BvS10s for Sweden, Germany and the UK, and the US Army’s competition forits Cold Weather All-Terrain Vehicle programme with Beowulf. To deliver profitable growth while meeting this surge in demand, the Hägglunds team is maintaining focus on operational excellence. We are optimising our own manufacturing capabilities and skilled workforce, while striking the right sourcing balance through robust industrial co-operation and partnering to grow smartly, build strong margin performance, and ramp operations to fulfil our customer commitments. New Glasgow ship build hall We have started construction on a new ship build hall in Glasgow, Scotland, which will enable us to build two Royal Navy warships under cover simultaneously. The new facility, together with a new Applied Shipbuilding Academy, is part of a £300m investment programme which will transform the way we design and build warships on the River Clyde and create more capacity for potentialfuture contracts. Designed to accommodate up to 500 workers per shift, the new ship build hall will improve working conditions for our colleagues and help ensure adverse weather conditions do not impact our shipbuilding operations. It will also enable a greater level of equipment outfit, before eachship moves to the dry dock for testing, commissioning and acceptance, and will support a quicker delivery of the Type 26 frigates to the Royal Navy. Azalea™ We are developing our first multi-sensor satellite cluster which isdesigned to operate in Low Earth Orbit to deliver high-quality information and intelligence in real time from space to defence customers. Known as Azalea ™ , the group of satellites will use arange of sensors to collect visual, radar and radio frequency data, which will be analysed by on-board machine learning on-edge processors to deliver intelligence securely from orbit. TheAzalea ™ cluster is designed to deliver timely, actionable intelligence for military operations and disaster response. Unlike conventional, single-purpose satellites, the cluster is designed tobe reconfigured while in orbit; this is designed to enable it to deliver future customer missions and to extend the lifecycle of thesatellites. The programme is well positioned to support the UKGovernment’s Defence Space Strategy, which named Earth observation as a priority area to help protect and defend UK interests, a sovereign capability which Azalea ™ could provide. Drive operational excellence Continuously improve competitiveness and efficiency Advance and further leverage ourtechnology 13 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategic report Financial statements Additional informationGovernance Our unique strengths and resources provide opportunities to create sustainable value for our stakeholders. Our business model Our people Our culture values inclusion and diversity andrewards integrity and merit so that everyone can fulfiltheir potential. We are committed tonurturing talent and developing highly-skilled people. We are training the nextgeneration of employees and business leaders to be able to drive innovation and solve complex challenges. Our technology We focus on technology innovation and engineering excellence, prioritising and investing in next-generation R&D programmes to deliver competitive solutions to meet our customers’ needs, now and in the future. The core activities we undertake to create value for stakeholders Our activities are undertaken with a clear, consistent and careful capital allocation. – We have established positions onlong-term programmes – We build strong and collaborative relationships with our customers – Our position as a trusted supplier allows us to identify emerging trends and opportunities for growth Identifying customerneeds – Technology and innovation underpin our strategy and the development ofour products and services – We partner with academic and industrial leaders todevelop new technologies that support our future product strategies – We have a clear focus for our R&D spend, and that ofour customers, aligned to future product and servicesstrategies Research & development – We focus on value for our customers while effectively managing risk – We maintain a record of delivery oncomplex projects – We develop partnerships with anetwork of suppliers supporting economic prosperity and development Bidding and contracting The value we create Through careful long-term sustainable management and governance of our business wewillcontinue to create value for our stakeholders. Customers Our largest customers are governments, butwe also sell to commercial businesses and other large prime contractors. We never lose sight of the users of our products and services and the critical work they do to keep us safe. We take on and solve some oftheir most complex and challenging engineering and technology projects to givethem a competitive edge and help them to protect what matters most. Money spent on R&D £2.3bn (2022: £2.0bn) Apprentices and graduates across the Group 5,500 (2022: 4,500) Environment We acknowledge the significant and lasting impacts of climate change. Our goal is to carry out a long-term strategy to reduce theimpact of our activities, supply chain and products on the climate by using our world-class engineering capabilities and cutting-edge technologies. We continue tomake progress on our target of achieving net zero greenhouse gas (GHG) emissions (Scope 1 and 2) across our operations by2030. Employees We support high-value jobs in our business and in our supply chains. This includes direct employment as well as indirect employment in our supply chain and jobs supported by theconsumer spending of our employees and supply chain. Communities We contribute to the economic prosperity ofthe places where our people live and work. In addition to the high-value jobs wesustain, supporting the communities inwhich we operate and causes that have meaning to our business is vitally important to us and our employees. 14 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategy and performance Responsible operations andsocialimpact We take pride in managing our operations responsibly and our ambition is to have a responsible and sustainable supply chain across our global business. We cannot achieve this alone, therefore it is important that we collaborate and partner with suppliers to make a positive business impact. This is essential to achieving our target of netzero GHG emissions (Scope 1 and 2) across our operations by 2030. Our governance framework We are accountable for all that we do and our robust governance framework sets out how we do business. Together with our Codeof Conduct, which requires our employees to conduct business in an ethical way, it enables us to earn and maintain the trust of our stakeholders. Our partners and key relationships We recognise the important contribution provided by our suppliers and partners andwe maintain close relationships with them to help us create best-in-class, cost-effective products and services. – Weprovide engineering expertise indeveloping cutting-edge productsand services – Working with our customers, we develop products designed to minimise environmental impacts during service and at end of life – Our products are designed and developed in a way that provides forfuture flexibility with the ability toupgrade in an agile manner Design and developing – We focus on operational excellence with safety as a priority – We continuously invest in advanced manufacturing techniques andfacilities – We manage complex projects andcollaborations across global supply chains Advanced manufacturing, commissioning and integration – We provide competitive services that add value for our customers – We develop technical expertise, which is acquired through product design and development – We use flexibility and responsiveness to maximise availability of our customers’ products Services, sustainment and upgrade Reduction in GHG emissions (Scope 1 and 2) -11.0% (2022: –9.6%) Total contributed to local, national and international causes 2 £11.3m (2022: £11.5m) Investors We have a strong track record of delivering financial returns for investors and, through thecareful long-term sustainable management and governance of our business, we are wellplaced to continue to generate good returns. Total shareholder returns 1 £1,145m£1,145m £2,735m£1,590m £4,153m£1,418m2023 2022 2021 Dividends Value of shares repurchased Cumulative Our investment proposition Page 16 2. The full value of our contribution to communities for 2023 was £11,267,109 (2022 £11,504,152). Deloitte has provided independent limited assurance in accordance with the International Standard for Assurance Engagements 3000 (ISAE 3000) and Assurance Engagements on Greenhouse Gas Statements (ISAE 3410) issued by the International Auditing and Assurance Standards Board (IAASB). Deloitte’s full unqualified assurance opinion, which includes details of the selected metrics assured, can be found at baesystems.com/annual-report. 1. This excludes the increase in value of shares. See calculation on page 32. 15 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategic report Financial statements Additional informationGovernance 3 We have a growing global opportunity pipeline. Our diverse geographic footprintsupports us in pursuingexcellent opportunitiesacross all sectors ascountries around theworld face up to the multi-faceted threat environment. Read more on Page 17 7 We operate a value- enhancing operating model, undertaking our core business activities with a clear, consistent and careful capital allocation. We focus on careful long-term sustainable management and governance of our business, to deliver value for all our stakeholders. We are poised for further top-line growth and profitability based on robust end markets, the value drivers of our operating model, and the strategic actions we are taking, presenting a compelling investment case for current and prospective investors. Our investment proposition Earnings per share Investment in the business Cash conversion andoperating profit Revenue growth Shareholder returns Our seven key advantages help deliver our sustainable value-compounding model: Supported by our seven key advantages: 1 We provide customers with world-class defence capabilities across multiple domains. Electronic warfare Combat air Combat vehicles Undersea warfare Cyber Naval ships Multi- domain Space 2 We undertake multi-decade programmes with long-term embedded value. Our contract order backlog provides a high level ofsales visibility, driven bymulti-year programmes. Read more on Page 10 4 We foster a high- performance,innovative cultureand consistently investinR&D to build on existingworld-leading capabilities andgenerate newinnovative and disruptivetechnologies. Read more on Page 20 6 Sustainability is fundamental toour business performance andwe have a strong, progressive environmental, social and governance (ESG) agenda. It isembedded into ourstrategicframework and underpins our purpose. Read more on Page 46 5 We have an intense focus on operational excellence, with strong, consistent programme performance. We are focused onoperational efficiencies to expand margins and create value for our investors and customers. Read more on Page 28 Read more on Page 4 Earnings compounder 16 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategy and performance Balance Sheet strength Maintain flexibility in how and when we apply our capital allocation policy to ensure operational flexibility. Maintain our investment grade ratings. Our diverse geographic footprint: Our clear, consistent and careful capital allocation policy: Increasing R&D Invest in research, design and development activities to create advanced technologies and new capabilities that support our customers’ requirements. CAPEX to drive growth Invest in new facilities to provide world-class work environments that support innovation, production andteamwork to enable usto deliver cutting-edge technologies to our customers. Investment in our people Support high-value jobs in our business and across our supply chain. Leading to higher andsustained cash conversion Our free cash flow for 2023 was £2,593m (2022 £1,950m). Our forecast free cash flow for the three years to 2026 is guided to be greater than £5bn. Read more on Page 31 Dividends 30.0p dividendpershare for2023 1 We plan to pay dividends in line withour policy of long-term sustainable cover of around two times underlying earnings. Share buyback £0.6bn worth ofshares repurchased in 2023 Announced a further up to £1.5bn share buyback programme in August 2023, tocommence after completion of the upto £1.5bn share buyback programme announced in July2022. M&A Acquisition of BallAerospace Pipeline of technology- focused bolt-on opportunities. Read more on Page 9 UK 26% sales – Astute and Dreadnought submarine build – SSN-AUKUS submarine design and future build – Naval ship build and support – Typhoon build and support – F-35 (aft fuselage) and support – GCAP/ Tempest – Digital Intelligence – Munitions US 42% sales – Electronic warfare – Precision strike – C4ISR – Intelligence & security – Combat vehicles – US ship repair – Munitions – Space Middle East 15% sales – Kingdom of Saudi Arabiasupport – Qatar Typhoon and Hawk – Kuwait and Oman Europe and other international 13% sales – Eurofighter – MBDA – Hägglunds/Bofors (CV90, BvS10, ARCHER) – US Foreign Military Sales Japan – GCAP – US Foreign Military Sales Australia 4% sales – Hunter Class Frigates – SSN-AUKUS – Naval support – Air support (Hawk, F-35) – C4ISR 1. Total dividend for the year comprises the interim dividend of 11.5p and final dividend of 18.5p. 17 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategic report Financial statements Additional informationGovernance BAE Systems maintains leading positions in major defence and security markets around the world – in the US, UK, Europe, Middle East and Asia Pacific. We are not only one of the world’s largest defence and security companies, but are one of the most geographically diverse, providing us with a competitive advantage. Our markets BAE Systems’ global defence market position Top ten global defence contractors’ revenue ($bn) 1. Lockheed Martin 2. RTX 3. Northrup Grumman 4. Aviation Industry Corporation of China 5. Boeing 6. General Dynamics 7. BAE Systems 8. China North Industries Group Corporation Limited 9. L3Harris Technologies 10. China South Industries Group Corporation Limited 63 40 32 31 31 30 25 18 14 13 Source: Defense News Top 100 for 2023 (based on 2022 numbers). Exchange rate applied to BAE Systems is $1.24/£1. Supporting our customers’ evolvingneeds Our strategy, as shown on page 12, is focused onproviding a vital advantage to our customers around the world through advanced technologies, innovation and agility, global industrial capacity, and responsiveness. In particular, we have built strong positions aligned with our core defence platforms to support our customers in our principal markets who have shown a significant and sustained commitment to their defence and security, and support for their allies. We have established strong and enduring relationships inthese markets and are recognised as playing akey role in the industrial capability of each ofthese countries. Our unique global position andcapabilities We have a strong position in the US through the Special Security Agreement and are the leading defence contractor in the UK and Australia. InEurope, we have a considerable presence through our Swedish combat vehicle and artillery business, our role on Eurofighter, our 37.5% shareholding in MBDA and our content on US foreign military sales. We have a long-established position in the Middle East, and through GCAP weare forging strong links with Japan. In addition, our diverse portfolio of capabilities inthe air, sea, land, cyber and space domains provides us with a comprehensive offering for ourcustomers around the world, making us oneof the broadest and most geographically diverse major defence companies. Our market positions and discriminating capabilities are aligned with enduring globaldefence priorities, to include our customers’requirements to operate in jointall-domainenvironments. Programme diversity and longevity The Group’s wide diversity of capabilities, products and programmes means we are notheavily reliant on a small number ofkey programmes or franchises. Additionally, our order backlog of £69.8bn includes major programmes that are well positioned to extend beyond their current funded backlog for many years, and in some cases, multiple decades. Response to increasing threatenvironment Our business continues to evolve and respond tothe geopolitical and technological trends shaping our customers’ defence andsecurity priorities now and in the future. Ourdemonstrated excellence in complex engineering, developing cutting-edge technologies and seeking innovative solutions enables us torespond to requirements for greateragility, global reach, and advanced technology products and services. Growth aspirations In response to significantly elevated global tensions and the acute threat environment, manycountries around the world continue to announce defence and security budget increases. The need to re-stock and upgrade equipment ishighly relevant to our portfolio and presents opportunities around the world. Factors likely to impact futureperformance Business risks facing the Group are reported in theprincipal risks section of this report (pages 70to 77). In relation to our market positions and future performance, the major risks would bein relation to political changes in alliances, defence spending outlook and defence export control regimes. At the operational level, performance of products and services and adherence to delivery schedules could impact ourmarket positions with customers and competitor pricing or new entrants could alsohave an impact. 18 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategy and performance Value of the top global defence markets accessible for business by the Group US and Canada Existing programmes Opportunities $848bn defence market The US continues to be the single largest defence market in the world. We are a top ten defence prime contractor in the US, and in Canada we have a long history of supporting the Canadian Armed Forces. – Electronic warfare – Precision strike – C4ISR – Intelligence & security – Combat vehicles – US ship repair – Munitions – Space – Canadian Surface Combatant – Precision munitions – Combat vehicles – Munitions restocking – Electrification – ground andair – Space, autonomy andcyber – US Foreign Military Sales – Maritime support UK $68bn defence market As the largest defence company inthe UK, we have strong and enduring relationships with theUKMinistry of Defence andourdomestic supply chains. – Astute and Dreadnought submarine build – SSN-AUKUS submarine design andfuture build – Naval ship build and support – Typhoon build and support – F-35 (aft fuselage) and support – GCAP/Tempest – Digital Intelligence – Munitions – MBDA – Domestic and exportpartnerships – Space, autonomy andcyber – Munitions restocking – Sustainable technologies Europe 1 $330bn defence market In Europe, we are meeting the increased demand for advanced military equipment across all domains, as countries are transitioning away from older- generation systems and recapitalising with modern, moreadvanced air-, land- and sea-based systems. – Eurofighter – MBDA – Combat vehicles/artillery – CV90,BvS10, ARCHER – US Foreign Military Sales – Precision munitions – GCAP – Combat vehicles/artillery – CV90, BvS10, ARCHER – US Foreign Military Sales – electronic systems – US Foreign Military Sales – combat vehicles/artillery/ precision weapons – MBDA domestic and exports – Eurofighter domestic andexports – Precision munitions Middle East 2 $148bn defence market The Kingdom of Saudi Arabia continues to be a leading military power in the Middle East and oneofthe largest defence marketsglobally. We also continue tosupportother customers in Oman, Kuwaitand Qatar. – Kingdom of Saudi Arabia support – Qatar Typhoon and Hawk – Kuwait and Oman – Typhoon – Support and training – Upgrades and defence infrastructure programmes – Cyber intelligence Asia Pacific 3 $265bn defence market As the largest defence company in Australia, we have a strong presence across all domains and are growing as the country’s defence budget increases. In the wider Asia-Pacific region, we are a supplier to a number of armed forces, both directly and through joint ventures. – Hunter Class Frigate – GCAP – US Foreign Military Sales – Fast jet support – Ship support – C4ISR – SSN-AUKUS – pillar 1 and 2 – GCAP – US Foreign Military Sales – Electronic Systems – US Foreign Military Sales – combat vehicles/artillery/ precision weapons – MBDA exports – Cyber intelligence – Australian defence exports Source: Jane’s Defence Budgets (basedon2023 total defence budgets). 1. Includes NATO countries, Sweden and Ukraine, but excludes UK as shown separately. 2. Includes Egypt, Kuwait, Oman, Qatar, Kingdom of Saudi Arabia and UAE. 3. Includes Australia, India, Indonesia, Japan, Malaysia, New Zealand, Philippines, Singapore, South Korea, Taiwan, Thailand and Vietnam. 19 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategic report Financial statements Additional informationGovernance The speed of change in technology today is greater than ever before. We need to develop our own technologies, leverage our investments and cultivate strategic partnerships with organisations, both inside and beyond the sector, to deliver the most compelling capability to our customers. Our investment in technology Focus areas We align our technology development to key strategic themes, which supports growth in today’s core franchises and tomorrow’s emerging capabilities. Digital integration across military and security domains Integration across land, sea, air, space and cyber domains is becoming essential for military operations, so this is a key pillar ofour current technology plan. While BAESystems has been digitally integrating naval vessels and combat jets for decades, more recently we have started building asuiteof products and services designed attheir core to share data and work seamlessly together. These include uncrewedground, sea and air vehicles, as well as battlefield networks and synthetic environments to share information, assist human decision-making and enable joint command and control. We have taken an open systems approach, using standards-based architecture, modular design and incorporated translation layers atevery boundary within the system. Thisallowscustomers to flexibly deploy our capabilities, making them easier to integrate with existing capabilities and equipment from other suppliers. For example, we have already integrated oursystems with third-party products such asSentinel’s LR70 uncrewed airvehicle anda third party’s fast interceptor boat. Our aim is tohelp our customers achieve integration among their procured products, no matter who supplies them. In 2023, our next-generation battlefield network was selected for the British Army’s Trinity programme, which will replace its existing Falcon network in 2026. Trinity willsignificantly increase the robustness andbandwidth of the network, allowing more data to be transferred and greater control over how individual nodes interact. Itwill enable UK military personnel to interact more effectively with allies when operating asasingle nation or part of an international coalition across multiple battlefield domains. Project OdySSEy – integrated synthetic training Military training is being transformed by integration and synthetic environments. Wehave developed Project OdySSEy, bringing together SMEs and technical experts, such as Bohemia Interactive Simulations, with engineers in our Air sector to deliverasingle synthetic environment enabling military forces inthe air, land, sea, space and cyber domains to train as one. Synthetic training is becoming increasingly important, as the modern battlespace hasevolved to a position where threats are often responded to by multi-nation coalitions and training operations are now largely conducted alongside allies located around the globe. In the real world, such joint training presents an extraordinary logistical challenge, involving more time, resources and high costs as well as environmentally harmful exercises. Leveraging a digital environment provides asecure and sustainable platform for joint training exercises which nations can ‘plug-and-play’ and test the actual tactics they would deploy in a real-life situation. www.baesystems.com/arti cle 20 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategy and performance Artificial Intelligence andautonomy While not a new area for BAE Systems, technological developments and increased computing power have allowed us to apply Artificial Intelligence (AI) in more areas, fromdesign and manufacturing to enabling new levels of autonomy in military platforms and services. We are investing in AI research, both in-house and with our strategic university partners. AtCranfield University, we have contributed to the development of anew course in Applied AI, ensuring it is relevant to the defence and aerospace industry. Through this course and sponsorship of PhD placements atthe university, we are developing systems that can dynamically plot optimal routes for uncrewed vehicles, through complex and changing threat environments. One such example is a project to find safe landing areas for autonomous air vehicles during hazardous search and rescue missions, removing humans from this dangerous task. At Manchester University, our AI data science accelerator is exploring autonomous navigation using a combination of sensors without usingGPS, which can’t always be relied on incontested military environments. We are using data from NASA’s openCAESAR initiative, building models of our complex engineering systems and allowing us to validate that design rules are being followed throughout millions of lines of code. Our battlefield-ready Electronic Warfare (EW) systems are working towards a future with AI, such as in the Eagle Passive Active Warning Survivability System (EPAWSS), which our BAESystems, Inc. team delivers. EPAWSS implements ‘cognitive’ EW to detect, identify, analyse and jam previously unknown threats, something that previous EW systems could not do without returning to base. Cognitive EW is one step closer to integrating AI into anEW system. The Defense Advanced Research Project Agency has also contracted with our USbusiness to develop new technology allowing advanced automated signals processing – vital for navigation, target detection and communication – on much smaller platforms than is currently possible. We use our advanced electronics skills tosignificantly reduce the size, weight andpower requirements for these computation-heavy operations. AI is used to inform the design and development process of the Future Combat Air System. It is also used to support collaborative research and development. Ourintention is to further integrate our digitalengineering data, helping us monitor the entire engineering lifecycle. This will meana change to one part of the design canbe assessed more quickly for any impacton other systems, rather than waiting for a time- and cost-consuming cycle of manual iterations. Autonomous products for air, landand sea In 2023, we unveiled several new productsat the world’s largest defence show, the Defence and Security Equipment International (DSEI) event. Weare designing these products to navigate autonomously as well as operate as part of a multi-domain force. There are clear benefits to uncrewed systems, as they can take on a range of dangerous jobs that would otherwise need to be done bya human. We are actively supporting ongoing work by our customers to establish appropriate principles and policies for the use of autonomous systems in defence, to ensure meaningful and context-appropriate human involvement and compliance with applicable national and international law. www.baesystems.com/arti cle Space In the US, we are developing, manufacturing and deploying state-of-the-art, radiation- hardened circuits to support missions of national importance across defence, space, intelligence, research and commercial applications. In February 2024, we completed our Ball Aerospace acquisition, which will redefine our position in the space domain. Our shared culture of innovation, combined capabilities and diverse portfolios will serve toadvance our growth strategy andenhance our position to address the global trends of an increased focus on the space domain, and rising concerns about global warming and the need for civil space systems to improve our understanding of itsimpacts. In 2022, we announced the intention to launch our first multi-sensing multi-satellite cluster, Azalea ™ . The Azalea ™ cluster will usearange of sensors to collect radar and radio frequency data to deliver high-quality information and intelligence to military customers. Unlike conventional intelligence satellites, Azalea ™ can be reconfigured whilst in orbit; it will also analyse the data it collects on board the satellites in space, sending down a more complete intelligence picture directly to end-users. This will put intelligence in users’ hands much more quickly, since itavoids large volumes of data being downloaded to earth for analysis before use. 21 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategic report Financial statements Additional informationGovernance New autonomous products include: Our investment in technology continued T600 heavy lift uncrewed air system (UAS) BAE Systems and Malloy Aeronautics (which was acquired by the Group on 31 January 2024) have collaborated on demonstrating the heavy lift capability of the T-600 heavy lift UAS and, in 2023, announced that it had successfully carried and released a 200kg inert Sting Ray training variant torpedo during a large NATO exercise, known as REPMUS (Robotic Experimentation and Prototyping with Marine Uncrewed Systems). The success of this sea flight mission atsea demonstrates the potential and versatility of this capability. www.baesystems.com/arti cle The ‘Nautomate ® ’ autonomous control system Nautomate ® is an intelligent autonomous control system for small-and medium-sized surface and sub-sea vessels, as exhibited onathird-party P38 Fast Interceptor Boat at DSEI. Nautomate ® brings smart autonomous platforms and mission controls with theability to host various mission modules, such as a non-lethal arrest system to disable enemy boats. As an example of the utility of this system, a surface platform couldbe tasked to autonomously pursue and disable an enemy craft,allowing human team mates toapproach more cautiously andwith greater advantage. www.baesystems.com/arti cle Advanced manufacturing Engineering and manufacturing is at the heart of what we do, from the size and complexity of nuclear submarines through tosmall uncrewed air vehicles and aircraft components. We are always looking for technologies that can help us be more efficient in manufacturing, as well as in the delivery of tools and techniques to protect the health and safety for our workforce. Inour Air business sector, in the North West of England, we are investing in digitalising thewhole design and production process fornew combat aircraft. We are developing a digital platform to combine our design, manufacturing and support engineering processes to happen simultaneously, rather than concurrently for our future Air products. Thismeans that if a design engineer makes achange in one area, the impact of that change can be assessed immediately across the full engineering lifecycle, rather than waiting for specialist engineers to translate it. We are also researching entirely new techniques with our university partners, such as wire and arc additive manufacturing to create titanium structures that have bespoke mechanical properties. This also has the advantage of significantly reducing wastage during manufacturing, as well as creating components that could not be made any other way. We are planning to use AI in 2024 to improve our manufacturing efficiency. For example, inour Australian shipyard, where we are currently building the Hunter Class frigate, wehave proven the usage of a highly complex simulation to assess more than 17 million ways to build the ship, simulating all identified processes involved down to individual work stations. The success of thissimulation has paved the way to use AIinthe next iteration of the software. M113 Optionally Crewed Combat Vehicles (OCCVs) In 2023, significant progress was made by the Land Autonomy team in BAE Systems Australia. Inpartnership with the Australian Army and academia, the team demonstrated multiple M113 OCCVs operating autonomously moving into critical locations, sweeping and searching an area for targets and executing a logistics mission. The event showcased the maturity of the Trusted Autonomous Ground Vehicle for Electronic Warfare (TAGVIEW) programme, which aims to deliver mission management, sensors and software integration, and allow an autonomous vehicle to manoeuvre independently in an obstacle-filled environment. 22 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategy and performance Sustainability Like our customers, we are committed to reducing the carbon footprint of our own operations and the products we provide. We have included some specific technology examples here and you can find a full overview on page 46. A grand challenge to create more efficient maritimevessels We are working with Strathclyde University and the University ofSouthampton, in the UK, to research how we can improve theenergy efficiency of warships, pull through new technology, and model the through-life costs of carbon, so that we can help customers make more informed decisions about future upgrades. We will also look at sustainable fuels, more efficient engines andAI-controlled support systems. www.baesystems.com/arti cle Collaborating on a newelectricaircraft We are collaborating with Heart Aerospace, a Swedish electric airplane maker, to define the battery system for Heart’s ES-30 regional electric airplane. The battery will be the first of its kind to be integrated into an electric conventional take-off and landing regional aircraft, allowing it to efficiently operate with zero emissionsand low noise. Heart Aerospace chose us for our extensiveexperience in developing batteries for heavy-duty groundapplications, as well asdeveloping safety-critical control systems foraerospace. The ES-30 aircraft will be powered by four electric motors and has an all-electric range of 200 kilometres, an extended reserve hybrid range of 400 kilometres with 30passengers and the ability to fly upto800 kilometres with 25 passengers. www.baesystems.com/arti cle PHASA-35 ® solar powered flight PHASA-35 ® , our High Altitude Pseudo Satellite (HAPS) platform, completed its first stratospheric flight, soaring to more than 66,000 feet before landing successfully. Designed tooperate above the usual weather systems and conventional air traffic, ithas the potential to provide a persistent and stable platform forvarious roles including ultra-long endurance intelligence, surveillance and reconnaissance, as well as security. It also has the potential to be used in the delivery of non-defence services, such as communications networks including 4G and 5G as an alternative to traditional airborne and satellite systems. www.ba esy stems.com/article 23 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategic report Financial statements Additional informationGovernance Understanding and exceeding the expectations of our stakeholders is critical to the long-term sustainability ofour business and the vital role we play in helping our customers to protect people, information and nations. 1. Relates to the UK, Australia and Kingdom of Saudi Arabia businesses. Our stakeholders Stakeholders What’s important to them Why we engage How we engaged in 2023 Our people Employees of BAESystems More information Page 56 – Safety and wellbeing – Career progression, trainingand development – Remuneration, reward andrecognition – Diversity, equity and inclusion (DEI) – How we work together – Business conduct – Decarbonisation programme – Contribution to the communities where wework The safety, wellbeing, skills, capabilities and commitment ofour people are critical to ensuring the long-term sustainability of our business and delivering the innovation needed to solve our customers’ complex challenges. Effective engagement enables our employees to contribute toimproving business performance and helps us tocreate an environment in which everyone is safe, valued and can fulfil their potential. – Surveys and insight sessions – In-person and virtual meetings, briefings, conferences, toolbox talks, safety stand-downs, events and listening forums at all levels – Regular leadership updates through videos and events throughout the year (including in relation to financial and business performance) – Digital channels including our Employee App, intranet, email and TV systems – Engagement forums with trades unions in Australia andthe UK and labour unions in the US – Launched a renewed employee resource group (ERG) framework, including a series of inclusion events throughout the year Our customers andend-users Governments and their procurement bodies, largeprimecontractors andcommercial businesses The people who use our productsand services, often members of the armed forces andsecurity services More information Page 20 – Value for money – Trust – Quality of our products andservices – Risk management – Timely delivery – Safety and wellbeing – Supporting operational capability and operability – Reducing product GHGemissions¹ – Reliability of our teams torectify issues quickly Understanding our customers’ needsand challenges is centralto our strategy and howand where we invest in technologies and infrastructure. Our end-users protect people, information, infrastructure andnations. Delivering on ourcustomer commitments iscritical to our mission to protect those who protect usand drives our focus on operational excellence. – Participated in major events including the DSEI exhibition in the UK and the Association of the United States Army exposition in the US – International summits, like the Shangri-La Dialogue (Singapore), provided strategic access to key customers and stakeholders – Bespoke technology event series launched providing anopportunity to engage customers around evolving capability requirements – Customer meetings, programme reviews, site visits andprogramme milestone events – Close working with end-users at customer facilities, bases and sites – Regular dialogue with senior military leaders as well as senior ministers and political officials in our key markets Our suppliers The companies we work withtodeliver products and services toourcustomers More information Page 65 – Labour and skills requirements – Cost of materials andoperations – Terms of trade – Timely payment – Sustainable sourcing – Supply chain resilience andcontinuity of supply – GHG emissions and decarbonisation agenda¹ Our suppliers and an effective, efficientand sustainable supply chain are essential to enable usto deliver forour customers and end-users. Engaged suppliers perform atamuch higher level, knowingthey are regarded asvalued partners and critical tomutual success. – Direct engagement with our suppliers, including at majortrade exhibitions and industry conferences such asDSEI, DPRE and JOSCAR Live in the UK and a bespoke supply chain event in Australia – This enabled us to maintain close relationships to help ensure continuity of supply, more proactively mitigate supply chain disruptions arising from global events and support our suppliers by providing extended demand visibility and expertise to find mutual solutions to identified supply challenges – We shared our expectations on the topic of sustainability with our suppliers Our partners Other industry companies, trade bodies or academic institutions with whom we work More information Page 15 – R&D investment – Product and service development – Collaboration on low- emission products – Developing common standards, including and approach to reduce industry GHG emissions¹ – Access to market and customer opportunities – Sharing best practices and common standards, including on ESG issues We benefit from collaborating with others toaddress industry-wide challenges and develop technologies, products and services for our customers. – Extensive engagement with university partners in Australia and the UK, including joint research projects, hackathons and an annual PhD conference – Funding of projects at UK catapult centres to facilitate R&Dcollaboration with industry, government scientists and academia – Maintained regular dialogue with industry partners, think tanks, trade bodies and customers around challenges that require a multi-partner approach, including evolving global events, multi-domain integration, resilient use of space for intelligence andcommunications, and sustainability 24 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategy and performance Stakeholders What’s important to them Why we engage How we engaged in 2023 Our investors Investors who provide capital tothebusiness More information Page 16 – Profitability, growth potential and cash generation – Capital allocation and shareholder returns – Operational performance – Quality of management – ESGconsiderations – Share price performance A strong investor base and continued access to capital is critical to the long-term success of the Group. It is important toensure the owners of our shares and potential investors have a full understanding of our business, including the strategy, growth potential andrisks as well as the overall performance of the business inorder to make informed investment decisions. – Comprehensive investor programme comprising a mixture of in-person and virtual engagements in the UK,US and other key international markets – Engagements included management and Investor Relations meetings, attendance at investor conferences, bank-led Q&A sessions and major trade shows, includingDSEI, the Paris Airshow and the Indo-Pacific Maritime Exposition – Held a capital markets event at our Hägglunds businessin Sweden and launched a virtual technology event series – Revamped investor pages on the BAE Systems website tomake information more easily accessible Our communities The people who live where weworkand charitable organisations we support More information Page 56 – Employment and economiccontribution – Education outreach and skills development, especially for young people – Community engagement and delivering meaningful local impact – Support for our armed forces’ communities, including veterans and military families We are committed to the communities in which we operate. In many locations where we have major sites weare one of the largest employers in the area and have a responsibility to support the local communities where our people live and work both economically and socially. As a leading defence and security company, we are dedicated to supporting members of our armed forces’ communities and strengthening the STEM pipeline. – Commissioned an independent report into our annual contribution to the UK economy – Extensive education outreach programme, including science, technology, engineering and mathematics (STEM) ambassadors in key markets, school roadshows inthe UK and sponsorship of the international FIRST Championship in the US – Continued support for local communities through sponsorships, donations and employee volunteering, including a local community hub supporting charities and voluntary organisations in the South of England andBeacon summer camps for disadvantaged children in Australia – Sustained partnerships with armed forces charities, including Legacy’s centenary torch relay in Australia andRoyal British Legion’s Poppy Appeal in the UK Our regulators Governmental bodies thatoverseeindustry orbusinessactivities More information Page 62 – Relevant laws andregulations – Appropriate compliance programmes We maintain constructive dialogue and relationships withthose who oversee the regulations which can impact our business. – Open and constructive engagement with various regulators, including meetings and discussions with UK,US and Australian regulators in support of efforts todrive efficient compliance, improve bilateral and multilateral defence trade co-operation and support ourlicensing strategy – Participation in industry association initiatives to work with regulators to the same end – Regulator participation in our internal training events and conferences, and support from us as speakers orparticipants at external conferences and engagementevents Our pension schememembers Members and trustees ofourpensionschemes More information Page 91 – Member benefits – Pension scheme fundingposition and investmentstrategy – Group performance We are committed to fulfilling our obligations to current andformer employees in our pension schemes. Our Trustees engage with scheme members regularly to ensure they are informed about how we continue to do so and ensurethat they have access toall the information they needto manage their pensionarrangements. – Continued to engage with our UK members via dedicated pensions websites, ensuring they have access to key scheme documents and pensions information – Newsletter made available to all members to keep themupdated andengaged in their pension planning – Consultations in 2023 with members of our schemes with defined contribution benefits which resulted in achange in provider for their pension provisions We also engage with other non-profit organisations and public interest groups who have a focus on business or defence and security issues to address factors that can impact ourbusiness and how we operate. Section 172 statement For the year ended 31 December 2023, in accordance with the requirements of Section 172(1) of the Companies Act 2006, the directors consider that they have acted in good faith and in a manner most likely to promote the success of the Company for the benefit of its members as a whole, having regard to stakeholders and other certain factors, including standards of business conduct and the impact ofitsoperations on the environment and local communities. More information in support of this statement, including key matters considered and decisions made by the Board during 2023 Page 91 25 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategic report Financial statements Additional informationGovernance Our KPIs are aligned to business strategy and are used toactively monitor performance. Key performance indicators Links to executive remuneration Executive directors’ annual and long-term incentives are assessed using a combination of the Group’s main performance indicators and other objectives designed to meet the Group’s strategy. Metrics, which are both financial and non-financial, as well as the achievement of personal objectives for annual remuneration, are determined and weighted according to business priorities and maybe structured as targets to be achieved, or underpins which, if not achieved, would reduce payouts. 75% of annual incentive targets relate to financial metrics aligned with long-term earnings and cash targets. The non-financial element is based on a combination of personal performance objectives that provide a clear line of sight to our strategic objectives including those in relation to ESG, safety measures and DEI. Remuneration report Page 107 Links to strategy Financial 1 Sales 1 3 5 Purpose Enables management to monitor the revenue of both the Group’s own subsidiaries as well as recognising the strategic importance in its industry of itsequity accounted investments, to ensure programme performanceis understood andinline with expectations. 2023 £25,284m 2022 £23,256m 2021 £21,310m Progress in 2023 Sales increased 9%, on a constant currency basis,with all our operating segments seeing anincrease in sales in the year. For more details onsegmental performance see pages 35 to 45. Underlying EBIT 3 5 Purpose Provides a measure of operating profitability, excluding one-off events or adjusting items that arenot considered to be part oftheongoing operational transactions of the business, to enable management to monitor the performance of recurring operations over time, and which iscomparable across the Group. 2023 £2,682m 2022 £2,479m 2021 £2,205m Progress in 2023 Underlying EBIT increased 9%, on a constant currency basis. We saw increases across all operating segments, with the exception of Cyber&Intelligence which decreased, as expected, asa result of the additional investments being made in the business around space and multi- domain networking. Underlying EPS 3 5 Purpose Provides a measure of the Group’s underlying performance, which enables management to compare the profitability of the Group’s recurring operations over time. 2023 63.2p 2022 55.5p 2021 47.8p 2 Progress in 2023 Underlying EPS increased 14%, on a constant currency basis. The main driver behind the increase in the year was the increase in underlying EBIT combined with the effect of share repurchases. Formore detail on the movement in underlying EPSin the year see page 30. 1 Sustain and grow our defencebusiness 2 Continue to grow our business inadjacentmarkets 3 Develop and expand our international business 4 Inspire and develop adiverse workforce to drive success 5 Enhance financial performance and deliver sustainable growth inshareholder value 6 Advance and integrate our sustainability agenda Our financial review Page 28 26 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategy and performance Non-financial Recordable accident rate (per 100,000 employees) 4 6 Purpose We are committed to continuouslyimproving health andsafety standards across the business. Our accident rate is usedto assess workplace safety improvements and ensure our safety efforts are aligned to theworking environment. 2023 424 2022 485 2021 496 Progress in 2023 The overall safety performance of our operations improved with our recordable accident rate reducing by 12.6%. The majority of this improvement related to a reduction in recordable injuries within our US business. However, the number of major injuries, our measure of severity, increased by 25%, from 32 to 40 during 2023. Thiswas most marked within our Maritime sector. To address this we have reviewed the controls around our significant safety risks. Percentage change in Scope 1 and 2 GHG emissions 1 6 Purpose Our roadmap to support our targetof achieving net zero GHGemissions (Scope 1 and 2) across our operations by 2030 isunderpinned by an annual targettoreduce operational GHGemissions by 4.2%. 2023 –11.0% 2022 –9.6% 2021 –4.5% Progress in 2023 In support of our ambition to have net zero GHG emissions (Scope 1 and 2) across our operations by 2030, global GHG emissions have reduced 11.0% during the year. Scope 1 emissions have fallen 5.1%, while scope 2 emissions have fallen 13.4%. This was driven by a reduction in electricity and gasconsumption asa result of factors such as production variances, efficiency improvements andoperational controlchanges. Free cash flow 1 5 Purpose Provides a measure of cash generated by the Group’s operations after servicing debt andtax obligations, available foruse in line with the Group’s capital allocation policy. 2023 £2,593m 2022 £1,950m 2021 £1,864m Progress in 2023 Free cash flow increased by £643m, driven by thestrong order flow in the year which generated anumber of advanced customer payments. Order intake 1 2 3 Purpose Allows management to monitor the order intake of the Group’s own subsidiaries, as well as its strategically important equity accounted investments, providinginsight into future years’sales performance. 2023 £37.7bn 2022 £37.1bn 2021 £21.5bn Progress in 2023 Order intake remained strong in 2023, and was £0.6bn higher than 2022. Order intake across theAir and Maritime segments accounted for over50% of order intake for the year, reflecting anumber of significant awards from the UKMinistry of Defence for SSN-AUKUS and Dreadnought (Delivery Phase 3), as well as therenewal of Salam Typhoon support for theSaudi Arabian Government. Read more onorder intake for the year on page 31. Net debt (excluding lease liabilities) 1 3 5 Purpose Allows management to monitor indebtedness of the Group, toensure the Group’s capital structure is appropriate and capitalallocation policy decisions are suitably informed. 2023 £(1,022)m 2022 £(2,023)m 2021 £(2,160)m Progress in 2023 During the year, net debt (excluding lease liabilities)has reduced by £1,001m to £1,022m. Thekey driver behind this was the increased freecashflow, resulting in cash of £4,067m (2022£3,107m) at 31 December 2023. 1. The definition and purpose of all performance measures defined by the Group is provided in the Alternative performance measures section on page 227. 2. For 2021, underlying EPS was 50.7p including a one-off tax benefit of £94m resulting from agreements reached regarding the exposure arising from the April 2019 European Commission decision regarding the UK’s Controlled Foreign Company Regime and the impact of the UK tax rate adjustment. Our sustainability agenda Page 46 27 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategic report Financial statements Additional informationGovernance Our financial review Full-year performance summary Strong demand has resulted in a record order intake of £37.7bn, pushing our order backlog to £69.8bn. On a constant currency basis, we delivered sales growth of 9%, surpassing our guidance expectations, with all sectors delivering above the expected ranges. A key feature of sales growth was the acceleration of activities on Dreadnought, which accounted for around aquarter of the overall Group growth in the year, and contributed to a 22% increase in Maritime sector sales. Our profitability, in the form of underlying EBIT, rose by 9% on a constant currency basis, to just under £2.7bn. Margins were steady as improvements in the Air sector and our Platforms & Services business offset the margin headwind presented by the higher submarines activity which trades at a regulated profit. Underlying EPS grew by 14% as the increase in underlying EBIT was further complemented by higher interest income and the impact of the ongoing share buyback programme. We had high cash conversion of our underlying EBIT to free cash flow of £2.6bn, driven by increased profitability and a net increase in customer advances of c.£1bn. Wecontinued to invest in the business, as capex exceeded depreciation by c.£0.3bn. We continued to follow our disciplined capital allocation policy and returned £1.4bn to shareholders through dividends and the ongoing share buyback programme. We have announced another increase in our dividend taking it to 30.0p for 2023, marking our 20th year in a row of increased dividends. 2024 Group guidance¹ The Group guidance for the year incorporates the acquisition of BallAerospace and the reduction in the Group’s shareholding in Air Astana following its initial public offering, which both completed in February 2024. Sales for the Group are expected to increase between 10% to 12%. Underlying EBIT is expected to improve by 11% to 13%. We expect underlying EPS to increase 6% to8%, largely as a result of the higher interest expense, following the Ball Aerospace acquisition, and an increased UK corporation taxrate. Free cash flow in 2024 is expected to be greater than £1.3bn as cash advances received in 2023 will start to unwind. Group guidance can be found on page 34. We have delivered strong financial performance withtop-line growth, margin expansion and high cashconversion. Our record order intake of £38bn increases our order backlog to £70bn, positioning uswellfor the future. In a time of ever-growing geopolitical tension, our teams have delivered at record levels to protect those who protect all of us. Across the board, our financial metrics show the results of their hard work. Brad Greve Chief Financial Officer 2023 full-year performance againstguidance Sales growth 5% 7% 9% Underlying EBIT 6% 8% 9% Underlying EPS 10% 12% 14% Free cash flow >£1,800m £2,593m 2023 guidance range Compared to guidance provided at the Half-year Results in August 2023, atan exchange rate of $1.24:£1 1. While the Group is subject to geopolitical and otheruncertainties, the following guidance is provided on current expected operational performance. Our guidance uses the same exchangerate we averaged in 2023 of $1.24:£1. 28 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategy and performance Group income statement Sales for the year were £25.3bn (2022£23.3bn) representing growth, onaconstantcurrency basis 1 , of 9% with allsectors delivering growth in the year. Maritime recorded sales of £5.5bn (2022 £4.6bn) which was an increase of 22%, onaconstantcurrency basis, and accounted fornearly 47% of the overall Group’s sales growth; submarines activity accounted for around 25%. Electronic Systems recorded sales of £5.5bn (2022 £5.1bn) equating to growth of 9%, ona constant currency basis. This was led bycontinued recovery in the commercial business across both civil aviation and power and propulsion, along with gains in electronic combat systems. Our Platforms & Services sector posted sales of £3.9bn (2022 £3.7bn), with growth of 8% on a constant currency basis. Our Hägglunds business accounted for almost two thirds of the sector’s growth. Across the Platforms & Services portfolio, nearly 600 vehicles were delivered in the year. TheAir sector recorded sales of £8.1bn (2022£7.7bn), representing growth of 4% ona constant currency basis. Thesector saw increased activity in MBDA and higher air support volumes, while the future combat airprogramme continued to gain pace with activity more than doubling in 2023. Sales in the Cyber & Intelligence sector grew to£2.3bn (2022 £2.2bn), an increase of 6%on a constant currency basis. Growth was 9%, on a constant currency basis, after adjusting for the impact of the disposal ofthefinancial crime detection business in 2022. TheUS Intelligence & Security business grew10%, primarily as a result of increased classified, sustainment and systems integration work, while outside the US we saw a sharp increase inNational Security cyber sales. Revenue was £23.1bn (2022 £21.3bn), with growth during the year of 9%, on a reported currency basis, reflective of the same drivers behind the increase in sales for the year excluding the impact of MBDA in Air. Underlying EBIT was up 9% to £2,682m (2022 £2,479m), on a constant currency basis. The Maritime sector reported underlying EBIT of £425m (2022 £356m) following a year of strong sales growth, withmargins reflecting the regulated profit environment on the Dreadnought programme. Our Electronic Systems sector grew underlying EBIT to £878m (2022 £838m), anincrease of 5% on a constant currency basis. Margin of 16.1% was within the guidance range and reflected lower pension recoveries in the US, marginally offset by an increase in higher margin commercial activity. Platforms & Services reported underlying EBITof £354m (2022 £326m), with margins increasing to 9.0%. The growth reflected thestrong operational performance in our Hägglunds and Ship Repair businesses in theyear. Our Air sector reported underlying EBIT of£949m (2022 £849m), increasing margin to 11.8%. The growth inthe year reflected thehigher sales and riskretirement. Finally, Cyber & Intelligence reported underlying EBIT of £199m (2022 £232m), adecrease of 14% on a constant currency basis. Margin of 8.6% was in the guided range and represented additional investment in the business in space and multi-domain networking. Operating profit increased 8%, to £2,573m (2022 £2,384m), on a reported currency basis. On an operating sector basis this reflected the same drivers as underlying EBIT. Other differences are discussed below (also see the reconciliation of underlying EBITto operating profit on page 227). Underlying net finance costs were £211m (2022 £246m), a decrease of £35m. Of this, costs of £231m (2022 £230m) related to the Group and income of £20m (2022 costs of £16m) related to the Group’s share of equity accounted investments. The improvement in underlying net finance costs largely reflected the increase in interest rates applied to surplus cash during the year. Financial performance measures as defined by the Group 2 2023 £m 2022 £m Sales KPI 25,284 23,256 Return on sales 10.6% 10.7% Underlying EBIT KPI 2,682 2,479 Underlying net finance costs (211) (246) Underlying tax expense (472) (422) Underlying profit for the year 1,999 1,811 Attributable to: Non-controlling interests 83 83 Equity shareholders 1,916 1,728 Financial performance measures as defined by IFRS 2023 £m 2022 £m Revenue 23,078 21,258 Return on revenue 11.1% 11. 2% Operating profit 2,573 2,384 Net finance costs (247) (395) Tax expense (386) (315) Profit for the year 1,940 1,674 Attributable to: Non-controlling interests 83 83 Equity shareholders 1,857 1,591 This has been delivered by focusing on: • strong operational performance allowing for risk retirement; • effective supply chain management; • proactive portfolio actions; and • business efficiency initiatives. Return on sales 2023 10.6% 2022 10.7% 2021 10.3% 1. Current year compared with prior year translated at current year exchange rates. The comparatives have not been restated, 2. The definitions and purpose of all performance measured defined by the Group is provided in the Alternative performance measures section on page 227. 29 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategic report Financial statements Additional informationGovernance Our financial review continued Adjusting items 2023 £m 2022 £m Profit on business disposal – 94 Acquisition-related costs (20) (16) Gain related to settlements and past service costonpensionschemes 60 13 Adjusting items 40 91 Net finance costs were £247m (2022 £395m), a decrease of £148m. Excluding the £35m improvement in underlying net finance costs, all other net finance costs recorded again of £113m. This was largely the result ofthe £41m interest income on the Group’s pension surplus (2022 cost of £37m on pension deficit position at the start of the year). The balance of the improvement was the result of foreign exchange gains on its USdollar-denominated borrowings, largely being offset by losses on the remeasurement of financial instruments principally held to manage the Group’s exposure to interest ratefluctuations. Underlying EPS increased to 63.2p (2022 55.5p), or 14% on a constant currency basis. This is largely driven by the improved underlying profit for the year as set out on page 29, as well as the benefit from the ongoing share buyback programme which accounted for 1.5p of the increase. Underlying tax expense of £472m (2022£422m), was an increase of £50m reflecting the higher underlying pre-tax profits. Theunderlying effective tax rate was19% (2022 19%). Tax expense of £386m (2022 £315m), was an increase of £71m reflective of the increase in the UK’s corporation tax rate in the year and the Group’s pre-tax profits. Basic EPS increased 20% to 61.3p (202251.1p) also reflective of the increased profitability of the Group for the year andthebenefit of the ongoing share buybackprogramme. Adjusting items in 2023 totalled a net gainof £40m (2022 £91m) mainly comprising afinal settlement gain on a US pension annuity buy-out of £60m. 2022 was mainly comprised of a £94m gain on the disposal ofthe financial crime detection business inDigital Intelligence. Reconciliation of underlying EBIT to operating profit 2023 £m 2022 £m Underlying EBIT KPI 2,682 2,479 Adjusting items 40 91 Amortisation of programme, customer-related and other intangible assets (111) (110) Impairment of intangible assets (5) (1) Net finance income/(costs) and tax expense of equity accounted investments (33) (75) Operating profit 2,573 2,384 Earnings per share (EPS) As defined by the Group 2023 2022 Underlying profit for the year attributable to equity shareholders £1,916m £1,728m Underlying EPS KPI 63.2p 55.5p As defined by IFRS Profit for the year attributable to equity shareholders £1,857m £1,591m Basic EPS 61.3p 51.1p Movement underlying EPS (pence) 55.5 (0.2) 1.5 5.8 0.8 (0.2) 63.2 2022 65 60 55 50 FX Share repurchases Tax Underlying EBIT Underlying net finance costs 2023 30 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategy and performance Free cash flow of £2,593m (2022 £1,950m) was an increase of £643m on the prior year. Operating business cash flow of £3,218m (2022 £2,552m) was an increase of £666m. Net cash flow from operating activities was £3,760m (2022 £2,839m), an increase of£921m. In addition to the increased profitability of the Group, there was a net inflow of c.£1bn from customer advances. Net cash flow from investing activities was an outflow of £541m (2022 £422m). TheGroup received cashin the year of £134m from dividends received from equity accounted investments, offset by an increased cash outflow of £272m in relation to capex investment in property, plant and equipment and intangible assets. This is reflective of theadditional investments within our sites tosupport future programme delivery, such as the shipbuilding facilities in Glasgow to support Type 26 construction, Order intake, at £37.7bn, was up £0.6bn onthe prior year, leading to a record order backlog of £69.8bn. Air recorded the highestorder backlog at 31 December 2023, reflecting significant orders in MBDA and theKingdom of Saudi Arabia during the year.The order backlog in Maritime also remains high reflecting the submarine and ship build programmes. Order intake KPI 20% 2023 £37.7bn 29% 2 7% 6% 18% (2022 £37.1bn) Order backlog 16% 2023 £69.8bn 38% 30% 3% 13% (2022 £58.9bn) Order book 19% 2023 £58.0bn 31% 35% 2% 13% (2022 £48.9bn) munitions sites in both the UKand US and construction of the modern shiplift and land-level repair complex at our Jacksonville, Florida shipyard. Net cash flow from financing activities was an outflow of £2,188m (2022 £2,333m), a decrease of £145m. Cash returns to shareholders, through dividend and share repurchases, decreased £172m to £1,418m. Although dividends increased, the value of share repurchases was lower. This year also saw a cash inflow from draw-down of loans of £162m, from the private placement to fundthe shiplift at our Jacksonville, Florida shipyard. 2022 saw a £400m cash outflow in respect of bond repayments which were due. The net cash outflow in respect of derivative financial instruments was £196m (2022 cash inflow of £328m) reflective of hedging against foreign exchange movements on theUS dollar-denominated borrowings. Details of awards in the year are included inthe segmental reviews on pages 35 to 45, but the three largest orders driving the order intake in the year were: – In Maritime, funding of £3.95bn was awarded by the UK Ministry of Defence for the next phase of the UK’s next-generation nuclear-powered attack submarine programme, SSN-AUKUS. Foreign exchange translation primarily arises in respect of the Group’s US dollar- denominated cash holdings. Cash and cash equivalents of £4,067m (2022 £3,107m) are held primarily for the repayment of debt securities, pension funding when required, payment of the 2023 final dividend, funding of further share repurchases under the up to £1.5bn share buyback programme announced in July 2022 and management of working capital. In completing the $5.5bn (£4.4bn) acquisition ofBall Aerospace on 16 February 2024, theGroup paid $1.5bn (£1.2bn) in cash anddrew down $4.0bn (£3.2bn) of debt funding in settlement of the transaction. – In Maritime, we also secured an order intake of £2.4bn for the continued Delivery Phase 3 activity on the Dreadnought Class submarine programme. – In Air, we renewed the Government-to- Government Typhoon support services in the Kingdom of Saudi Arabia for a further five years through to the end of 2027, valued at £3.7bn. Cash flow As defined by the Group 2023 £m 2022 £m Free cash flow KPI 2,593 1,950 Operating business cash flow 3,218 2,552 As defined by IFRS Net cash flow from operating activities 3,760 2,839 Net cash flow from investing activities (541) (422) Net cash flow from financing activities (2,188) (2,333) Net increase in cash and cash equivalents 1,031 84 Cash and cash equivalents at 1 January 3,107 2,917 Effect of foreign exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents (71) 106 Cash and cash equivalents at 31 December 4,067 3,107 Orders As defined by the Group As defined by IFRS Electronic Systems Platforms & Services Air Maritime Cyber & Intelligence 31 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategic report Financial statements Additional informationGovernance Our financial review continued Net debt (excluding lease liabilities) Components of net debt 2023 £m 2022 £m Cash and cash equivalents 4,067 3,107 Debt-related derivative financial instruments (net) 22 112 Loans – non-current (4,432) (5,189) Loans and overdrafts – current (679) (53) Net debt (excluding lease liabilities) KPI (1,022) (2,023) The Group’s net debt (excluding leaseliabilities) at 31 December 2023 was£(1,022)m,a net decrease of £1,001m from theposition at the start of the year. Thiswasprimarily as a result of strong free cashflowperformance, partially offset byshareholder returns through dividends andshare repurchases. For details of maturity of the Group borrowings see note 21 on page 189. Non-current loans have decreased by £757m during the year as the $800m 3.8% bond due for repayment in 2024 is now classified as a current loan; this movement was partially offset by draw-down of the $200m private placement to fund the Jacksonville, Florida, shiplift which is repayable in 2050. Current loans have increased by £626m during the year reflecting the $800m 3.8% bond maturing in October 2024. Movement in net debt (excluding lease liabilities) (£m) (2,023) 3,218 (625) (1,418) (174) (1,022) 31 December 2022 2,000 1,000 0 – 1,000 – 2,000 Operating business cash flow Interest and tax Shareholder returns Other 31 December 2023 Free cash flow £2,593m Shareholder returns of £1,418m (2022 £1,590m) comprised both dividends of £857m (2022 £802m) and share repurchases of£561m (2022 £788m). Dividends paid represent the 2022 final dividend and the 2023 interim dividend. During 2023, we repurchased 59m shares under the up to£1.5bn share buyback programme announced in July 2022 (2022 107m sharesunder the 2022 and 2021 share buyback programmes). Other movements includes foreign exchange on the Group’s US dollar- denominated cash and borrowings, offset bytheir associated derivatives, and dividends paid to non-controlling interests. 32 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategy and performance Balance sheet 2023 £m 2022 £m Intangible assets 12,099 12,644 Property, plant and equipment, right-of-use assets and investment property 5,003 4,723 Equity accounted investments and other investments 916 886 Working capital (5,468) (4,119) Lease liabilities net of finance lease receivables (1,396) (1,582) Group’s share of IAS 19 post-employment benefits surplus 229 646 Net tax assets and liabilities 474 363 Net other financial assets and liabilities (112) (138) Net debt (excluding lease liabilities) KPI (1,022) (2,023) Net assets 10,723 11,400 Intangible assets of £12.1bn (2022 £12.6bn) was a decrease of £0.5bn on the prior year, driven by the foreign exchange impact of the Group’s US dollar-denominated goodwill. Property, plant and equipment, right- of-use assets and investment property was£5.0bn (2022 £4.7bn), an increase of £0.3bn. Property, plant and equipment increased by a net £0.4bn reflecting capex spend across the business of£0.8bn, offset by depreciation and foreign exchange adjustments. Equity accounted investments and otherinvestments was £916m (2022 £886m). The Group’s share of profits of equity accounted investments during the year, which was offset by dividends paid, resulted ina net gain of £45m at the end ofthe year. Working capital saw a £1.4bn decrease, inaggregate, mainly reflecting an increase inadvanced funding from customers on anumber of contracts. Lease liabilities, net of finance lease receivables, was £1.4bn (2022 £1.6bn) with no new significant lease agreements entered into during the year. The Group’s share of the net IAS 19 post-employment benefits surplus was£0.2bn (2022 £0.6bn), net of a 35% withholding tax of £0.4bn. The decrease inthe net surplus of £0.4bn largely reflects afall in the discount rate applied to the UK schemes at 31 December 2023. Details of the Group’s post-employment benefit schemes are provided in note 24 tothe Consolidated financial statements on page 191. Exchange rates Average 2023 2022 £/$ 1.244 1.236 £/€ 1.150 1.173 £/A$ 1.874 1.778 Year end £/$ 1.275 1.203 £/€ 1.154 1.127 £/A$ 1.868 1.773 33 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategic report Financial statements Additional informationGovernance Guidance for 2024 1 After a strong financial year for 2023, we look forward to continued top-line growth with increased return on sales and good free cash delivery againstour rolling targets. Guidance is provided on the basis of an exchange rate of $1.24:£1, which is in line withthe actual 2023 exchangerate, therefore guidance is the same for both reported and constant exchange rates. The Group guidance for 2024 incorporates the acquisition of Ball Aerospace² and the reduction in the Group’s shareholding in Air Astana following its initial public offering, both of which completed in February 2024. See note 34 on page213. Segmental guidance The following table provides guidance by segment, aligned to the Group guidance. Year ended 31 December 2024 Expected sales Expected Return on sales 4 Electronic Systems³ Up 32% to 34% c.15% Platforms & Services Up 5% to 7% 10% to 11% Air Up 3% to 5% 11% to 12% Maritime Up 6% to 8% c.8% Cyber & Intelligence Up 3% to 5% 8% to 9% In 2024, the HQ reporting segment is expected to be an expense of c.£155m (2022 expense of £123m) reflecting the reduction in the Group’s shareholding in Air Astana in February 2024 (see note 34 on page 213). Three-year free cash flow guidance 5 Actual Forecast 2022 2023 2024 2025 2026 2022–2024 in excess of £5.5bn previously in excess of £5bn £2.0bn £2.6bn >£1.3bn 2023–2025 in excess of £5bn previously £4.5bn – £5.5bn £2.6bn >£1.3bn 2024–2026 in excess of £5bn >£1.3bn 1. While the Group is subject to geopolitical and other uncertainties, the following guidance isprovided on current expected operational performance. The guidance isbasedon the measures used to monitor the underlying financial performance of the Group. See the Alternative performance measures section on page 227. 2. Guidance incorporates the acquisition of Ball Aerospace from the 16 February 2024. 3. The acquired Ball Aerospace business will be reported through the Electronic Systems segment. 4. Underlying EBIT as percentage of Sales. 5. In addition to the free cash flow above, the Group received proceeds of c.£0.2bn from the reduction in the Group’s shareholding in AirAstana. The cash flow impact of business acquisitions and disposals is excluded from the Group’s definition of free cash flow. Sensitivity to foreign exchange rates: the Group operates in a number of currencies, the most significant of which is the US dollar. As a guide, a5 cent movement inthe £/$exchange rate will impact Sales by c.£500m, Underlying EBIT by c.£70m and Underlying EPS by c.1.3p. Free cash flow target for 2024 >£1.3bn 2023: £2,593m Underlying EBIT expected to increase in the range of 11% to 13% 2023: £2,682m Underlying EPS expected to increase in the range of 6% to 8% 2023: 63.2p Sales expected to increase in the range of 10% to 12% 2023: £25,284m Underlying finance costs £350m to £375m Non-controlling interests c.£80m Effective tax rate c.21% 34 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategy and performance The Group reports its performance through six reporting segments. Segmental review Financial performance measures defined by the Group 1 Financial performance measures derived from IFRS Year ended 31 December 2023 Sales £m Underlying EBIT £m Return on sales % Operating business cash flow £m Order intake £bn Order backlog £bn Revenue £m Operating profit £m Return on revenue % Net cash flow from operating activities £m Order book £bn KPI KPI KPI Electronic Systems Page 36 5,458 878 16.1 811 6.7 8.9 5,456 806 14.8 961 7.6 Platforms & Services Page 38 3,922 354 9.0 426 7.7 11.5 3,842 373 9.7 624 11.1 Air Page 40 8,058 949 11.8 1,669 11.0 27.2 6,517 948 14.5 1,808 18.5 Maritime Page 42 5,536 425 7.7 291 10.1 21.3 5,391 423 7.8 629 20.4 Cyber & Intelligence Page 44 2,321 199 8.6 204 2.5 2.0 2,321 179 7.7 261 1.4 HQ 2 471 (123) (183) 0.4 – 10 (156) (128) – Deduct Intra-group (482) (0.7) (1.1) (459) (1.0) Deduct Tax 3 (395) Total 25,284 2,682 10.6 3,218 4 37.7 69.8 23,078 2,573 11.1 3,760 58.0 We use financial performance measures as defined by the Group to monitor the underlying financial performance of the Group’s reporting segments. The definitions and purposes of these Alternative performance measures can be found on page 227. Reconciliations from these measures to the financial performance measures derived from IFRS are provided in our Alternative performance measures section on pages 227 to 231. 1. The definition and purpose of all performance measures defined by the Group is provided in the Alternative performance measures section on page 227. 2. HQ comprises the Group’s head office activities, together with a 49% interest in Air Astana as at 31 December 2023. 3. Tax is managed on a Group-wide basis. 4. At a Group level, the key cash flow metric is free cash flow (see Alternative performance measures on page 227). In2023, free cash flow was £2,593m (2022 £1,950m). 35 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategic report Financial statements Additional informationGovernance Electronic Systems, with 17,500 1 employees, comprises the Group’s US-and UK-based electronic solutions, including electronic warfare systems, navigation systems, electro-optical sensors, military and commercial digital engine and flight controls, precision guidance and seeker solutions, next- generation military communications systems and data links, persistent surveillance capabilities, space electronics and electric drive propulsion systems. Electronic Systems Electronic Combat Solutions designs, builds andsupports integrated electronic warfare systems for platform prime and government customers, and is a trusted mission systems provider for all three electronic warfare missions: electronic attack; electronic protection; and electronic support. Countermeasure & Electromagnetic Attack Solutions provides next-generation threat detection, countermeasure and attack solutions that deliver full-spectrum electronic warfare capabilities to enhance mission survivability. Precision Strike & Sensing Solutions designs andmanufactures state-of-the-art systems and technology that enable our customers to execute their precision strike missions. C4ISR Systems provides actionable intelligence through innovative technical solutions for airborne persistent surveillance, secure communications, identification systems, signals intelligence, underwater and surface warfare solutions, and space resiliency. Controls & Avionics Solutions develops and produces electronics for military and commercial aircraft, including fly-by-wire flight controls, fullauthority digital engine controls, power management solutions, cabin management systems and mission computers. Power & Propulsion Solutions delivers propulsionand power management performance with innovative electrification products and solutions that advance vehicle mobility, efficiency and capability. – The Compass Call programme is executing contracts valued at more than $1bn (£0.8bn) focused on the cross-decking of prime mission equipment to the new EA-37B aircraft whilesustaining and upgrading theexisting EC-130H fleet. We successfully delivered the first of ten EA-37B aircraft tothe US Air Force for formal combined developmental and operational testing. Thenext-generation system evolves the Air Force’s electromagnetic attack capabilities and is targeted to initially field in 2024. – Our Eagle Passive Active Warning Survivability System (EPAWSS) programme completed Design Verification and Qualification Testing enabling Initial Operational Test andEvaluation by the US Air Force. – Our Advanced GEOINT Systems team was selected by a customer in the Asia-Pacific region to provide our Geospatial eXploitation Products ™ (GXP ® ) software asa key component of its large-scale Geospatial Intelligence implementation. The delivery of this software, comprised ofadvanced imagery exploitation, analytics, and data fusion software tools, further solidifies our industry-leading position andenables future expansion to allies around the globe. – The Navigation & Sensor Systems team continues to execute a contract with Space Systems Command to develop an M-Code Increment II Miniature Serial Interface GPS receiver for ground embedded applications with next-generation Application Specific Integrated Circuit technology valued at more than $278m (£224m). Strategic and order highlights – In addition to a successful test event, conducted in January 2023, of the Advanced Precision Kill Weapon System (APKWS ® ) that demonstrated new capabilities for critical mission sets in support of US and allied forces, the APKWS ® laser-guidance kit programme continues to execute under an Indefinite Delivery, Indefinite Quantity contract with awards worth $590m (£476m) in 2023, including international orders. – Building on our position in energy and power management, weannounced a collaboration with Heart Aerospace to define the battery system forHeart’s ES-30regional electric airplane, and Eve AirMobility selected us toprovide an advanced energy storage system for its electric vertical take-off andland aircraft. – Our Power & Propulsion Solutions business was selected for North America’s largest battery electric bus award, meaning our Gen3 system will power up to 1,229 Nova Bus battery electric buses in Quebec, Canada. Operational performance We continued to experience strong demand across our customer base for electronic systems, as evidenced by our 2023 order generation. We continued to manage supply chain constraints effectively in 2023 and sawstability and easing in some areas. Wesupported existing customers on key electronic warfare and precision guided munition programmes, while pursuing andmaturing new opportunities. In our commercial businesses, with airline traffic and business travel increasing, there isstronger demand for Original Equipment Manufacturer (OEM) deliveries and aftermarket services. Clean air regulations continue to drive the transportation industrytowards alternative energy sources, like our propulsion solutions. Operational highlights – The F-35 Lightning II programme completed deliveries on Lot 15 electronic warfare (EW) systems and has delivered a cumulative total of over 1,400 EW systems. We are also supporting the Block 4 modernisation efforts under multiple contracts, including a recent contract for future Lot 17/18 production worth $491m (£395m), and continue to demonstrate high performance under a five-year Performance Based Logistics contract for F-35 sustainment. 36 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategy and performance Financial performance Financial performance measuresderivedfrom IFRS 2023 2022 Revenue £5,456m £5,057m Operating profit £806m £747m Return on revenue 14.8% 14.8% Cash flow from operating activities £961m £860m Order book £7.6bn £6.7bn Financial performance measures asdefined by the Group 2023 2022 Sales KPI £5,458m £5,057m Underlying EBIT KPI £878m £838m Return on sales 16.1% 16.6% Operating business cash flow £811m £650m Order intake 1 KPI £6.7bn £5.4bn Order backlog 1 £8.9bn £8.1bn – Through our Data Link Solutions joint venture with Rockwell Collins, Inc. we were selected by the US Navy to provideour Firenet ™ small form factor Multi-functional Information Distribution System Joint Tactical Radio which enables in-network communication for smaller platforms. This award continues to build onour portfolio of next-generation full-spectrum communication systems. Looking forward – Our Electronic Systems sector remains positioned for growth in the medium term, as the team continues to address current and evolving priority programmes from itsstrong franchise positions and long- standing commitment to research anddevelopment. – We maintain a diverse portfolio of defence and commercial products and capabilities for US and international customers, and expect to benefit from applying innovative technology solutions to defence customers’ existing and changing requirements, building on our significant roles on F-35Lightning II, F-15 upgrades, M-Code GPS upgrades and classified programmes, as well as a number of precision weaponproducts. – Over the longer term, we are poised to build on our technology strengths in emerging areas of demand, including precision weaponry, space resilience, hyper-velocity projectiles, autonomous platforms, and the development of multi-domain capabilities. – In our commercial portfolio, we continue to leverage our leading electric drive propulsion capabilities to address growing demand for low and zero emission solutions across an increasing number of civil platforms, with opportunities to migrate these technologies to defence applications. – We continue to invest in our people, R&Dand facilities to ensure capacity and resources are in place to capitalise on the positive outlook across our defence and commercial markets. – The acquisition of Ball Aerospace will provide further access to the growing spacedomain, C4ISR and missile and munitions markets. – Sales of £5.5bn increased 9% 2 , led by continued recovery in the commercial aviation business acrossboth civil aviation and power and propulsion, along with gains in electronic combat systems. – Underlying EBIT grew 5% 2 , generating areturn on sales of 16.1%, within theguided range. This reflected the absorption oflower pension recoveriespartially offsetby higher commercial activity. – Operating business cash flow was £811mand reflects improved working capital management. 1. Including share of equity accounted investments. 2. Constant currency basis. Sales analysis: Defence and commercial A Defence 83% B Commercial 17% A B Sales by domain A Air 87% B Maritime 3% C Land 10% C A B Sales by line of business A Electronic Combat 29% B C4ISR Systems 22% C Controls & Avionics 16% D Precision Strike & Sensing 15% E Countermeasure & Electromagnetic Attack 14% F Power & Propulsion 4% C D E F A B 37 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategic report Financial statements Additional informationGovernance Platforms & Services, with 11,900 1 employees, with operations inthe US, Sweden and UK, manufactures and upgrades combat vehicles, weapons and munitions, and delivers services and sustainment activities, including naval ship repair and the management and operation of two government-owned ammunition plants. Platforms & Services Combat Mission Systems focuses on a portfolio of tracked combat vehicles, amphibious vehicles, naval weapons, artillery systems, advanced weapons and precision munitions for the USmilitary and international customers. Ordnance Systems is the operator of the USArmy’s Holston and Radford ammunition facilities under government-owned, contractor- operated agreements, and focuses on explosives, propellants and facility modernisation. US Ship Repair is a major provider of non-nuclearship repair, modernisation, overhauland conversions to the US Navy andother government and commercial maritimecustomers across three US sites ontheAtlantic and Pacific coasts. BAE Systems Hägglunds focuses on thetrackedvehicle market for Swedish andinternational customers. BAE Systems Bofors, based in Sweden, providesadvanced landandmaritime weaponsand precision-guided munitions. Weapon Systems UK is a provider ofland-basedartillery systems, sustainment andservices, primarily for the M777 towed ultra-lightweight howitzer. FNSS, the Turkish land systems business inwhichBAE Systems holds a 49% interest,produces and upgrades tracked andwheeled military vehicles for Turkish andinternational customers. In our support services operations, modernisation and maintenance activities continue in our US shipyards for the US Navy’s non-nuclear fleet. We secured a ten-year contract, with a ceiling value of $8.8bn (£7.1bn), to continue operating the US Army’s Holston Army Ammunition Plant, and we continue to operate and modernise the Radford Army Ammunition Plant into 2026. Operational highlights – Our Hägglunds business continued to buildits order book, with a large order ofthe CV90 vehicle in seven variants from the Czech Republic, and grow its portfolio through strong strategic investments and apartnership with Norway’s Ritek AS to produce two new variants for the Swedish Armed Forces. – The UK Government selected ARCHER forits interim mobile artillery solution requirement through a Government-to- Government agreement with Sweden. – Our US shipyards were recognised for Safety Leadership, and the Holston Army Ammunition Plant received the US Army Materiel Command’s Excellence in ExplosiveSafety Award. – We started construction on a modern shiplift and land-level repair complex at ourJacksonville, Florida, shipyard that is expected to be operational in early 2025. However, in response to lower demand forPacific-coast ship repair services throughout the year, wescaled back theworkforce at our San Diego shipyard bynearly 500 positions. Strategic and order highlights – We secured a ten-year contract, with aceiling value of $8.8bn (£7.1bn), to continue operating the US Army’s HolstonArmy Ammunition Plant. – We secured a $797m (£641m) contract with the US Army to continue production ofthe AMPV, with additional options for apotential total contract amount of $1.6bn (£1.3bn). Thisaward brings the AMPV into full-rateproduction. – We secured multiple contracts exceeding atotal value of $870m (£700m) for the continued production of the Bradley A4. These awards will move more than 270 vehicles through our production lines andextend production into 2026. – The Czech Republic awarded Hägglunds acontract to produce 246 CV90 MkIV infantry fighting vehicles in seven differentvariants. The contract is valued at$2.2bn (£1.8bn). – Following the joint procurement agreement between Sweden, Germany and the UK, Germany purchased an additional 227 ultra-mobile, protected, all-terrain BvS10s valued at c.$400m (£322m). This investment from Germany will extend deliveries through to 2030. Operational performance In response to a changing global landscape that is prioritising defence spending to enhance and replenish capabilities, we remain focused on meeting increased customer demand for our products and services, including munitions, tracked combat vehicles, artillery systems and support services. In the US, our Combat Mission Systems teamis producing at heightened volumes across multiple programmes, drawing on ourextensive manufacturing network and engineering capability spanning the US, including expanded operations at our York,Pennsylvania, site to enable increased production of Armored Multi-Purpose Vehicles (AMPVs) and Amphibious Combat Vehicles (ACVs) to match customer requirements. Theteam continues to support critical vehicle modernisation programmes, and the AMPV entered the full-rate production phase during the second half of the year as the next- generation replacement for the M113. Our BAE Systems Hägglunds team continued to build its order book with a large order ofthe CV90 MkIV infantry fighting vehicles inseven different variants from the Czech Republic. Ongoing build and upgrades continue for the current fleet of CV90s for a number of nations. Hägglunds has also seen a renewed interest in Arctic operations, leading to additional sales of our BvS10 all-terrain family of combat vehicles. Additionally, the team secured a strong partner to bring theBvS10 to the Indian market. 38 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategy and performance Financial performance Financial performance measuresderivedfrom IFRS 2023 2022 Revenue £3,842m £3,598m Operating profit £373m £322m Return on revenue 9.7% 8.9% Cash flow from operating activities £624m £633m Order book £11.1bn £7.7bn Financial performance measures asdefined by the Group 2023 2022 Sales KPI £3,922m £3,688m Underlying EBIT KPI £354m £326m Return on sales 9.0% 8.8% Operating business cash flow £426m £525m Order intake 1 KPI £7.7bn £5.7bn Order backlog 1 £11.5bn £8.1bn – Our Weapon Systems UK team secured a five-year contract to follow from a previous ten-year programme for the delivery of M777 support services for the US, Australia and Canada with theinitial year funded at $17m (£14m). Following M777 deployments to Ukraine and increased interest from armies around the world, Weapon Systems UK also secured a contract from the US Army to produce M777 superstructures for spares and repairs through the foreign military sales (FMS) process. This effectively brings the M777 towed lightweight howitzer back into production. – We remain a critical provider of Army combat vehicles with our current franchises of AMPV, M109A7, M88 and Bradley vehicles, though we were not selected to participate in the follow-on phases of the US Army’s Optionally Manned Fighting Vehicle programme. Looking forward – We continue to focus on increased long-term demand from the US and international customers. The uplift in European and allied countries’ defence spending is in addition to our strong order backlog on key franchise programmes, including the AMPV, M109A7 self- propelled howitzer, Bradley upgrades, M88HERCULES recovery vehicle and theUS Marine Corps’ ACV. – There is a significant pipeline of future business opportunities for the CV90 and BvS10 from our Hägglunds business, as well as for artillery systems and munitions from ourBofors business. – We continue to manage and operate theUS Army’s Radford and Holston ammunition plants, and focus on key modernisation activities. – We will maintain our strong position onnaval guns, missile launch programmes, and submarine programmes, as well as USNavy ship repair and modernisation activities where the business has invested incapitalised infrastructure and our facilities in key home ports. – Sales were £3.9bn, an increase of 8% 2 . OurHägglunds business accounted forthe majority of the sector’s growth, with significant gains also recorded in ourShip Repair business. – Operating business cash flow was £426m,reflecting significant advanced funding from customers partially offset bycapital expenditure, predominantly inShip Repair. – Order intake of £7.7bn reflects a number of significant awards in the year, but primarily relates to the Czech Republic award for 246 CV90 MkIV infantry fighting vehicles worth $2.2bn (£1.8bn). 1. Including share of equity accounted investments. 2. Constant currency basis. Sales analysis: Platforms and services A Platforms 53% B Services 47% AB Sales by domain A Air 1% B Maritime 28% C Land 71% C A B Sales by line of business A Combat Mission Systems 49% B US Ship Repair 17% C Ordnance Systems 14% D BAE Systems Hägglunds 11% E BAE Systems Bofors 4% F Weapon Systems UK 3% G FNSS 2% C D E F G A B 39 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategic report Financial statements Additional informationGovernance Air, with 26,000 1 employees, comprises the Group’s UK‑based airbuild and support activities for European and international markets, US programmes, development of Future Combat AirSystems and FalconWorks ® , alongside our business in theKingdom of Saudi Arabia and interests in our European jointventures: Eurofighter and MBDA. Air Our UK-based business includes UK and international programmes for the production ofTyphoon combat aircraft, support, training andupgrades for Typhoon and Hawk, support and upgrades for Tornado, and development ofnext‑generation combat air technologies anddefence information systems, as well as theUK‑based F‑35 Lightning II manufacture, engineering development and support activity. In the Kingdom of Saudi Arabia, we provide operational capabilitysupport to the Kingdom’s air and naval forces through UK‑Saudi government‑to‑government programmes. TheSaudi British Defence Co‑operation Programme and Salam Typhoon project providefor multi‑year contracts between thegovernments. MBDA is a leading global prime contractor ofmissiles and missile systems across the air, maritime and land domains. solar aircraft, with successful stratospheric flight trials taking place in June. – We continue to deliver services under thefive-year SBDCP, with the Tornado Support Service providing anenhanced andmodernised solution forthe Royal Saudi Air Force. Strategic and order highlights – Additional UK Ministry of Defence funding of £143.5m was awarded in the second half of the year, taking the total funding awarded in 2023 toc.£800m, to advance the concepting and technology of the next-generation combat aircraft to 2025. – On GCAP, a trilateral collaboration agreement between BAE Systems, Leonardo SpA (Italy) and Mitsubishi Heavy Industries (Japan) is now in place to enable collaboration and sharing of information towards the next phase of activities. – We secured a further £535m of funding for European Common Radar System (ECRS) Mk2 Radar development for the Typhoon weapon system. The Royal Air Force of Oman has elected not to renew the current support arrangements for its Typhoon fleet. Discussions around our rolein providing a level of support to theRoyal Air Force of Oman continue. – We secured the Lightning Air System National Capability Enterprise (LANCE) contract in March, which extends our leadership of UK F-35 support at RAF Marham until the end of2027. – Following the completion of the previous five-year Salam Typhoon support contract on 31 December 2022, we reached anagreement with the Saudi Arabian Government to continue to provide these services for another five years through tothe end of 2027, valued at £3.7bn. – Through FalconWorks ® , the Air sector continues to invest in promising new andinnovative technologies for the future,including the development of electric aircraft products with a number ofpartners. – MBDA secured significant orders through 2023, in particular in air defence, maritime and land domains. These include production of medium-range ASTER B1 &B1NT missiles for use across the Italian and French armed forces, from the Polish Armament Agency to supply Launchers andCommon Anti-Air Module Missiles (CAMM) for Poland’s PILICA+ Air Defence upgrade programme. It also won orders for SAMP/T NG newgeneration ground-based air defence systems for the Italian Air Force, and for theMid-Life Upgrade of the air defence systems of the French and Italian Horizon class frigates. – MBDA is also supporting GCAP and signeda collaboration agreement with Mitsubishi Electric to work towards a weapons and effectors solution in support of the design ofthe GCAP core platform. Operational performance We continue to work with our customers tosupport their existing platforms and provide new enhanced capabilities. Deliveries of Typhoon to Qatar continue, alongside support to the in-service fleet. Inthe Kingdom of Saudi Arabia, our support for Typhoon has been extended for a further five-year term. In our US Programmes division, weare focused on delivery execution across all production lines with 162 F-35 aft fuselages completed in 2023. The formation of our new FalconWorks ® organisation and ongoing progress on the future combat air activities are important to future growth as we invest in our people, facilities and cutting-edge technologies. Operational highlights – Activity on our Qatar Typhoon and Hawk programmes continued with ten further Typhoon deliveries in the year, and a total of 18 aircraft now in service with the Qatar Emiri Air Force. – On the future fighter programme, we continue work on developing the UKflying demonstrator to fly within four years. The programme is focused on key technology areas of flight simulation, aerodynamic engine testing, and crew escape. – Our FalconWorks ® organisation, formed during the year to develop and bring to themarket new products and technologies, is leading the development and testing of PHASA-35 ® , our persistent high altitude 40 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategy and performance Sales analysis: Platforms and services A Platforms 5 1% B Services 49% AB Sales by domain A Air 92% B Maritime 5% C Land 3% A B C Sales by line of business A Kingdom of Saudi Arabia 33% B European and International Markets 29% C MBDA 18% D US Programmes 15% E Future Combat Air System 5% C D E A B Financial performance Financial performance measuresderivedfrom IFRS 2023 2022 Revenue £6,517m £6,286m Operating profit £948m £809m Return on revenue 14.5% 12.9% Cash flow from operating activities £1,808m £1,202m Order book £18.5bn £17.4bn Financial performance measures asdefined by the Group 2023 2022 Sales KPI £8,058m £7,698m Underlying EBIT KPI £949m £849m Return on sales 11.8% 11.0% Operating business cash flow £1,669m £1,140m Order intake 1 KPI £11.0bn £14.0bn Order backlog 1 £27.2bn £24.4bn Looking forward – The UKFuture Combat Air System is a key element of the UK Combat Air Strategy which enables long-term planning and investment in a key strategic part of the business, ensuring we have a long-term combat aircraft design, development and manufacturing capability. – We will continue to focus on ensuring that deliveries of Typhoon aircraft and support are made in line with agreed customer milestones. Future Typhoon production andsupport sales are underpinned by existing contracts and discussions continue to secure potential further contract awards for Typhoon. – Production of the rear fuselage assemblies for the F-35 has reached full rate levels and is expected to be sustained at approximately 150 to 160 aft fuselages to be completed annually. The business plays a significant role in the F-35 sustainment programme in support of Lockheed Martin and support volumes should increase as the number ofjets in service continues to increase. – In the Kingdom of Saudi Arabia, the In-Kingdom Industrial Participation programme continues to make good progress consistent with our long-term strategy, whilst supporting the Kingdom’s National Transformation Plan and Vision 2030. Our in-Kingdom support business is expected to remain stable underpinned by long-standing contracts that are expected to be renewed every five years, while we continue to support development of a Future Combat Air Partnership between the Kingdom of Saudi Arabia and the UK. – MBDA has a strong order backlog and development programmes continue toimprove the long-term capabilities of thebusiness in air, land and sea domains. MBDA continues to be well placed tobenefit from increased defence spendingin Europe and internationally. – Sales were £8.1bn, an increase of 4%², driven by increased activity in MBDA andhigher air support volumes, while thefuture combat air programme continues to gain pace with activity morethan doubling in 2023. – Return on sales of 11.8% reflects goodoperational performance and riskretirement. – Operating business cash flow of £1.7bn reflects the timing of customer advances and down payments from recent awards. – Order backlog reached £27.2bn, following an order intake of £11.0bn in the year. Significant orders include agreement ofafurther five-year Salam Typhoon support contract, valued at £3.7bn, as well as multiple awards in MBDA across both theimport and export markets. 1. Including share of equity accounted investments. 2. Constant currency basis. 41 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategic report Financial statements Additional informationGovernance Maritime, with 27,500 1 employees, comprises the Group’s UK‑based maritime and land activities, including major submarine, ship build and support programmes, as well asourAustralianbusiness. Maritime Maritime programmes include the construction of seven Astute Class submarines for the Royal Navy, as well as the design and production of the Royal Navy’s four Dreadnought Class submarines and eight Type 26 frigates. The Maritime portfolio also offers in‑service support, including the delivery of training services and providing worldwide engineering support to the Royal Navy’s Portsmouth‑based surface flotilla on behalf ofthe UK Ministry of Defence, as well as the design and manufacture of combat systems, torpedoes and radars. Land UK’s munitions business designs, developsand manufactures a comprehensive range of munitions products for a number ofcustomers including our main customer, theUKMinistry of Defence. Rheinmetall BAE Systems Land (RBSL) – our UK‑based jointventure with Rheinmetall – specialisesin the design, manufacture andsupport of military vehicles used by the BritishArmy and international customers. LandUK also develops and manufactures cased‑telescoped weapons through our CTAInternational joint venture. In Australia, the business primarily delivers upgrade and support programmes for customers in the defence and commercial sectors across theair, maritime and land domains. This includesthe Jindalee Operational Radar Network (JORN) upgrade. The business is also delivering the Hunter Class Frigate Programme. Services contracts include the provision of sustainment, training solutions andupgrades. – The UK Type 26 programme continues and construction is underway on the first four City Class Type 26 frigates, with a focus on skilled and experienced resource availability, including within the supply chain. HMS Glasgow isprogressing through the key stages ofoutfit, test and commissioning, while HMS Cardiff is being prepared to enter the water for the first time in 2024. Following steel cut in June 2021, HMSBelfast continues steelwork construction, while the initial unit construction for HMS Birmingham began inApril and is well underway. – In Australia, the Hunter Class frigate programme continues to make strong progress towards a production contractforBatch 1. During the year, construction commenced on the first schedule protection block at Osborne NavalShipyard in South Australia and theprogramme successfully completed the Preliminary Design Review. Alongside this, we continue the upgrade and sustainment of Australia’s Anzac Class frigates at pace. Construction has also commenced on facilities at our Williamtown site to support F-35 maintenance activities. – The new £2.4bn 15-year contract with theUK Ministry of Defence, the Next Generation Munitions Solution (NGMS), commenced on 1 January 2023. Building on this, we secured additional orders for the supply of munitions to the UK Ministry of Defence worth over £400m, to significantly increase the production ofvitaldefence stocks. – Development and investment activity acrossour munitions business continues. Over £200m is being invested, including two new machining lines in Washington (Tyne and Wear). Strategic and order highlights – We secured an order of £2.4bn forthe continued Delivery Phase 3 activity on the Dreadnought Class submarine programme. Construction of the first three boats is underway at Barrow-in-Furness, Cumbria. Aceremony took place in February 2023 tomark the official steel cuton the third submarine, HMS Warspite. – During the year, Australia, the UK and theUS announced the pathway for Australia toacquire nuclear-powered submarines as part of the AUKUS programme. The nations will deliver atrilaterally developed submarine based onthe UK’s next-generation Astute replacement design. Australia and the UKwill operate SSN-AUKUS, as it will beknown, incorporating technology from all three nations. Our submarines business has secured an order intake of £3.95bn to enable the programme to transition into the detailed design phase and commence procurement of long-lead items and supporting infrastructure. Operational performance Our major maritime platform programmes continue to progress, with sea trials commencing for HMS Anson, the fifth Astute Class submarine, as well as the start of construction of both the third Dreadnought Class submarine, HMSWarspite, and the fourth Type 26 frigate, HMS Birmingham. TheHunter Class Frigate Programme (HCFP) in Australia has achieved key milestones and we continue to meet customer delivery andsupport requirements in both Munitions and Maritime Services. Ongoing investments inour facilities and our people will help ensure we can support increasing customer demand and, with the future potential ofAUKUS, the sector is well positioned forfuture growth. Operational highlights – In February, HMS Anson left our Submarines site in Barrow-in-Furness, Cumbria, to begin seatrials with the Royal Navy. She joins HMSAstute, HMS Ambush, HMS Artful and HMS Audacious at their operational base, HM Naval Base Clyde, in Faslane. Theremaining submarines in the Astute Class – Agamemnon and Agincourt – are atan advanced stage of construction. 42 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategy and performance Financial performance Financial performance measuresderivedfrom IFRS 2023 2022 Revenue £5,391m £4,484m Operating profit £423m £352m Return on revenue 7. 8% 7.9% Cash flow from operating activities £629m £418m Order book £20.4bn £16.6bn Financial performance measures asdefined by the Group 2023 2022 Sales KPI £5,536m £4,598m Underlying EBIT KPI £425m £356m Return on sales 7.7% 7.7% Operating business cash flow £291m £235m Order intake 1 KPI £10.1bn £9.7bn Order backlog 1 £21.3bn £17.2bn – We continue investing in our people and facilities to better enable us to deliver on our customer commitments and secure the long-term future for complex shipbuilding in Glasgow. Construction of a new ship assembly hall in Govan is well underway, and the new Applied Shipbuilding Academy in Scotstoun is planned to open in 2024. – In Australia, we continued to invest innew products and opportunities and unveiled Strix ™ , a vertical take-off and landing (VTOL) uncrewed aerial system, RAZER, alow-cost precision guided munition, andshowcased the Guided Missile Frigate, an evolution of the Hunter Class. – In June, we secured a ten-year contract worth £270m to support the RoyalNavy’s three main radar systems. Under the contract, our engineers will provide maintenance to existing radars, alongside technology upgrades to systems already inuse, and those being installed onthe new Type 26 frigates under construction inGlasgow, UK. Looking forward – Our Submarines business is executing across Astute, Dreadnought and SSN-AUKUS. Investment continues in the facilities at our Barrow-in-Furness, Cumbria, shipyard to provide the capabilities to deliver these long-term programmes. – In the UK, shipbuilding sales are underpinned by the manufacture of Type26 frigates and our capabilities acrossWarship Support, Underwater Weapons, Radar and Maritime Training. – The Australian Defence Strategic Review confirmed the acquisition of conventionally armed, nuclear-powered submarines as part of the SSN-AUKUS programme andthe Australian Government’s commitment to continuous naval shipbuilding. Our Australian business iswellpositioned to respond to future opportunities this creates. – Additionally, the Australian business has long-term sustainment and upgrade activities in maritime, air, wide-area surveillance, missile defence and electronic systems. – As the UK Ministry of Defence’s long-term strategic partner for munitions supply, wecontinue to focus our operations in support of the UK Ministry of Defence andthe UK’sNATO allies, as well as other customers. To support this, investment continues across our facilities and infrastructure alongside recruitment activities to support increased demand. – Sales of £5.5bn were up 22%², duetoaccelerated funding on the Dreadnought programme. – Operating business cash flow of £291misafter capital investment in shipbuilding facilities in Glasgow and theMunitions business in Glascoed. – Order intake of £10.1bn in the year haspushed order backlog to £21.3bn, primarily driven by the award of £3.95bn for the next phase of SSN-AUKUS as well as additional funding of £2.4bn for the continued activity on Dreadnought. Sales analysis: Platforms and services A Platforms 67% B Services 33% AB Sales by domain A Air 4% B Maritime 8 7% C Land 9% A C B Sales by line of business A Submarines 46% B Naval Ships 29% C Australia 18% D Land UK 7% A B D C 1. Including share of equity accounted investments. 2. Constant currency basis. 43 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategic report Financial statements Additional informationGovernance Cyber & Intelligence, with 11,000 1 employees, comprises theUS‑based Intelligence & Security business and UK‑headquartered Digital Intelligence business, and covers theGroup’s cyber security activities for national security, centralgovernment and government enterprises. Cyber & Intelligence Intelligence & Security is made up of three US‑based business units. Air & Space Force Solutions provides the US Air Force, US Space Force and combatant commands with innovative systems engineering and integration solutions to modernise, maintain, test and cyber‑harden aircraft, radars, strategic missile systems, mission applications and information systems that detect, deter and dissuade national security threats. Integrated Defense Solutions provides the USArmy and Navy with systems engineering, integration, and sustainment services for critical weapons systems, C5ISR (Command, Control, Computers, Communications, Cyber, Intelligence, Surveillance and Reconnaissance) and cyber security that enhance mission effectiveness. Oursolutions are deployed across platforms andnetworks in the air, maritime, land and cyberdomains. Intelligence Solutions provides innovative mission‑enabling solutions and services to intelligence and federal/civilian agencies, as wellas the provision of cost‑effective synthetic training and simulation software products and components for global defence applications. Digital Intelligence provides cyber, intelligenceand security expertise to help protectnations, businesses and citizens. Ourservices, solutions and products span customers in law enforcement, national security,central government and government enterprises, critical national infrastructure, telecommunications, military and space. – Our businesses continue to deliver strong performance on existing contracts with theUSNavy, US Army, US Air Force and federal/civilian agencies – including a $699m (£562m), five-year contract for operations, maintenance and management services for the US Army’s Defense Supercomputing Resource Center and a$478m (£384m), five-year contract to support weapon systems on USand UK submarine classes. – The Wargaming Capability (WGC) programme conducted a successful operational demonstration test event of ourwargaming system in June. The event consisted of test case and scenario execution demonstrating abroad range ofwargaming activities and resulted in a successful pass from the US Marine Corps. The success of this test event allows the WGC team to continue moving forward toa production-ready capability with anticipated initial operating capability in2025. – In Digital Intelligence, investments in newproducts for space and international markets continue to progress well and allmajor external projects are delivering well against schedules. Strategic and order highlights – In Intelligence & Security, we secured taskorders, in March, valued at $457m (£367m) tosupport critical mission operations foragovernment customer. – In December, Germany’s Bundeswehr acquired a BISim VBS4 enterprise licence. The enterprise licence provides the Bundeswehr with full access to BISim’s easy-to-use, whole-earth virtual and constructive desktop trainer and simulation. – Through collaboration between the Airsector and the Intelligence & Security business, PHASA-35 ® successfully demonstrated its ability toachieve stratospheric flight, and Intelligence & Security was subsequently awarded a US Army Space and Missile Defense Command contract that provides opportunities over afive-year period to undertake military utility demonstrations through the integration ofsensor payloads operating onboard thePHASA-35 ® aircraft. – In June 2022, the US Air Force awarded theIntegration Support Contract (ISC) 2.0 re-compete to BAE Systems with an 18-year period of performance and $12bn(£10bn) total contract ceiling. TheISC 2.0 contract award was protested, andthe Government Accountability Office(GAO) sustained portions of the protest in October 2022. The Air Force istaking corrective action to address the GAO issues, and we continue to support the ISCprogramme under a $652m (£524m) contract extension received inJanuary 2023. Operational performance Our Intelligence & Security business hasperformed well in 2023, supporting government customers across the USDepartment of Defense, federal agencies and civilian organisations with innovative, mission-enabling solutions. We continue tofocus on cultivating a strong pipeline of qualified business opportunities across our US-based business units – Air & Space Force Solutions, Integrated Defense Solutions, andIntelligence Solutions. In Digital Intelligence, we have stepped upour investment in the business for futuregrowth. During the year, we opened anew site in Manchester to broaden our footprint and enable the business to accessthe wider labour market. We have alsoinvested in talent recruitment and development through training academies to generate skillsets which are in short supply. Operational highlights – As we continue to address the growing modelling & simulation and synthetic training markets, BAE Systems-owned PitchTechnologies was realigned from Platforms &Services toour Intelligence & Security business. Theaddition of Pitch builds on the 2022 acquisition of Bohemia Interactive Simulations (BISim) as we address the increased demand for innovative and cost-effective training andsimulation software products. 44 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategy and performance Financial performance Financial performance measuresderivedfrom IFRS 2023 2022 Revenue £2,321m £2,205m Operating profit £179m £291m Return on revenue 7.7% 13.2% Cash flow from operating activities £ 261m £191m Order book £1.4bn £1.4bn Financial performance measures asdefined by the Group 2023 2022 Sales KPI £ 2,321m £2,205m Underlying EBIT KPI £199m £232m Return on sales 8.6% 10.5% Operating business cash flow £204m £154m Order intake 1 KPI £2.5bn £2.4bn Order backlog 1 £2.0bn £2.1bn – In Digital Intelligence, we are making positive progress in expanding our multi-domain communications footprint inthe UK defence sector. We have also securedanumber of multi-year deals withCentralGovernment and National Securitycustomers. Financial performance – Sales increased by 6% 2 , to £2.3bn, with both the UKand US businesses seeing increased operations in the year. Growth was 9% 2 after adjusting for the divestment ofthe financial crime detection business in2022. – Underlying EBIT was down 14%², delivering a return on sales, as expected, of 8.6% following additional investment in the year in space and multi-domain networking, and higher recruitment and facilities costs. – Order backlog has remained steady againstthe prior year, with a book-to-bill 3 ratio of 1.1. Looking forward – Our Intelligence & Security team maintains a strong pipeline of qualified business opportunities and is seeing an increase in demand driven by global security threats, even with some delays in Department of Defense procurements. – The outlook for our US Government services sector in Intelligence & Security is robust with theopportunity for mid-term growth, thoughmarket conditions remain highly competitive and continue to shift inresponse to government priorities. – The modelling, simulation and synthetic training environment markets in theUS and internationally support a positive outlook for our BISim and Pitch Technologies teams, and we continue to expand our wargaming capabilities to new markets and customers. – In Digital Intelligence, where our capabilities are well aligned to UK defence, security and digital budgets, we continue torecruit talent and invest in our people through our training academies and a new facility in Manchester, in the North West ofEngland. – In the space domain, our Digital Intelligencebusiness is focusing ondelivering our Azalea ™ programme todevelop and build Low Earth Orbit satellites for the defence market. – Sales increased by 6% 2 , to £2.3bn, with both the UKand US businesses seeing increased operations in the year. Growth was 9% 2 after adjusting for the divestment ofthe financial crime detection business in2022. – Underlying EBIT was down 14%², delivering a return on sales, as expected, of 8.6% following additional investment in the year in space and multi-domain networking, and higher recruitment and facilities costs. – Order backlog has remained steady against the prior year, with a book-to-bill 3 ratio of1.1. Sales by business A Digital Intelligence 30% Intelligence & Security: B Intelligence Solutions 30% C Integrated Defence Solutions 22% D Air & Space Force Solutions 18% A D B C Sales by domain A Air 29% B Maritime 14% C Land 11% D Cyber 4 6% A D B C Sales by customer A US Government 68% B UK and other governments 30% C Other 2% A C B 1. Including share of equity accounted investments. 2. Constant currency basis. 3. Ratio of Order intake to Sales. 45 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategic report Financial statements Additional informationGovernance We are committed to playing our part in creating a secure and sustainable future 1 . Our sustainability agenda Sustainability plays an increasingly important role; it is embedded into our strategic framework and aligns with our purpose – “toserve, supply and protect those who serve and protect us”. We innovate, engineer and deliver products and services that help governments keep people safe around the world and strengthen international stability. At the same time, our business supports theeconomic growth of nations through high-quality, well-compensated, sustained employment and a global network of suppliers. We are committed to development of our employees, including both their skills and career advancement, and to investment in the communities and regions where weoperate. With business growing at an accelerated pace, it is critical that we continue to attract, retain and develop the diverse and top talent who will ensure we fulfil our mission. We must ensure that our culture is inclusive, providing an environment where employees feel valued, supported, listened to and are able to grow both personally and professionally. In 2023, along with progressing programmes related to our core foundations, we continued to focus on leveraging our strengths and capabilities to make progress on the four pillars of our sustainability agenda and make the most material contributions in the future. Our four pillarsare: • Addressing climate risks • Furthering ideas, innovation and technology • Creating opportunity for people andcommunities • Achieving success through partnering We recognise that we are part of a complex ecosystem of stakeholders, and that progress requires changing behaviours, aligning expectations and partnering with others. Westart with our customers and their decarbonisation programmes and social impact objectives – and we must work together with the support andinvolvement ofouremployees, suppliersand communities. We engage with these different stakeholders groups onour plans and roadmaps, in addition tolistening to their perspectives onour sustainability approach. Commitment from all levels Sustainability is driven from the top down byour Chief Executive and integrated throughout the business from our strategic framework, our governance systems and policies, to the integrated financial planning process and business review cycles. Cross-functional and cross-sector steering groups provide expertise and oversight andour assurance framework and Internal Audit regularly assess our compliance with policies and processes. Our Board Environmental, Social and Governance Committee provides oversight, input and assurance of the Group’s agenda and progress, including approving theESG- related objectives and targets that form part of our executive incentives. At each meeting, the Committee receives input from both senior management andtheGroup’s subject matter experts. TheCommittee routinely reviews data andparticipates in site visits and meetings toengage directly with employees and heartheir views. This dialogue enables theCommittee to reflect employee perspectives in boardroom discussions. In addition, we have established a number ofemployee groups which discuss and consider various sustainability topics and provide feedback to the Group ESG, Culture & Business Transformation Director. Clear and open two-way communication from the boardroom, through the executive team and across all our sites encourages our employees at all levels of the business interms of understanding the organisation and their role within it and to be proud ofwhat we are doing. 1. References to ‘sustainable’ and/or ‘sustainability’ (across pages 46 to 66 inclusive) may refer to arange of environmental and/or social and/or economic business practices, unless otherwise described within a particular statement. 2. Deloitte has provided independent limited assurance in accordance with the International Standard for Assurance Engagements 3000 (ISAE3000) issued by the International Auditing andAssurance Standards Board (IAASB) over the selected metric. Deloitte’s full unqualified assurance opinion, which includes details of the selected metrics assured, canbe foundat baesystems.com/annual-report. 3. https://universumglobal.com/. 2023 highlights Having established our approach and key goals in 2022, this year we focused onincreasing awareness internally and executing our plans and roadmaps. Here are the key highlights at a glance. Environment – Scope 1 and 2: reduced future emissions byagreeing Power Purchase Agreements with energy suppliers that will provide renewable energy to help us meet energydemand in the UK. – Scope 3 product-related emissions: we arepartnering with the Royal Navy and Rolls-Royce to trial alternative fuels in navalvessels by blending currently availablefuels (see page 55). – In the UK, we have engaged with suppliers responsible for 45% of the Group’s UK supply chain emissions and provided them the tools to measure and monitor their CO 2 emissions. – In the US, we continue to execute onavariety of sustainability efforts andinitiatives. Social – 29% of the Executive Committee arefemale. – £11,267,109 2 contributed to the communities inwhich we live and work, inaddition tothe regions and countries inwhich weoperate. – In the UK, the Group was ranked second byfemale engineers in the Most Attractive Employers list by Universum 3 , up from 24thin 2022. – In the US, we were recognised as Military- Friendly for a 13th consecutive yearand awarded ‘Best for Vets’ for a 10thconsecutive year. Responsible business practices – We continued to support transparency andunderstanding of our sustainability agenda and governance framework. – We updated our global Code of Conduct toinclude changes to our internal processes and policies for roll-out during 2024. – In the UK, we continued to progress ourworkstreams on improving due diligence on modernslavery. – We sustained robust corporate governance in linewith our Operational Framework. 46 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Sustainability A responsible defence company Sustainability embedded in our strategic framework Underpinned by core foundations Safety, health and wellbeing Accountability and transparency Robust ethicsand governance Diversity, equity and inclusion Product trading,quality and safety Early careers Environmental impact management Addressing climate risks Furthering ideas, innovation and technology Creating opportunity for people and communities Achieving success through partnering Responsible business practices Covers: Anti-bribery, anti-corruption and ethics programmes; Improving industry standards; Human rights; Cyber security; and, Responsible supply chain. Social Covers: Creating opportunity for people andcommunities; and achieving success throughpartnering. – Workplace environment – Education and skills – Community investment – Armed forces support Environment and climate Covers: Addressing climate risks; furthering ideas, innovation and technology; and achieving success through partnering. – Decarbonisation strategy – Environmental stewardship – Biodiversity and nature Pillars accelerating our ambitions –opportunities to advance and integrate our sustainability agenda How we report Read more Page 48 Read more Page 56 Read more Page 62 47 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategic report Financial statements Additional informationGovernance Our decarbonisation strategy supports delivery of our Group strategic framework, mitigating our impact on climate change by decarbonising our operations and working towards a net zero value chain by supporting ourcustomers’ transition. We strive to mitigate the impacts we have on the environment while adapting our operations and products to thewider challenges and risks presented by climate change. Environment and climate Climate change is one of the great global challenges of our time requiring us all to act together. Like other industries, the defence industry is supporting the transition to a global decarbonised economy, while prioritising a safe and reliable defence capability for our customers. Many defence platforms are energy intensive,with the majority of emissions resulting from upstream procured products and downstream activities covering customeruse and military deployment. Globally, the total carbon footprint of thedefence sector, including government activities, is approximately 520 MtCO 2 e eachyear or 1% of global man-made GHG emissions 1 . Defence platforms are designed to be in service fordecades while retaining the ability tooperate across different geographical regions, with different climatic conditions andinfrastructure, and alongside our allies. So we must work in partnership withourcustomers to understand their futurerequirements. For us, climate resilience includes the assessment of the physical and strategic impacts of our own sites and operations andthe ongoing development of a wider decarbonisation strategy that addresses climate-related risks and opportunities to: – achieve our target of net zero GHG emissions (Scope 1 and 2) across our operations by 2030; – support our customers on their climate goals by developing energy efficient products and services whilst maintaining military operational advantage; – develop the skills and capabilities of our employees to drive innovative solutions for energy management and efficiency across our operations and the product lifecycle; – seek to mitigate adverse environmental impacts and be good stewards of the environment in the locations where we operate; and – work with our local communities tosupport sustainability initiatives. Our decarbonisation strategy includes ourtarget of: – achieving net zero GHG emissions across our operations (Scope1and 2) by 2030 – we aim to dothisby reducing our emissions as aminimum in line with the1.5°C pathway²;and – working towards a net zero value chainby2050. For the UK, Australia and Kingdom of SaudiArabia businesses, net zero means reducing ouremissions by following a Paris-aligned pathway, supporting efforts in limiting global warming to well-below 2°C above pre-industrial levels and pursuing efforts to limit warming to1.5°C. Once our emissions have been reduced as much as practicable, we will consider the use of offsets to decarbonise our operations by 2030. We are working to minimise exposure to offsets and will develop aresponsible strategy to implement asappropriate. 1. Roland Berger – Defence Zero Volume 1: Military emissions and potential solutions and https://asd-europe.org/climate-change-and-defence. 2. Following a Paris-aligned pathway, supporting efforts in limiting global warming to well-below 2°C above pre-industrial levels and pursuing efforts to limit warming to1.5°C – https://unfccc.int/process-and-meetings/the-paris-agreement. Analysis of emissions for Defence companies – adapted from Boston Consulting Group Review 2022 Scopes ofdefence industry- related emissions 20–30% of defence emissions >65% of defence emissions5–10% of defence emissions Scope 3 upstream Scope 3 downstream Procured products, transport of supplies, travel Transport of products, usage of sold products, product disposal Scope 2 Electricity, heat for manufacture Scope 1 Operations 48 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Sustainability Decarbonising our operations Our target is to be net zero across our operations (Scope 1 and 2) by 2030 by reducing operational GHG emissions year-on-year by 4.2%, in line with a Paris- aligned pathway, limiting warming to 1.5°C, over ten years (against a baseline year of 2020), with a 90% reduction in GHG emissions being achieved by 2050. Ifthe year-on-year reduction target of 4.2%is not met during any given year, the year-on-year reduction targets for subsequent years will be adjusted to deliver the overall reduction target. We will achieve our net zero targets through a variety of different instruments including engagement on power purchase agreements (PPAs), investing in renewable and other energy efficiency measures and switching tolower carbon fuels where practicable. Ourroadmap to 2030 estimates that the reduction associated with each of these is approximately 75% through renewables, 15% through energy efficiency measures and10% through fuel switch opportunities. During 2023, we progressed activities related to our emissions reductions levers. Our overall operational GHG emissions (Scope 1 and 2) have reduced by 11% compared to 2022, this is driven by reductions in electricity and gas consumption as a result of factors such as production variances, efficiency improvements and operational control changes. A key element of our net zero ambition isincreasing the proportion of renewable energy across our sites. The nature of ouroperations will continue to require a significant amount of energy for current demand and the predicted growth in our business over the coming decade. During 2023, we proactively pursued renewable energy development opportunities including investment in power purchase agreements (signed during 2023) for a new wind farm development and a number of solar projects across our UK enterprise. These projects willbe completed in Q4 2026 and 2024 respectively. These projects are expected to provide energysecurity and certainty for our future operations and also increase the overall renewable energy generation across the UKfrom 2024 onwards. Site consolidation, new-build and refurbishment projects provide further opportunities for us to optimise and reduce our energy consumption. Robust data on building efficiency and infrastructure is a key enabler to achieve this. We have building information management systems in place across a number of our sites, we are extending them further and also establishing common building standards across geographies. During 2023, we updated the steam delivery network at our munitions site in the UK, invested in new and more energy efficient office locations in the US andconsolidated all of our Head Office administration buildings inthe UK. Across our business we are seeking, where possible, to switch to low carbon alternatives to heat our buildings. In the US, we continueto explore efficiencies in heating and cooling operations to reduce energy andsubsequent impacts. We continue to mature our assessment andmanage the climate-related physical risksand impacts across our global facilities, implementing improvement recommendations, including investment to improve facilities. Our decarbonisation strategy and activities related to our emissions reduction levers areembedded in our sectors’ five-year business plans and we are assessing the impact of our predicted business growth toensure our energy and infrastructure strategies are aligned to our decarbonisation pathways. Our Group-level policies and processes have been revised to include ourdecarbonisation ambitions and to strengthen our climate resilience. Our in-year and long-term incentives are aligned to the Group achieving a 4.2% operational GHG emissions reduction targetyear-on-year. KPI In-year reduction of GHG emissions (Scope 1 & 2) ACHIEVED -11.0% GHG emissions data 1 1 Emissions from activities which BAESystemsowns orcontrols (Scope 1) 107,360 113,089 54,204 55,686 Total gross Scope 1 and 2 emissions 350,817 394,271 108,660 116,059 2 Emissions from the electricity, natural gas andsteam purchased for BAE Systems’ use (Scope 2 – location-based) 243,457 281,182 54,456 60,374 3 Emissions from employee business travel included in (Scope3) 114,030 62,519 44,261 20,999 Global 2 tonnes CO 2 e UK tonnes CO 2 e 2022 figures Read more – Other sustainability information/GHG methodology statement Page 234 Product sustainability guidance for our UK, Australia and Kingdom of Saudi Arabia businesses Managed impact Our products, as part of their design, manufacture, use and disposal have managed impact on the environment Operational resilience Our products are resilient to changes in the environment in which they will operate Energy and materialresilience Our products consider energy and material resilience GHG emissions We are working towards making our products net zero with respect to GHGs 1. Relevant reporting period 1 November 2022 to 31 October 2023. 2. Deloitte has provided independent limited assurance in accordance with the International Standard for Assurance Engagements 3000 (ISAE 3000) and Assurance Engagements on Greenhouse Gas Statements (ISAE 3410) issued by the International Auditing and Assurance Standards Board (IAASB). Deloitte’s full unqualified assurance opinion, which includes details of the selected metrics assured, can be found at baesystems.com/annual-report. 49 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategic report Financial statements Additional informationGovernance Decarbonising our operations continued Environment and climate continued Value chain transition We recognise that our value chain contributes to our total GHG emission footprint beyond that of our Scope 1 and 2 emissions. We acknowledge the importance of continuing to partner and collaborate with our customers and suppliers to reduce emissions by 2050. According to external studies, approximately 65% 1 of defence industry emissions come from downstream customer use of products/ platforms. To address this requires collaboration with our customers and across the wider defence sector while recognising that operational performance and capability must always take precedence. In Australia, the Kingdom of Saudi Arabia andthe UK, we are undertaking a programme ofwork to understand the GHGprofile of material product types. Thiswill help us understand how to further progress the efficiency of our products, research and develop alternate solutions andidentify how we can support future customer decisions and investment in productupgrades and development. Thiswork will support our customers’ decarbonisation transition. We are innovating to drive decarbonisation ofproducts and services, and reduce the dependency on fossil fuels. This will be achieved by: – Energy optimisation – Alternate fuels – Developing electrification programmes During 2023, we launched product sustainability guidance for our UK, Australia and Kingdom of Saudi Arabia businesses toembedsustainability criteria across our Lifecycle Management Framework. The guidance gives a framework to consider theimpact of design choices, throughout aproduct’s lifecycle, on Scopes 1, 2 and 3, including decarbonising our products, resilience of products to adapt to changes inthe environment, energy and material resilience and minimising product impacts onthe environment – air, water, land andbiodiversity. 20-30% 1 of defence industry emissions comesfrom upstream activities, so it is key that we collaborate and partner with our UKsuppliers to reduce upstream emissions, while maintaining operational edge. We have estimated the contribution of ourglobal supply chain and developed aSupply Chain Decarbonisation Roadmap (above), which outlines how we will work with our peers, suppliers and industry groups to collectively reduce upstream emissions by 2050. We are initially focused on prioritising this activity within our businesses in the UK, Australia andthe Kingdom of Saudi Arabia. During 2023, we undertook a global spend-based assessment of our key suppliers to better understand which are material to our value chain GHG emission contributions. In the UK, we will continue to engage with material suppliers on our decarbonisation ambitions (above), to highlight key actions where we can collaborate. In the UK, we will continue to measure our spend-basedGHG emissions as we build capacity with oursupply base through the use of our service partner, Helios Information, and itsJoint Supply Chain Accreditation Register (JOSCAR) Zero and ESG Analysis toolsets. Byobtaining primary emissions dataandfurther ESG maturity insights across ourpurchased goods and services, we can shape ambition into action. We will continue to engage and support wider industry initiatives, for instance, from ADS and the International Aerospace Environmental Group(IAEG) to facilitate shared learning andcollective decarbonisation. 1. Roland Berger – Defence Zero Volume 1: Military emissions and potential solutions. Our Supply Chain Decarbonisation Action Plan for our UK, Australia and Kingdom of Saudi Arabia businesses Collaborating with suppliers to transition to net zero by 2050. Laying the foundations Capacity building Enduring engagement What have we delivered and what do we collectively need to deliver in our journey towards net zero by 2050? Our ambition is informed bythe UK Government’s PPN06/21 guidance. Through collaboration and by partnering for success we can play our part in decarbonising our sector. Establish our community. Complete spend-based data baselines and materiality assessment. Develop the stakeholder engagement pathway and launch our ambitions and action plan. Integrate decarbonisation into our core processes andour supplier relationship requirements. Upskill ourselves and our suppliers. Transition to hybrid emissions calculation. Maintain decarbonisation efforts through business asusual practices and supply chain collaboration. Introduce minimum decarbonisation maturity requirements. Transition to product footprint data. 2022–2024 2025–2029 2030–2050 Net zero 2050 Renewable energy and efficiency Green transport and logistics Waste reduction and recycling Climate resilience & risk management Packaging optimisation Emissions Enablers Engagement 2022 Emissions baseline and materiality assessment 2025 Transition tohybrid methodology calculation 2030 Transition to product footprint data 2023 Supplier ESG assessments introduced 2024 SC decarbonisation metrics operationalised 2023 Supply chain ambitionsset 2023 Supplier engagement approach developed 2023 Phase 2.2 supplier engagement (UK) 2024 Phase 3 supplier engagement (AU) 2023 Phase 1 supplier engagement 2024 Phase 2.3 supplier engagement (UK) 2024 Phase 4 supplier engagement (KSA) 2023 TOSCAN zero supplier carbon accounting tool launched 2024 Capability upskilling 2022 Supply chain ESGcommunity established 2025 Decarbonisation integratedinto coreprocesses 2028 Decarbonisation supplier risk tool introduced 2028 All material suppliers have published CRP 2025 Decarbonisation included in standard terms and conditions 2025 Suppliers with contracts>£3m pa havepublished CRP 2028 Decarbonisation weighting included in all relevant procurement activity 2030 Minimum supplier decarbonisation requirements introduced 2030 Decarbonise our operations to reduce theimpacts of our ownactivities 50 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Sustainability Environmental stewardship We are committed to high levels of environmental stewardship and aim toresponsibly consume resources: – through the efficient use of energy; – by reducing all types of waste (e.g.hazardous, non-hazardous, radioactive) where we can; and – by minimising water use, recognising thatthis is a valuable resource globally. We also seek to prevent adverse environmental impacts through the prevention of sources of contamination, andto protect thenatural environment fromharm anddegradation in the geographies wherewe operate. Consumption of resources and materials canbe different year-on-year, due to differences in geography across our operations and the stage of manufacture ofour platforms and programmes. We are taking a business-led approach tosetting reduction targets and driving improvement programmes and activities tosupport responsible consumption. During2023, our US business marked EarthDay with a Battle of the Buildings competition. This generated morethan 22,743 total energy reduction actions withestimated environmental savings: 9,000kWh of electricity; 95,000 gallons ofwater; 1,300gallons of gas; 500 pounds ofplasticand 500 pounds of waste. For 2023, there have been significant reductions inwater consumption, compared to 2022, as a result of varying production requirements and infrastructure improvements. Waste production has increased for both non- hazardous and hazardous waste, as a result of factors including production requirements and the review and update of the basis ofreporting. Biodiversity and natural capital Nature loss and degradation pose a risk toboth the environment and society. Weareundertaking surveys and assessments to better evaluate how our facilities and operations impact the surrounding natural habitat. In the US, we have completed projects to enhance the underwater ecosystems at our Norfolk and San Diego shipyards, and other efforts have been undertaken to establish water and riparian buffer areas at our Norfolk and York facilities. Operationally, significant aspects of biodiversity are considered to include protecting natural habitats, conserving protected species and the management ofinvasive species in and around our sites. Advocacy We recognise that addressing climate and environmental matters requires partnership andcollaboration across many different entities. We work closely with our defence sector peers through industry associations and with our customers and governments. Inthe UK, we take leadership roles in key organisations such as the AeroSpace and Defence Industries Association of Europe, ADS Group and the International Association for Engineering Geology and the Environment toactively participate in developing common standards and approaches. Climate and environmental riskmanagement Climate and environmental risk is embeddedin our approach to risk management (seepage 75) through our business and project risk registers. We have identified and assessed climate-related physical and transition risks aspart of our decarbonisation strategy. Consideration of current and emerging regulation is key to mitigating risk. Identified regulatory risks include enhanced transparency and regulatory reporting obligations, taxation instruments, and the potential for water restrictions in stressed/scarce geographies. Understanding how our businesses may be impacted by changing environmental factors is important to mitigating medium- and longer-term risk. A direct environmental risk factor is water scarcity which has the potential to impact our operations, particularly at those sites extracting water forprocess use. Indirect environmental risks include the impact of customer product useand supply chain risk. Climate change and the environment is identified as one of the principal risks for the Group (see page 75). Climate-related risks may present as financial or non-financial risks depending on the extent to which their impacts are associated with financial planning or have a wider reputational or strategic impact. During 2023, our sectors continued to incorporate wider climate risk within risk registers, including probability, speed and mitigation impact. This activity willcontinue in 2024 supported by maturing sector net zero roadmaps. Key environmental data 1 Water consumption (cubic metres) A B C 17% recycled (2022 9%) 2023 2022 A Mains 2,135,695 2,409,896 B Abstracted 2,925,651 5,968,417 Total 5,061,346 8,378,313 C Recycled 884,906 728,911 Waste production (tonnes) A B C 48% recycled (2022 70%) 2023 2022 A Non-hazardous 58,482 42,413 B Hazardous 9,308 5,072 Total 67,790 47,485 C Recycled 32,870 33,167 Electricity consumption (kWh) A B 0.3% renewable (2022 0.7%) 2023 2022 A Grid 755, 301,151 877,726,240 B Renewable 2,083,735 5,951,873 Total 757,384,885 2 883,678,113 Read more – Other sustainability information/ GHG methodology statement Page 234 1. BAE Systems Internal Audit has reviewed the systems, processes and controls in place to collate,validate and report this data. Based ontheprocedures and the evidence obtained, nothing has come to its attention that indicates the disclosures have not been properly prepared inaccordance with such systems, processes andcontrols. 2. Deloitte has provided independent limited assurance in accordance with the International Standard for Assurance Engagements 3000 (ISAE3000) and Assurance Engagements on Greenhouse Gas Statements (ISAE 3410) issued bythe International Auditing and Assurance Standards Board (IAASB). Deloitte’s full unqualified assurance opinion, which includes details of the selected metrics assured, can be found at baesystems.com/annual-report. 51 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategic report Financial statements Additional informationGovernance Environment and climate continued BAE Systems Board Quarterly Overall responsibility for climate-related risks and opportunities impacting the Group, including consideration of climate-related matters whensetting the Group’s strategy. The Board is supported by a number of Committees, as shown below. Nominations Committee Ensures the Board retains the required skills and experience, including climate- related matters. Businesses/sectors Each business/sector has net zero leads who progress the decarbonisation ambitions of each business/sector. Sustainability Council Monthly Reports to the Group ESG, Culture & Business Transformation Director, providing recommendations for areas of sustainability tobe given priority and focus as well as supporting the sectors inimplementation of the Group’s sustainability agenda. Net Zero Working Group Monthly Reports to the Group ESG, Culture & Business Transformation Director, and co-ordinates the progression of our decarbonisation ambitions. The Group is made up of functional representatives, business leads and environmental specialists. Executive Committee Monthly Responsible for managing climate-related risks and opportunities for delivering the decarbonisation strategy, including climate-related expenditure and investments. Our Group ESG, Culture & Business Transformation Director, who has day-to-day responsibility for environmental issues and ownership of the Group’s Environmental Policy, sits on the Executive Committee and provides the Committee with regular updates on our environmental and decarbonisation strategy. Audit Committee Reviews and approves TCFD disclosures, including analysis of any financial impact of climate-related risks. Environmental, Social and Governance Committee Oversees the Group’s ESG performance, including review of progress against objectives and targets. Innovation and Technology Committee Oversees the Group’s ability to make technological advancements through low- or zero-emission technologies. Remuneration Committee Determines the Group’s remuneration policy, including performance conditions linked to climate change and ESG-related matters. Core Business Processes Quarterly Business Review Quarterly Management review of the performance of each of the Group’s businesses against decarbonisation objectives and targets. Integrated Business Plan (IBP) Bi-annual Annual long-term strategy review and five-year plan for each sector,including investment case to decarbonise. Chief Executive’s Business Review Quarterly Top-level review of progress against decarbonisation strategy and key sector deliverables. Business Risk Bi-annual Management self-assessment of compliance with the Operational Framework and summary of key risks. Includes mandated review ofOperational Assurance Statement. Read more Page 94 Read more Page 97 Read more Page 102 Read more Page 105 Read more Page 107 How we manage climate-related risks and opportunities 52 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Sustainability Environmental stewardship continued Task Force on Climate-related Financial Disclosures (TCFD) The following tables summarise our disclosures relating to the four TCFD Recommendations and 11 Recommended Disclosures pursuant to ListingRule 9.6.8R(8). We have considered our obligations in respect of climate-related disclosure under the UK Financial Conduct Authority’s Listing Rules and confirm that these disclosures are consistent with the relevant Listing Rules and the TCFD Recommendations and Recommended Disclosures (including the implementing guidance set out in the 2021 TCFD Annex), save for – Metrics and Targets, part b. During 2023, we progressed internal workstreams to understand the GHG emissions associated with our global supply chain and in Australia, the Kingdom of Saudi Arabia and the UK, we continued to progress a programme of work to understand the GHG profile of material product types. We are not currently in a position to disclose our total Scope 3 emissions data. During 2024, we will continue to progress internal workstreams to understand our Scope 3 GHG emissions related to our suppliers and products. We expect to be able to make a recommended disclosure in respect of Scope 3 emissions data in our 2025 Annual Report. Governance Pillar/recommendation Overview Where can information be found? Disclose the organisation’s governance around climate-related risks and opportunities a) Describe the Board’s oversight of climate- related risks and opportunities. The Board oversees climate-related risks and opportunities in setting overall strategy, including expenditure and investments as part of the IBPprocess. It oversees the Nominations Committee, Audit Committee, ESG Committee, Innovation and Technology Committee and Remuneration Committee. The Board, through the ESG Committee, ensures that appropriate climate resilience and environmental programmes are in place and remuneration is set as required to drive the reduction in the Group’s environmental impact. Oversight and management of climate- related risk and opportunity Page 52 Governance framework Page 86 The work of the Board Page 91 Committee reports Page 94 b) Describe management’s role in assessingand managing climate-related risks and opportunities. Our Executive Committee is responsible for managing climate-related risks and opportunities and for delivering the decarbonisation programme through our business and value chain. Climate-related risks and opportunities are embedded across our Operational Framework, including roles and responsibilities, key policiesand processes. Oversight and management of climate- related risk and opportunity Page 52 Governance framework Page 86 Strategy Pillar/recommendation Overview Where can information be found? Disclose the actual and potential impacts of climate-related risks and opportunities on the organisation’s businesses, strategy and financial planning where such information is material a) Describe the climate-related risks andopportunities the organisation hasidentified overthe short, medium andlongterm; and b) Describe the impact ofclimate-related risks andopportunities on theorganisation’s businesses, strategy andfinancial planning. Our decarbonisation strategy supports our purpose and strategic framework in delivering a sustainable business and is an overriding initiative that encompasses our transition plan. It encompasses how wewill decarbonise our operations and product and service portfolio, whilst supporting our customers and suppliers in their transition, as aminimum in line with a 1.5°C pathway 1 . The decarbonisation strategy encompasses material climate-related risksand opportunities that have the potential to impact our business model and strategy over the short, medium and long term taking into consideration our assets and infrastructure. In putting together the decarbonisation strategy we have considered the commitments made bythe UK Government. We have considered the outputs from our scenario planning work andassessed these as part of our decarbonisation strategy. We can confirm that this strategy and our ongoing approach to business continuity encompasses the material risks and opportunities we have identified through the scenario planning process. These will continue tobe monitored, managed and, to the extent necessary, mitigated. These activities will be included within the annual business planning processes, and our current assessment is that the financial risk associated with the impact of climate risk on our operations is appropriately managed and mitigated, and will continue to be in the future. Our strategic framework Page 12 Our business model Page 14 Environment and climate Page 48 How we manage risk Page 67 Our principal risks Page 70 Impact of climate ambitions on the Consolidated financial statements Page 158 2023 CDP – baesystems.com/en/ sustainability/sustainability-reporting Other information – scenario planning Page 232 c) Describe the resilience of the organisation’s strategy, taking into consideration different climate-related scenarios, including a 2°C or lower scenario. During 2021 and 2022, we progressed qualitative and quantitative scenario planning covering physical risk, transition risk – regulation andtechnology and transition opportunity – products. Material climate-related risks and opportunities identified during thoseprocesses continue to be monitored, managed and, to the extentnecessary, mitigated. We will continue to address material climate-related risks and opportunities as part of our decarbonisation strategy. We anticipate revisiting our scenario planning as part of ournext business review in 2025. Other information – scenario planning Page 232 1. Following a Paris-aligned pathway, supporting efforts in limiting global warming to well-below 2°C above pre-industrial levels and pursuing efforts to limit warming to1.5°C – https://unfccc.int/process-and-meetings/the-paris-agreement. 53 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategic report Financial statements Additional informationGovernance Environment and climate continued Risk management Pillar/recommendation Overview Where can information be found? Disclose how the organisation identifies, assesses and manages climate-related risks a) Describe the organisation’s processes foridentifying and assessing climate-related risks; b) Describe the organisation’s processes formanaging climate- related risks; and c) Describe how processes for identifying, assessing and managing climate- related risks are integrated into the organisation’s overall risk management. Our approach to identifying, assessing and managing environmental risks,including climate-related risk, is embedded within our approach torisk management, via our business and project risk registers. Climate and environmental risks may present as financial or non-financial risks depending on the extent to which their impacts can be quantified, andhow they have been classified. Climate change and the environment is identified as a principal risk. Current and emerging regulations are considered as part of the environmental management system, including energy-related taxes andschemes. Environment and climate Page 48 Oversight and management of climate- related risk and opportunity Page 52 How we manage risk Page 67 Our principal risks Page 70 Impact of climate ambitions on theConsolidated financial statements Page 158 Metrics and targets Pillar/recommendation Overview Where can information be found? Disclose the metrics and targets used to assess and manage relevant climate-related risks and opportunities wheresuchinformation is material a) Disclose the metrics used by the organisation to assess climate-related risks and opportunities in line with its strategy and risk management process. We have reviewed the TCFD Guidance on Metrics, Targets and TransitionPlans and the cross-industry metric categories included in thatdocument. We report against the following cross-industry metrics: GHG emissions – absolute Scope 1, 2 and 3 (employee and business travel only) emissions, carbon intensity measure. Capital deployment – disclosure within ‘Impact of climate ambitions on the Consolidated financial statements’. Remuneration – 10% ESG weighting for ESG metrics in Performance Share metric. We disclose revenue from alternative energy-related products within ourAnnual Report (see Power & Propulsion on page 37) and Sustainability Accountability Standards Board (SASB) disclosure – Resource Transformation: Aerospace & Defence sector disclosure. We disclose our energy consumption within our Annual Report. We also disclose other key environmental metrics – water consumption, waste production and electricity consumption. We disclose our investment in R&D within our Annual Report (see page14). Environment and climate Page 48 Segmental review Page 35 Remuneration Committee report Page 107 Impact of climate ambitions on theConsolidated financial statements Page 158 Sustainability Accounting Standards Board (SASB) Disclosure | Sustainability reporting | Sustainability | BAE Systems b) Disclose Scope 1, Scope2 and, if appropriate, Scope 3 GHGemissions and therelated risks. We report our absolute GHG Scope 1, 2, 3 (employee and business travel only) emissions in line with Streamlined Energy and Carbon Reporting (SECR) regulations. This data is externally assured, to a limitedlevel of assurance, by Deloitte LLP. We have matured our understanding of Scope 3 emissions related to our industry’s value chain – 20-30% of defence industry emissions comes from upstream activities (procured products, transport of suppliers and travel); >65% 1 of defence industry emissions comes from downstream customer use of products/platforms (transport of products, usage of sold products, product disposal). We are continuing to progress internal work streams to understand theGHG emissions related to our suppliers and products. We acknowledge the importance of continuing to partner and collaborate with our customers and suppliers to reduce emissions by 2050. Key performance indicators Page 26 Environment and climate Page 48 GHG emissions and methodology Page 234 c) Describe the targets used by the organisation to manage climate-related risks and opportunities andperformance againsttargets. Our target is to be net zero across our operations (Scope 1 and 2) by 2030 by reducing operational GHG emissions year-on-year by 4.2%, following a Paris-aligned pathway, limiting warming to 1.5°C, over tenyears (against a baseline year of 2020), with a 90% reduction inGHG emissions being achieved by 2050. We are working towards a net zero value chain by 2050. We are continuing to progress internal work streams to understand the GHG emissions related to our suppliers and products and to put in place respective interim reduction targets in line with a 1.5°C pathway 2 . Environment and climate Page 48 Remuneration Committee report Page 107 1. Roland Berger – Defence Zero Volume 1: Military emissions and potential solutions and https://asd-europe.org/climate-change-and-defence. 2. Following a Paris-aligned pathway, supporting efforts in limiting global warming to well-below 2°C above pre-industrial levels and pursuing efforts to limit warming to1.5°C – https://unfccc.int/process-and-meetings/the-paris-agreement. 54 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Sustainability All images: © UK MOD Crown Copyright 2024 From left: Air Vice-Marshal Paul Lloyd, Director Support, Royal Air Force, Minister for Defence Procurement James Cartlidge MP, BAESystems’ Air sector Chief Operating Officer, Ian Muldowney, and Steve Gillard, Regional Director of UK,Middle East and International Defence Sustainability, Boeing. Reducing reliance on fossil fuels across our products andplatforms We are partnering with our customers and academia to identify andtrial new methods to reduce our reliance on fossil fuels, which isfundamental to achieving our net zero Scope3 ambition. In 2023, we signed the Defence Aviation Net Zero Strategy Charter – acommitment to positively contribute to the UK Government’s net zero ambition and support Defence’s Climate Change and Sustainability strategic approach. We are continuing to collaborate with the Royal Air Force, and wider defence industry, in their goal to reduce carbon emissions. In January 2023, after its successful sustainable aviation fuel trial the previous year, the Royal Air Force blended the remaining sustainable aviation fuel with traditional Jet A1 products (46–48%) to conduct the first air-to-air refuelling sortie with a Typhoon aircraft using sustainable aviation fuel blends. Additionally, we are partnering with theRoyal Navy and Rolls-Royce to trial alternative fuels in naval vessels by blending currently available fuels. We aim to demonstrate a Royal Navy destroyer running on 100% Hydro-treated Vegetable Oil (HVO), significantly reducing GHG emissions with no adverse impact on performance. Working with academia, we launched a three-year challenge with Southampton andStrathclyde universities in the UK to develop innovative solutions around hydrodynamic improvements and on-board energy consumption to reduce emissions incurrent warships and future designs. www.baesystems.com/article 55 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategic report Financial statements Additional informationGovernance We are developing an inclusive work environment, and creating opportunities for people andcommunities where we live and work. Social Our social value activities seek to positively contribute to the communities, regions and countries in which we operate and propel the business by ensuring we canattract, develop and retain atalented anddiverse workforce that will take us intothe future. During 2023, we focused onfour areas of social value: • Workplace environment – Creating anattractive, diverse and inclusive environment with an engaged workforce who feel that they belong, their safety andwellbeing are supported and they wantto stay. • Education and skills – Attracting, retaining and upskilling talent within our business and inspiring young people to consider science, technology, engineering and mathematics (STEM) careers, while supporting theiremployability and contributing to economic growth. • Supporting local communities – Working tosupport the communities where we operate, including charitable sponsorships, donations, employee fundraising and volunteering. • Armed forces support – Being a preferred employer for service leavers and reservists andcontributing to organisations that support active service personnel, veterans and their families. We progressed other activities during 2023 tosupport wider social value, including work streams on responsible supply chain to develop a diversesupply chain (see page 65). Workplace environment Workplace environment encompasses the range of activities that we undertake as an employer of choice, a Group that people want to join and stay in, where employees areengaged and their safety and wellbeing are supported. Our people strategy Our people strategy is designed to support our aim to retain, attract and develop talent and is delivered through: – robust succession planning; – targeted recruitment; – focused talent management; – a culture of inclusivity, learning anddevelopment; and – competitive employee value proposition. This is underpinned by people policies, guidance and support tools to enable ourleaders and enhance the employee experience. Our people policies lay the foundations and our people manager expectations highlight the responsibilities ofour leaders, which include: leading with authenticity, fostering a safe and inclusive culture, developing our people and rewarding them accordingly, enabling teams to perform, and establishing and sharing direction and our long-term vision. Our dedicated employee communications team systematically provides employees withinformation on all matters that impact them, including the Group’s financial and business performance. We also have an established employee experience team whoregularly survey different employee populations. Currently, the team serves the UK and in 2024 will expand to Australia and the Kingdom of Saudi Arabia. Wealso consult with our employees and theirrepresentatives regularly on a widevariety of topics. Their views are takeninto account in our decision- making processes on matters that affect their interests. We also encourage employees’ involvement in Group performance through an employee share scheme. Diversity, equity and inclusion We believe that diversity of thought drives innovation and performance and we have setourselves the following gender and ethnicity goals: – Group level – 50% of Executive Committee members to be women by2030; – UK – 30% of our workforce to be women by 2030 at the latest; – BAE Systems, Inc. – progress towards greater gender and racial diversity where currently below market availability; and – Other countries – targeted ambitions forother countries in which we operate. Throughout 2023, we prioritised initiatives around recruitment and retention of underrepresented talent, ensuring they are embedded into ourgovernance system and processes. As at31 December 2023, 29% ofthe Executive Committee and 25% of ourUKworkforce were women. In 2023, in the UK, 31% of apprentices, 21%of graduates and 25% of experienced professionals recruited were women. In Australia, 26% of our early careers intake (apprentices and graduates) and 23% of experienced hires were women. In the UK, we run a Women in Engineering Insight Experience encouraging young women (as well as men) to learn more aboutengineering by gaining first-hand insight at BAE Systems. In 2023, we offered79 engineering apprenticeships toparticipants (56 offers towomen) in thisprogramme. At 31 December 2023, in the US, 57% of ourexecutive leadership team members were women and women represented 26% of theoverall workforce. These US metrics are the result of not only acontinued focus on establishing robust pipelines for recruiting women, but also therecognition of the importance of every employee being able tosee themselves reflected at all levels of the organisation. Forexample, a quarter of our new hires were female, and approximately one-third of our senior leadership population are female. We have also made progress on ethnicity. Inthe UK, in 2023, 24% (2022 14%) of graduates and 8% (2022 6.7%)of our apprentices recruited represented different ethnicities. In the US, 29% of our Inc. college and intern hires represented people ofcolour. In relation to Board diversity, please see page84 of this Annual Report. Our Women in Defence mentoring programme continued alongside our InspiringFemale Leaders group, supporting the development of our female talent pipelinethrough mentoring and networking. Beyond our own business, we support initiatives to develop women in STEM andgrow female talent across the industry, for example, our Women in Defence mentoring programme. During 2023, female engineers in the UKranked our Company second in Universum’s 1 Most Attractive Employers list, and second for culturally diverse engineering professionals. BAE Systems has been ranked number one byEngineering Professionals in the UK’s MostAttractive Employers list by Universum and Ranstad, and voted 28th in TheTimes Top 100 UK Graduate Employers. Our business in the Kingdom of Saudi Arabia was also awarded Best Working Environment for Women within the Gulf Cooperation Council by the organisation Great Place toWork. We are also committed to giving open, full andfair consideration to applications for employment from disabled people and people with health conditions or impairments who meet the requirements for roles. We firmly believe that the inclusion of all of our people, including those who develop disabilities during employment, is vital to the success of our business and ensure training opportunities and appropriate accessibility areavailable to all. Sustaining a diverse workforce relies on building an inclusive work environment whereemployees feel valued, heard and thatthey belong. 1. World’s Most Attractive Employers 2023 – Universum https://universumglobal.com/rankings/wmae/. 56 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Sustainability In the UK, we have committed to 33 differentpledges and commitments to external charters, including veterans, LGBTQ+,mental health, disability, menopause, careers in technology and social mobility. Our ERGs play animportant role in creating a sense of belonging and educating employees about the unique issues our colleagues face in and out of the workplace. In 2023, in the UK, we also launched aLearning Community site to facilitate peer-to-peer knowledge sharing and best practice, both internally and externally. Thisincludes tools to help people managers build more inclusive teams. Age diversity 3,4 C A B UK ethnicity diversity 3 E D C A B 1. Senior managers has the meaning given to that term by section 414C(9) of the Companies Act 2006. Senior managers are defined as employees (excluding executive directors) who have responsibility for planning, directing or controlling the activities of the Group orastrategically significant part of the Group and/or who aredirectors of subsidiary companies. 2. Executive Committee (excluding executive directors) andtheirdirect reports. 3. As at 31 December 2023, excluding share of equity accounted investments androundedto the nearest thousand employees. 4. BAE Systems Internal Audit has reviewed the systems, processes and controls in place to collate, validate and report this data. Based on the procedures and the evidence obtained, nothing has come to its attention that indicates the disclosures have not been properly prepared in accordance with such systems, processes and controls. 5. Source: Office for National Statistics, Gender pay gap in the UK: 2023. Gender diversity Board (14) Male 9 (64%) Female 5 (36%) Male 254 (73%) Female 94 (27%) Male 71,000 (77%) Female 21,000 (23%) Senior managers (348) 1,2 Total employees (92,000) 3,4 A Under 30 years 19,000 21% B 30–50 years 42,000 45% C Over 50 years 31,000 34% A Ethnic minority 1,600 4% B White 29,000 67% C No data entered 9,10 0 21% D Not disclosed/prefer not to say 3,600 8% E Other <100 <1% Gender pay gap We have published our seventh annual gender pay gap report in line with UK regulations. For 2023, our mean gender paygap for our UK workforce was 7.7% (20228.6%) and our median gender pay gapwas 8.7% (2022 8.3%). This compares tothe UK median gender pay gap of 14.3% 5 . We rely onemploying large numbers of employees with STEM qualifications and we,like other companies, face challenges recruiting women with these qualifications because there are significantly fewer women who study and work in these fields. As a result, a greater proportion of our workforce and our senior leadership population are men and this isamajor factor in our gender pay gap. Wecontinue to work hard to improve our gender balance and remain steadfast in our commitment to delivering the plans we have in place to increase the number of women in BAE Systems and support the progression ofwomen into senior executive positions. Ethnicity pay gap We published our first UK ethnicity pay gapreport in December 2023, following our commitment to Change the Race Ratio and wider ongoing work in response to the Parker Review. We are committed to progressing racial and ethnic minority representation and in order to do this, we need to understand our ethnicity pay gap and supporting data. We already have a number of programmes underway to progress racial and ethnic minority talent, including RISE, the KPMG mentoring programme and our ERGs. In the UK, we are also committing to growing the number of employees from an ethnic minority background year-on-year and aim to double ethnic minority representation among the senior leadership of the business (Executive Committee and Executive Committee -1) by2026, from our 2023 baseline. Disclosure rates We ask our employees to voluntarily disclose their ethnicity. As at 7 November 2023, 86.3% of our employees have disclosed their ethnicity. 82.3% of our employees identifiedas White,4% identified as beinginAll Other Ethnic Groups and 13.7%did not respond tothe survey. Disclosure categories There is currently no specific guidance on ethnicity pay gap reporting, so we have mirrored our gender pay gap reporting requirements. We use two groupings – Whiteand All Other Ethnic Groups – to ensure anonymity of employee disclosures. Our ethnicity pay gap We have a mean ethnicity pay gap of 3.9% and a median ethnicity pay gap of 5.8%. Bonus Looking at the bonuses that ouremployees received, we have a mean ethnicity bonus gap of –2.3% and a median ethnicity bonusgap of 1.0%. 98% of our White employees received a bonus compared to93.4% of employees from AllOther Ethnic Groups. Mean ethnicity pay gap 3.9% Mean ethnicity bonus gap –2.3% Median ethnicity pay gap 5.8% Median ethnicity bonus gap 1.0% 57 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategic report Financial statements Additional informationGovernance Social continued We continued to run regular employee engagement surveys and analyse data to understand any differences, between groups of employees, which is regularly reviewed andfedinto our DEI strategy. Recognising our focus on inclusion, we appeared in the Stonewall Top 100 Employers Workplace Equality Index and we have launched an external benchmarking exercise to measure our progress as part of The Employers Network for Equality and Inclusion organisation’s Talent and Diversity Evaluation which has awarded us Silver Standard. In the US, our DEI strategy is focused acrossthree key areas – career, culture and community. Supporting strategic efforts include providing inclusive professional development opportunities (coaching, mentoring and sponsorship), developing culturally conscious, inclusive leaders, enablingoptimal mental health and wellbeing, and partnering with various non-profit organisations such as NAMI (National Alliance on Mental Illness). ERGs areat the centre of our efforts to continue fostering a culture where everyone is valuedand feels they belong. Finally, accountability for DEI is underpinned by theInclusive Leader Goal assigned to all people managers through the performance management process, with the aim of achieving transparency through our annualDEI Impact Report. Priorities for the year ahead In 2024: – We will expand the work of our employee experience team from the UK to launch astandardised approach to listening acrossUK/RoW (United Kingdom, Australia, the Kingdom of Saudi Arabia, Defence Information and Local Markets). – We will seek to strengthen awareness on managingand supporting neurodiverse employees through training for line managers and employees. – We will sustain our progress to foster a workplace where differences are valued and employees see themselves reflected atall levels of the organisation by removing barriers, providing opportunities, amplifying voices, and delivering programmes that educate, elevate andinspire our workforce. Safety, health and wellbeing Our people’s safety is a top priority. During 2023, together with contingent labour, we recruited more than 11,000 new hires and scaled up safety training to ensure our people are safe at work, in addition to increasing awareness around health and wellbeing. In 2023, the overall safety performance ofouroperations improved with our recordable accident rate reducing by 12.6%. The majorityof this improvement relates to areduction in recordable injuries within our USbusiness, especially those related to heavy vehicle manufacturing, explosives production and ship repair. However, the number of major injuries, our measure of severity, has increased by 25%, from 32 to 40 during 2023. This has been most marked within our Maritime sector. The majority of these injuries relate to bone fractures due to slips, trips or falls. To address this we have reviewed the controls around our significant safety risks. To further strengthen our safety culture wefocused on three key areas: – preventative safety management with theaim of investigating, mitigating and learning from incidents that can potentially cause serious injury or a fatality (SIF); – visible leadership engagement led by ourExecutive Committee team; and – continued deployment of safety training forallemployees. These areas of focus are regarded as qualifying metrics linked to the award ofourexecutive bonuses. In 2023, in the UK, we strengthened our focuson supporting employee mental healthand wellbeing. We achieved Tier 2 status in the CCLA Corporate Mental Health Benchmark, up from Tier 3 in 2022 as a result of a sustained collaboration with workplace mental health experts, data providers, charities and UK-listed and global companies. Our ERG for mental health, MindSet, delivered #breakthestigma roadshows atmany of our UK sites with high numbers ofmale operational workers. We launched a MindSet chapter in the Kingdom of Saudi Arabia and Australia during the year. In both markets, we have undertaken significant activity to raise awareness of mental health and where to getsupport including ‘Health & Wellbeing’ stand-downs in the Kingdom of Saudi Arabiawith engagement from over half theworkforce. In the US, our ABLE (Abilities Beyond Limits and Expectations) ERG continued its focus on de-stigmatising mentalillness through its Sharing Our Truths storytelling series. Additionally, we expanded our mentalhealth and wellbeing efforts through the creation of our Multicultural Network Inclusive Well- Being team, sharing our wellbeing framework ‘The Prescription (Rx) for Well-Being’ with nearly 500 employees through various forums, partnering with theNational Alliance on Mental Illness and commemorating Mental Health Awareness Month and Minority Mental Health Awareness Month. Priorities for the year ahead In 2024, we will: – expand our mandatory safety trainingoffering; and – continue to visibly lead on health, safetyand wellbeing from the ExecutiveCommittee level. Each of our operating regions will have anadditional priority: – in the UK, we will deploy a psychosocial risk assessment aligned to ISO 1 45003 toenable a standardised approach to identifying and reducing work-related risksto mental health; – in the US, we will refresh our peer-to-peer mental health advocacy programme and begin facilitating our ‘Prescription (Rx) for Well-Being’ sessions with teams; – in Australia, we will develop a bespoke risk mitigation programme in partnership with a leading psychosocial practitioner in response to new legislation which mandates management of psychosocial hazards at work; and – in the Kingdom of Saudi Arabia, we will expand our capability to deliver mental health first aid to employees. Recordable Accident Rate (per 100,000 employees) 1 BONUS KPI 2023 424 4852022 Major injuries recorded 1 BONUS 2023 40 322022 BONUS The award of the executive directors’ bonuses is dependent upon achievement of improvements in both safety and diversity (see page 123). 1. BAE Systems Internal Audit has reviewed the systems, processes and controls in place to collate, validate andreport this data. Based on the procedures and the evidence obtained, nothing has come to its attention that indicates the disclosures have not been properly prepared in accordance with such systems, processes andcontrols. 1. International Organization for Standardization. 58 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Sustainability Education and skills In 2023, we strengthened our recruiting efforts to meet the growth we experienced inall areas of our business and prepare for contracts in new markets. We prioritised recruiting people with the skills required to support our key programmes including engineering, project management and operations. However, wealso focused on developing digital, sustainability and entrepreneurial skills whichare becoming increasingly important. In 2023, in the UK, we recruited more than 6,700 experienced professionals as well as 2,400early careers trainees. This represents an increase of 18% and 37%, respectively, compared to 2022. Together with contingent workers, we recruited more than 11,000 newhires into our sites across the UK. As part of our plans to upskill our existing workforce, we launched our Global Digital Academy, initially in the UK, to develop employee skills at all levels from leaders to theshop floor. We have two cohorts of employees going through our sustainability apprenticeship with Cranfield University. Sixty current and future leaders have also attended an Entrepreneurial Development Programme with the University of Oxford’s Saïd Business School in the last few years, designed to help candidates understand how they can deliver greater efficiency and growth. In the US, we hired 7,200 people and received offer acceptances of just over 8,000 with a significant focus on attracting talent to our industry. These combined efforts resulted in a26% increase in applicants to over 300,000 and an 89% offer acceptance rate, an improvement compared to 86% in 2022. Wealso invested in our existing talent, launching mandatory people manager training to increase capabilities in leading hybrid teams and driving engagement and productivity (Soar with Core4), as well as a CEO-sponsored programme for leaders called ‘Senior Seminar: Leading is Learning’, using case studies of BAE Systems programmes to enhance performance and development through organisational learning. Our ability to retain and recruit people with appropriate talent and skills is a principal risk (see page 73) that we continue to take a range of actions to mitigate. Our early careers programme is the biggest opportunity we have to create the future workforce we need and contribute to social mobility in the regions where we operate. In 2023, we had c.5,500 apprentices and graduates in training in the UK. Our early careers apprentices achieved a 94% completion rate, compared to a national average rate of 51% 1 , playing a key role instrengthening our talent pipeline. In the US, we continued to increase thenumber of college interns in LEAP –ourinternship and co-op programme. Wewere also ranked 26th on the 2023 Forbes ‘America’s Best Employers for NewGrads’ list; coming second in its Aerospace & Defense companies sector. During 2023, in Australia, we recruited 113apprentices and graduates, and 40summer interns and we launched the firstdegree apprenticeships to meet a demand for software engineering skills whicharescarce in Australia. In 2023, in the Kingdom of Saudi Arabia, werecruited 246 graduates, trainees and apprentices to support growth in the region. During 2023, we continued our global STEMeducational outreach programmes toseek to inspire young people at an early age to choose a career in STEM supporting our future talent pipeline. In the UK, we invested £180m in skills, education and training in 2022 – almost double our investment in 2020 – and 1,600employees volunteered 11,308 hours oftheir time as STEM ambassadors 2 . In 2023, wealso launched the 18th annual season of our schools roadshow, jointly with the Royal Navy and Royal Air Force. With space as its central theme, the roadshow delivered an interactive experience for students aged 9to12 years old in more than 420 primary and secondary schools nationwide. In the US, we sponsored the FIRST Championship, the world’s largest K-12 robotics event, gathering innovative students from around the globe. The event attracted more than 50,000 attendees from more than60 countries, impacting more than 18,000 students. In Australia, our national STEM Outreach programme for Year 4 to 6 students is now inits second year. The programme was delivered in 23 schools and engaged just under 1,500 students. Priorities for the year ahead In 2024, we will seek to: – ensure our new employee intake is diverse, building on the progress made this year; – progress plans to expand the Global Digital Academy to Australia and the Kingdom of Saudi Arabia; – in the UK, recruit almost 2,700 early careers colleagues to meet business growth; – ensure thebusiness and our education providers can provide the placements andtraining places needed; – in the UK, continue to promote STEM opportunities to young people in schools. Our schools roadshow for 2024 will have a curriculum theme of ‘electricity’ and engage more than 400 schools and 100,000 school pupils aged 9 to 12 years, jointly with the Royal Navy and Royal Air Force; and – in the US, continue to invest in our partnerships focused on diversity in STEM,including NSBE, SHPE, BEYA, SWE,SASE and oSTEM to enable a robustworkforce ofthe future 3 . In addition, we will focus on internal mobility and career development and rolling out a virtualcareer centre for employees with anenhanced ‘My Career’ profile. Community investment As a Group, we recognise our responsibility to contribute to the communities in which welive and work, as well as to the regions and countries in which we operate. We contributed £11,267,109 4 (2022 £11,504,152) to local,national and international organisations throughout the year and our employees volunteered 23,705 hours of their time working with charities and not-for-profit organisations supporting those communities which we arepart of. As with all aspects of our sustainability agenda, partnerships are key. Wecontinued to strengthen our long-term relationships with the charities we work with,supporting them wherever possible tohelp mitigate the rising cost of delivering charitable services. For example, we donated £150,000 to help foodbanks across the UK, taking our total donation over the last four years to more than £600,000. Our people played a huge role contributing their time and energy to fundraising and volunteering for our charity partners, as they do year after year. Around the world, our employees worked with local organisations intheir communities to donate a variety ofitems including food, clothes, toys and furniture, providing essential resources forthose in need. 1. Source: the Department for Education Robert Halfon letter (publishing.service.gov.uk). 2. Oxford Economics 2022 ‘The Contribution of BAE Systems to the UK Economy’ report. 3. NSBE – National Society of Black Engineers. SHPE – Society of Hispanic Professional Engineers. BEYA – Black Engineer of the Year Awards. SWE–SocietyofWomenEngineers. SASE – Society of Asian Scientists and Engineers. oSTEM – Out in Science, Technology, Engineering and Mathematics. 4. Deloitte has provided independent limited assurance in accordance with the International Standard for Assurance Engagements 3000 (ISAE3000) issued by the International Auditing andAssurance Standards Board (IAASB) over the selected metric. Deloitte’s full unqualified assurance opinion, which includes details of the selected metrics assured, can be foundat baesystems.com/annual-report. 59 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategic report Financial statements Additional informationGovernance Social continued As well as hosting dedicated fundraising andvolunteering activities, such as our armed forces fundraiser ‘Skilful Salute’ in the UK and combining Group donations with employee- led foodbank drives across our sites, we developed new community partnerships that offered employees new ways of delivering impact for their communities. In the UK, we are a founding member of Movement to Work, a charity which aims to tackle youth unemployment. In 2023, our Chief Executive, Charles Woodburn, took upthe role of Chair of the Charity and we renewed our commitment for a further three years. We delivered 110 work experience placements to young people, 60 of whom went on to secure further education, training or a job, including 39 with BAE Systems. We continued to develop skills in our supplychain and other communities throughpartners, such as Be the Business, oursponsorship of Recruit for Spouses, coaching and mentoring, and support tothecadet forces. We also continued to support local projects close to our sites that served disadvantaged communities. For example, in Australia, we provided our second year of support to Stars Foundation, working with the organisation tosupport positive social outcomes for indigenous girls and young women across ourcommunities. We also donated £480,000 to InnovateHer, which willbenefit 8,000 young women and people from minority groups of less advantaged backgrounds across the North West of England over the next four years, promoting career possibilities in digital and cyber through a series of workshops, digital educational sessions andinspiring assemblies. In the US, we continued to intentionally investin local communities, channelling our contributions into social impact partnerships to advance meaningful change. For example, through our partnership with Step Up, members of our Women’s Inclusive Network ERG participated as mentors in Step Up’s Career Camps – virtual field trips designed tointroduce teen girls and young adults toavariety of industries, workplaces and professional cultures that inform their careerinterests. Priorities for the year ahead In 2024, we will: – improve our volunteering offering to our employees, introducing more opportunities for our employees to support their local communities and introducing a volunteering tool to make iteasier for more of our employees to getinvolved; and – focus on the impact of what we dobyworking to better understand thepositive difference we are making inour communities and sharing these insights with our different stakeholders. Armed forces support Given our Group purpose, supporting thearmed forces community is part of whowe are. Our activities focus on two areas: working with charitable organisations to support veterans, serving personnel, their families and heritage institutions through ourcommunity investment activities; and being apreferred employer for service leaversand reservists. We know that there isa broad talent pool available, aligned withour business operations and ambitions, and we want to be at the top of their listasthey look to employment in the privatesector. In 2023, we held our first ever global veteran ERGcollaboration session with employee representatives from seven countries coming together virtually to share challenges, knowledge and experiences. In the UK, we celebrated the 10th year of ourcommitment to the UK Armed Forces Covenant – for which we hold gold status – and 20 years of support to Combat Stress. We have also developed and launched our first ever Armed Forces Framework which brings together all elements of our support tothe Armed Forces Community under one model with data points for each component and a steering group structure with Executive Committee sponsorship. This will aid better decision-making and help us strengthen ouroverall offering. We have been working hard to grow the UKveteran talent pool through attendance atthe larger career transition workshops andsmaller events local to our business, as well as targeted contracts and social media campaigns. We have grown our veteran talent pool this year by more than 80% to1,000 people. During 2023, 6% of our experienced hires were veterans. Our Australian business was recognised withagold award for Best Employer Veteran Support Program, relating to the Vetnet ERG. We were proud to support our charity partner, Legacy, as it carried out a six-month torch relay to celebrate 100 years of support to the families of those who have served andsacrificed. Our employees stood, walkedand ran alongside the organisation tocelebrate this incredible achievement andraise important funds to enable Legacy to continue to support military families inAustralia. In the US, we continued to attend military and veteran hiring events and employee summits. In 2023, 25% of our new hires wereveterans, increasing our total veteran headcount to 17%. We were voted Military- Friendly for the 13th consecutive year by Victory Media (Gold-level 2024) andAwarded ‘Best for Vets’ for the 10th consecutive year by Military Times (2023). We continued to partner with the USChamber of Commerce ‘Hiring our Heroes’ programme toprovide transitioning service members with professional training and hands-on experience for work in the civilian world. Weare an Executive Committee member ofthe Virginia Chamber of Commerce Military and Veteran Affairs Council. Priorities for the year ahead In 2024, we will: – work with our community partners andheritage institutions to support important armed forces anniversaries, suchas the 80th anniversary of the D-Daylandings; – develop a global veterans’ charter toformalise our collaboration across theGroup; and – pilot a Corporate Fellowship programme for transitioning service members in two ofour business units. Community investment by type C D A B A Armed forces 1 32% B Education 40% C Local community 25% D Other 3% 1. Heritage data included in armed forces total. 60 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Sustainability Creating a sense of belonging Our ERGs are important to creating aninclusive work environment where everyone feels they belong. Each of our ERGs is sponsored by representatives fromour Executive Committee and seniorsector and geographical leadership teams. Our ERGs help shape our DEI agenda and support our progress tocreating a diverse workforce. We have six ERGs in the UK spanning gender, ethnicity, disability, LGBTQ+, mental health and wellbeing, and our veterans. The groups feed back to leadership on issues that matter to themand offer employees a nurturing community with regular engagement andactivities. Our ERGs are also valuable in raising awareness and educating thosewho may not directly relate to their focus area, but wish to support as an ally. In 2023, we increased overall membership in our UK ERGs by 28.5% through leadership advocacy, regular engagement within our sectors and early careers population, and raising awareness through our communication channels. We also launched three ERGs in the Kingdom of Saudi Arabia focused on gender, disability, and mental health and wellbeing, as well as two ERGs in Australia tosupport our First Nations and LGBTQ+ employees. In BAE Systems, Inc. we have continued our support through the broader Multicultural Network and achieved an 11% increase in membership of our eightUS ERGs in 2023. www.baesystems.com/article Marking significant membership growth during the year, our OutLink ERGs in the US (above) and the UK (below) organised participation in Pride parades and events in dozens of cities to support the LGBTQ+ and Ally community. 61 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategic report Financial statements Additional informationGovernance We are committed toethical and responsible behaviour in everything we do. Responsible business practices Ethics and compliance Our industry is among the most highly regulated of any sector. Our global Operational Framework sets outour approach and the mandated policies, processes and standards that apply everywhere we operate. Our Code of Conduct and ‘SupplierPrinciples – Guidance for Responsible Business’ (Supplier Principles) outline expectations forall our employees and partners. Anti-corruption programme Our customers, shareholders, partners and colleagues expect the highest standards of ethical conduct. We support our employees in understanding the vital role they have to playto conduct business in an ethical and responsible way. We have a zero tolerance policy regarding corruption in all its forms. Our anti-corruption programme is designed to ensure we adhere to all relevant legal and regulatory requirements recognising the bribery and corruption risks the Group faces (see the ‘Laws and regulations’ principal risk on page 76). The programme provides our employees with practical guidance, helps them to understand what is expected of them and creates an environment where they feel they can confidently, and confidentially if needed, ask questions and raise concerns. We regularly test the effectiveness of ourprogramme through internal and externaloversight and assurance, including encouraging feedback from our employees and from independent third parties. Risk- based due diligence procedures have been implemented to address bribery, corruption and other financial and non-financial risk, and our policies include processes for risk-based internal and external approvals, ongoing monitoring and repeat due diligence. We drive improvements in the programme annually to ensure it continues to meet best practice. Our anti-corruption programme alsoincludes our Code of Conduct and ethicstraining, and is firmly embedded in ourOperational Framework through our: • Code of Conduct – which explicitly prohibits the giving or receiving of bribes by BAE Systems employees; • Advisers Policy – which governs the appointment, management and payment of third parties who are engaged to assist with our sales and marketing activities or the strategic development of the Group; • Gifts and Hospitality Policy – which governs the offering, giving or receiving ofgifts or hospitality; • Conflict of Interest Policy – designed toensure that personal conflicts of interest do not impair employees’ judgement anddamage the Group’s integrity and interests; and • Facilitation Payments Policy – designed to ensure that facilitation payments are notpaid and that the Group and our employees seek to eliminate the practice offacilitation payments. Other relevant policies include: Community Investment Policy; Finance Policy; Fraud Prevention Policy; Export Control Policy; Pursuit of Export Opportunities Policy; Lobbying, Political Donations and Other Political Activity Policy; Offset Policy; and Procurement Policy, which include measures to address bribery and corruption risks. Theanti-corruption programme guides andsupports our employees in making responsible decisions. Our ethics programme Our global Code of Conduct lays out the standards and behaviours that we expect of all employees who work for us. It guides us in acting responsibly and ethically in everything we do and outlines the ways inwhich anyone can seek help and guidance. Our Code is supported by a training and engagement programme to empower people to make ethical decisions. All of our employees are required to complete live, manager-led ethics training annually alongside e-learning programmes of role-specific training, for example, on export controls. During 2023, we updated our Code of Conduct to include changes to our internal processes and policies and incorporate external best practice. The Code will be rolledout across our business, supported byemployee training, during 2024. In 2023, 98.4% of our employees completed our Business Integrity Scenario training, with the majority of those who did not complete itbeing employees on secondment, maternity leave, sick leave or other long-term absence. These employees will complete their training on their return to the business. We engage employees throughout the yearon ethics and responsible business. Weactively promote our Ethics Officers andEthics Helpline, to help ensure employees feel they can raise issues and seek guidance in a safe environment. In the US, we produce monthly ‘Ethics Minute’ messages to communicate directly on a range of topics, including workplace respect, gifts and hospitalities, conflicts ofinterest and speaking up, among others. Inthe UK, we produce regular ethics and compliance communications to spotlight particular areas including gifts and hospitalities, security and export controls. 62 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Sustainability Raising an ethics concern Employees can raise a concern anonymously across four primary channels: via our Ethics Officers; by email; on the telephone; and online reporting to our externally run Ethics Helpline service. Our Ethics Officers receive regular role-specific training to ensure that they are equipped with the skills to give guidance to employees raising anissue. During 2023, we received 1,531 enquiries, anincrease of 28% compared to 2022. There has been a 55% increase in ethics enquiries from the UK, Saudi Arabian and Australian businesses, primarily driven by theMaritime sector. This reflects as a 28%increase globally. There is a direct correlation between the increase in number of reports received in parallel to engagement activities delivered by the ethics leads in their respective businesses. Overall, the numbers of reporters seeking guidance has steadily increased with the substantiation rate of allegations remaining consistent. We see this as a positive trend, with employees reaching out for early resolution showing trust in the business andin ‘speaking up’. Of the 1,531 enquiries received, 770 (50%) required investigation, 42% of which were substantiated. The top five categories for investigation were: employee conduct; accounting charge practices (including time-booking matters); employee relations; management practices; and anti-corruption (including conflicts of interest). Of the 770 investigations for 2023, 576 were closed and194 remain open. 22 ethics enquiries were received about oursuppliers. 2 enquiries required investigation and were substantiated. 51% of ethics enquiries came from the US market. The number of ethics reports varies by region. Factors influencing this include the number ofindividuals working in that region and the cultural propensity of individuals from that region to utilise Speak Up mechanisms. We value openness, and strive to create a culture where people feel they can speak upfreely. Our main metric is the number ofenquiries made, and more specifically the number of enquiries per 1,000 employees. We also measure the proportion of requests for guidance compared to reports requiring investigation, anonymity rate and contacts made directly to one of our 245 Ethics Officers (one for approximately every 360 employees) across our business. In 2023, our anonymity rate was 25% compared to 26% from 2022, well below the benchmark rate 1 of 56%. 56% of reports were made directly to Ethics Officers in 2023 – we encourage this route formaking reports, as it allows for an immediate response by someone familiar withthe local situation. There has been an overall increase in dismissals due to unethical behaviour in 2023. Dismissals data has been reviewed with no particular trends identified. 2023 ethics enquiries by type 2 1 761 168 21 6 330 2 3 4 5 1256 47 708 79 1110 1611 912 313 Enquiries that did not lead to investigations 1 Enquiries that led to guidance and advice Enquiries that led to investigations 2 Accounting charge practices (including time-booking matters) 3 Anti-corruption (including conflicts of interest) 4 Data, technology and trade controls 5 Employee conduct 6 Employee relations 7 Financial misconduct 8 Management practices 9 Policy, process and trading 10 Safety, health and environment 11 Sales, manufacturing and delivery 12 Security and misuse of assets 13 Supplier and procurement Total ethics enquiries 2,3 2023 1,531 1,1962022 Anonymity rate 25% (2022 26%) Dismissals for reasons relating tounethical behaviour 2 2023 300 2432022 2023 ethics enquiries by region C D A B A US 787 B UK 673 C Kingdom of Saudi Arabia 47 D Australia 24 1. Navex 2022 anonymity benchmark. 2. BAE Systems Internal Audit has reviewed the systems, processes and controls in place to collate, validate andreport this data. Based on the procedures and the evidence obtained, nothing has come to its attention that indicates the disclosures have not been properly prepared in accordance with such systems, processes and controls. 3. Our US business uses the Helpline as a mechanism for people to declare a conflict of interest (e.g. a family member also working at BAE Systems, or a second job) – these are not reports of inappropriate behaviour orrequests for guidance, but a simple logging process. How our Ethics Helpline has been used How were concerns raised? What happened? Concerns raised 1,531 Helpline 512 Ethics officer 851 Email 135 Other 33 Case to answer 244 No case toanswer 332 Still under investigation 194 Concerns investigated 770 Advice given 761 63 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategic report Financial statements Additional informationGovernance Responsible business practices continued Improving industry standards We continue to play our part in setting an example for business partners and seeking tohelp improve ethics standards across ourindustry. We take a proactive leadership role in our engagement with the defence industry, governments, NGOs and other interested parties to develop initiatives that will address the key ethical issues affecting our industry. For example, we take leadership positions with industry ethics groups such as the International Forum on Business Ethical Conduct and the US Defense Industry Initiative. We also regularly interact and support the Institute of Business Ethics andthe Ethics & Compliance Initiative, andare proactive members of both the Aerospace and Defence Industries of Europeand the Aerospace, Defence, Securityand Space TradeAssociations. Product trading The defence industry is subject to strict regulatory controls. We maintain stringent internal controls that govern what we sell andto whom. To identify responsible trading risks our Product Trading Policy requires an evaluation on all products, services and trading activities. The process ensures that inaddition to a commercial assessment, consideration is given to wider ESGconcerns. Our Product Trading Policy and Responsible Trading Principles help us to make informed decisions about the business opportunities we pursue in accordance with our values. Export of controlled goods and technologies must be authorised in advance by governments. Failure to comply with all applicable laws and regulations could result inserious penalties for BAE Systems and theindividuals concerned, and could harm national security and foreign policy interests. Our Export Control Policy and Procedures are designed to comply with applicable laws and regulations, including sanctions and trade embargoes, as well as to detect and provide timely responses to actual or potential violations, including prompt investigations, disclosures and appropriate remedial actions. Product safety and quality We are responsible for ensuring that the products we deliver conform to their design and achieve an agreed level of safety and quality with our customer. We do this bycomplying with our Product Safety and Quality policies and processes. We define a Product as any goods orservices, including intellectual property, developed or traded byBAE Systems. Thiscould be physical such as a platform orsub-system, non-physical such as software or a design licence, oraservice such as a maintenance plan orsupport training package. Our Product SafetyPrinciples apply throughout the product’s lifecycle, and certain safety-related responsibilities may extend beyond the formalend of a project or programme. Human rights We are committed to respecting and upholding human rights wherever we operate, in the activities that fall under thefull, direct control of the Group. Our employees, our suppliers and business partners are all expected to adopt high standards of ethical behaviour. We are committed to conducting business responsibly and maintaining and improving systems and processes to minimise the risk ofslavery and human trafficking in our business or supply chain. Our human rights statement outlines our approach to responsible business behaviour, including in relation to anti-corruption, the environment, as well as our workplace, supply chain, local communities and products. Our Code of Conduct and other global policies and processes mandated under the Operational Framework, together with our supporting principles and guidance, support our commitment to human rights and are regularly reviewed. Our ‘Supplier Principles –Guidance for Responsible Business’ communicate the human rights principles weexpect of our suppliers (see page 87). Weengage suppliers on our Supplier Principles during the supplier evaluation stage and undertake assurance activity as part of ongoing supplier management assessments. In the UK and Australia, we have modern slavery working groups to progress actions toreview and strengthen how modern slavery and human trafficking risk is identified, assessed and managed across ourbusiness. We publish our annual responses, including work streams and progress achieved during the year, to the UKand Australian Modern Slavery Acts, anda statement in response to the California Transparency in Supply Chains Act on ourwebsite. Our approach to identifying and assessing human rights risks is embedded within our approach to risk management (see page 67). Cyber security As a major defence, aerospace and security company, it is critical that our information technology and operational technology, as well as the products and services we sell, arecyber resilient and the information, intellectual property and data held and processed on them is appropriately secured. The security of the Group’s products andservices, data, facilities and IT & OT infrastructure is regularly considered by the Board and senior management and underpins the Group’s protective securitystrategy and influences its engineering, technology, and digital strategies. Our cyber security strategy identifiesstakeholder trust in our business and our products as a fundamental enabler tomeeting our Group strategy. We constantly review our cyber security riskand take an agile, proactive approach to mitigating the risk. We do this by efficiently leveraging our core internal capabilities in cyber security, including our specialist threat intelligence service, to maintain a managed risk position as we digitally transform and thethreat landscape evolves. For further details, please see Cyber security on page73. Our internal Cyber Security Standards arealigned to the National Institute of Standards and Technology Framework and aformal, three layers of defence assurance programme, which is reviewed both internallyand externally, is operated to check adherence to these standards and customer requirements. To further increase cyber resilience, the Group’s Security Operations Centres perform continual monitoring of activity on core networks. 64 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Sustainability Responsible supply chain Our ambition is to be responsible and sustainable across our global business. Wecannot achieve this alone, therefore itisimportant that we collaborate and partner with suppliers to make a positive business impact, and the steps we are takingare detailed below. In 2023, we spent £14bn with 21,500 directlycontracted suppliers worldwide. These relationships are often long lasting dueto the complexity of our products and their long lifecycles, so it is critical that our suppliers share our values. Our success as a business relies on the resilience of our supply chain. It is vital that we collaborate and partner with suppliers todeliver the capability our customers need and to support our suppliers in addressing challenges, including in respect of the products and services they supply to us. Byworking together with our supply chainwe can accelerate our sustainability programmes which benefits us, our customers and wider society. In the UK, Australia and the Kingdom of Saudi Arabia we have developed a Supply Chain Sustainability Framework that covers how we will engage suppliers on our sustainability strategy. We communicate our expectations about responsible supply chain and our sustainability ambitions through the distribution of our Supplier Principles document. Our Supplier Principles cover supplier workplace and employee business practices as well as widersustainability issues. We strive to work with suppliers who share our approach to responsible business. Oursupplychain management starts with ourGlobal Procurement Policy which defines therequirements to be implemented by eachofour sectors to support the management ofsupplier-related risk. At the contracting stage, we stipulate our expectation that suppliers embrace our standards on ethical behaviour, including those set out in our Supplier Principles. During 2023, we undertook an annual risk-based assurance activity to test our suppliers’ adoption of these principles andtoidentify any risk areas that requiredinvestigation and/or mitigation. Wecompleted this assurance activity withsuppliers representing more than 30%of our global spend. Additionally, our standard terms and conditions require suppliers to comply with allapplicable laws and regulations, including those related to human rights, anti-slavery and the environment. We are committed to maintaining and improving systems and processes that reduce the risk of slavery and human trafficking in our supply chain. During 2023 we continued to assess our tier 1 suppliers against high-risk commodities and locations and we delivered awareness training to targeted employees who are responsible for procurement in our UK businesses. Additionally, we developed and communicated a formal Modern SlaveryReporting Procedure within our UKbusinesses to escalate reports of andconcerns relating to human trafficking and slavery. Conflict minerals We expect our suppliers to provide products made from materials, including constituent minerals, that are sourced responsibly, and to support efforts to eradicate the use of any minerals which directly or indirectly finance orbenefit armed groups that are perpetrators of serious human rights abuses. Reporting, disclosure andassurance We report on progress of our sustainability agenda within our Annual Report and online: baesystems.com/sustainability. ESG Materiality We have continued to address the material ESG issues that were identified during our 2021 materiality assessment. During 2023, wescoped a double materiality assessment based on current guidance issued from EFRAG¹, which we will use within the methodology of our next materiality assessment. Results from thisassessment willbecome available during2024. Our approach to UN Sustainable Development Goals We continue to support the UN Sustainable Development Goals (SDGs) and remain committed to making progress on specific goals that are aligned to our sustainability agenda. The SDGs provide a framework fordevelopment and addressing the challenges that global populations face from climate change and environmental risks through to managing societal needs andbuilding economic growth. For more information on the UN Sustainable Development Goals, please visit our website www.baesystems.com/en/sustainability Assurance of data External assurance of GHG emissions (page234), energy (page 234) and community investment (page 59) data isprovidedbyDeloitte LLP. Deloitte statement Deloitte has provided independent limitedassurance in accordance with theInternational Standard for Assurance Engagements 3000 (ISAE 3000) and Assurance Engagements on Greenhouse GasStatements (ISAE 3410) issued by theInternational Auditing and Assurance Standards Board (IAASB) over the selected metrics identified on pages 234 and 235. Deloitte’s full unqualified assurance opinion, including details of the selected metrics assured www.baesystems.com/annual-report For more information on all aspects of our sustainability reporting, please visit our website www.baesystems.com/en/sustainability/sustainability-reporting 1. https://www.efrag.org/News/Public-471/Publication-of-the-3-Draft-EFRAG-ESRS-IG-documents-EFRAG-IG-1-to-3-. 65 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategic report Financial statements Additional informationGovernance Non-financial and sustainability information statement The ‘Sustainability’ section (pages 46 to 66) constitutes the Non-financial and sustainability information statement as required by the Companies Act 2006 as amended, together with the ‘Our stakeholders’, ‘The work of the Board’, ‘Our business model’ and ‘Risk’ sections listedin the table below, which are incorporated in this Non-Financial and Sustainability Information Statement by reference: Topic Our principles, policies and standards that govern our approach Where to find information inthisreport Environmental matters and climate-related disclosures – Environmental policy – Decarbonisation plan Environment and climate Page 48 Addressing climate risks (TCFD) Page 54 Employees – Our People policy – Health and Safety policy – Communications policy – Code of Conduct – Personal Data Protection policy Our stakeholders Page 24 Responsible business practices Page 62 The work of the Board Page 91 Respect for human rights – Code of Conduct – Human Rights Statement Responsible business practices Page 62 Social matters – Community Investment policy – Commercial policy – Lobbying, Political Donations and other PoliticalActivity policy – Dignity and Respect Standards, in support ofourglobal diversity&inclusion vision – Supplier Principles – Guidance for ResponsibleBusiness Our stakeholders Page 24 The work of the Board Page 91 Responsible business practices Page 62 Environmental, Social and Governance Committee report Page 102 Anti-bribery and corruption – Gift and hospitality policy – Finance policy – Conflicts of Interest policy – Facilitation payments policy Responsible business practices Page 62 Description of principal risks relating to topics mentioned above – Risk Management policy How we manage risk Page 67 Description of business model Our business model Page 14 Non-financial key performanceindicators Key performance indicators Page 26 All our policy summaries can be found on our website: baesystems.com/en/sustainability/governance/oversight/policy-summaries 66 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Sustainability Effective management of risks is essential to the delivery of the Group’s strategic objectives andthe creation of sustainable shareholder value. How we manage risk Board The Board has overall responsibility for determining the nature and extent of the risksthe Group is willing to take, and ensuring that risks are managed effectively across the Group. Risk is considered on a regular basis at Board and Board committee meetings and the Board reviews risk (including emerging risk) aspart of its business planning and annual strategy review process. This provides the Board with an appreciation of the key risks within the business and oversight of how they are being managed. The Board delegates oversight of certain riskmanagement activities to the Audit, Environmental, Social and Governance andRemuneration Committees. Audit Committee The Audit Committee monitors the Group’s key risks identified by the risk assessment processes and reports its findings to the Board twice a year. It is also responsible for reviewing in detail the effectiveness of the Group’s system of internal control policies and procedures for the identification, assessment and reporting of risk. Environmental, Social and GovernanceCommittee The Environmental, Social and Governance Committee monitors the Group’s performance in managing those risks arising in respect of business conduct, health and safety, and the environment. The Committee reports its findings to the Board on a regular basis. Remuneration Committee The Remuneration Committee ensures that reputational and other risks from excessive reward, and behavioural risks that can arise from target based incentive plans, are identified and mitigated. Approach The Group’s Risk Management Policy is setout in the Operational Framework, the Group’s detailed governance framework. The Group’s approach to risk management isaimed at the early identification of material risks, mitigating the effect of those risks before they occur and dealing with them effectively if they crystallise. The Group is committed to the protection ofits assets, which include human resources, intellectual and physical property, and financial resources, through an effective risk management process, underpinned where appropriate by insurance. Reporting within the Group is structured sothat key issues are escalated through the management team and ultimately to the Board where appropriate. The underlying principles of the Group’s risk management processes are that risks are monitored continuously, associated action plans reviewed, appropriate contingencies provisioned, with this information reported through established management control procedures. The Board has conducted a review of the effectiveness of the Group’s systems of risk management and internal control processes, including financial, operational and compliance controls and risk management systems, in accordance with the UK Corporate Governance Code. The Group hasdeveloped a system of internal controls that was in place throughout 2023 and to thedate of this report. As with any system of internal control, the policies and processes that are mandated inthe Operational Framework are designed to manage rather than eliminate the risk offailure to achieve business objectives andcan only provide reasonable, and not absolute, assurance against material misstatement or loss. Process The responsibility for risk identification, analysis, evaluation and mitigation rests withthe line management of the sectors andGroup functions. They are also responsible for reporting and monitoring keyrisks in accordance with established policyand processes under the Group’s Operational Framework. The Group’s risk management process issetout in the Risk Management Policy, amandated policy under the Operational Framework, and, in respect of projects, intheLifecycle Management Framework, acore business process under the OperationalFramework. Identified risks are documented in risk registers showing: the risks that have been identified; characteristics of the risk; the basisfor determining mitigation strategy; andwhat reviews and monitoring are necessary. Each risk is allocated an owner who has authority and responsibility for assessing and managing it. Project risks are reported and monitored in Group-mandated format Contract Review Packs, which are reviewed by management atmonthly Contract Reviews. The financial performance of projects is reported and monitored using Contract Status Reports, which form part of the Contract Review Pack. These include programme margin metrics, which are reviewed regularly by the Executive Committee and Board. Project margin is recognised after making suitable allowances for technical and other risks related to performance milestones yet to be achieved. 67 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategic report Financial statements Additional informationGovernance How we manage risk continued In addition, every six months, the businessesand Group functions complete anOperational Assurance Statement (OAS), which is a mandated policy under the Operational Framework. The OAS is in two parts: a self-assessment of compliance with the Operational Framework; and a report showing the key risks for the relevant business and Group function. Together withreviews undertaken by Internal Audit and the work of the external auditors, theOAS forms the Group’s process for reviewing the effectiveness of the system ofinternal controls. Risks can develop and evolve over time andtheir potential likelihood and impact mayvary over time in response to events. These may include emerging risks, which areconsidered through the above existing processes, and through the Group’s business planning and annual strategy review process. Executive Committee The key risks identified by the sectors and Group functions from the risk assessment processes are collated into a report for reviewby the Executive Committee. In addition, the Group’s business planning andannual strategy review process considers longer-term emerging risks and opportunities. The Executive Committee reviews these reports and presentations to identify those issues where the cumulative risk, or possible reputational impacts, could be significant. These reports and presentations are shared with the Board. Management responsibility for the Group’s most significant risks is determined by the Executive Committee. The risk registers are reviewed regularly by the Executive Committee to monitor the status and progression of mitigation plans. The key risks are reported to the Board on aregular basis. Principal and emerging risks The Board has carried out a robust assessment of the principal and emerging risks facing the Group. Principal and emerging risks have been identified, and aremanaged or mitigated, through the application of the policy and processes outlined above. Principal risks include those that would threaten the Group’s business model, future performance, solvency, liquidity or reputation. Risks have been identified as principal based on the likelihood of occurrence, the potential impact on the Group and the timescale over which they might occur. The principal risks, together with details of how they are being mitigated and managed, are detailed on pages 70 to 77. The safety of our people and products haslong been a high priority for the Group; many of the environments in which our people work are hazardous and many of ourproducts and services inherently pose asafety risk. In the Board’s regular review ofrisks, it has determined that safety ought to be regarded as a principal risk, providing consistency of emphasis between the key safety objectives set for operational management across the business and the riskthat the objectives seek to mitigate. In addition, the risks associated with operating in international markets have beenconsolidated, with the principal risk from the 2022 Annual Report entitled ‘Competition in International Markets’ being subsumed within a simplified ‘International markets’ principal risk. The Board considers that presenting international market risks under a single heading adds clarity to this aspect of the Group’s risk profile. The directors have considered the relevanceof the risks of climate change andtransition risks associated with the Group’s net zero GHG emissions targets when preparing and signing off theGroup’saccounts. Our principal risks Page 70 68 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Risk Our risk management framework Chief Executive’s Business Review Quarterly top-level review of the key operational, financial and non-financial performance issues within the business, and significant forthcoming bids and events Quarterly Business Review Quarterly management review of the performance of each of the Group’s businesses against their objectives, measures and milestones Integrated Business Plan Annual long-term strategy review and five-year plan for each business Risk challenge, monitoring and reporting Core Business Processes Board Overall responsibility for risk management Audit Review Board Assurance of the Business and Project Risk management processes as mandated in the Audit Charter Audit Committee Operational Assurance Statement Risk Registers Environmental, Social and GovernanceCommittee Operational Assurance Statement Risk Registers: ESG subset Executive Committee Operational Assurance Statement Risk Registers Core Business Processes Strategic objectives and shareholder value Project objectives and financial return Project Risk Lifecycle Management Framework (Mandated Policy) Operational Assurance Statement Six-monthly management self-assessment of compliance withtheOperationalFramework and summary of key risks (Mandated Process) Lifecycle Management Project Performance Review Regular management review of project performance, issues and risks toensurethatappropriate decisions and actions are taken Business Risk Risk Management Policy (Mandated Policy) Identification Risks recorded in risk registers Mitigation Risk owners identified and action plans implemented. Robust mitigation strategy subject to regular and rigorous review Analysis Risks analysed for impactandprobability to determine exposure Evaluation Risk exposure reviewed andrisks prioritised See the Group’s Operational Framework for definitions of policies, processes and reviews Page 87 69 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategic report Financial statements Additional informationGovernance Our principal risks Risks are identified based on the likelihood of occurrence, the potential impact on the Group and the timescale over which theymight occur. The Group’s principal risks are identified below together with a description of how it mitigates those risks. The risks estimated as more significant to the Group (as at the date ofthis Strategic Report) are placed at the top end of the list. Government customers, defence spending and terms of trade The Group’s largest customers are governments. The Group is dependent on government defencespending, and the timing and terms of trade of government contracts. Key links to strategy 1 2 3 4 5 6 Description Impact Mitigation In 2023, 94% of the Group’s sales were defence- related. Levels of defence spending by governments are difficult to predict and can fluctuate depending onchange of government policy, other political considerations, budgetary constraints, specific threats to national security and macro-economic conditions (including movements in oil prices). From time to time, there have been constraints on government expenditure in a number of the Group’s principal markets. Lower defence spending by the Group’s major customers could have a material adverse effect on the Group’s business, results of operations, financial condition and prospects. The business is geographically spread across the US,UK and international defence markets. The diverse product and services portfolio is marketed across a range of defence markets. Many of the countries in which the Group operates have announced increases or are making plans to increase spending to address the elevated threat environment. Whilst governments face global economic and fiscal pressures, the commitment to defence in the Group’s major markets remains robust. The Group’s principal markets – the UK, US, the Kingdom of Saudi Arabia and Australia – have a significant and sustained commitment to defence and security – see ‘Our markets’ on pages 18 to 19 ofthis Annual Report. The Group benefits from alarge order backlog, with established positions onlong-term programmes in its principal markets. The Group also has a portfolio of commercial businesses, including commercial avionics. The Group has long-standing relationships and securityarrangements with a number of its government customers, including its three largest customers, the governments of the US, UK and theKingdom of Saudi Arabia, and their agencies (whorepresented, as at 31 December 2023, 69% ofthe Group’s revenue). It is important that these relationships and arrangements are maintained. In the defence and security industries, governments can typically modify contracts for their convenience orterminate them at short notice. Furthermore, governments from time to time review their terms oftrade and underlying policies and seek to impose such new terms and policies when entering into new contracts. Most long-term US government contracts, for example, are funded annually or incrementally andare subject to cancellation if funding appropriations for subsequent periods are not made. Further, the Group’s performance on its contracts withsome government customers is subject to financial audits and other reviews which can result inadjustments to prices and costs. Deterioration in the Group’s principal government relationships resulting in the failure to obtain contracts or expected funding appropriations, adverse changes in the terms of its arrangements with those customers or their agencies, or the termination of contracts could have a material adverse effect on the Group’s business, results of operations, financial condition and prospects. The Group has established strong and enduring relationships in its principal markets and is recognised as playing a key role in the industrial capability of each of the countries in which it operates. Government customers have sophisticated procurement and security organisations with which the Group has long-standing relationships with well-established and understood terms of business. In the event of a customer terminating a contract forconvenience, the Group would typically be paid for work done and commitments made at the time of termination. The Group’s profits and cash flows are dependent, toasignificant extent, on the receipt and timing oftheaward of defence contracts and the profile ofcash receipts thereunder. Amounts receivable under the Group’s defence contracts can be substantial and, therefore, the timing of, or failure to receive, awards andassociated cash advances and milestone payments could materially affect the Group’s profits and cash flows for the periods affected, thereby reducing cash available to meet the Group’s capital allocation priorities, potentially resulting in the need to arrange external funding and impacting its investment grade credit rating. This in turn could have a material adverse effect on the Group’s business, results of operations, financial condition and prospects. The Group’s balance sheet continues to be managed in line with its policy to retain an investment grade credit rating and to ensure operating flexibility. The Group monitors a rolling forecast of its liquidity requirements to ensure that there is sufficient access to cash to meet its operational needs and maintain adequateheadroom. Key links to strategy 1 Sustain and grow our defencebusiness 2 Continue to grow our business inadjacentmarkets 3 Develop and expand our international business 4 Inspire and develop adiverse workforce to drive success 5 Enhance financial performance and deliver sustainable growth in shareholder value 6 Advance and integrate our sustainability agenda Our strategic framework Page 12 70 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Risk Contract risk, execution and supply chain The Group has many contracts, including a number of large contracts and fixed-price contracts, and is dependent upon the delivery of services and component availability, subcontractor performance andkeysuppliers. Key links to strategy 1 2 3 4 5 6 Description Impact Mitigation As a major defence, aerospace and security company, the Group executes long-term high-valuecontracts for the provision of complex, strategically important products and services foritscustomers. For example, in 2023, 51% of theGroup’s sales were generated by its 16 largest programmes and, as at 31 December 2023, the Group had 12 programmes with an order backlog inexcess of £1bn. A significant portion of the Group’s revenue is derived from fixed-price contracts. Actual costs may exceed the projected costs. Assumptions on future rates of inflation on which the fixed prices are agreed may prove to be inaccurate and, since these contracts can extend over many years, it can be difficult to predict the ultimate outturn costs. It is important that the Group delivers on its projects within tight tolerances of quality, time andcost performance in a reliable, predictable andrepeatable manner. The failure by the Group to anticipate technical problems or deliver on its contractual commitments could result in (among other things) the loss, expiration, suspension, cancellation or termination of any one of its large contracts, which could have a material adverse effect on the Group’s business, results of operations, financial condition, prospects or reputation. The failure to estimate accurately and control costson fixed-price contracts could have a material adverse effect on the Group’s business, results ofoperations, financial condition and prospects. All of the Group’s major programmes are managed under the Group’s mandated Lifecycle Management process, which includes contract-related risks. Robust bid preparation and approvals processes arewell established throughout the Group, with decisions required to be taken at the appropriate level in line with clear delegations of authority. The Group has limited exposure to fixed-price design and development activity which is in generalmore risk intensive than fixed-price production activity. Further, the Group has a well-balanced spread ofprogrammes and a significant defence order backlog which provides portfolio resiliency and forward visibility. A significant proportion of the Group’s largest and most complex contracts are with the UKMinistry of Defence. In the UK, development programmes are normally contracted with appropriate levels of risk being initially held by thecustomer and contract structures are used to mitigate risk on production programmes, including where the customer and contractor share cost savings and overruns against target prices. A leadership development programme for project directors is in place across the Group, covering theleadership competencies required to manage complex projects containing significant levels of riskand uncertainty. The Group is dependent upon the delivery ofservices and materials by suppliers and the assembly of components and subsystems by subcontractors used in its products in a timely andsatisfactory manner, on satisfactory commercial terms and in full compliance withapplicable terms and conditions. This can be exacerbated where the Group is dependent on either one or a limited number ofsuppliers. Some of the Group’s suppliers or subcontractors may be impacted by the economic environment (including inflationary pressures and material shortages) which could impair their ability to meet their obligations to the Group and to supply on satisfactory commercial terms. A failure by one or more of the Group’s suppliers toprovide the agreed-upon materials, components or products or perform the agreed-upon services, on a timely basis, at the agreed price, according to specifications (including compliance with regulatory requirements) or at all may adversely affect the Group’s ability to perform its obligations, result inadditional costs or delays, require the Group totransition work to other companies (resulting infurther additional costs and delay) and/or resultin penalties under, or the termination of,customer contracts. This impact is heightened where a supplier is a solesupplier or one of a small number of suppliers. Additionally, the Group could be adversely affectedby actions, or issues experienced by, theGroup’s suppliers which are outside its control,such as misconduct and reputational issuesinvolving the Group’s suppliers, which couldsubject the Group to liability or adversely affect its ability to compete for contracts. Any of the foregoing could have a material adverseeffect on the Group’s business, results ofoperations, financial condition, prospects andreputation. The Group’s supply chain function establishes and manages enduring end-to-end integrated supplier arrangements, in partnership with the programmes it supports. In many cases, the Group benefits from long-term programme positions and incumbencies with more stable forward visibility for long-lead items allowing the Group to better manage supplier deliverables against programme requirements. Supply chain management starts with the Group’sGlobal Procurement Policy which definesthe requirements to be implemented byeach of its sectors for the establishment ofprocurement controls and the management ofsupplier-related risk. Risk-based due diligence and audit activity is undertaken for each supplier whom the Group engages. Once a supplier has been approved, andacontract has been executed, the supply chainfunction continues to monitor that supplier. The supply chain risk management programme isworking toward providing an enterprise-wide view of supplier risk, contributing to the continuity of supply and enabling better intelligence of sub-tier supply chain risk. Regular global supply chain meetings are heldwith senior procurement leaders to ensure that the latest risk data is appropriately shared. The Group seeks to manage inflation risk throughits customer contracting arrangements onmany of its major programmes, supplier cost management activity and through its long-term supplier agreements. 71 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategic report Financial statements Additional informationGovernance Our principal risks continued International markets The Group operates in international markets. Key links to strategy 1 2 3 4 5 6 Description Impact Mitigation The Group is an international company conductingbusiness in a number of regions, including the US, Australia and the Middle East. International sales and operations are sensitive to:social and political changes impacting the business environment; economic downturns and inflation; political instability, armed conflict and civildisturbances; the imposition of capital controls; the introduction ofburdensome taxes or tariffs; changes to exportcontrol, tax and other government policy and regulations in the UK, US and all other relevantjurisdictions; and the inability to obtain or maintain the necessary export licences and other trade restrictions. For example, the risk of the Group’s inability to obtain and maintain the necessary export licences for the Group’s business in the Kingdom of Saudi Arabia could affect the Group’s provision of capability to the country. Any of these factors could have a material adverseeffect on the Group’s business, results ofoperations, financial condition and prospects. The Group has a balanced portfolio of businesses across a number of markets internationally. The Group benefits from a large order backlog, with established positions on long-term programmes inthe US, UK, the Kingdom of Saudi Arabia andAustralia. The Group’s contracts are often long-term in nature and, consequently, it may be able to mitigate these risks over the term of those contracts. Whilst some of the Group’s contracts are on a government-to-government basis, for contracts which are not government-to-government, political risk insurance is held where considered appropriate with regard to the level of risk involved. However, as with all insurance, it does not provide full cover against all potential loss scenarios. The Group has a well-established legal and regulatory compliance structure aimed at ensuring adherence to legal and regulatory requirements and identifying restrictions that could adversely impact the Group’s activities, including export control requirements. Given the international nature of its business, theGroup is exposed to volatility arising from movements in currency exchange rates, particularly in respect of the US dollar, euro, Saudi riyal and Australian dollar. Significant fluctuations in exchange rates to whichthe Group is exposed could cause volatility inits financial results reported in pounds sterling and couldhave a material adverse effect on the Group’sbusiness, results ofoperations, financial condition and prospects. The Group’s policy is to hedge all material firm transactional currency exchange rate exposures. The international markets in which the Group operates are highly competitive and the Group’s business depends upon its ability to win and contract for high-quality new programmes in thesemarkets. The Group is dependent upon US and UK government support in relation to a number of itsbusiness opportunities in export markets. Furthermore, the Group’s competitors may also develop new technologies or offerings, novel support models or more efficient ways to produce existing products that could cause the Group’s existing products or services to become obsolete orthat could gain market acceptance before the Group’s own products or services. If the Group is unable to compete adequately and/or obtain new business in the international markets in which it operates, there may be a material adverse effect on its business, results ofoperations, financial condition and prospects. The Group has an international, multi-market presence, a broad portfolio of products and services, leading capabilities and a track record ofdelivery on its commitments to its customers. The Group continues to invest in research and development, and to reduce its cost base and improve efficiencies, to remain competitive. In the UK, export contracts can be structured onagovernment-to-government basis and government support can also involve military training, ministerial support for promotional activities and financial support through UK Export Finance. In the US, most of the Group’s defence export sales are delivered through the Foreign Military Sales process, under which the importing government contracts with the US government. 72 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Risk Cyber security The Group could be negatively impacted by threats to the security of its information technology and operational technology systems and products. Key links to strategy 1 2 3 4 5 6 Description Impact Mitigation As a major defence, aerospace and security company, it is critical that the Group’s information technology and operational technology (IT & OT) infrastructure, as well as the products and servicesit sells, are cyber resilient and the proprietary, classified, confidential or otherwise protected information, intellectual property andpersonal data held and processed on them areappropriately secured. Cyber security threats are continuous and evolving, and vary from attacks common to most industries, including those originating both externally and internally, to those from more advanced and persistent, highly organised adversaries, including nation states. The war in Ukraine has also increasedRussian-aligned hacktivist activity against pro-Ukraine nations andtheir defence industries. The cyber security threats faced by the Group include (but are not limited to): an attack impactingthe availability of the Group’s IT & OT infrastructure and systems and/or those of its customers, partners andsuppliers; unlawful attempts to gain access to the Group’s proprietary, classified, confidential or otherwise protected information, intellectual property and personal data, and that held or generated by the Group onbehalf of its customers, partners and suppliers; and compromise of products and services for the purposes of sabotage or to disable or deny their use and/or alter their performance characteristics. The Group might also be exposed to cyber securityrisks through an attack on the Group’s supply chain. Given the nature and scope of cyber attacks, itispossible that theGroup is unable to defend itself against all cyber-attacks, that unknown vulnerabilities could be exploited or that the Group may otherwise be unable to mitigate customer losses and other potential liabilities (including potential liabilities related to privacy and intellectual property). The Group could potentially be subject to: (a)production downtimes; (b) operational delays; (c) other detrimental impacts to its operations or ability to provide products and services to customers; (d) the compromise, misappropriation, destruction or corruption of the Group’s proprietary, classified, confidential or otherwise protected information, intellectual property and personal data, and that held or generated bythe Group on behalf of its customers, partners and suppliers; (e) security breaches; (f) other manipulation or improper use oftheGroup’s or third-party systems, networksor products; and/or (g) financial losses from remedial actions, loss of business, or potential liability, penalties, finesand/or damages. Any of these could have a material adverse effect on the Group’s business, results of operations, financial condition, prospects and reputation. The security of the Group’s products and services, data,facilities and IT & OT infrastructure is regularly considered by the Board and senior management and underpins the Group’sstrategy and influences its engineering, technology and digital strategies. The Group’s internal Cyber Security Standards are aligned to the National Institute of Standards and Technology framework and a formal, three layers of defence assurance programme, which is reviewed both internally and externally, is operated to check adherence to these standards and customer requirements. Additionally, where government customers require formal accreditation of theGroup’s IT networks, the Group ensures compliance and accreditation. A number of the Group’s IT networks are thus formally accredited and/or assessed as compliant by its government customers. Education and awareness to embed a strong cyber security culture across the Group is another vital part ofits preventative activities. Employees are subject to mandatory training which, depending on role, covers cyber security, physical security, document marking, security of export-controlled information, and personal data protection. As many cyber-attacks involve email, theGroup runs a programme of phishing exercises for allemail users across the enterprise. To further increase cyber resilience, the Group’s Security Operations Centres perform continual protective monitoring of activity on core networks. The Cyber Incident Response plan feeds into the Group’s crisis management plan and regular exercises are conducted across the business to test the Cyber Incident Response plan, including up to the Executive Committee. The Group purchases cyber insurance; however, as with all insurance, it does not provide full cover against all potential loss scenarios. To mitigate the cyber security risk posed by suppliers, theGroup includes cyber security-related obligations inits contracts where relevant. Cyber security risk is constantly reviewed and an agile, proactive, approach to mitigating the risk is taken. The Group does this by efficiently leveraging its core internal capabilities in cyber security, including its specialist threat intelligence service, to maintain a managed risk position as it digitally transforms and the threat landscape evolves. People The Group’s strategy is dependent on its ability to recruit and retain people withappropriate talent and skills. Key links to strategy 1 2 3 4 5 6 Description Impact Mitigation Competition for the people the Group needs to deliver its strategy, including those with innovative technological capabilities, is high. Competition may be intensified by nationality and regulatory restrictions (including the requirement for security clearances for certain roles), and exacerbated by macroeconomic, industry and labour market conditions more generally. The loss of key employees or inability to attract the appropriate people on a timely basis could adversely impact the Group’s ability to deliver its strategy, meet its businessplan and deliver on its contractual commitments, which accordingly could have a material adverse effect on the Group’s business, results of operations, financial condition and prospects. The Group recognises that its employees are key to delivering itsstrategy and business plan, and focuses on developing the existing workforce and hiring talented people to meet current and future requirements. The Group has well-established graduate recruitment andapprenticeship programmes and, to maximise thecontribution that its workforce can make tothe performance of the business, has an effective through- career capability development programme. In order to seek to maximise its talent pool, the Group iscommitted to creating a diverse and inclusive environment for its employees. 73 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategic report Financial statements Additional informationGovernance Our principal risks continued Safety Employees work with hazardous materials and in challenging locations and the Group’s products and services, and those of its customers’ or suppliers’, inherently pose a safety risk. Key links to strategy 1 2 3 4 5 6 Description Impact Mitigation Given the nature of the Group’s business, employees work in challenging locations, perform high-risk activities and at times use hazardous materials. Furthermore, many of the activities that the Groupundertakes are in high-hazard industries with inherent risk of harm, such as heavy industrial production including shipbuilding. The risks associated with the Group’s activities and working environments can cause harm to its people and those affected by its operations. There could be significant impacts if the Group failsto meet the necessary standards to adequately mitigate against health and safety risks. The Groupmay face criminal and civil prosecution inconnection with health and safety incidents, which could result in substantial penalties and fines. Furthermore, the Group could be prevented from operating, due to employees being unavailable for work, investigations being conducted or if a regulatory approval or certification is withdrawn, potentially leading to contractual penalties due toloss of productivity orinability to deliver on contractual commitments. Any of these factors could have a material adverse effect on the Group’s business, results of operations, financial condition, prospects and reputation. Safety of the Group’s personnel, contractor personnel and the wider communities in which theGroup operates is a primary concern. The Group monitors its safety performance constantly through leading and lagging indicators and strives to be a leader in safety performance. Safety performance is led at an Executive Committee level by the ESG, Culture and Business Transformation Director and is reported to the Board quarterly (with the Chief Executive providing updates at each Board meeting). Accountability for safety performance at a business level rests with the relevant Managing Director, who is responsible forensuring compliance with the Group’s Safety, Health and Environmental management systems and the Operational Framework. At a user level, every employee receives safety training that is both company-wide and job role-specific. The Group follows recognised safetyrisk assessment processes that are task specific and seeks to ensure hazards are identified, classified and mitigated against prior to activities taking place. The Group’s safety performance and practices areassured both internally and by external consultants to ensure compliance with both Groupand regulatory standards. The Group designs, develops, manufactures and maintains highly complex and specialised products and services. By their very nature, many of the Group’s products and services are hazardous and technical, mechanical and other failures may occur from time to time, whether as a result of a manufacturing or design defect, ineffective maintenance, incorrect usage, poorly executed integration with a third party’s products or services or through some other cause. In addition, the safety of the Group’s products could be compromised as a result of cyber-attacks, such asthose that seize control and result in misuse orunintended use of the Group’s products, or other intentional acts. The impact of a catastrophic product, service or system failure or similar safety incident affecting the Group’s, its customers’ or its suppliers’ products or services could be significant and could result in injuries or death, property damage, loss ofstrategic capabilities, loss of intellectual property, environmental harm, reputational damage or other significant effects. It could also lead to a loss of equipment, product recalls and product liability andwarranty claims, other service, repair and maintenance costs, significant damages and other costs (including fines and other remedies), regulatory and environmental liabilities and a reduction in demand for the Group’s products andservices. Any of the foregoing could have a material adverse effect on the Group’s business, results of operations, financial condition, prospects and reputation. The Group recognises it is vitally important to workwith its customers, suppliers and partners toensure its products continue to work safely, securely and with integrity, within their intended operational environments. The Group ensures the safe design and development of its products through a system ofcontrols centred on its Operational Framework and associated policies and procedures, including those specifically addressing Product Safety and Engineering standards. Assurance of adherence tothese aspects of the Operational Framework isprovided through regular operating business review, reporting and assessment, with independent assessment of the effectiveness of controls by in-house subject matter experts, Group Internal Audit and external domain regulators. In addition to the above, the Group continues toevolve and improve product safety best practice driven by new technologies and ways of working; liaise across industry and its government customers to develop new safety-related standards;and learn from safety-related failuresin adjacent industries. 74 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Risk Acquisitions The anticipated benefits of acquisitions may not be achieved. Key links to strategy 1 2 3 4 5 6 Description Impact Mitigation The Group considers investment in value-enhancing acquisitions where market conditions are right and where they deliver on its strategy. There are a number of risks and uncertainties which may arise in these transactions, including (but not limited to): (a) the risks involved in enteringnew markets; (b) diversion of management attention and Group resources to integration efforts; (c) unidentified issues not discovered in duediligence; (d) the performance of underlying products, capabilities ortechnologies; and (e)failure of the acquired businesses to perform inline with expectations. Any of these factors could have a material adverseeffect on the Group’s business, results ofoperations, financial condition and prospects. Inparticular, the potential for an impairment ofgoodwill and other assets could arise. Whether the Group realises the anticipated benefitsfrom these transactions depends upon thesuccessful integration of the acquired businesses as well as their post-acquisition performance in the markets in which they operate. The Group has established policies and procedures to conduct due diligence, manage the acquisition process, monitor the integration and performance of acquired businesses, and identify potential impairments. Climate change and the environment The Group may be impacted by environmental factors, including those relating toclimatechange. Key links to strategy 1 2 3 4 5 6 Description Impact Mitigation The Group is subject to comprehensive environmental laws, regulations and permitting requirements in each of the countries in which it operates, including those relating to the impacts ofclimate change. Such laws and regulations impose standards with respect to air emissions, wastewater discharges, the use, handling and storage of hazardous materials and waste, remediation of soil and groundwater contamination and the prevention of pollution. Increasingly, environmental legislation is seeking to encourage areduction in GHG emissions. These laws, regulations and/or permitting requirements may beinterpreted in different ways, conflict and/or change from time to time (as may any related interpretations and guidance). The Group may also be impacted by environmental factors, including physical risks arising from climatechange, such as extreme weather events, for example flooding and storms, and scarcity of water and other resources. In addition, the Group may be impacted by climate change transition risks resulting from the process ofadjusting to a low carbon economy. Associated with this are potential risks around (a) the Group’s ability to attract and retain future talent; (b) the technology evolution and innovation required torespond to future customer lower-emissions requirements; (c) energy-related taxes; and (d)theincreased costs of compliance with energy-related schemes. Environmental factors, including those relating toclimate change, have the potential to materially impact the Group’s business and operations. Increasing changes in environmental laws and regulations can expose the Group to increasing unplanned capital and operating costs associated with compliance, remediation and protection oftheenvironment. Breaches of these laws and regulations can result in substantial costs, including fines, penalties or other sanctions, investigations and clean-up costs, and third-party claims for property damage or personal injury as well as thetermination of permits. Extreme weather events can impact the Group’s operational sites as well as those of its suppliers. The shift to a low carbon economy has the potential to increase the cost of business as the Group transitions to lower-emissions technologies and deals with the disposal of its legacy assets. The Group has set itself the target of achieving net zero GHG emissions across its operations (Scope 1 and 2) by 2030 and working towards a net zero value chain by 2050 and has developed a plan to deliver this goal which includes exploring green energy options and surveying its buildings to determine how to make them more energy efficient. During 2023, the Group further developed its understanding of climate-related risks and opportunities so that the Group could understand potential unmitigated risks and its business readiness to mitigate any such risks. The Group uses analytical tools to apply natural catastrophe classifications to its sites worldwide. Thishas informed its strategy as to where to targetaprogramme of specific flood, windstorm and earthquake assessments of the Group’s sitesand implement the subsequent risk reductionrecommendations. The Group maintains property insurance cover which includes property damage and business interruption; however, as with all insurance, it does not provide full cover against all potential loss scenarios. The Group continues to progress a programme of work to understand the GHG emissions profile of its material products. This work will help the Group understand how to further progress efficiency of the Group’s products; to research and develop alternate solutions; and to identify how the Group can support future customer decisions and investment in product upgrades and new product development, having due regard for environmental considerations. 75 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategic report Financial statements Additional informationGovernance Our principal risks continued Laws and regulations The Group is subject to risk from a failure to comply with laws and regulations. Key links to strategy 1 2 3 4 5 6 Description Impact Mitigation The Group operates in a highly regulated environment, across many jurisdictions and istherefore subject to a variety of legal, regulatory and litigation risks. These risks relate to (among other things) trade controls, intellectual property rights, data protection and security, contract-related claims, government contracts (including auditsand reviews of those contracts), taxes, environmental matters, sanctions, product safety and reliability, health and safety, employment matters, competition laws and laws governing improper business practices (such as money laundering, false accounting, anti-bribery and corruption, and anti-boycott laws). These laws and regulations may be interpreted in different ways, conflict and/or change from time to time (as may any related interpretations and guidance). For example, export restrictions could becomemore stringent and political factors orchanging international circumstances couldresult in the Group being unable to obtain or maintain necessary export licences. Changes in laws and regulations (or the interpretation thereof) could result in higher compliance costs and impact customer or supplier contracts. Uncertainty relating to laws and regulations may also affect how the Group conducts its business and could limit its ability to enforce its rights. A breach of applicable legislation and/or regulations by the Group, its employees, sales representatives, marketing advisers or others working on its behalf could result in significant fines, penalties or other damages and/or the suspension or debarment of the Group from government contracts or the suspension of theGroup’s export privileges. If customers or other third parties were harmed by the conduct of members of the Group, this may also give rise to legal proceedings, including class actions. Other legal disputes mayalso arise between members of the Group and third parties relating to matters such as breaches or enforcement of legal rights or obligations arising under contracts, statutes orcommon law. Adverse findings in any such matters may result in members of the Group being liable to third parties or may result in rights not being enforced or not being enforced in the manner intended or desired. Any of the foregoing could have a material adverse effect on the Group’s business, results of operations, financial condition, prospects and reputation. The Group has a well-established legal and regulatory compliance structure aimed at ensuring adherence to regulatory requirements and identifying restrictions that could adversely impact the Group’s activities. Internal and external market risk assessments form an important element of ongoing corporate development andtraining processes. A uniform global policy and process for the appointment ofadvisers engaged in business development is in effect andan export control policy mandates compliance with allapplicable trade controls requirements. It is important that the Group maintains a culture in which itfocuses on responsible business behaviours and that all employees act in accordance with the requirements of the Group’s policies, including the Code of Conduct, at all times. Accordingly, it continues to reinforce its ethics programme globally, supporting employees in making ethical decisions and embedding responsible business practices. The Group’s internal legal team and, where appropriate, external counsel manage litigation and advise on the management of associated impacts. 76 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Risk Outbreak of contagious diseases The outbreak of contagious diseases may have an adverse effect on the Company’s business, financial condition and results of operations. Key links to strategy 1 2 3 4 5 6 Description Impact Mitigation An outbreak of a contagious disease could occur which could introduce constraints on both the Company’s operations and those ofits supply chain. Contagious diseases, and the measures taken to control them, can have a material adverse effect on the Group’s business, results of operations, financial condition and prospects. Areas of the Group’s business that could be impacted include a decrease in spending by the Group’s customers; an increase in taxation by governments; the failure to obtain awards for contracts; the inability of the Group to execute its contractual obligations on time and within planned budgets; the inability to adequately staff and manage the business; and a lack of availability of funding. The Group’s experience in dealing with the COVID-19 pandemic between 2020 and 2022 will assist it in dealing with any further outbreaks of contagious diseases. This includes the use of safe working practices, the effective useof home working and working collaboratively with government customers to maintain critical defence and security programmes. Pension funding An aggregate funding deficit could arise in the Group’s defined benefit pension schemes. Key links to strategy 1 2 3 4 5 6 Description Impact Mitigation The assets held by the Group’s defined benefit pension schemes (which, as at 31 December 2023, were £24.0bn) could prove to be insufficient to meet the anticipated liabilities of the schemes, resulting in a funding deficit. Such a funding deficit could be caused by anumber of factors including insufficient investment returns and greater than expectedmember longevity. If a funding deficit were to arise in any of the schemes, the Group may be required to make deficit repair contributions to those schemes, thereby reducing cash available to meet the Group’s other capital allocation priorities. Thiscould have a material adverse effect on theGroup’s business, results of operations, financial condition and prospects. The funding positions of the schemes are monitored on a regular basis and the latest triennial actuarial valuations of the Group’s UK defined benefit pension schemes showed asat their respective dates that there is no funding deficit in any of those schemes on a technical provisions basis. That position is estimated to have been maintained since then. Each defined benefit scheme pursues an investment strategy designed to provide a high probability that the scheme will be able to satisfy its liabilities as they fall due, even under a range of plausible downside scenarios. To further reduce the risk of deficits arising in the future, theschemes’ trustees, in conjunction with the Group, have continued to take action to hedge major risk factors such asinflation and interest rate risk, and longevity risk. All of the Group’s UK defined benefit schemes have beenclosed to new employees since 2012 and, in the US,employees have not accrued salary-related benefits indefined benefit schemes since 2013. The ranking and evaluation of risks as at the date of this Strategic Report should not be relied upon as a guide to their future ranking and evaluation. Additional risks and uncertainties currently unknown to the Group, or which the Group currently deems immaterial, may also have an adverse effect on the business or financial condition of the Group. 77 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategic report Financial statements Additional informationGovernance As required by the provisions of the UK Corporate Governance Code 2018, theBoard has undertaken an assessment of the future prospects of the Group, taking into account the Group’s current position and principal risks. Viability statement The viability assessment period The directors have assessed the viability of the Group over a five-year period. This is considered the most appropriate period for the assessment as it is consistent with the Group’s five-year business planning cycle. Analysis of business prospects The Board has considered the long-term prospects of the Group based on its strategy, markets and business plan as outlined in this report. Initsstrategic review of the Group, the Board recognised the importance of certain factors that underpin its long-term prospects and viability. In summary, these are: • a diverse portfolio of businesses based onwell-established market positions, providing both complex, high-technology products and programmes, and differentiated technical services and support. In 2023, 40% of Group sales wereproduct/programme related and 39%services and support; • a geographically diverse business with a high proportion of sales to governments and other major prime defence contractors. In 2023, 33% of revenues were to the USDepartment of Defense, 25% to theUKMinistry of Defence and 11% totheKingdom of Saudi Arabia Ministry ofDefence and Aviation. The Group’s robust order backlog continues to provide astrong foundation for further market diversity and growth; • long-term visibility of sales and future saleprospects through a substantial order backlog and incumbent positions on major defence programmes; and • market positions underpinned by a highly-skilled workforce, intellectual property assets and proprietary know-how, which are safeguarded and developed for the future by customer- and Group-funded investment. Such investment is focused on a well-developed understanding of future technologies and the threat environment shaping the long-term defence and aerospace market. This assessment considered both the Group’s long-term prospects and also its ability to continue in operation and meet its liabilities asthey fall due over its five-year business planning period. Assessment The Board’s assessment of the Group’s prospects was informed by the following business processes: Risk management process – the Group hasdeveloped a structured approach to themanagement of risk (see above) and principal and emerging risks identified are considered as part of the Board’s annual review of the Integrated Business Plan. The Board recognises that the principal risksidentified on pages 70 to 77 could impact the future viability of the Group, andhas undertaken more detailed scenario analysis in relation to specific risks that areconsidered most likely to have a more immediate and severe financial impact ontheGroup. The viability assessment has taken into account reasonably plausible, but severe, downside scenarios related to these risks andassessed the impact on the future cash flows, profitability, financial covenants, solvency and liquidity of the Group. Integrated Business Plan (IBP) – the IBP represents a common process with standard outputs and requirements that produces anintegrated strategic and business plan forthe Group and also for each of its businesses over the following five years. Theuse of a five-year period provides arobust planning tool against which long-term decisions can be made concerning, among other things; strategic priorities, addressing the Group’s stated net zero target and climate-related risks and opportunities, funding requirements (including commitments to Group pension schemes), returns made toshareholders, capex and resource planning. Longer-term strategic inputs also form part of the IBP process and,where activity is required to meet suchlong-term priorities, this is provided forin the plan. The detailed plan is reviewed each year bytheBoard as part of its strategy review process. Once approved by the Board, the IBPprovides the basis for setting all detailed financial budgets and strategic actions across the businesses, and is subsequently used bythe Board to monitor performance. Liquidity and solvency analysis – the Group’s liquidity is underpinned by an undrawn committed Revolving Credit Facility (RCF) of £2bn. During the year, the Group entered into a new five-year RCF, with twoone-year extension options, taking the expected maturity of the facility to 2030. 78 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Risk Strategic report The Strategic report was approved by the Board of directors on 20 February 2024. David Parkes Company Secretary This facility is available to meet general corporate funding requirements. The Board regularly reviews an analysis based on the financial output from the IBP, looking at the forecast working capital requirements, cash flow, and committed borrowing (see note 21 on page 189) and other funding facilities available to the Group overthe five-year period covered by the IBP. This analysis includes ‘stress testing’ of the Group’s liquidity and solvency under severe, but plausible, scenarios as developed from the IBP, including the following: • the Group being unable to access debt markets to renew term debt facilities; • an unfavourable change to the terms oftrade the Group enjoys with certain principal customers; • the inability of the Group to estimate accurately and control costs on significant fixed price contracts; and • the loss of significant export awards assumed in the IBP. The scenarios tested included the impact of multiple adverse factors and any mitigating factors. In August 2023, the Group announced that it had entered into a stock purchase agreement to acquire the Ball Aerospace business from Ball Corporation for $5.5bn. The acquisition completed in February 2024 and wasfunded through a combination of new external debt,in the form of a bridge loanfacility (the‘facility’), and existing cashresources. Following completion of the acquisition, theGroup intends to refinance the facility. As at 31 December 2023, thefacility was undrawn. The Board has considered the utilisation of the facility and the anticipated refinancing ofthe facility, taking into account the Group’s investment grade credit ratings, strong balance sheet and track record of raising external debt to fund M&A activity, and the cash outlay associated with the acquisition when making this viability statement. Conclusion In undertaking its review of the IBP in 2023,the Board considered the prospects ofthe Group over the five-year period covered by the process. On the basis of this and other matters considered and reviewed by the Board, the Board has reasonable expectations that the Group will be able to continue in operation and meet its liabilities as they fall due over the following five years. It is recognised that such future assessments are subject to a level of uncertainty that increases with time and, therefore, future outcomes cannot be guaranteed or predictedwith certainty. Also, this assessment was made recognising the principal risks thatcould have an impact on the future performance of the Group (see pages 70 to77). Going concern statement Accounting standards require that directors satisfy themselves that it is reasonable for them to conclude whether it is appropriate to prepare financial statements on a going concern basis and the Code requires that, if appropriate, this report includes a statement to that effect. Following review, the directors have concluded that it is appropriate to adopt the going concern basis for these financial statements and have not identified any material uncertainties concerning the Group’s ability to do so in the 12-month period from the date of approving them. For this reason, they continue to adopt the going concern basis in preparing the accounts. 79 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Strategic report Financial statements Additional informationGovernance Chair’s governance letter Contents Chair’s governance letter 80 Board of directors 81 Board and Executive Management diversityinformation 84 Governance framework 86 Applying the 2018 UK Corporate GovernanceCode Principles 88 Compliance with the 2018 UK Corporate Governance Code provisions 90 The work of the Board (s.172) 91 Nominations Committeereport 94 Audit Committee report 97 Environmental, Social and GovernanceCommitteereport 102 Innovation and Technology Committeereport 105 Remuneration Committeereport 107 Dear Shareholders This section focuses on the Company’s governance structures, the work of the Board and its committees and how we comply with the UK’s Corporate Governance Code 2018 (the Code), and other regulatory requirements. A change of Chair allows for a proper review of the governance structures and processes already in place. As you would expect, our existing governance practices are robust, with clear standards of behaviour laid out in our Code of Conduct, and a strong operational framework for managing the business from Board level down. Our committee responsibilities are clear and well managed by individual committee chairs, and we are in the process of updating and refreshing terms of reference and standing agendas for all committees. Some of these changes are in anticipation of changes in UK governance standards; for example, weare updating and refreshing our approach to risk management and assurance. You can read about this in more detail in the report onthe activities of the Audit Committee on page 97. Such changes are an essential part of maintaining a robust governance framework on an ongoing basis. Our governance structures also respect and uphold the special arrangements in place to protect the national security interests of our government customers. These arrangements are essential to our success as an international company and, at the same time, a valued and trusted partner in the security interests of our customers. We have a significant presence in the US, where the Department of Defense is our largest customer. There is more detail on arrangements for managing our US business on page 87. I am keen to ensure that all non-executive directors have opportunities to visit our operations and engage directly with employees and local leadership teams. This gives directors deeper insight into employee views and our culture. In 2023, the Board visited our Naval Ships’ facilities in Glasgow, and also some of our Air operations in Warton, Lancashire where we are working onthe GCAP future fighter programme. Along with its broader responsibilities, ourEnvironmental, Social and Governance Committee has been focused on employee issues and you can read more about its activities on page 102. The Innovation andTechnology Committee has had its ownprogramme of visits and you can readmoreabout its activities on page 105. The diversity of background, skills and experience of our Board is key to its strong performance, and there is more detail on ourplanning for director succession in the Nominations Committee report on page 94. Effective board performance is a key part ofgovernance, and with a change in Board leadership, we have taken the opportunity tohave an external evaluation of board performance, led by No.4. Further details onthe evaluation process, its outcomes andactions we will be taking as a result areoutlined in more detail on page 95. Overall the Board is keen to ensure that our future growth is built on a firm foundation ofrobust and effective governance and adisciplined approach to decision making andprogramme management. Cressida Hogg CBE Chair 80 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Directors’ report N N Committee Chair A Audit Committee E Environmental, Social and GovernanceCommittee I Innovation and Technology Committee N Nominations Committee R Remuneration Committee Board of directors Dr Charles Woodburn CBE Chief Executive Tom Arseneault President and Chief Executive Officer of BAESystems, Inc. Brad Greve Chief Financial Officer Cressida Hogg CBE Chair Appointed to the Board: 2016 Nationality: UK Skills, competence and experience Charles joined BAE Systems in May 2016 asChief Operating Officer and became ChiefExecutive on 1July 2017. He is an experienced business leader with over 27 years’ experience in the defence andaerospace, and oil and gas industries. Prior to joining the Company in 2016, he wasChief Executive Officer of Expro Group, before which he spent 15 years with Schlumberger Limited holding a number ofsenior management positions in Asia, Australia, Europe and the US. Charles is atrustee and Chair of the charity Movement to Work. He is a Fellow of the Royal Academyof Engineering. Charles was awarded a CBE in 2023 for services to international trade and skills. Appointed to the Board: 2020 Nationality: US Skills, competence and experience Brad joined BAE Systems in 2019 as Group Finance Director Designate and joined the Board on 1 April 2020. He is a highly experienced executive with deep financial and operational management experience, gained during a career in excess of 30 years in international engineering and technology businesses. Prior to joining the Company, he held a number of senior executive roles in Schlumberger, undertaking roles in Europe, Africa, South America and the US. Appointed to the Board: 2020 Nationality: US Skills, competence and experience Tom was appointed to the Board on 1 April2020, and serves as President and Chief Executive Officer of BAE Systems, Inc. Throughout his career, Tom has led complex organisations responsible for fulfilling critical and technologically challenging missions. Before becoming President and Chief Executive Officer of BAE Systems, Inc., heheld various senior roleswithin BAESystems, Inc. Prior to his senior leadership appointments, Tommanaged various organisations and programmes for Sanders, a Lockheed Martincompany, until it was acquired byBAESystems in2000. Earlier in his career,heheld a variety ofengineering andprogramme management positions withGeneral Electric and TASC. Tom is a member of the Executive committee oftheAerospace Industries Association. Appointed to the Board: 2022 Nationality: UK Skills, competence and experience Cressida was appointed Chair of BAE Systems plc in May 2023, having joined the Board as anon-executive director and Chair designate in November 2022. Cressida is also a non-executive director of London Stock Exchange Group plc, where she is the SeniorIndependent Director. She has previously enjoyed a long executive career, spent largely with 3i Group, during which shedeveloped adeep understanding of large,long-term infrastructure projects and businesses, gaining international experience whilst working in various countries including the US, Canada, India, Australia and theMiddle East. Cressida was awarded a CBE in 2014 forservices to infrastructure investment andpolicy. 81 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Financial statements Additional informationGovernanceStrategic report E I N A I N R A E N I N R R A N E N Board of directors continued Nick Anderson Non-executive director Crystal E Ashby Non-executive director Dame Elizabeth Corley CBE Non-executive director Dr Jane Griffiths Non-executive director Dr Ewan Kirk Non-executive director Angus Cockburn Non-executive director Appointed to the Board: 2016 Nationality: UK Skills, competence and experience Dame Elizabeth brings a wealth of investor, governance and boardroom experience to the Board. She is the Chair of Schroders plc and a former non-executive director of Pearson plc and Morgan Stanley Inc. She chairs the board of the Impact Investment Institute, having previously chaired the industry Taskforce on Social Impact Investing for the UK government. She served as Chief Executive Officer of Allianz Global Investors, initially for Europe then globally, from 2005 to 2016. Prior to that, she worked for Merrill Lynch Investment Managers. Elizabeth is active in representing the investment industry and developing standards within it. She is amember of the CFA Future of Finance Advisory Council, the AQR Institute of Asset Management attheLondon Business School, the Committee of 200and the 300 Club. Elizabeth is also an acclaimed writer, a Fellow of theRoyal Society for the encouragement of Arts, Manufactures and Commerce and a trustee of theBritish Museum. Appointed to the Board: 2020 Nationality: UK Skills, competence and experience As the former Group Chief Executive of a FTSE 100 industrial engineering company, Nick has a strong record of leading and growing global businesses. Hisknowledge and experience, particularly in leadinginternational engineering and manufacturing operations, are a particular asset to the Board. During his tenure as Group Chief Executive ofSpirax-Sarco Engineering plc, a position he heldforten years, Nickoversaw the successful globalgrowth of Spirax-Sarco Engineering. Prior tohisroles at the company, he was Vice-President ofJohn Crane Asia Pacific and Presidentof John CraneLatin America. Appointed to the Board: 2021 Nationality: US Skills, competence and experience Crystal has held various senior leadership roles withinthe energy and healthcare sectors and hasconsiderable expertise in government affairs, legalandregulatory matters. She is currently the ExecutiveVice President, Chief People Officer, DEIandCommunications Officer ofthe US health insurance company, Independence Blue Cross. In her executive career, Crystal held various senior leadership roles during a long career with BP America Inc., culminating with her appointment as Executive Vice President of Government and Public Affairs and Strategic University Partnerships and membership of itsAmericas Leadership Team. She is an Independent Director on the Board of Texas Reliability Entity, Inc. and serves on the Engineering Dean’s Leadership Advisory Board at the University of Michigan. She is aNational Association of Corporate Directors Fellow and a member of the International Women’s Forum and American Bar Association. Appointed to the Board: 2020 Nationality: UK Skills, competence and experience Jane has experience in leading high technology businesses and international corporate leadership. Sheis Chair of Redx Pharma Plc, an AIM listed company, Chair of Theramex and a non-executive director of Johnson Matthey. Jane is a director of theSpanish healthcare company, Esteve. In her executive career with Johnson & Johnson, she held various executive positions and led its Corporate Citizen Trust in EMEA and sponsored its Women’s Leadership Initiative. Jane previously had been Company Group Chair ofJanssen EMEA, Johnson & Johnson’s research- basedpharmaceutical arm, where she was sponsor ofJanssen’s Global Pharmaceuticals Sustainability Council. She is a former Chair of the European Federation of Pharmaceutical Industries and Associations, past Chair of the PhRMA Europe Committee and former member of the Corporate Advisory Board of the UK government-backed ‘YourLife’ campaign, aimed at encouraging more people to study STEM subjects. Appointed to the Board: 2021 Nationality: UK Skills, competence and experience Ewan has extensive experience in commercialising datascience and quantitative analysis. He has led multiple ventures to identify, apply and leverage technology and mathematics research in both businessand philanthropy. In 2006, he founded Cantab Capital Partners, a science-driven investment management firm, which was acquired by GAM Investments in 2016 and is one of the top-performing quantitative investment companies in the UK. Prior tofounding Cantab, Ewan was Partner and Head of Quantitative Strategies Group at Goldman Sachs. He is Chair of the Isaac Newton Institute for Mathematical Sciences, Chairman of DeepTech Labs, aUK-based venture capital fund that invests in deep technology businesses, and Co-Chair of the Turner Kirk Trust. In 2023, Ewan became the first Royal Society Entrepreneur in Residence at the Cambridge University at the Centre for Mathematical Sciences. He holds aPhD in General Relativity from the University of Southampton, a MASt in Mathematics from Queen’s College, Cambridge, andaBSc in Natural Philosophy and Astronomy fromthe University of Glasgow. Appointed to the Board: 2023 Nationality: UK Skills, competence and experience Angus joined the Board on 6 November 2023. He was formerly the Group Chief Financial Officer ofSerco Group plc and, before that, Chief Financial Officer of Aggreko plc. Angus is Chair of James Fisher & Sons plc and the Senior Independent Director of Ashtead Group plc. He is also the Senior Non-Executive Director of the charitable trust-owned Edrington Group. He is currently a non-executive director of STSGlobal Income & Growth Trust but will be stepping down from that role later this year. He is a former non-executive director of GKN plc and Howdens Joinery Group PLC. Angus holds an MBA from the IMD Business School in Switzerland, and is also an Honorary Professor at the University of Edinburgh and a member of the Institute of Chartered Accountants of Scotland. 82 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Directors’ report E N A E N I N R Mark Sedwill Baron Sedwill of Sherborne GCMG, FRGS Non-executive director Appointed to the Board: 2022 Nationality: UK Skills, competence and experience During a long career serving the UK government, LordSedwill held a wide range of national security anddiplomatic roles in the UK and overseas. In his final decade in public service, he was British Ambassador and NATO Representative inAfghanistan, Foreign Office Political Director andHome Office Permanent Secretary, culminating in his appointments as National Security Adviser (2017 to 2020) and Cabinet Secretary (2018 to 2020). Earlier in his career, he held diplomatic and security posts, serving in Egypt, Syria, Jordan, Cyprus and Pakistan. He is a senior adviser and Supervisory Board member of Rothschild & Co, and the Senior Independent Director and Senior Deputy Chair of Lloyd’s of London. He is also the Chairman of the Atlantic Future Forum and a member of the UK Parliament’s House of Lords. Lord Sedwill is a Fellow of the Royal Geographical Society and of the Institute of Directors. He is Presidentof the Special Forces Club and a member ofthe IISS Advisory Council, a trustee of the RNLI, anHonorary Colonel in the Royal Marines and an Honorary Bencherof Middle Temple. Stephen Pearce Non-executive director Nicole Piasecki Non-executive director and Senior Independent Director Appointed to the Board: 2019 Nationality: AU Skills, competence and experience Stephen has more than 20 years’ experience as a director of public companies and over 30 years of financial and commercial experience in the mining, oiland gas, and utilities industries. He has held a rangeof leadership roles including, until recently, Finance Director of Anglo American plc, a position heheld for over sixyears. He previously served as CFO and as an executive director of Fortescue Metals Group Limited from 2010to 2016. He is a Fellow of the Institute of Chartered Accountants, a Fellow of the Governance Institute of Australia and a Member of the Australian Institute of Company Directors. Appointed to the Board: 2019 Nationality: US Skills, competence and experience Nicole was appointed Senior Independent Director on1 January 2024. She has extensive experience gained from executive positions within the aerospace industry and leadership of multi-functional teams. Shepreviously held a number of engineering, sales, marketing and business strategy roles during her 25-year career with the Boeing Company, including Vice President and General Manager of the Propulsion Systems Division and Vice President of Business Development & Strategic Integration for Boeing’s commercial aircraft business, and President of BoeingJapan. She is a non-executive director of Weyerhaeuser Company and BWX Technologies, Inc. She also serves on theboards of Kymeta Corporation and Alitheon Inc. She is a senior advisor to Mitsubishi Heavy Industries, Ltd and a director of the US think tank, TheStimson Center. Nicole formerly served on the Federal Aviation Authority’s Management Advisory Board, the American Chamberof Commerce in Japan, the US Department of Transportation’s Future of Aviation Advisory Committee and the Federal Reserve Bank of San Francisco’s Seattle branch. She is a former director ofHowmet Aerospace Inc. Membership and attendance for the year ended 31 December 2023 Board meetings Committee membership Audit Committee Environmental, Socialand Governance Committee Innovation and Technology Committee Nominations Committee Remuneration Committee Cressida Hogg 1 8/8 N – – – 6/6 – Nick Anderson 8/8 E I N – 4/4 3/3 6/6 – Crystal E Ashby 8/8 E N – 2/4 7 – 6/6 – Angus Cockburn 2 2/2 A N 2/2 – – – – Dame Elizabeth Corley 8/8 A I N R 5/5 – 3/3 6/6 5/5 Jane Griffiths 8/8 E N – 4/4 – 6/6 – Chris Grigg 3 8/8 A N R 5/5 – – 6/6 5/5 Ewan Kirk 4 8/8 I N R – – 3/3 5/6 7 1/2 7 Stephen Pearce 8/8 A N 5/5 – – 6/6 – Nicole Piasecki 5 8/8 E I N R – 4/4 3/3 6/6 5/5 Lord Sedwill 8/8 E N – 4/4 – – – Charles Woodburn Chief Executive 7/8 6 – – – – – Brad Greve Chief Financial Officer 8/8 – – – – – Tom Arseneault President and Chief Executive Officer of BAESystems, Inc. 8/8 – – – – – 1. Appointed Chair on 4 May 2023. 2. Joined the Board on 6 November 2023 and appointed to the Audit Committee on 7 November 2023. 3. Retired as non-executive director and Senior Independent Director on 31 December 2023. 4. Appointed to the Remuneration Committee on1 March2023. 5. Appointed as Senior Independent Director on 1 January 2024. 6. Could not attend due to customer meeting. 7. Attendance impacted by personal matters. Committee Chair A Audit Committee E Environmental, Social and GovernanceCommittee I Innovation and Technology Committee N Nominations Committee R Remuneration Committee The average length of appointment ofnon-executive members of the Board (asat 31 December 2023) was three yearsand nine months. The average length of appointment of executive members of the Board (as at 31 December 2023) was four years. As a result of Chris Grigg’s retirement on31 December 2023,the following committee reports and associated membership, board diversity and skills datarefer to the board composition from 1 January 2024 unless otherwise stated. 83 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Financial statements Additional informationGovernanceStrategic report Board and Executive Management diversity information Gender B A A Male 8 B Female 5 Nationality B C A A UK 8 B US 4 C Australia 1 Ethnicity B A A White British or other 12 White (including minority White groups) B Black/African/Caribbean/ 1 Black British Tenure (independent non-executive directors) B C A A Up to three years 4 B Over three and up to six years 4 C Over six years 1 Skills and experience Risk management Long-term contracting Legal and regulatory International business/commercial Human capital management Executive Non-executive Financial/accounting Environmental and social Engineering, science and technology Company leadership Board experience 15 35 34 310 16 26 36 9 3 7 Sex and gender identity Number of Boardmembers Percentage oftheBoard Number of senior positions on the Board(CEO, CFO, SIDand Chair) Number in executive management Percentage of executive management Men 9 64% 3 11 73% Women 5 36% 1 4 27% Other categories – – – – – Not specified/ prefernottosay – – – – – Ethnic background Number of Boardmembers Percentage oftheBoard Number of senior positions on the Board(CEO, CFO, SIDand Chair) Number in executive management Percentage of executive management White British or otherWhite (including minority-white groups) 13 93% 4 14 93% Mixed/Multiple Ethnicgroups – – – 1 7% Asian/Asian British – – – – – Black/African/ Caribbean/Black British 1 7% – – – Other ethnic group, including Arab – – – – – Board and Executive Management diversity asat31December 2023 In accordance with Listing Rule 9.8.6(9) oftheFinancial Conduct Authority’s (FCA) Listing Rules, these tables set outdetails of the diversity of the individuals onthe Board and Executive Management as at 31 December 2023. On that date, there were 14 Executive Committee members (including the Chief Executive, President and Chief Executive Officer of BAE Systems, Inc. andthe Chief Financial Officer, who are alsoexecutive directors) and14directors of theBoard. The Company Secretary is included inthe calculation of executive management. The data was obtained on a voluntary self- reported basis. Participants were invited to complete a survey through a secure electronic portal, wherein they were asked to confirm their sex andgender identity, and ethnic background. Thedescriptive categories of sex, gender and ethnic background set out in the survey, were taken verbatim from Listing Rule 9.8.6(9), and therefore correspond precisely with the tables. On 1 January 2024, following the retirement of Chris Grigg on 31 December 2023, the number ofmen on the Board reduced to eight. As a result, the number of percentage of women on the Board increased to 38%. Changes were made to the executive management with effect from 1 January 2024 that reduced membership to 13and increased the percentage of women in executive management to 36%. See Nominations Committee report on page 94 for further information and disclosure on diversity. 1. Reflective of the Board from 1 January 2024. Board information 1 84 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Directors’ report Board Diversity & Inclusion Policy This policy sets out the approach to diversity and inclusion in respect of the Board of Directors of BAE Systems plc. Diversity and inclusion We are committed to maintaining a diverse and inclusive Board. As a company, we value diversity and are committed to creating a diverse and inclusive working environment forour employees, in which colleagues from any background can fulfil their potential. Thisis reflected in our clear purpose, values and the behaviours that guide our culture. The Board understands that diversity is a keyattribute to its effectiveness. We aim tomaintain a diverse Board, including an appropriate balance of nationalities, gender, ethnicity, skills, knowledge, experience and personal strengths. Work of the Committee The Nominations Committee, on behalf oftheBoard, undertakes a formal, rigorous and transparent approach to succession planning for director appointments. The Committee oversees the development and implementation of succession plans for directors and senior managers. Appointments and succession plans are based on merit and objective criteria, reflecting the skills, knowledge and experience needed to ensure we have a well-rounded, diverse and effective Board. In the case of Non-Executive Directors, other relevant matters are also taken into account, such as independence andthe ability to fulfil time commitments. Due to the nature of its activities, the UKgovernment holds a Special Share in theCompany, ensuring that the Company cannot be non-British controlled. The Special Share also includes provisions requiring that amajority of the directors on the Board areBritish nationals and the roles of Chair andChief Executive are also subject to UKnationality restrictions. The Committee shall aim to comply withthefollowing targets in respect ofBoardmembership: • At least 40% of Board members shall bewomen (including those identifying aswomen). • At least one of the four senior Board positions (Chair, Chief Executive, Senior Independent Director, Chief Financial Officer) shall be a woman (or identifying asa woman). • At least one member of the Board shall befrom an ethnic minority background (asreferenced in categories recommended by the UK’s Office for National Statistics). In line with UK regulatory requirements, theCommittee shall report in the Company’s annual report on compliance with the abovetargets. The Board and Committee will maintain oversight of the range of activities the Company is pursuing aimed at increasing thediversity of our workforce, including theexecutive pipeline that is essential for Executive Directors’ succession planning. Inaddition, when the Committee engages search consultants, we will use their services to help identify a diverse range of potential non-executive Director candidates and, wherenecessary, to help with Executive Directors’ succession requirements. Reporting The Committee will ensure that there is continued appropriate and meaningful disclosure in the Company’s annual report against the matters set out in this policy. Board diversity Last year, the Committee amended its Diversity and Inclusion Policy (see above) toadopt a target of increasing the level of women on the Board to 40%, and also for atleast one of the Chair, Senior Independent Director, Chief Executive or Chief Financial Officer roles to be held by women. These targets are in line with the regulatory requirements introduced recently by the UK’sFCA onBoard and Executive Committee diversity targets and disclosures. The membership of the Board’s Audit, Remuneration and Nominations committees is drawn from the wider membership of the Board and therefore the membership of these bodies is broadly aligned with the Board’s Diversity and Inclusion Policy. The Committee regularly considers the composition of committees, including the needs for particular attributes, skills and experience, when undertaking non-executive search activities. As at 31 December 2023 (the reference dateadopted by the Company pursuant tothe FCA’s Listing Rules), we did not meet the target of 40% of the Board’s membership being women. On that date, 35.7% of the members of the Board were women. However, as part of our long-term succession plan, Chris Grigg retired as a Director with effect from that day, consequently, since the beginning of the year and up to the 20 February (the latest practicable date for inclusion in this report), that figure increased to 38.5% – just short of the 40% target. Relative to therequirement in the FCA’s Listing Rules concerning the four senior Board roles, the Company met that target on the reporting reference date of 31 December 2023, with the role of Chair being held by a woman. Inaddition, Nicole Piasecki succeeded ChrisGrigg as Senior Independent Director and therefore from 1 January 2024 to the date of this report, two of those senior roles were currently held by women. One member ofthe Board is from a minority ethnic background, and the Company was compliant with that FCA target at the end ofthe year and that has remained the case. Progress has been made in promoting greaterdiversity on the Board over a number of years and that continued during 2023. Asdetailed above, we are just short of the 40% target in the FCA’s Listing Rules and our policy objectives. One Board appointment decision was made in 2023 and, based on merit and the specification agreed for the search, a male candidate was nominated forappointment. As part of the appointment process, the Committee did take steps to ensure that every effort was taken to deliver adiverse list of candidates for consideration. With regard to diversity in our senior leadership population, the number of women on the Executive Committee has increased tofive, 36% of the membership. Currently, 34% of the wider group formed of those executives reporting to an Executive Committee member are women (the same applies if the Company Secretary and his firstreports are included). 85 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Financial statements Additional informationGovernanceStrategic report Principal committees The Board has established principal committees which focus on particular areas, as set out below. The chair of each committee reports to the Board onthe committee’s activities after each meeting. Executive and other committees This is the structure through which we manage the Group including the Board division of responsibilities. Governance framework Board engagement with stakeholders In considering and engaging with stakeholders, the Directors act in accordance with Section 172 of the Companies Act. The work of the Board during the year is detailed on pages 91 to 93. Role of the Board The Board is responsible for promoting the long-term sustainable success of the Company, generatingvalue for shareholders, while havingregard toits other stakeholders and theimpact of itsoperations on the environment and the communities in which we operate. Seepage 91 formore information on the workof the Board. The Board agrees the Company’s purpose, values and standards of behaviour expected of all employees, satisfying itself that these and theculture of the business are aligned. The Board also sets the Group’s strategy, and oversees and monitors internal controls, risk management andthe Company’s governance framework. Ourrobust governance framework, the Operational Framework, is agreed by the Boardand setsout how we do business. Purpose The Company’s purpose (see contents page) recognises that we serve, supply and protect those who serve and protect us, and that we have important wider stakeholder responsibilities that the Board has regard toin its decision making. The Board monitors our strategy, behaviours and culture and their alignment with our purpose. Culture Our culture is to be performance driven and values led. The Board is responsible for ensuring that culture is aligned with our purpose, values andstrategy. Strategy Our strategy (see page 12) is comprised of five key long-term focus areas aligned with our vision and mission. Agreed annually by the Board, it is an important part of how it promotes the long-term sustainable success ofthe Company. The Board Board composition The Board consists of executive and independent non-executive directors, plusanon-executive chair who wasindependent in accordance with the UKCorporate Governance Code on her appointment. There is a clear division inthe roles and responsibilities of the executive and non-executive directors and between the Chair and Chief Executive which are detailed in our Board Charter (available on the Company’s website). Chair Leads the Board and is responsible for its overall effectiveness in directing the Company. Alsofacilitates constructive Board relations and the effective contribution of all non-executive directors, and ensures that directors receive accurate, timely and clear information. Chief Executive Responsible for the development and delivery of the strategy agreed by the Board. Developing fortheBoard’s approval, appropriate values and standards to drive the required behaviours andbyleading by personal example with regards to company culture. Senior Independent Director Acts as a sounding board for the Chair and alsoas an intermediary for the other directors asnecessary. Annually, or on other occasions asnecessary, leading the non-executive directors inappraising the Chair’s performance, and providing feedback. Company Secretary Ensuring that Board procedures are complied with andadvising the Board on all governance matters.Also supports the Board by ensuring that it has the policies, processes, information, timeandresources it needs in order to function effectively. Environmental, Social and Governance Committee Page 102 Remuneration Committee Page 107 Nominations Committee Page 94 Innovation and TechnologyCommittee Page 105 Audit Committee Page 97 86 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Directors’ report Responsible trading principles How we conduct business is fundamental to thesuccess of our Company and we mandate aprinciples-based approach to our business activity. We do not compromise on the way weconduct business, and consistency of this approach is key in defining our reputation. Product safety policy We set out principles which describe our approach to product safety to reduce the risk of unintentional harm to people, property and the environment. They apply throughout the life of the Product and throughout the supply chain. Workplace and operational environment Our people management expectations are communicated to all employees and set out within our People Policy. We have a zero tolerance policy regarding corruption and our employees are made aware of their role in ensuring we maintain high standards of ethical conduct. Pages62 to 64 provide further detail about ouranti-corruption programme. The safety and wellbeing of our employees is paramount and our high standards for Health andSafety management provide a common framework to guide our workforce and further information can be found on page 58. We use our expertise to reduce our global environmental impacts and to develop products and services for our customers which reduce their impacts on the environment. Our climate transition strategy and impact on the environment including greenhouse gas (GHG) emissions, efficient use ofresources, land use and biodiversity, and the environmental impact of the Group’s supply chainis overseen by the Environmental, Social and Governance Committee. We are committed to ensuring that IT systems and services are used in a manner which promotes effective communication and working practices within the organisation and to preventing damage to its business orreputation through misuse of those systems. With the support of ourInternal Audit team, ourIT assurance and governance programme hasbeen developed to support the effective management of cyber risks. Suppliers The Group depends upon its suppliers to provide fully compliant, cost-effective equipment, goods, services and solutions, which are an integral partof the world-class products required by ourcustomers, and also support the effective operations of our businesses and the Group’s standards of business conduct. Our supply chainmanagement and Supplier Principles – Guidance for Responsible Business (the Supplier Principles) are focused on high achievement of our standards. Our supplier contracts contain anti-corruption and anti-bribery provisions andstipulate the expectation to compliance, meet ourstandards on ethical business conduct and Supplier Principles, including safety, environment and human rights. Product trading policy Underpins all of our business activity and the policy applies to all Company products, trading, and throughout the product lifecycle. The policy is used to reflect the Company’s standards of integrity and help us to thoroughly evaluate theopportunities we pursue. Risk management policy We set clear requirements for the management and reporting of risks in support of the delivery ofour strategy. Project risks are managed through our Lifecycle Management Framework. Core business processes Our IBP represents a common process with standard outputs and requirements that producesan integrated strategic business plan forthe Group and also for each of its businesses over the following five years. The IBP isreviewed each year by the Board as part of itsstrategy review process. Once approved, theIBP provides the basis for setting all detailed financial budgets and strategic actions across thebusinesses, andissubsequently used by theBoard to monitorperformance. As mandated by the Operational Framework, Businesses and Group functions complete a bi-annual Operational Assurance Statement (OAS). The OAS is in two parts: a self-assessment of compliance with the Operational Framework; and a report showing the key financial and non-financial risks for the relevant business andGroup functions. Together with reviews undertaken by Internal Audit and the work oftheexternal auditors, the OAS forms the Group’s process for reviewing the effectiveness ofthe system of internal controls. Lifecycle Management (LCM) Framework describes our approach to the assurance of Projects. LCM is integral to the successful execution of the Group’s projects and programmes. Its application provides progressive risk-based assurance throughout the lifecycle toaid decisions, supporting delivery of projects toachieve customer satisfaction, schedule andfinancial requirements. The purpose of the Mergers, Acquisitions andDisposals process is to provide a structured approach to managing the acquisitions, strategic joint ventures and disposals. It forms a part of ourStrategy and Planning framework in order tosupport the delivery of the IBP. National security arrangements The Group is subject to various national security requirements which are an important part of howwe operate as a defence company and meet the needs of our customers. Due to the nature ofits activities, the UK government holds a Special Share in the Company, ensuring that theCompany cannot be non-British controlled. Wealso have a Special Security Agreement with the US Department of Defense addressing national security matters relating to the ownership and control of our US defence businesses. Through the Special Security Agreement, our governance structure is augmented by the BAE Systems, Inc. board, which is populated by experienced individuals drawn principally from the US armed forces and intelligence community, and also former Members of Congress. Similarly, our Australian operations are subject toan Overarching Deed with the Commonwealth of Australia which protects national security andother interests, and allows the Group to ownand manage certain Australian defence- related industrial assets. These national securityarrangements are an important part ofourgovernance. We take pride in managing our operations effectively and responsibly Internal controls Core Business Processes This describes thereporting and reviews mandated by theOperational Framework, which provide upwards visibility of project and business performance. Operational Assurance A process through which line and functional leaders respectively confirm twice yearly that their businesses andfunctions are compliant with theOperational Framework. Internal Audit Assesses the effectiveness ofinternal controlsthrough aprogramme ofreviews based on acontinuous assessment of business risk across the Group. Operational Framework Agreed annually by the Board, the Operational Framework is a comprehensive statement of mandated governance requirements and delegated responsibilities. The UK Corporate Governance Code’s (theCode) principles are embedded within the Operational Framework, and its policies and processes underpin all the disclosures made by the Board pursuant to the Code’s provisions. Our Operational Framework provides a stable foundation from which todeliver our strategy, improve our Group performance and continue todevelop our culture. It is mandatory across allwholly-owned entities and details our organisation, governance framework, core business practices anddelegated authorities. 87 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Financial statements Additional informationGovernanceStrategic report Applying Principles of Good Governance: The Company has applied the Principles in theUKCorporate Governance Code. Using the principal headings in the Code, the following provides details of how it has applied those Principles and references other parts of these reports to provide more detail. The statements reference the Code Principles. Applying the 2018 UK Corporate Governance Code Principles Principles Reference Section 1 – Board leadership and Company purpose A. We have an effective and entrepreneurial Board that promotes the long-term sustainable success of the Company, generates value for shareholders and contributes to wider society. Sustainability Page 46 Dividends paid and capital allocationpolicy objectives Page 17 Annual Board evaluation Page 95 B. The Board has established the Company’s purpose, values and strategy, and satisfied itselfthat these and its culture are aligned. All directors are required to act with integrity, leadby example and promote the culture they wish to see for the Company. Our purpose Contents page Our strategic framework Page 12 Sustainability Page 46 Governance framework Page 86 Environmental, Social and GovernanceCommittee report Page 102 C. Through the Company’s integrated strategic planning process the Board has agreed annualand long-term strategic and financial objectives for the Company. The integrated nature of the planning process helps ensure that the necessary resources are in place to meet those objectives. The Board regularly reviews progress against the plan. The Company has a comprehensive controls structure thatenables risk to be assessed and managed. Our business model Page 14 Governance framework Page 86 D. In order for the Company to meet its responsibilities to shareholders and stakeholders, thedirectors have established a number of means through which it is able to engage withthem in order to better understand their views and expectations. Our stakeholders Page 24 The work of the Board Page 91 Environmental, Social and GovernanceCommittee report Page 102 E. The Board looks to ensure that workforce policies and practices are consistent with ourvalues and support our long-term sustainable growth. All members of our workforce areable to raise any matters ofconcern through our Ethics Helpline or with a local EthicsOfficer. Our purpose Contents page Our strategic framework Page 12 Sustainability Page 46 Section 2 – Division of responsibilities F. The Chair leads the Board and is responsible for the overall effectiveness of the Board indirecting the Company. In doing so she seeksto demonstrate objective judgement and promotes a culture of openness and debate within the boardroom. The directors are provided with accurate, timely and clear information, to facilitate open and constructive board relations. Governance framework Page 86 Annual Board evaluation Page 95 G. The Board comprises the Chair, three executive directors and nine independent non-executive directors 1 . There is a clear division in the roles andresponsibilities of the executive and non-executive directors andbetween the Chair and Chief Executive which are detailed inourBoard Charter (available on the Company’s website). Chair’s governance letter Page 80 Governance framework Page 86 H. The non-executive directors have committed to having sufficient time to meet their responsibilities. The non-executive directors provide constructive challenge, strategic guidance, offer specialist advice and holdmanagement to account. Governance framework Page 86 Governance disclosures Page 80 Board information Page 81 I. The Company Secretary supports the Board in ensuring the directors have the correct policies, processes, information and time in order to function effectively and efficiently. Governance framework Page 86 Board performance evaluation Page 95 88 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Directors’ report Principles Reference Section 3 – Composition, succession and evaluation J. The Nominations Committee undertakes a formal, rigorous and transparent approach to succession planning for Board appointments. The Board oversees the development and implementation of succession plans for directors and senior management. Appointments andsuccession plans are based on merit and objective criteria, whilst also promoting diversityin all forms. Board information Page 81 Nominations Committee report Page 94 K. The directors look to maintain a good combination of skills, experience and knowledge onthe Board and on its committees. Succession plans take into consideration the lengths ofservice of directors and the need to regularly refresh Board membership. Chair’s governance letter Page 80 Board information Page 81 Nominations Committee report Page 94 L. The Board annual performance evaluation undertaken by the Board in 2023/2024 considered its composition, diversity and how effectively members worked together toachieve objectives. The evaluation included an assessment of the effectiveness ofindividual members. Nominations Committee report Page 94 Annual Board evaluation Page 95 Section 4 – Audit, risk and internal control M. The Board through its Audit Committee has established formal and transparent policies andprocedures to ensure the independence and effectiveness of internal and external auditfunctions and the work theyundertake assists the Board in satisfying itself as to theintegrity offinancial and narrative statements. Audit Committee report Page 97 N. As detailed in these reports, the directors confirm they consider the2023 Annual Report andfinancial statements taken as a whole tobe fair, balanced and understandable and provide the information necessary for shareholders to assess the Group’s position and performance, business model and strategy. Directors’ responsibility statement Page 140 O. The Board has established procedures to manage risks. It also overseesthe Internal ControlFramework and determines the nature and extent of the principal risks the Companyis willing to take in orderto achieve its long-term strategic objectives. Our risk management framework Page 69 Our principal risks Page 70 Governance framework Page 86 Section 5 – Remuneration P. The policies and practices of the Remuneration Committee have beendesigned to supportour strategy and promote the long-term sustainable success of the Company. Executive remuneration is aligned to Company purpose and values and is linked to thesuccessful delivery of our long-term strategy. Remuneration Committee report Page 107 Annual remuneration report Page 115 Q. The Remuneration Committee has a formal and transparent procedure for developing policyon executive remuneration and also for determining the remuneration of directorsandsenior management. Directors are not involved in determining their ownremunerationoutcome. Remuneration Committee report Page 107 Directors’ remuneration policy Page 110 R. The Remuneration Committee has the ability to exercise its discretion and independent judgement when agreeing remuneration outcomes. When exercising such discretion it will take into account Company and individual performance, and also wider circumstances. Remuneration Committee report Page 107 1. Since 1 January 2024, there are eight non-executive directors, following the retirement of Chris Grigg on 31 December 2023. 89 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Financial statements Additional informationGovernanceStrategic report Compliance with the 2018 UK Corporate Governance Code provisions The Company is subject to the principles and provisions of the Code, a copy of which is available at frc.org.uk. The Company was compliant with the provisions of the Code throughout 2023. The following statements are made in compliance with the Code. Dame Elizabeth Corley Dame Elizabeth Corley, a non-executive director, is a non-executive director and Chairof Schroders plc. Schroders plc is ashareholder in the Company, holding approximately 0.4% of the total share votingrights as at 20 February 2024 (the latest practicable date for inclusion in this report). Anassessment was undertaken prior to herappointment to assess whether this relationship could have a bearing on her independence for the purpose of Provision 10 of the Code. It was agreed that the number of shares held by Schroders was not sufficiently material to have a bearing on herindependence. The Company was also made aware of steps that have been taken bySchroders to avoid a conflict of interest with regard to any shares it may hold in BAESystems plc. Angus Cockburn In compliance with Provision 15 of the Code, the Nominations Committee considered Angus Cockburn’s other commitments prior to his appointment to the Board as a non-executive director in 2023. In particular, it noted his other listed company board appointments, they being his role as non-executive Chair of James Fisher & Sons and non-executive director positions at Ashtead Group and STS Global Income & Growth Trust. Prior to his appointment, it was confirmed that he would be stepping down from the STS Global Income & Growth Trust at its AGM this year. Recognising that Mr Cockburn will be stepping down from a listed company board later this year (most likely in July) and that all of his other corporate interests are non-executive innature, the Board is satisfied that he has sufficient time to undertake his duties as a non-executive director of the Company. Risk management and internalcontrol statement The Board is responsible for the Group’s risk management and internal control systems. Ithas delegated responsibility for reviewing indetail the effectiveness of these systems tothe Audit Committee, which reports to theBoard on its findings so that all directors can take a view on the matter. An overview of the processes used to identify,evaluate and manage the principal risks can be found on pages 70 to 77. Theseprocesses are an integral part of our governance framework, and the Operational Framework, details of which can be found onpage 86. The Operational Framework mandates the Operational Assurance Statement (OAS) process, which is owned bythe Group’s Internal Audit function and isone of the principal processes used by the Board in monitoring the effectiveness of control systems. The OAS process has been designed to provide assurance with regard to compliance with the policies and processes mandated bythe Operational Framework. It is a key element of the Group’s governance and is formed of two parts: a self-assessment by businesses and functions of compliance with the Operational Framework; and a report showing their assessment of key risks. Twice ayear, the line leaders for our business and the heads of our functions are required to critically analyse compliance relative to a scoring framework, which sets clear standards against which compliance must beassessed. Line and functional leaders arerequired to assure themselves of the level of compliance for a business, and submit as required supporting information and data toprovide evidence of compliance. The output from the OAS process is reviewed by (and subject to challenge from) the Internal Audit function relative to its understanding ofmatters within particular businesses. Inaddition, the OAS risk management process requires that twice-yearly the risks identified in each of the businesses are reported against a set risk framework. Theoutput from the OAS process is provided to the Board and isreviewed in detail by the Audit Committee. Thereport to the directors on the output from the OAS process provides granular graphical and narrative analysis of compliance against the requirements of the Operational Framework, and as such is an important part of how the Board monitors and reviews the Company’s risk management and internal control systems. Further details of the Board’s monitoring and review process can be found in the Audit Committee report on page 97. The risk management and internal control systems detailed in the Operational Framework were in place throughout the yearand the Board, having reviewed their effectiveness, believes they accord with the Financial Reporting Council’s Guidance on Risk Management, Internal Control and Related Financial and Business Reporting. Viability statement and going concern As required by the provisions of the Code, theBoard has undertaken an assessment ofthe future prospects of the Group, taking into account the Group’s current position and principal risks. This assessment considered both the Group’s long-term prospects and also its ability to continue in operation and meet its liabilities as they fall due over its five-year business planning period. This can be found on page 78 of the Strategic report. Directors In compliance with the Code, all directors are subject to annual re-election by shareholders. The Board considers all of the non-executive directors (except the Chair) named on pages 81 to 83 of this report to be independent forthe purposes of the Code. The Chair wasalso independent on her appointment inMay last year. Prior to making Board appointments, theBoard considers other demands on an individual’s time to ensure that, following appointment, directors have sufficient timetomeet their Board responsibilities. Non-executive directors arerequired to seek prior approval before taking on additional external appointments. The Board also considers whether there are any matters thatcould have a bearing on a non-executive director’s independence pursuant to Provision10 of the Code. The following disclosure is made on these matters: 90 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Directors’ report The directors of BAE Systems plc – and those of all UK companies – must act in accordance withaset of general duties. These include a duty under Section 172 of the Companies Act (s.172) topromote the success of the Company, and in doing so the directors must have regard (amongother things) to certain stakeholders and other factors. In this statement, on pages 91to93, we highlight some of the key decisions and discussions undertaken by the Board in2023and stakeholder consideration. The work of the Board Companies Act 2006, s.172 ( 1 ) “A director of a company must act in the way, he considers, in good faith, would bemost likely to promote the success ofthe company for the benefit of its members as a whole, and in doing so haveregard (amongst other matters) tothe following factors: (a) the likely consequences of any decisionin the long term; (b) the interests of the company’s employees; (c) the need to foster the company’s business relationships with suppliers, customers and others; (d) the impact of the company’s operations on the community andtheenvironment; (e) the desirability of the company maintaining a reputation for high standards of business conduct; and (f) the need to act fairly as between members of the company.” Shareholder returns In July 2022, the Board announced a three-year share buyback programme of upto £1.5bn. Good progress was made withthat programme and, consequently, in August 2023 the Board considered whether to approve a further buyback programme which would commence after the completion of the 2022 programme. In making the decision to approve a further up to £1.5bn share buyback programme the Board considered its stakeholder obligations, the strength ofthe Company’s financial position and its capital allocation priorities. The members ofthe Group’s pension schemes, comprisinga large number of present andformer employees, was seen as a key stakeholder group in respect of this decision. TheCompany is committed to meeting its funding obligations to its pension schemes. Whilst these are long term in nature, the directors noted that the main UK pension scheme was in surplus, andalso that the Company would be making additional funding contributions as a consequence ofthe buyback. The buyback decision was also only reachedafter the Board considered, and wassatisfied, that it could continue to invest for the long-term success of the Company through research and development funding and other organic investment opportunities. Such funding underpins our ability to meet present and future customer requirements and drive future growth for the benefit of allstakeholders. The Board also considered itsability to invest in future value-enhancing acquisitions, should that be in line with strategy, and was satisfied that its ability to do so would not beunduly impacted by the buyback decision. Having considered these matters and the strength of the balance sheet and business plan, a further buyback programme of up to £1.5bn was approved and announced inAugust 2023. Key matters considered and decisions made in 2023 inrespectof the directors’ duties under s.172 Ball Aerospace acquisition As part of the Board’s annual strategic review process, Ball Aerospace had been identified as a business that, if the opportunity arose, would add scale to our USspace ambitions and complement our Electronic Systems business. Ball Aerospace isa leading provider of mission-critical spacesystems and defence technologies, attractively positioned and with an outlook across military and civil space, C4ISR, and missile and munitions markets. The work undertaken over a number of years to identifyBall Aerospace as a potential acquisition target came to fruition last year and, following a detailed review, the Board approved a proposal for its acquisition by ourUS business. The Company was successful in its bid to acquire Ball Aerospace for approximately $5.5bn. In approving the proposed acquisition, the Board believed that investing in this high-quality, fast-growing and technology- focused asset would help promote the long-term success of the Company. Consideration of the acquisition within the context of our capital allocation policy was animportant part of the Board’s deliberations. The Group’s capital allocation policy can be found on page 17. In reaching the decision toacquire Ball Aerospace the Board carefully considered its duties under s.172 of the Companies Act, particularly withregards tolong-term capital allocation. That policy has the objective of maintaining the Group’s investment grade credit rating and ensuring operational flexibility whilst: meeting its pensions obligations; investing in the business; paying dividends; making accelerated returns to shareholders, when the balance sheet allows; and making value-enhancing acquisitions. The Board made the decision toacquire Ball Aerospace after considering these priorities and the interests of relevantstakeholders. 91 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Financial statements Additional informationGovernanceStrategic report The work of the Board continued Next-generation nuclear-powered attack submarine programme In February last year, the Board considered and agreed the proposed basis under which the Group would enter into a contract with the Ministry of Defence for the next phase ofthe UK’s next-generation nuclear-powered attack submarine, known as SSN-AUKUS. Theambition is for the UK and Australia to both build submarines to this new design, with the construction of the UK’s boats taking place principally at the Group’s site inBarrow-in-Furness, Cumbria. The £3.95bn award for the next phase of theUK’s next-generation attack submarine programme will cover the development workup to 2028 and enable the Group toprogress into the detailed design phase ofthe programme. In making the decision onthe Group’s long-term role on this major programme, the Board was very much aware of a range of stakeholders that will benefit from it, particularly suppliers, employees andthe local community in Barrow-in- Furness, Cumbria. The long-term funding secured by the awardhas enabled the Group to begin the procurement of long-lead items, placing contracts through our supply chain that willmitigate programme risk and widen theeconomic benefit for these suppliers andthe communities they serve. The Group’s employees will benefit from theinvestment in the SSN-AUKUS and the Group’s other submarine programmes. Workforce planning and skills development was an important part of the Board’s considerations in approving the Group’s participation in the SSN-AUKUS programme. In order to meet our customer commitments, it recognised that we will have to grow the workforce and ensure that we have the range of skills required to deliver this major new programme. We currently have a workforce of over 12,000 in Barrow-in-Furness, Cumbriawith plans to recruit an additional 2,700 people. Investment in early careers development is critical for the Submarines business and we plan to recruit and train around 900 apprentices a year to support thelong-term success of the business. Investment in recruiting and training alargeskilled workforce benefits the localcommunity. For example, last year we announced the acquisition of former retail properties in Barrow-in-Furness town centre that, working with the local authorities, wewill refurbish and convert into modern multi-use units to support our future growth plans. This, together with a number of otherlocal investments, will bring economic advantages to the local area in addition tothe Group’s long-term commitment to providing high-quality employment opportunities in the town. Global Code of Conduct The s.172 duty includes having regard to maintaining a reputation for high standards of business conduct. Our Code of Conduct sets the expected standards of business conduct across the Group. It is a critical part of our ethics and governance framework, and the foundation of our ethical corporate culture. As part of our Operational Framework, it guides what we do and how we do it. During 2023, the Board undertook its triennial review of the Code of Conduct, aimed at ensuring that it remains up-to-date and aligned with best practice. Everyone in the Group, including the Board, is required to behave inaccordance with the standards set by the Code of Conduct when dealing with colleagues, business partners, customers, suppliers, contractors, competitors and other stakeholders. The revised Code of Conduct, approved by the Board and effective from thebeginning of 2024, provides additional emphasis on speaking upand reporting concerns. It highlights the need to speak up ifsomething does not feel right and how to do so, whether that is in person to one of our Ethics Monitors, online, by phone or by email. The Board maintains oversight of the requirement of the Code of Conduct, principally through an annual review of business conduct. Such a review was undertaken in 2023 and this included an analysis of matters raised by employees and how these had been dealt with. The Board also considered the processes in place to further investigate matters raised by employees. Customers The Board receives regular updates on customer relationships from the Chief Executive, who meets regularly with our principal customers. During the year, the Board also met with a senior customer officialto gain a first-hand understanding ofdefence procurement priorities and capability requirements, and also the Group’sperformance as a major supplier tothe UK’s armed forces. In the US, customer relationships are managed by the President and Chief Executive Officer of our US business. Totheextent allowed by national security considerations, he provides feedback to theBoard on BAE Systems, Inc.’s customers. Given the elevated global threat environment that we saw throughout 2023, one of the key messages that the Board received from many of our national customers last year was the Warton In September, the Board visited the Airsector’s manufacturing and assembly facilities in Warton. As well as operating existing programmes from the site, suchas Typhoon and Hawk, it is the basefor the development of the Group’sUK future flying combat airdemonstrator. 92 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Directors’ report need for the defence industry to respond to increased operational requirements, and to actively engage in how we can help replenish and equip our armed forces customers to meet their urgent needs. In response to customer requirements, we saw increased activity across the Group; one example of which was the significant increase in investment inour UK munitions business and orders received for additional battlefield munitions. Employees The principal means by which all membersofthe Board engage directly withemployees is through visits to our sites.During 2023, the Board visited our Naval Ships business in Glasgow and the Airbusiness in Warton, Lancashire. In Glasgow, directors met with employees and also engaged with local trade union officials. A key part of the visit was an opportunity to meet with different employee groups and engage with them on a range oftopics. These included the use of an Employee Resource Group (ERG) to explore different workplace issues, ethical business conduct, health and safety, sustainability within the workplace, supporting early careers and adapting to new technology. Workplace health and safety, and how we can continue to drive improvements in this area was an important part of the Board’s learning from the visit. One example of which was developing a better understanding of the roletrade unions can play in engaging withemployees and reinforcing key safety messaging, such as the use of personal protective equipment. During the Warton visit, employee engagement with a cross-section of the local workforce took the form of six groups of 12 employees engaging directly with Directors on a variety of topics they wished to raise and discuss. These included issues such asworkplace conditions, career opportunities and organisational change. During the year, individual non-executive directors also visited our businesses elsewhere in the UK and in the US, the Kingdom ofSaudi Arabia andAustralia. More information on employee engagement can be found in the ESG Committee report on pages 102 to 104. Suppliers The directors receive information on particular supply chain matters through ourregular Board reports. In addition, the Chief Procurement Officer attended a Board meeting last year and provided an update onsupply chain matters. The Board was particularly interested in how the Group was managing the post-pandemic supply chain challenges and the actions being taken to increase the level of supply chain resilience. Inthis respect, the Board was informed aboutthe work initiated to improve sub-tier supplier visibility and help manage potential risks below the Group’s direct suppliers. Werecognise the vital role that our suppliers play in allowing usto deliver our programmes in line with ourcommitments to customers. Consequently we work closely with key suppliers and take steps as may be necessary tomaintain continuity of supply. Environment The Board had regard to environmental considerations during 2023 in a number of different contexts. Elsewhere in this report you will read about our sustainability agenda and how this has a focus on climate risk, what we need to do to address these risks inour own operations and how we can workwith stakeholders in our supplier andcustomer base to address this issue. TheBoard and its ESG Committee are a keypart of the governance and oversight ofenvironment and climate change matters, and these activities are regularly reported anddiscussed in Board meetings. Sustainability, and the adoption of new and alternative technologies aimed at reducing environmental impacts, formed part of the Board’s strategy review in 2023. The review highlighted opportunities to evolve low- carbon products and develop decarbonisation technologies to meet future defence and civilcustomer needs. In our US business, theBoard continues to see opportunities toleverage our power management and flight controls expertise and broaden our range of electrification offerings, one example of which is our collaboration with Heart Aerospace to define the battery system for its ES-30 regional electric aircraft. Stakeholder engagement The Company engages with a variety of stakeholders on a regular basis. Feedback is received at a number of different levels and helps inform numerous decisions made on a delegated basis across the Company – but within a well-developed governance structure approved by the Board. Stakeholder feedback isalso received by the directors, either directly via executive management or through formal reporting processes. In addition to that shown below, further information on stakeholders andhow we engaged in 2023 can be found inthe ‘Our stakeholders’ section of this report (see pages 24–25). Also, further details of thematters covered by the s.172 duty, includingenvironment and climate, workplace environment and community investment can befound in the Sustainability section of the report on pages 46 to 66. Glasgow In March, the Board visited our Naval Ships business in Govan and Glasgow, Scotland where construction is underway on the first four City Class Type 26 frigates. In total, eight Type 26 frigates will be constructed in Govan and Scotstoun, with work recently commencing on a new ship build hall atthe Govan shipyard to enhance the shipbuilding facilities in Glasgow. 93 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Financial statements Additional informationGovernanceStrategic report Membership from 1 January 2024: Nick Anderson Crystal E Ashby Angus Cockburn Dame Elizabeth Corley Jane Griffiths Ewan Kirk Stephen Pearce Nicole Piasecki Lord Sedwill Nominations Committee report Cressida Hogg Chair Dear Shareholders I am pleased to present my first Nominations Committee report as Chair. As with many companies, all the non-executive Directors are members of the Committee. Therefore, itsmembership reflects changes to the Board, with Sir Roger Carr and Chris Grigg ceasing to be members during the year and Angus Cockburn joining on his appointment to theBoard in November 2023. Executive succession The Board and Nominations Committee have a crucial role in planning effectively for senior management succession. I understand why this is an area of focus for many shareholders, and is frequently raised during shareholder meetings. We currently have an excellent leadership team in Charles, Brad and Tom and we are focused on keeping them supported and motivated. However, all companies must have resilience and be able to maintain momentum through management change. The Nominations Committee has been working on our plans throughout 2023, focusing on identifying talent and potential internally and externally. The heads of our Air and Digital Intelligence businesses retired at the end of 2023. This provided an opportunity to promote some ofour most talented managers, and the Nominations Committee was pleased to endorse the appointments of Simon Barnes to lead our Air sector, and Andrea Thompson to head Digital Intelligence. Both have been part of the senior executive development andsuccession programme for several years. During 2023 the Committee reviewed thedetailed succession plans for the three Executive Directors, and looked at them inthe context of wider succession planning across the Group. The plans for these individuals continue to develop and mature, and further work is planned for 2024. The Committee also has to consider nationality requirements in succession planning. National security considerations place certain restrictions on the pool of talent available when considering candidates for certain leadership roles. In particular, the Chief Executive must be a UKnational, and the role of President and CEO of BAE Systems Inc. can only be undertaken by a US resident citizen. To attract and retain talented individuals inleadership roles, the Committee is also veryaware that our remuneration needs tobe competitive within the wider market context. We are grateful that, to date, shareholders have supported the Board’s recommendations on our remuneration policy. Competitive reward and retention willcontinue to be critical issues for both the Nominations and Remuneration Committees, and ones that underpin the effectiveness of our succession plans. In addition to the Executive Director succession reviews, during last year we alsoreviewed executive succession planning processes across the group, recognising thevital importance of this activity in delivering effective long-term Board succession planning. This review showed howwe are increasing the resilience of ourbusinesses by positively managing our talent resource. Our talent pipeline is being strengthened, with greater focus on clear succession routes for key executives below the level of the Executive Committee, andmore executives being identified and developed for specific roles. We also increased investment in the recognition andretention of high-potential individuals and this more focused approach is achieving results. The Committee is pleased to see thatthe diversity of our talent pipeline has improved, with 42% of the individuals identified as being up to two jobs away from an Executive Committee role being women, an increase of 9% compared with 2022. Non-executive succession As I have already mentioned in my Letter to Shareholders, this has been a year of Board evolution with the retirement of both the Chair and our Senior Independent Director during the course of the year. Following ChrisGrigg’s retirement, I am pleased that Nicole Piasecki has taken on the role of SID inaddition to Remuneration Committee chair. The Committee has continued to plan forcontinuity of knowledge and depth ofexperience as the Board evolves. AngusCockburn joined the Board and AuditCommittee at the end of 2023. Angusis anexperienced business leader who will be known to many shareholders from his time as CFO at Aggreko and Serco. He brings deep boardroom experience as both an executive and a non-executive and Chair. Since joining the Board at the beginning of November he has been engaged with learning more about the Company, and an overview of his induction programme is shown below. 94 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Directors’ report Process The evaluation was an externally facilitated self-evaluation by an external provider, No4,who conducted thorough one-on-one interviews with the Board and key individuals. The 2023/2024 evaluation process guided amore strategic review of the Board, and itsoperation to consider how the Board might make improvements to an already well-functioning Board and also how to bethe most effective Board it can be for BAESystems over the next three to five years. The evaluation was conducted according to the guidance in the Code. Jan Hall and No 4 have no connection to, or relationship with, the Company or any director. The process started with briefing meetings where Jan Hall of No 4 met the Chair, ChiefExecutive, Senior Independent Director and Group Finance Director. These meetings helped her understand the Board, how itoperates and the future priorities for BAESystems, as well as to agree the evaluation’s objectives, scope and timetable. No 4 then prepared a discussion guideline which formed the basis of her one-on-one meetings, and this was sent to the individuals who participated in the Board evaluation ahead of her meetings with them. During January 2024, Jan Hall conducted confidential and detailed interviews with theBoard, selected executives, the Company Secretary, BAE Systems’ external auditor and independent remuneration adviser, to seek their views on the Board’s effectiveness. The report was shared with the Chair andChief Executive and then the full Board. Itwas presented by No 4 and discussed in detail at a meeting of the Board in February2024. Content The Board evaluation addressed the views ofdirectors on matters including: • organisation for the Board and Committees; • the Board and Committee agendas andpapers; • strategy development and discussion; • leadership of the Board and the Committees; • dynamics and culture of the Board; • relationships between non-executive directors and management; • technology development and innovation; • stakeholder engagement and communication; and • succession planning and composition oftheBoard. Areas for future focus The Board has agreed to take certain actions based on the outcomes from the evaluation. These deal with the following: • optimising the scheduling of formal andinformal Board time; • giving more time to discussing senior executive development and succession planning; • including sessions in strategy discussions onlonger term strategic options; • greater insight into how new technologies are likely to impact the future development of the business; and • reviewing the Board composition for the longer term. Conclusions of the evaluation The overall conclusion of this Board evaluation is that the BAE Systems Board hasbeen operating effectively. The Board is hugely supportive of the ChiefExecutive and his team, and recognises the excellent leadership and enormous commitment they bring. The areas for future focus will serve to furtherstrengthen the Board and ensure itremains effective. Board evaluation 2023/24 1. Russell Reynolds Associates provide other services tothe Company but have no connection to any ofitsdirectors. When initiating the search that led to Angus Cockburn’s appointment, the Committee considered and specified the attributes required in the ideal candidate. The Committee generally uses external search consultants to assist in its appointment activity and engaged the services of Russell Reynolds Associates 1 to lead the search. When making Board appointments, the Committee also has to consider nationality. As mentioned, there are specific nationality requirements for certain executive roles. In addition, the Special Share provisions in the Company’s Articles of Association require that a majority of the members of the Board must be British nationals, and that also applies to the membership of Board Committees. Thesenationality requirements must be factored into the Committee’s long-term plans for managing Board composition. It also has to be considered when we are looking at Board Committee membership. Cressida Hogg Chair of the Nominations Committee 95 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Financial statements Additional informationGovernanceStrategic report Nominations Committee report continued February Committee (London, UK) – Reviewed Board composition and themembership of its Committees. – Discussed non-executive director successionplanning. – Reviewed annual performance evaluation. May Committee (Farnborough, UK) – Discussed the role specification fornon-executive director search. June Committee (Washington DC, US) – Discussed candidate short-list for non-executive director search. July Committee (London, UK) – Discussed ongoing non-executive committee appointment. September Committee (Warton, UK) – Reviewed succession plans for executivedirectors. – Discussed nomination of candidate for appointment as non-executive director. November Committee (Horsham, UK) – Reviewed succession plans for executive directors. – Reviewed non-executive director’s term ofappointment. – Discussed appointment of Senior Independent Director. February Committee May Committee The Nominations Committee’s year June Committee July Committee September Committee November Committee Non-executive directorinduction The following provides an overviewof the induction programme for Angus Cockburn, who was appointed a member ofthe Board in November 2023. Business sector overview Visits completed to date Maritime and Land Submarines, Barrow-in-Furness, UK Maritime and Land Naval Ships, Glasgow, UK Visits planned for 2024 BAE Systems, Inc. Head office, Washington DC,US BAE Systems, Inc. Electronic Systems, Nashua NH, US Air Warton/Samlesbury, Lancashire, UK Digital Intelligence Guildford, Surrey, UK Executive briefings covering: – Financial control and reporting – Legal and regulatory compliance – Directors’ duties and listed companyregulation – ESG and sustainability – Investor relations – HR and reward – Technology management – Health and safety – Treasury and corporate finance – Pension – Strategic development and business planning – Employee engagement – Internal audit – IT and information security – Corporate communications – Community investment 96 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Directors’ report Membership from 1 January 2024: Angus Cockburn Dame Elizabeth Corley Jane Griffiths Audit Committee report Stephen Pearce Chair Dear Shareholders This report is intended to provide you with aninsight into the activities and key areas weconsidered for theyear-ended December 2023. On page 101 there is an overview of the areas we havereviewed and discussed during the year. As part of this report, I will give a summary of some of our discussions. The Committee, on behalf of the Board, monitors the Group’s internal control environment and the integrity of financial reporting. Additionally, we challenge the management team and the internal and external auditors on a number of areas, including key accounting judgements and control matters. The Committee’s Terms of Reference are available on the Company’s website. Committee composition Our biographies on pages 82 to 83 provide asummary of our skills and our experience, which highlights that all Committee membershave the necessary skills, and financial literacy, in order to effectively discharge our duties as an Audit Committee. During the year, Angus Cockburn joined theCommittee and Chris Grigg retired as anon-executive director and member of theAudit Committee on 31 December 2023. I would like to express my thanks to Chris forhis contribution to our discussions and welcome Angus. In addition, from 1 January2024, Dr Jane Griffiths, Chair oftheEnvironmental, Social and Governance Committee, has joined the Audit Committee. Meeting overview After four of our meetings, we met privately (without management) with the External Auditors and the Internal Audit Director. Our meetings were also attended by the Board Chair, the Chief Executive, the Chief Financial Officer, the Group General Counsel, the Internal Audit Director, the Group Financial Controller, and the Senior Audit Partners from Deloitte LLP. During the year, Iregularly met with the Audit Partners to discuss key issues. From time-to-time and depending on thematters to be discussed, other senior executives are invited to attend our meetings in order to provide subject matter expertise and further insight. After each Committee meeting, I report tothe Board on the Committee’s activities, the key matters discussed and any recommendations from the Committee. In2023, we met six times during the year andhad five formal meetings. Climate-related financial reporting To stay abreast of developments, weregularly receive updates from the management team on developments in reporting regulations, including global initiatives and climate-related reporting regulations, in relevant jurisdictions, that could impact the Group. The Committee is responsible for the oversight of the internal and external assurance processes in regard to ESG data, including the sustainability-related disclosures that are linked to the financial statements, which includes the Task Force on Climate- related Financial Disclosures (TCFD). During our joint Audit and ESG Committee meeting earlier in the year, we reviewed the requirements and the robustness of the assurance processes surrounding the provision of the data underpinning the TCFDdisclosures. We consider the impact of climate-related transition activities and physical risks on financial reporting. We have judged there tobe no material impact on the Group’s Consolidated financial statements for the yearended 31 December 2023 and we will continue to closely review this position. External audit Following a tender process, Deloitte LLP wasappointed as the Group’s external auditor at the 2018 Annual General Meeting and has completed the first year of its second five-year cycle. Claire Faulkner succeeded John Adam as Senior Audit Partner in 2023. The Committee monitors engagements withexternal stakeholders relevant to the Committee’s areas of oversight, including theFinancial Reporting Council (FRC). Duringthe year, the FRC’s Audit Quality Review (AQR) team reviewed Deloitte’s audit of the Group’s 2022 financial statements as part of its annual inspection of audit firms. The Committee received and reviewed the final report from the AQR team which identified no key findings or other findings and noted several areas of good practice. During the year, the Committee reviewed andagreed the scope of the external audit plan in respect of the auditors’ review of the half-year accounts, and of their audit of the full-year accounts, taking into consideration key audit risks and other particular areas of focus for the Group. We also reviewed and approved the fees for this work and the auditengagement letters. The Statutory Audit Services for Large Companies Market Investigation (Mandatory Use of Competitive Tender Processes and Audit Committee Responsibilities) Order 2014 The Company has complied with the Statutory Audit Services Order issued bythe UK Competition and Markets Authority for the financial year ended 31 December 2023. 97 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Financial statements Additional informationGovernanceStrategic report Audit Committee report continued Auditor independence We oversee the relationship with the externalauditor and regularly assess their effectiveness, in order to ensure that they retain their independence and objectivity. As part of this process, we formerly consider when it would be appropriate to complete acompetitive tender process for the external audit. We do so in line with the Statutory Audit Services for Large Companies Market Investigation (Mandatory Use of Competitive Tender Processes and Audit Committee Responsibilities) Order 2014, concerning the frequency and governance of tenders for theappointment of the external auditor. During the year, the Committee concluded that Deloitte remained effective in its role asexternal auditor. In view of this, and havingconsidered the continued objectivity, independence and effectiveness of the auditors, the Committee considers it to be inthe best interests of the Company’s shareholders for Deloitte LLP to remain as external auditors for the upcoming financial year. The scope and output of our annual review of the external auditor’s independence and effectiveness is discussed below. We will continue to review the effectiveness and independence of Deloitte LLP as external auditor and will ensure that an audit tender isconducted no later than the 2028 financialyear. Non-audit services policy We maintain a policy on non-audit services which is aligned to the FRC’s 2019 Revised Ethical Standard of Permitted Audit-Related and Non-Audit Services. The policy prohibits certain activities from being undertaken bythe auditor and places restrictions on theemployment of former employees of theauditor. The policy permits the provision of Audit- Related Services and Permitted Non-Audit Services up to limits that are pre-approved bythe Committee, with specific Committee approval required beyond such limits. Assuch, these matters were approved by theCommittee and were compatible with thegeneral standard of independence for auditors. Prior to approving any non-audit work, the Committee considered the nature of the services, and concluded that the provision of these services did not impair theindependence of the external auditor. Further information about the audit and non-audit fees for 2023 is disclosed in note3to the Consolidated financial statements onpage 165. Internal audit The Group’s Internal Audit function is independent and has no responsibility foroperational business management. Through its assurance activities, it is able toindependently review the effectiveness ofinternal control systems and processes. Committee meetings are attended by the Internal Audit Director and the VP Internal Audit, Inc. The Internal Audit Director provides regular reports to the Committee onthe assessment of the Group’s risk management activities, internal controls andcorporate governance framework. The scope and authority of the Internal Auditfunction is defined within its charter and we review and approve the Internal Auditplan and any changes to its programme. We received updates on the execution of the Internal Audit Plan, relevant findings and enhancement opportunities andremediation plans. During the year, the Internal Audit Director announced his intention to retire and the Committee oversaw the identification and appointment of a successor. Prior to their appointment, we reviewed the suitability ofthe individual, examining their skills, qualifications and ability to undertake the post and continue the delivery of robust assurance activities and focus on quality bythe Internal Audit function. Assessing the effectiveness of External Audit Who we surveyed to inform our assessment on the effectiveness of the Group’s External Auditor What we surveyed Outcome The Committee noted that the output of the review was broadly positive and consistent with prior years. Participants felt thatthe external auditor provided robust and constructive challenge and overall delivered an effective audit. On the basis of the review following the 2023 year-end audit, the Committee hasproposed to the Board that it recommends that shareholders support the re-appointment of Deloitte LLP at the 2024 AGM. Senior Finance Executives Partners & Audit Teams Communication & Reporting Planning Scope & Execution Challenge & Insight Internal Audit Director 98 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Directors’ report Effectiveness of the Internal Audit function In 2023, in accordance with the International Standards for the Professional Practice of Internal Auditing, an External Quality Assessment of the Internal Audit function was conducted by Ernst & Young. The results showed that the Internal Audit function was well established and well respected across the Group. We were pleasedto learn that the remit, role, mandate, and independence and objectivity were understood by stakeholders. The function was found to be ‘Proficient’ across all components of the EY Internal Audit maturity model (Purpose, People and Process), which demonstrated an overall increase in the function’s maturity and establishment, sincethe previous assessment five years ago.The assessment also provided some useful suggestions for further development. The implementation of these areas of development and overall effectiveness oftheInternal Audit function will continue tobean area of focus for the Committee. Risk management and internal controls A key focus for the Committee in 2023 hasbeen the oversight of the evolution andmaturity of the Group’s business risk management processes. During the year, we received updates on the progress of various risk and internal controls improvements, including undertaking a deep dive on internalcontrols and risk management. Wealso continued to review the IT controlenvironment and enhancements recommended. The work undertaken sets a solid foundation for the recently announced changes, required by theUK Corporate Governance Code 2024, which will apply from 1 January 2026. The Group’s Risk Management and InternalControl Framework are designed tomanage, rather than eliminate, the risk offailure to achieve its strategic objectives. Itcan only therefore provide reasonable andnot absolute assurance against materialmisstatement or loss. We discussed, in detail, the evolution ofthebusiness risk management process. Inparticular, we were pleased with the workto further develop improved business risk management processes. An overview ofthe Group’s risk management systems andprincipal risks are provided on pages 67and 77 of this Annual Report. As part of our responsibilities, we review theGroup’s risk management and Internal Control Framework, including overseeing theeffectiveness of the operation of the relevant policies, standards and procedures inoperation. The six-monthly OAS process, coupled with the risk register, provides the basis for our review of the effectiveness of internal controls and risk management. The OAS returns comprise submissions by each business or function. The amalgamated output highlights trends and provides the context which supports the identification and monitoring of risks. Following reviews by the Executive Committee and the Group Audit Review Board, an assessment is made on the probability of the risks arising and potential impact to the Group’s five-year IBP. The most significant of these, as measured through potential impact and probability, are the Group’s principal risks as set out on pages 70to 77. In considering the effectiveness of internal controls and risk landscape, the Committee received updates from the Group General Counsel, Group Financial Controller, Group Treasurer, Group Tax Director, Internal Audit Director and the External Auditor, on material developments within the legal, regulatory and financial context of the Group. These internal control and risk management processes are part of the Group’s governance framework (page 86). As a whole this governance framework underpins our financial and narrative reporting processes and seeks to provide reasonable assurance that the Annual Reportand financial statements are preparedin accordance with applicable standards. Financial statements andnarrativereporting As in previous years, the Committee reviewed all significant issues concerning the financial statements which include the going concern and viability statements. In considering the Group’s Annual Report, the Committee assessed whether the report was fair, balanced and understandable and also whether it provided the information necessary for shareholders to assess the Group’s position and performance, business model and strategy. In order to make this determination, we received updates on the internal verification processes which had taken place, and usedthat to assist our assessment of the disclosures made within the Annual Report. We also received early sight of the draft Annual Report and Accounts, in advance offinal review and sign-off by the Board, allowing us the opportunity to consider theAnnual Report asa whole. After careful review and consideration of allrelevant information, the Committee was satisfied that, taken as a whole, the 2023 Annual Report and Accounts are considered to be fair, balanced and understandable and we therefore affirmed this view to the Board. The Committee also agreed the parameters of, and subsequently reviewed the reports which supported the going concern statement (see page 79) and the statement on the Board’s assessment of the prospects of the Group (see the viability statement on page 78). The assessment of the going concern and the directors’ viability statement is underpinned by assessments of reasonably plausible, but severe, downside scenarios related to the Group’s principal risks and assessed the impact on the future cash flows, profitability, financial covenants, solvency and liquidity of the Group. As part of this process, we also considered the period covered by the viability statement and we continue to be of the viewthat a five-year period remains the mostappropriate timespan for the Group, given the business planning cycle and the long-term nature of a number of the Group’sprogrammes. Overview of the process to ensure that the Group’s Annual Report, taken as a whole, is fair, balanced and understandable and provides information necessary for shareholders toassess the Group’s position andperformance, business model and strategy 1 Fulsome guidance issued to all the contributors at operational level 2 A verification process dealing with the factual content of the reports 3 Thorough reviews undertaken at different levels in the Group that aim to ensure consistency and overall balance 4 A comprehensive review by the directors and the Executive Committee 99 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Financial statements Additional informationGovernanceStrategic report Audit Committee report continued The principal areas of judgement considered concerning the 2023 financial statements were as set out below. Margin recognition The estimation of contract margin and the level of revenue and profit to recognise in a single accounting period requires the exercise of management judgement. The Committee reviewed key estimates and judgements applied in determining the financial status of the more significant programmes. Pensions Accounting for pensions and other post- employment benefits involves making estimates when measuring the Group’s retirement benefit obligations. These estimates require assumptions to be made about uncertain events, such as discount rates, inflation rates and longevity. As at 31 December 2023, a number of the Group pension schemes remain in an accounting surplus. The Group has recognised the surpluses on the basis that the future economic benefits are unconditionally available to the Group. These have been recognised after deducting a 35% withholding tax, which would be levied prior to the future refunding of any surplus and have been presented on a net basis as this isnot deemed to be an income tax of the Group. Wehave reviewed this presentation and concluded this estimate is appropriate based on the Group’s ability to access its defined benefit surpluses. We reviewed the methodology used to allocate a proportion of the net post- employment benefit surpluses to equity accounted investments and concluded thatthis continues to be appropriate with reference to agreement between the Company and the retirement benefit schemes. We also considered the disclosures in respect of the sensitivity of the surplus tochanges in these key assumptions (see note 24 to the Consolidated financial statements on pages 191 to 202). Taxation Computation of the Group’s tax expense andliability, the provisioning for potential tax liabilities and the level of deferred tax asset recognition are underpinned by management judgement and estimation of the amounts that could be payable. We noted that the UK Government has nowenacted legislation to embed Pillar 2 within UK tax law. While the legislation became effective from 1 January 2024, we reviewed the disclosure requirements ahead of this date to make an initial assessment of the expected impact of thenew legislation onthe Group going forward. Although the Group continues to work through the impact of the legislation, we believe the disclosures are appropriate given the complexity of the legislation. Management will continue to work through the impact of the legislation so as to comply with the requirements for 2024. Tax policy ultimately remains a matter for theBoard’s determination, we reviewed the Group’s tax strategy. Twice during the year, we reviewed the Group’s tax expense and tax provisions, and discussed these with the Group Tax Director. Acquisition of Ball Aerospace On 17 August 2023, the Group announced itsintention to acquire 100% of the share capital of the Ball Aerospace division for consideration of $5.5bn (£4.4bn), The acquisition completed on 16 February 2024. Given the limited time since the acquisition date and the size and complexity of the transaction, the Group is working through the accounting under IFRS 3 Business Combinations and is unable to reasonably estimate and determine the fair value of net assets acquired and resulting goodwill at the date of this report. The Group will work through the fair value exercise under IFRS 3 and the Committee will review the provisional disclosures that will be reported in the Group’s 2024 half-year results. Stephen Pearce Chair of the Audit Committee 100 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Directors’ report February Committee (London, UK) – Reviewed the financial statements andspecific disclosures, including viability and going concern, for recommendation tothe Board. – Received a presentation from the Group Financial Controller and Group Treasurer inrespect of work supporting the viability and going concern statements. – Considered the accounting, financial control and audit issues reported by theexternal auditor that flowed from theaudit work. – Reviewed the effectiveness of the external audit process. – Received a report from the Group TaxDirector. – Reviewed external auditor independenceand nature and value ofnon-audit services. Joint session with the Environmental, Social and Governance Committee: – Considered output from the six-monthly OAS review. – Reviewed the procedures and outputs forthe identification, assessment and reporting of risk. – Agreed final iteration of the 2023 InternalAudit programme. – Reviewed ESG assurance map. – Received an update on limited assurance work undertaken by Deloitte on various ESG matters. – Considered development of ESG-related disclosures, including climate change and TCFD reporting requirements. June Committee (Washington DC, US) – Agreed the 2023 external audit plan andscope. – Reviewed external auditor independence. – Agreed external audit engagement letter and fee. – Considered any emerging accounting issuesprior to the half year. – Received a presentation from VP, InternalAudit, for the US businesses. – Reviewed the Non-Audit Services Policy. – Reviewed the nature and value of non-auditservices. – Agreed external audit partner successors for the US and UK/RoW businesses. July Committee (Videoconference) – Reviewed the financial statements and specific disclosures, including going concern, for recommendation to the Board. – Received a presentation from the Group Financial Controller and Group Treasurer inrespect of work supporting the going concern statement, together with an update on viability. – Considered the accounting, financial control and audit issues reported by the external auditor that flowed from the half-year review work. – Received a report from the Group TaxDirector. – Considered output from the six-monthly OAS review. – Reviewed the procedures and outputs forthe identification, assessment and reporting of risk. – Reviewed external auditor independence and the nature and value of non-audit services. – Discussed the outcome of the External Quality Assessment of the Internal Audit department. November Meeting (London, UK) – Informal meeting with the Internal Audit Director and external auditor. Committee (Sussex, UK) – Undertook a deep dive on the proposedchanges to the UK Corporate Governance Code and the implications ofthe UK Economic Crime and Corporate Transparency Act 2023. – Received an update on the financemodernisation programme from theChief Financial Officer. December Committee (Videoconference) – Considered any emerging accounting issues prior to the year end. – Considered the external auditor’s controlsreport. – Considered output of the Internal AuditDirector’s report. – Received a report on export control compliance from the Chief Counsel Export Control and Compliance. – Reviewed the risk radar. – Set the parameters for work supportingthe viability and going concernstatements. – Received technical accounting and reporting updates. – Discussed the first iteration of the 2024Internal Audit programme. – Reviewed the Internal Audit Charter. – Reviewed external auditor independence and the nature and value of non-audit services. February Committee The Audit Committee’s year June Committee July Committee The Committee holds a quarterly session with the Internal Audit Director and external auditor without management present. The Audit Committee Chair alsomeets with the Chief Financial Officer, the Internal Audit Director and the external auditor on an ad hoc basis. November Meeting Committee December Committee 101 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Financial statements Additional informationGovernanceStrategic report Membership from 1 January 2024: Nick Anderson Crystal E Ashby Stephen Pearce Lord Sedwill Environmental, Social and Governance Committee report Jane Griffiths Chair Dear Shareholders This summary provides you an overview ofthe discussions of the Environmental, Social and Governance Committee during 2023. Page 104 below gives an outline of ourkey areas of focus and the timeline ofactivities. Our Terms of Reference can befound on the Company’s website andprovides further details of the Committee’s responsibilities. At each meeting, we received progress updates from Executive Committee members and senior leadership, against delivery of theGroup’s ESG programme and various initiatives. During the year, we met four timesand, after each Committee meeting, Ireported to the Board on the Committee’s activities, the key matters discussed and anyrecommendations from the Committee. Committee composition Our biographies, on pages 82 to 83, provide asummary of the Committee member skills and our experience which highlights that our collective skills enable us to properly oversee the Company’s progress on ESG matters. Environment and climate transition Environmental factors, including those related to climate change, are one of the Group’s principal risks. The Group’s decarbonisation ambitions, with regard to net zero GHG emissions (Scopes 1 and 2) by 2030, are embedded within the strategic framework and climate transition matters are considered as part of the IBP. As such, climate transition and climate resilience remained important areas of discussion during our meetings thisyear. We received updates from the Climate Resilience & Environment Director, on the impact of climate change on the Group’s activities, transition risks and opportunities and also considered areas such as material scarcity and supplier vulnerability. The impactof the Group’s activities on the climate, nature and biodiversity were alsoexamined by the Committee. Furtherdetail on the Group’s decarbonisation strategy can be found on pages 48 to 50. Wewere pleased tohear of the various decarbonisation activities underway, such as: • investment in power purchase agreements; • site consolidation and building energy efficiency initiatives; and • the development of decarbonisation products. As approved by shareholders at the 2023 AGM, the long-term incentive plan features an ESG objective. In 2023, the ESG metric had a 10% weighting and was based on thereduction of Group GHG emissions (Scope 1 and 2) aligned toascience-based pathway. In assessing performance against this objective, we notedthat the Group had achieved a reductionof 11% in Scope 1 and 2 GHG emissions. Workplace environment The Committee received reports on the various workplace environment initiatives thathad been undertaken across the Group, to create and maintain a positive and welcoming workforce environment. Safety, wellbeing and the approach to diversity, equity and inclusion (DEI) are integral to theGroup’s employer of choice approach. Safety The Committee was pleased to see theinclusion of safety as a principal risk. Employee and product safety have long been key areas of focus for the Group, the Board and this Committee. The inclusion of safety asa principal risk formalises that this remains a key area of focus, and provides consistency between the objectives and the risk that those objectives seek to mitigate. Whilst we were pleased to note an overall improvement in the safety performance, with the reduction of the recordable injury rate by 12.6% compared to 2022, we noted that there had been an increase in the number ofmajor injuries, by 25%. At various points in the year, we heard fromour Safety, Health and Wellbeing and DEI Director who provided updates as to the initiatives being taken to address the potential increase in the severity of injuries which occurred during the year. We learned that thefollowing initiatives had been implemented, with a view to improving safetyculture and awareness: • engagement on safety continued with aGroup-wide focus on safety culture, face-to-face training, leading indicators andvisible leadership; • additional training materials had been made to managers and individual contributors providing scenario-based learning and improvements made to new employee inductions; • a Group-wide software platform, which would allow managers and individuals to review safety and input safety data, leading to improved identification of Serious Injury or Fatality (SIF) and sharing best practice; and • a standardised approach to safety investigations had been articulated which required different injury types and potential SIFs, to be investigated at various levels, with major injuries being reviewed in detailby the UK and US CEOs. Diversity, equity and inclusion As part of every meeting, we review an ESGdata dashboard, which includes key performance indicators for areas such as safety and DEI. At our meeting in February, we had a deep dive into the Group’s progress in respect of its DEI ambitions. In particular, we were pleased to note the progress madethrough recruitment efforts; a fuller explanation of this progress can be found onpage 56. 102 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Directors’ report The Group has a wide range of ERGs that have seen an overall membership increase of 27.5% compared to 2022. We heard of the various campaigns which brought authenticity and personal perspectives on matters such asmental health, menopause and veteran workplace integration. In 2023, the Group had a record early careersintake with the recruitment of 1,323apprentices and 1,113 graduates and undergraduates in the UK. The Committee were pleased to learn that 31% of the apprentice intake were female, and this proportion surpassed the national average of10% within engineering and manufacturing apprentice placements. The work being done across the Group tobecome a preferred employer for service leavers, was an area of interest for us. AGlobal Veterans Network had been established during the year, with membership from the Australian, Canadian, Indian, Saudi Arabian, Swedish, UK and US businesses. The Group’s performance on DEI is a non-financial component of the annual incentive plan for senior executives. These objectives operate as a downward underpin to the incentive, reducing incentive payment if performance is not at the expected levels. We set, measure and determine the level ofperformance achieved against all ESG objectives and make a recommendation tothe Remuneration Committee. Information on further employee engagement undertaken by members of the Board can be found on pages 92 to 93. The 2023 DEI objectives were: • within UK/RoW: increasing gender diversity in mid-management employees and increasing the proportion of employees from minority ethnic backgrounds; and • within BAE Systems, Inc.: increasing gender diversity in mid-management roles and increasing the proportion of employees from minority ethnic backgrounds, in each case compared to 2022. Details of the objectives forthe2024 annual incentive plan may befound on page 114. Communities The communities in which we operate and the Group’s impact are an area of focus for this Committee and the Board. During our meetings, we review the community impact and investments being made across the Group. At the end of the year, we reviewed the contributions and commitments which had been made in 2023. Overall, £4.8m had been invested in STEM education initiatives, £2.9m donated in support of armed forces charities, £1.3m provided to local community projects and £448k contributed to heritageprojects. Employee voice In accordance with Provision 5 of the UK Corporate Governance Code (the Code), the Board maintains an effective mechanism to engage with the workforce. The Committee undertakes some employee engagement on behalf of the Board. This approach is regularly reviewed, to ensure its effectiveness, taking into account contemporary employee engagement practices. As a Board, we discuss employee engagement matters and feed back important elements of conversations and observations from our interactions. Site visits provide useful insight into employee voice, aswell as the considerations and concerns ofthe local communities in which we operate. Together with data and reports fromsenior management, our site visits, meetings and opportunities discussions withemployees give us good perspective intothe matters important to our employees and their communities. Jane Griffiths Chair of the Environmental, Social andGovernance Committee Summary of employee engagement undertaken by the Board and its Committees Key Board/committee/director Date Location Themes and activity ESG Committee Chair April Video calls with UKSHEandDEI team Discussions on safety culture, new SHIELD system, safety performance and DEI initiatives Board members June Chair’s awards Discussions onemployee wellbeing andculture Innovation and Technology Committee July Site visit to Rochester Discussions on early careers, diversity andcommunity Board September Site visit to Warton Discussions on innovation, culture, key skills and education ESG Committee Chair May Video calls with Australia SHE team Discussions on safety culture improvements and integration of safety within business teams Board March Site visit. Glasgow –Scotstoun and Govan Discussions on culture, early careers, safety and gender diversity ESG Committee Chair June Site visit with Shared Services team Board June Dinner with BAESystems, Inc. Senior Leadership Team Discussions on culture andkey challenges 103 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Financial statements Additional informationGovernanceStrategic report Environmental, Social and Governance Committee report continued February Committee (London, UK) – Received an update on the progress of the Group’s net zero programme and reviewed some key developments in the Group’s sustainable technologies. – Discussed the application ofthe Group’s Lobbying policies. – Reviewed workplace safety and wellbeing. – Discussed the progress being made in respect of DEI ambitions. – Joint meeting with the Audit Committee toreview TCFD requirements, non-financial risk register and agree the 2023 Internal Audit programme. June Committee (Washington DC, US) – Performed a deep dive on the Group’s safety performance to date. – Received a briefing on the progress oftheGroup’s diversity, DEI programmes. – Discussed the progress of the Group’s environment and climate transition – netzero programme. – Reviewed the Group’s approach to employee engagement on ESG matters. September Committee (Preston, UK) – Performed a deep dive on various stakeholders perspectives of the Group’s ESG performance. December Committee (Videoconference) – Received an update on the Group’s social value activities, particularly in respect of skills and education, communities and employee wellbeing. – Reviewed the 2023 safety and DEI performance in respect of the outcomes of the annual incentive plan. – Considered the initial proposed objectives and annual incentive targets for 2024 in respect of safety and DEI. February Committee June Committee September Committee December Committee The Environmental, Social and Governance Committee’s year 104 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Directors’ report Membership from 1 January 2024: Nick Anderson Dame Elizabeth Corley Nicole Piasecki Innovation and Technology Committee report Ewan Kirk Chair Dear Shareholders I am pleased to present this report of the Innovation and Technology Committee andprovide a summary of our activities during 2023. Our Terms of Reference canbefound on the Company’s website whichgives further details of the Committee’s responsibilities. We met three times during the year andaftereach meeting I reported the keytakeaways from our discussions and interactions with employees during our site visit to the Board. All of our discussions and our site visit were undertaken in accordance with national security requirements of the UK andother nations. In all of our conversations, we are particularly cognisant of and observe the requirements of BAE Systems, Inc.’s Special Security Agreement. Technologies As part of our standing meeting agenda, we review the Group’s research and development activities and consider relevant emerging and current technologies. During the Board strategy reviews, we hearfrom the Group Chief Technology andInformation Officer (CTIO) and BAESystems, Inc.’s Senior Vice President ofStrategy & Corporate Development on theGroup’s landscape, customer priorities and the key technology drivers for the Group’s global customers. As part of ourCommittee meetings, we review these technologies inmore detail and develop a further understanding of the Group’s ability to effectively respond to customer needs. In the year we learned that, due to theevolving nature of conflicts, there is increasing demand for agile technologies with higher levels of resilience and interconnectivity between tactical andstrategic assets, as well as commandsystems. A brief summary of our discussions aboutthese key technology focus areas isprovided below. Space We reviewed the progress made in respect ofAzalea ™ , the Group’s low Earth orbit, multi-sensor satellite cluster. The 2024 acquisition of Ball Aerospace will enhance theGroup’s already existing capabilities todesign, build and operate satellites andsatellite systems. Sustainability and electrification Sustainability remains an area of focus for theGroup and its customers who wish to meet national decarbonisation commitments. We heard about the ongoing work in regardsto sustainable alternatives such asnovel maritime heat to power solutions, hybrid power and propulsion, hydrogen andmethanol fuel cells and aircraft electrification programmes. Quantum technologies We also discussed quantum sensing andthepotential incorporation into our products,and specifically, within navigation and detection technologies. Quantum sensing haspotential to provide more accurate and sensitive measurements when used for Position, Navigation and Timing, which reduces the need for GPS technologies. Developments in quantum sensing could alsoenable the detection of underwater andstealth vehicles. During the year, we learned of the work being undertaken bytheUK business, working with key universities to understand the capability ofthese technologies and how they could beintegrated and applied in our products. Autonomy, uncrewed systems andArtificial Intelligence (AI) As part of our Board strategy discussions, wenoted the increased use of uncrewed andautonomous systems in various domainsand the changing nature ofwarfare.The Group is working on its various programmes to develop autonomous and counter autonomous solutions. As a Committee, we discussed the investments being made in AI and the abilityto increase autonomy within design and manufacturing processes, as well as enhancing and creating new capability within platforms and services. We understand that any proposed application of AI in defence and security must be carefully considered andapplied in line with regulatory and legalframeworks and we acknowledge ongoing work by our customers to establish appropriate principles and policies. The Board will continue to monitor developments in this and other technology areas. 105 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Financial statements Additional informationGovernanceStrategic report Innovation and Technology Committee report continued Multi-domain and digital integration Multi-domain capabilities and digital integration continues to be an area of focusfor the Group and therefore an areaofdiscussion for this Committee. Integration across the air, sea, land, cyber andspace domains was increasingly important for customers. The CTIO and Technology Director provided us with updates on our own programme todevelop multi-domain andintegration autonomous solutions. Weunderstood that these capabilities could be implemented within existing and developing products and services, as well as those of third parties, and deliver improved interoperability or augment product performance. We heard about the progress being made to improve network robustness and resilient connectivity, and theinvestments in developing high-fidelity synthetic environments that could be used fortraining and the preparation and planning ofmissions. Further information on our integration work can be found on page20. Innovation culture From an innovation culture standpoint, wewere pleased to learn that the activities and discussions required to deliver against ourintegration, autonomy and other programmes, led to increased collaboration with various teams across business units. Anew cross-sector manufacturing technology strategy has been articulated. Thisis aligned to overall Group strategy and associated key technology drivers and will help create a better understanding of where we can collaborate and help deliver a more innovative culture. We heard about the Company’s grand technology challenges whereby business unitteams and university partners are fundedand tasked with devising innovative approaches to technical challenges. Additionally, an entrepreneurial development programme sponsored by the CTIO team hasbeen created. Various cohorts of product owners and engineers were brought together to collaborate and were encouraged to broaden their skillsets in an effort to augment innovation and develop entrepreneurial skills. Ewan Kirk Chair of the Innovation and TechnologyCommittee March Meeting (London, UK) – Strategic context. – Discussion on advanced programmes. – Review of culture. – Discussion on sustainability projects. July Dinner (London, UK) – Dinner with key member of the Electronic Systems sector to better understand innovation culture, challenges and key areas of management focus. Site visit (Rochester, UK) – Strategic context, challenges and opportunities. – Informal lunch with employees to understand and hear first-hand experiences. – Product demonstrations and conversations with employees. October Meeting (Videoconference) – Strategic context. – Agreed key areas of focus for 2024. – University partnerships. – Review of Committee operations andkeythemes. March Meeting July Meeting Site visit October Meeting The Innovation and Technology Committee’s year 106 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Directors’ report Membership from 1 January 2024: Angus Cockburn Dame Elizabeth Corley Ewan Kirk Contents Remuneration Committee report 107 Quick read summary 110 2024 remuneration framework 114 Annual remuneration report 115 Remuneration Committee report Nicole Piasecki Chair Dear Shareholders On behalf of the Board, I am pleased to present the Remuneration Committee’s report for 2023, and to share our decisions inrespect oftheremuneration outcomes for2023. The Remuneration Committee remains responsible for the full spectrum of senior executive employment matters, including ensuring remuneration structures, measures and targets that reward performance and determine appropriate outcomes. This is considered in the context of how performance has been delivered, aligned with both company values and shareholder interests. The Company has been mindful of the needs of our entire workforce in last year’s inflationary environment with regard to higher average salary increases. Lower-paid and mid-level employees in the UK and some other jurisdictions also received special lump sum payments in 2023, in addition to a performance-related bonus and annual award of shares. This year, we have sought to make the remuneration report simpler and easier toread, by including a ‘quick read’ section onpages 110 to 114 summarising the remuneration policy for each component ofpay, and detailing its application and outcome for 2023. Achievements against each of the performance targets for 2023 are detailed onpage 113, showing total remuneration foreach executive director. A summary ofthe2024 remuneration framework is included on page 114. I hope that you will find these improvements useful to our annual remuneration reporting. A full copy of our Remuneration Policy can befound on theCompany’s website at www.baesystems.com/rempolicy. Pay and performance in 2023 BAE Systems has delivered another year ofstrong performance. In 2023, each of our business sectors delivered improved financial and operating results, supported by higher defence spending and highly relevant capabilities to meet the current threat environment. As a result, each of our key performance indicators have exceeded target, including Group underlying EPS up 14%, Group order intake of£37bn and Total Shareholder Return of 144.8% overthreeyears, making BAE Systems one ofthehighest performers inthe FTSE 100. Within this context, and considering overall business performance, the Committee has determined the following outcomes for the annual andlong-term incentive plans: Annual incentive For executive directors, 75% of their annual bonus opportunity is determined by financial performance, and 25% is determined by theachievement of key strategic objectives. The financial performance targets are agreed by the Committee at the beginning of the year, in line with the Integrated Business Plan (IBP), with appropriate performance levels setat threshold, target and stretch. For 2023, thefinancial outcomes exceeded stretch, withmost but not all of the key strategic objectives achieved (see page 123). TheCommittee determined annual bonus outcomes of around 98% ofmaximum for each of the executive directors for 2023. One-third ofthe bonus amounts are deferred into shares for a further three years, in accordance with our Remuneration Policy. Our CEO pay is 84% performance-based, with58% paid in shares, and a minimum shareholding requirement of 300% ofsalary. 2023 – another year of strong performance • Group underlying EPS up 14% • Group order intake at record levels • Total Shareholder Return of 144.8% over three years, one of the highest performers in the FTSE 100 Remuneration Committee We achieve our objectives with anexecutive remuneration programme that: • offers competitive pay that allows us to retain and attract top talent; • emphasises pay for performance that drives superior financial results and value creation; • provides strong alignment with the interests of our shareholders; • mitigates unnecessary and excessive risk-taking; and • considers the needs of our entireworkforce. 107 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Financial statements Additional informationGovernanceStrategic report Remuneration Committee report continued Long-term incentive Performance Share awards were granted toexecutive directors in 2021 with vesting subject to the achievement of stretching goals for relative total shareholder return (TSR), earnings per share (EPS) growth, cashflow and strategic progress metrics incorporating operational excellence (ontimedelivery of key projects), return oncapital, and advances in technology. For the three-year performance period ended31 December 2023, TSR grew by 144.8%,with average annual EPSgrowth of13.3% per annum and free cash flow of£6.2bn over theperiod, exceeding the stretch targets setin 2021. Not all of the strategic progress metrics were fully achieved (see page 124) andtherefore the Committee determined vesting of the Performance Shares of 97.9% of maximum for the executive directors. Before approving the outcomes, the Committee considered overall financial performance and whether there had been awindfall gain due to market volatility at around the time of grant in March 2021. The2021 Performance Share awards were granted on 25 March 2021 at a share price of£4.999. Having considered the share pricemovements around the time of grant, and also having retrospectively reviewed share price performance since grant, the Committee was satisfied that the level of vesting and values for the 2021 Performance Shares is appropriate. The Committee has discretion to reduce formulaic outcomes if appropriate. The Committee did not consider it necessary inrespect of the 2023 pay outcomes. Accordingly, the Remuneration Policy as approved by shareholders in 2023, operated as intended throughout the year, in the context of company performance and overallpay outcomes. Taking care of our people High price inflation continued during the year,resulting in increased cost of living adjustments.Employees in the UK received anaverage 6% pay increase in 2023, andwillreceive pay increases in 2024 averaging 4.5%for executives and 5.2% forcollectively-bargained (manual and professional) employees. In addition, UKcollectively bargained and mid-level non-collectively bargained employees (representing around 88% of the total UKworkforce) received a further £750 lump sum payment in August 2023, in addition tothe £1,000 lump sum payment received inJanuary 2023, to help with the higher costofliving. The First Rate Credit Union, owned and runby current and retired employees of BAESystems, also provided assistance toemployees during 2023. Additionally, UK employees are eligible toreceive a performance-related bonus, plusan annual award of shares worth £629for2023, as wellas company pension contributions, freematching shares through the all-employee Share Incentive Plan, life insurance, income protection insurance, andaccess to shopping discounts, and otherhealth and wellbeing benefits through aflexible benefits platform, including a 24/7/365 employee assistance helpline. In the US, average salary increased by5% for2023. For 2024, average salary increases of around 4% are expected, with additional off-cycle increases for critical talent. Summary of key decisions andoutcomes • 2024 salary increase for executive directors is 4.5%, in line with the low endof increases for the UKworkforce. • 2023 annual bonus payouts for executive directors are around 98% ofmaximum. • 2024 annual bonus will be based 75% onIBP stretch goals for earnings, cash and order intake, and 25% based on theachievement of strategicobjectives witha safety and DEIunderpin. • Performance Shares granted in March 2021 will vest at 97.9% of maximum based on three-year performance to 31December 2023. • Performance Shares to be granted in2024 will be subject to the same performance measures as applied in2023, with stretching targets. 108 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Directors’ report Executive director pay in 2024 The Committee is comfortable that the internal pay relativity reference points set outin this report and external market positioning, provide justification that the current remuneration structure is appropriate. Accordingly, for 2024, no revisions are proposed to the executive remuneration framework that would constitute a change tothe Remuneration Policy. Base salary In line with the low end of the pay increases for UK employees in 2024, the executive directors have received base salary increases of 4.5% with effect from 1 January 2024. Annual incentive The annual bonus structure and opportunity for executive directors will remain unchanged in 2024, with 75% determined by financial performance and 25% determined by theachievement of key strategic objectives. For2024, the performance measures andweightings will continue to be based onearnings, cash and order intake, with performance targets set in line with the Integrated Business Plan (IBP). Long-term incentives The Committee rebalanced the performancemeasures in 2023, to better align with business goals, introducing a return on capital employed (ROCE) measure and adding specific and measurable environmental, social and governance (ESG)goals. For2024, the Committee has maintained thesame performance measures andweightings. The competitive environment We continue to operate in a very competitivemarket for skills and talent, notonly in the UK, but throughout our majormarkets inthe United States, Australia,the Kingdom of Saudi Arabia, andother key international markets. Our employees are highly skilled and experienced, and critical to the delivery of ourfuture business ambitions. Accordingly, our approach to remuneration needs to beflexible and appropriate tothe various markets in which we compete for talent. Two of our executive directors have US nationality, with one based in the US, leading our US business representing 43% of our global revenues. Many of our employees arein demand globally, so we need a Remuneration Policy that enables us to respond quickly to competitive threats fromwherever they arise. The Remuneration Policy approved by shareholders at the 2023 AGM provided renewed opportunity to compete in this increasingly challenging environment, and Iam grateful for the feedback and support ofshareholders at the 2023 AGM who votedfor our Remuneration Policy proposals with more than 97% in favour. We will continue to keep our Remuneration Policy under review, to ensure that it remains sufficient to recruit and retain employees thatare critical to our future success. Committee changes I cannot close without thanking the Committee for their knowledge, insight and challenge during the year, and in particular, Chris Grigg who retired from the Board and Committee in December 2023. I am delighted that both Ewan Kirk and Angus Cockburn have joined and will further strengthen theCommittee. In conclusion I hope that you will find this year’s report aclear account of the Committee’s considerations, decisions and explanation ofthe remuneration outcomes for 2023. Furthermore, I hope that you will continue to support the Committee in its determination to enable fair and effective remuneration linked to business results and shareholder returns, while securing the key skills needed for our future success. On behalf of the Board Nicole Piasecki Chair of the Remuneration Committee We need a Remuneration Policy that enables us torespond quickly to competitive threats. We received strong shareholder support for our Remuneration Policy in 2023, with more than 97% in favour. 109 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Financial statements Additional informationGovernanceStrategic report Quick read summary Remuneration policy summary and 2023 implementation This section summarises the key features of the remuneration policy approved by shareholders at the 2023 AGM. Please refer to the 2022 Annual Report (available on the Company’s website) for full details. Remuneration element and time horizon Policy summary 2023 implementation Base salary 2023 2025 2024 2026 2027 Operation Base salaries are reviewed annually, taking intoaccount performance, skills, the scope oftherole,and the individual’s time in role. Opportunity Increases for executive directors will generally notexceed the average percentage increase foremployees asa whole. As a maximum, inexceptional circumstances (e.g. a material increase in job sizeor complexity, or for a recentlyappointed executive director where salary has been positioned low against themarket), the increase is not expected to exceed 10% in any single year for executive directors performing in the same role. Performance Business and individual performance will betakeninto consideration. Base salary Effective 1 January 2023 Effective 1 January 2024 % increase Charles Woodburn £1,180,635 £1,233,764 4.5% Brad Greve £750,150 £783,907 4.5% Tom Arseneault $1,094,080 $1,143,314 4.5% UK employees below board (average) 4.5% – 5.2% Pension 2023 2025 2024 2026 2027 Operation For UK executive directors, a defined contributionpension plan, or a salary supplementin lieu, or some combination thereof.Base salary is the only element of pensionable remuneration. The President andCEO of BAE Systems, Inc. participates in theUS Defined Benefit pension plans and a USSection 401(k) defined contribution plan. Opportunity The maximum employer contribution for theChief Executive has been aligned to theweighted average of the UK workforce. Themaximum employer contribution for any newUK executive director is in line with the levelavailable to new joiners to the wider UKworkforce. The maximum annual accrual forthe US Defined Benefit pension plans is $1,500, and the maximum 401(k) contribution is6% of base salary, capped at applicable USregulatory limits. Performance No performance conditions. Pension contributions during 2023 (% of salary) Charles Woodburn 14% Brad Greve 8% Tom Arseneault US DB + 401(k) (see page 121) Benefits 2023 2025 2024 2026 2027 Operation Employment benefits which are competitive inline with relevant home market. Opportunity The maximum amount is the cost of providing thebenefits, subject to the limits of those benefitplans and any tax or regulatory limits. Performance No performance conditions. Benefits during 2023 include: – Transportation benefits – Financial and tax advice support – Medical benefits (see page 121). 110 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Directors’ report Remuneration element and time horizon Policy summary 2023 implementation Annual incentive 2023 2025 2024 2026 2027 One-third deferred for threeyears Operation Annual cash bonus linked to in-year financial performance, corporate responsibility and other non-financial objectives. One-third of the total net bonus is compulsorily deferred for three yearsinto shares without any matching. Malusand clawback provisions apply. Opportunity No bonus for below threshold performance, with20% of maximum at threshold; 50% ofmaximum at target; 100% of maximum atstretch; and payout determined on a straight-line basis for performance in-between. Performance 75%-80% of targets will relate to financial metrics aligned with long-term earnings and cash. The non-financial element will be based ona combination of personal performance objectives that provide clear line of sight to our strategic objectives including those in relation toESG, safety measures, diversity, equity andinclusion. At target (% of salary) At maximum (% of salary) Actual 2023 (% of max) Charles Woodburn 112.5% 225% 98.375% Brad Greve 100% 200% 98.125% Tom Arseneault 112.5% 225% 98% 2023 performance measures UK executive directors AB A Financial performance 75% EPS 45% Cash 22.5% Order intake 7.5% B Key strategic objectives 25% (see page 123) Long-Term Incentives Performance shares 2023 2025 2024 2026 2027 Performance Deferral Restricted shares (USexecutive director) 2023 2025 2024 2026 2027 Service Clawback period Operation Performance Share awards are subject tothree- year performance conditions. For UKexecutive directors, shares are deferred forafurther two years and vest from the fifth anniversary of grant, and for US executive directors the shares vest in three equal trancheson the third, fourth and fifth anniversaries of grant. USexecutive directors receive Restricted Shares, subject to remaining employed for threeyears after grant, with a requirement toretain those shares for a further two-year clawback period. Opportunity Nil vesting for below threshold performance, with25% of maximum at threshold; 50% of maximum at target; 100% of maximum at stretch; and vesting on astraight-line basis between these points. Performance Direct financial measures based on the KPIs that drive our financial ambitions, linked to long-term strategic priorities. The Committee has discretion to override the formulaic outcome if it is not reflective of underlying performance. Malus andclawback provisions apply. No performance conditions for Restricted Shares. Performance shares Maximum opportunity (% of salary) 2023 grant (% of salary) Vesting based on performance ending in 2023 (% of max) Charles Woodburn 370% 370% 97.9% Brad Greve 335% 335% 97.9% Tom Arseneault 440% 1 440% 1 97.9% 1. Plus 150% salary in Restricted Shares. 2021 grant performance measures (performance period ended 2023) A Group EPS growth 25% B TSR vs FTSE 100 25% C Cash flow 25% D Strategic progress 25% C D A B 2023 grant performance measures A Group EPS growth 30% B TSR vs FTSE 100 15% C Cash flow 30% D ROCE 15% E ESG 10% C D E A B 111 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Financial statements Additional informationGovernanceStrategic report Quick read summary continued Remuneration policy summary and 2023 implementation continued Remuneration element and time horizon Policy summary 2023 implementation Minimum Shareholding Requirement (MSR) Employment Post (UK) Post (US) Executive directors are required to establish andmaintain a minimum shareholding equal toaset percentage of base salary. Executive directors are expected to achieve 50% of theMSR as quickly as possible, and achieve thefull MSR within a five-year period. If an executive director leaves employment forany reason, they are required to maintain aminimum level of shares for a minimum periodpost-cessation. Full MSR (% of salary) Post-cessation MSR (% of salary) Actual shareholding 31December 2023 (% of salary) Charles Woodburn 300% 300% for two years 485% Brad Greve 200% 200% for two years 150% Tom Arseneault 425% 300% for one year 1,176% Shareholder voting The outcomes of shareholder voting on the resolutions to approve the annual Remuneration Report at the 2023 AGM, and the latest vote (in2023) ontheDirectors’ Remuneration Policy are shown in the charts opposite. Repo rt Poli cy 2.18% For 97.82% 97.61% 2.39% Against Total Shareholder Return (TSR) The total return to BAE Systems’ shareholders (including share price growth and dividends) over the ten-year period to 31 December 2023, compared to the FTSE 100 index. £100 invested in BAE Systems on 31 December 2013 was worth £381.74 by 31 December 2023, compared to £167.98 if invested in theFTSE100. The bars in the chart represent total remuneration of the Chief Executive. £0 £50 £ 100 £150 £200 £300 £350 £400 £450 £500 £550 £250 FTSE 100 Chief Executive remuneration 0 1,000 2,000 3,000 4,000 5,000 11,000 7,000 8,000 9,000 10,000 6,000 12,000 13,000 BAE Systems £’000 20232022202120202019201820172016201520142013 112 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Directors’ report 2023 performance outcomes Actual performance against targets set for 2023 Weight (% of maximum) Threshold Target Stretch Actual UK executive directors US executive director % of maximum achieved Annual bonus Group underlying EPS 45.0% 15.0% 100% 54.2p 57.0p 58.7p 63.5p Group net cash/(debt) 22.5% 7.5% 100% £(2,942)m £(2,542)m £(2,142)m £(1,108)m Group order intake 7.5% 2.5% 100% £19.7bn £20.8bn £21.8bn £37.3bn Inc. underlying EBIT 30.0% 100% $1,580.9m $1,650.9m $1,695.9m $1,715.8m Inc. net cash/(debt) 15.0% 100% $2,383m $2,608m $2,833m $3,210m Inc. order intake 5.0% 100% $11.3bn $11.9bn $12.4bn $19.8bn Key strategic objectives See key strategic objectives on page 123 25.0% 25.0% 92%–93.5% 100% 100% 98%–98.375% Long-term incentives Annual average EPS growth (3-year) 25.0% 25.0% 3.0% per annum 5.0% per annum 7.0% per annum 13.3% per annum 100% TSR vs FTSE 100 13.6% median 53.5% 80th percentile 144.8% 25.0% 25.0% 100% Free cash flow £3.7bn £4.0bn £4.2bn £6.2bn 25.0% 100% Inc. operating cash flow $3,754m $3,979m $4,429m $4,985m 25.0% 100% Strategic progress metrics – Operational excellence (on time delivery) UK executive directors –5% Improvement in 3-year average +3% +6.4% 8.3% – 100% – Operational excellence (on time delivery) US executive director –5% Improvement in 3-year average +3% +5.8% – 8.3% 100% – Return on capital employed 14.98% 15.23% 15.48% 17. 22% 8.3% 8.3% 100% – Advance technology 50% 75% 100% 87.5% 8.3% 8.3% 75% 100% 100% 97.9% Note: Actual results adjusted to be on a comparable basis with the targets, including alignment of foreign exchange rates. Total remuneration The charts below provide a breakdown of the total remuneration received by the executive directors and their maximum total remunerationopportunity. Charles Woodburn (£’000) 2022 (actual) 1,356 2,490 8,161 12,008 13,451 13,696 9,450 9,652 2,613 2,656 2023 (actual) 1,387 2023 (maximum) 1,387 Brad Greve (£’000) 2022 (actual) 741 1,025 6,366 7,126 7,256 4,807 4,599 4,909 1,472 1,500 2023 (actual) 846 2023 (maximum) 846 Tom Arseneault (£’000) 2022 (actual) 996 1,865 4,629 8,751 9,259 9,407 5,015 5,123 1,261 1,350 1,350 1,940 1,980 2023 (actual) 954 2023 (maximum) 954 Fixed (base salary, benefits and pension contributions) Annual incentive Performance Shares Other (Restricted Shares, free shares and matching shares under the UK all-employee Share Incentive Plan). The totals for Charles Woodburn and Brad Greve include between £1k and £2k attributable to ‘Other’. The values for the 2020 Performance Shares which vested based on the three-year performance period ended 31 December 2022, have been updated to reflect the share price at the date of vesting on 25 March 2023 (£9.73). Thiswasnot known at the date of publication of the 2022 Annual Report, so the Performance Shares vesting values were based on the three-month average share price to 31 December 2022 (£8.127). Further details can be found on page 120. 113 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Financial statements Additional informationGovernanceStrategic report Quick read summary continued 2024 remuneration framework Charles Woodburn CEO Brad Greve CFO Tom Arseneault President and CEO Inc. Base Salary £1,233,764 £783,907 $1,143,314 Pension andbenefits Pension Defined contribution (14% of salary) Defined contribution (8%ofsalary) US defined benefit andSection 401(k) definedcontribution Benefits Transportation benefits Financial and tax advice support Medical benefits Annual Incentive On-target/maximum opportunity (%salary) 112.5%/225% 100%/200% 112.5%/225% Performance condition 75% financial (earnings, cash and order intake) 25% non-financial (key strategic objectives) Deferral into Deferred Bonus Plan One-third compulsorily deferred for three years Performance Shares Grant (% salary) 370% 335% 440% Performance condition 30% three-year diluted underlying EPS growth 15% relative TSR vs FTSE 100 30% cash flow 15% return on capital employed 10% ESG metrics Vesting Three-year performance conditions, vests in year 5 Three-year performanceconditions andvested shares released one-third in years 3, 4, 5 Restricted Shares Grant (% salary) n/a 150% Vesting n/a Three-year service conditionand two-year clawback period Minimum Shareholding Requirement (% salary) 300% 200% 425% Post-cessation shareholding requirement (% salary) 300% for two years 200% for two years 300% for one year 114 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Directors’ report This section provides further detail on the remuneration of theexecutive directors, as well as theremuneration of the non‑executive directors (including the Chair), during the financial year ended 31 December 2023. Together with the Committee Chair’s report and quick read summary on pages 110 to 114 inclusive, it will be proposed for an advisory vote by shareholders atthe 2024Annual General Meeting (AGM). It has been preparedon the basis prescribed in Schedule 8 of the LargeandMedium‑sized Companies and Groups (Accounts andReports) Regulations 2008. UK Corporate Governance Code 2018 Reporting against Code requirements canbe found as follows: Strategic rationale for our directors’ remuneration Pages 116 and 119 Appropriateness of ourremuneration Pages 116, 118 and 132–133 Addressing Provision 40 factors Page 118 Operation of our policy Pages 107–112 Engagement with shareholders Page 117 Engagement with workforce Page 117 Exercise of discretion Pages 107–109 Annual remuneration report for the year ended 31 December 2023 Contents Statement of voting 115 Our reward approach andstrategicrationale 116 Engagement with our stakeholders 117 Remuneration principles 118 Implementation of policy for 2024 119 ‘Single figure’ of remuneration – executivedirectors 120 Benefits 121 Pension entitlements 121 Annual bonus 122 Key strategic objectives 123 Long-Term Incentive Plan (LTIP) performance 124 Share interests: – Description of share plans 125 – Scheme interests awarded duringthefinancial year 126 – Statement of directors’ shareholdingsand share interests 127 Executive directors’ service contracts 129 ‘Single figure’ of remuneration for theChair and non-executive directors 130 Chair and non-executive directors’ lettersof appointment 131 Pay comparisons 132 Remuneration Committee composition andadvisers 134 The Remuneration Committee’s year 134 Statement of voting Shareholder voting on the resolutions to approve the Annual remuneration report and the Directors’ remuneration policy put to the 4 May 2023 AGM were: Annual remuneration report Votes for % Votes against % Total votes cast Votes withheld (abstentions) 2,159,695,607 97.82 48,155,233 2.18 2,207,850,840 1,023,290 Directors’ remuneration policy Votes for % Votes against % Total votes cast Votes withheld (abstentions) 2,150,307,412 97.61 52,732,857 2.39 2,203,040,269 5,851,354 The current Directors’ remuneration policy approved at the 2023 AGM is available on the Company’s website at www.baesystems.com/rempolicy. 115 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Financial statements Additional informationGovernanceStrategic report Annual remuneration report continued Our reward approach and strategic rationale Our people strategy is designed to support our aim to retain, attract and develop talent. This is delivered through robust succession planning,targeted recruitment, focused talent management, a culture of inclusivity, learning and development and a competitive employeevalue proposition. Accordingly, as set out in its terms of reference (available on our Company website at baesystems.com), the Remuneration Committee has responsibility for determining the policy for executive director remuneration and ensuring that it is aligned to the Company’s values andclearly linked to the successful delivery of its long-term strategy. As part of this, the Committee reviews group workforce remuneration and related policies, and the alignment of incentives and rewards with culture, taking these into account when setting the policy for executive remuneration. This was considered as part of the core principles in the renewal of the 2023 Remuneration Policy (2023 Policy), including how reward policy and practice compares across the wider workforce. The table below sets out our strategic rationale for each element of remuneration and how our remuneration structure applies for the different groups of employees within BAE Systems. Remuneration element and strategic rationale Executive directors Executive Committee Senior executives Middle management Wider workforce Base salary Recognises market value of role and individual’s skills, experience and performance to ensure thebusiness can attract and retaintalent. Base salaries are based on a market pay approach, taking into account performance, skills, the scope of the role, and the individual’s time in role. Normally reviewed annually with increases typically in line with the wider workforce. Base salary is either subject to negotiation with recognised trades unions and/or is set in linewith market and/ or performance. Pension andbenefits Provides employment and post-retirement benefits that aremarket competitive as part ofoverall package. Range of employment benefits and competitive post-retirement benefits in line with relevant home market. Short‑term incentives Drives and rewards annual performance of both financial andnon-financial metrics, including leadership behaviours, inorder to deliver sustainable growth inshareholder value. Compulsory deferral intoshares increases alignment with long-term shareholder interests. Annual cash bonus linked to in-year financial performance, corporate responsibility and other non-financial objectives. Compulsory deferral for three years into shares without any matching. Annual cash bonus linked to in-year KPIsand other personal objectives and behaviours. Compulsory deferral for three years into shares without anymatching (forthemajority ofUKandRest of Worldexecutives). Annual cash bonus linked to in-year business and individual performance. In UK businesses, cash bonustypically based onin-year business and/or individual performance. None in US, Australia or the Kingdom of Saudi Arabia. Long‑term incentives Longer term reward, predominantly in shares, providing alignment with interests of our shareholders. Performance shares drive our financial ambitions for the Company, with measures linked toour key long-term strategic priorities including our sustainability agenda, aligned to the interests of our shareholders. Restricted shares are designed topredominantly help ensure remuneration for senior US-based executives is competitive in the local market. Eligible employees may participate in and receive free matching shares in our Company Share Incentive Plan (SIP) orinternational equivalent. The Company rewards eligible employees with annual award of free shares, or cash equivalent, based on our Group financialperformance. Performance shares are subject to three-year performance conditions (andfurther holding requirements). Restricted shares vest subject to remaining employed for three years, with a further two-year clawback period (applicable in the US only). Performance shares are subject to three-year performance conditions. Restricted shares vest subject to remainingemployed for three years (predominantly applicable in the US). 116 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Directors’ report Engagement with our shareholders In line with our commitment to full transparency and engagement with our shareholders on the topic of executive remuneration, the Remuneration Committee Chair periodically writes to our major shareholders and also the Institutional Shareholder Services, the Investment Association and Glass Lewis, to set out our planned remuneration changes. In particular, during the formulation of the 2023 Policy, the Remuneration Committee Chair engaged directly with and met our major shareholders to discussand seek their views on potential changes. The Remuneration Chair values direct engagement with our shareholders andmade herself available for such meetings to hear their perspective on remuneration matters which helped shape the 2023 Policy. Engagement with our workforce The safety, wellbeing, skills, capabilities and commitment of our people are critical to ensuring the long-term sustainability of our business anddelivering the innovation needed to solve our customers’ complex challenges. Effective engagement enables our employees to contribute toimproving business performance and helps us to create an environment in which everyone is safe, valued and can fulfil their potential. Both the Board as a whole and the ESG Committee undertake workforce engagement. Feedback from the ESG Committee on its engagement activities, and insights from the Board’s own conversations and observations from employee interactions at site visits and in various other forums, all provide useful context. This, coupled with data and reports from senior management, gives good perspective for the Board into employee voice, including matters important to the wider workforce. Further detail on Board and ESG Committee employee engagement can be found on pages 93 and 103. During 2023, we used a range of channels to engage with employees across the Group, including in-person and virtual meetings, briefings, conferences, toolbox talks, safety stand-downs, events and listening forums at all levels. Leaders provided regular updates aswell as attending events throughout the year. We also engaged with employees using digital channels including our Employee App, intranet, email and TV systems. Our Employee Resource Groups (ERGs) are important to creating an inclusive work environment where everyone feels they belong, and educating employees about the unique issues our colleagues face in and out of the workplace. We also consult with our employees and their representatives regularly and ona wide variety oftopics. Their views are taken into account in our decision-making processes on matters thataffect their interests. Engagement with our trades unions Engagement forums continued with trades unions in Australia and the UK and labour unions in the US. Engagement on executive remuneration This report is the principal means through which we communicate and engage with employees on how executive remuneration aligns with thatof the wider workforce. Over 53,000 of the Company’s employees who are shareholders in the Company receive email communications with a direct link to this report on the Company’s website and an invitation to vote on the resolutions being put to the Annual General Meeting (AGM), including those resolutions on executive remuneration. The results of employee shareholder voting on the AGM resolutions, including those relating to executive remuneration and the renewal of our remuneration policy in 2023, are subsequently reported to the Board for discussion. This is not used to seek feedback on individual outcomes. Engagement on wider workforce remuneration The Committee regularly undertakes in-depth sessions to build its understanding of reward arrangements applicable to the wider workforce across different populations and geographies. The Committee has continued to deepen its approach, not only due to the broader governance requirements, but because it believes that well-designed remuneration can be a tool of culture change and progressive improvement in Company performance. Such sessions provide assurance that the remuneration for the wider workforce is consistent with market trends, withregulation, and support an inclusive work environment in line with our focus on Diversity, Equity and Inclusion. These sessions have covered a range of topics including the outcome of the annual reward review, spotlight on the total reward package withindifferent workforce populations and geographies and the outcome of our UK gender and ethnicity pay analysis. 117 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Financial statements Additional informationGovernanceStrategic report Annual remuneration report continued Remuneration principles The Committee has established six core principles which underpin our approach to executive remuneration. The principles are aligned to theCompany’s strategic objectives, taking account of shareholder expectations and the remuneration factors set out in Provision 40 of the UKCorporate Governance Code (the Code). The Committee considered these principles in the renewal of our 2023 Policy, whilstbeing mindful of the alignment and fairness of remuneration with the wider workforce. The table below shows this close alignment between the Committee’s core principles and the Code’s factors, including how the Committee addresses each factor. Factor within Provision 40 How the Committee addresses the factor Clarity Remuneration arrangements should be transparent and promote effective engagement with shareholders and theworkforce. In line with our commitment to full transparency and engagement with ourshareholders on the topic of executive remuneration, the Remuneration Committee Chair periodically engages with our major shareholders to set outthe changes planned. In a year of significant change, the Remuneration Committee Chair will consult with our major shareholders todiscuss andseekviews on potential changes. The Company consults directly with the broader employee population ontheirremuneration through a variety of methods including virtual meetings, explanatory guides hosted on the intranet, human resources or business-led briefings, direct line manager engagement and materials posted to employees’ homes (see also page 117 for engagement on executive pay). Simplicity Remuneration structures shouldavoidcomplexity and their rationale and operation should be easy tounderstand. Simple three-part construct of salary, annual incentive and long-term incentives has been in use for a number of years. Use of a single ‘umbrella’ LTI plan allowing for simplicity and flexibility ofdesign. Risk Remuneration arrangements should ensure reputational andother risks from excessive rewards, and behavioural risks that can arise from target-based incentive plans, are identified andmitigated. Full range of design features exist within remuneration arrangements to take risks into account as follows: – malus and clawback mechanisms within annual and long-term incentives; – Remuneration Committee application of reasonable discretion to override formulaic outcomes; and – safety targets expected to be met in all circumstances, with a downward underpin applying within the annual incentive in the event of below- targetperformance. Predictability The range of possible values ofrewards to individual directorsand anyother limits ordiscretions should be identified and explained at the timeof approving the policy. Our remuneration policy contains the following: – maximum award levels and vesting outcomes applicable to annual andlong-term incentives; and – as set out above in Risk, the Committee has the ability to apply malus, clawback and reasonableness discretion where appropriate. Proportionality The link between individual awards, the delivery of strategy and the long-term performance of the Company should be clear. Outcomes should not reward poor performance. Performance conditions attached to annual and long-term incentive arrangements require a minimum level of performance to be achieved before any payout is made. There is a direct link between anindividual’s reward and their contribution to driving strategy and increasing Company performance. No payment is made for poor performance. Any individual’s performance that is below expectations is dealt with as part of our performance management process – any individual leaving due to performance issues would not be entitled to any incentive payments. Alignment to culture Incentive schemes should drivebehaviours consistent withCompany purpose, valuesand strategy. As set out on pages 116 and 119, there is a direct link between driving BAESystems’ strategy and an individual’s reward, with incentive measures chosen as they align with the Company’s shared strategic objectives. As shown to the right, the Committee has applied six core principles which underpin the philosophy and approach to executive remuneration to ensure alignment to the Company’s strategic objectives. Remuneration Committee coreprinciples Simplicity Clarity and simplicity of design; ease of understanding by executives and external stakeholders. Motivational Plans are relevant and meaningful with clear line of sight between actions and reward outcomes; metrics and targets which drive superior performance and value for shareholders. Aligned with shareholderinterests Close alignment of reward outcomes and shareholder experience; long-term share ownership and ‘skin in the game’for executives. Globally competitive Reward opportunity alignedtorelevant competitive employment market; enabling mobility across different businesses and geographies. Reflects ESG progress Embedding the sustainability agenda to benefit all stakeholders; compliance and scrutiny of executive pay and fairness relative to the wider workforce. Flexibility Transparent and responsible application of discretion to override formulaic outcomes; ability to respond to special/ unforeseen circumstances duringlife of binding policy. 118 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Directors’ report Strategic alignment of our incentives The chart below shows how our remuneration framework directly aligns to our shared strategic objectives through the use of incentive arrangements that support the Company’s strategy. Annual incentive Long-term incentive How our strategic objectives aremeasuredin our incentives Shared strategic objectives Sustain and grow ourdefence and security business Continue to grow ourbusiness in adjacent markets Develop and expandour international business Enhance financial performance and deliver sustainable shareholder growth Inspire and developa diverse workforce to drive success Advance and integrateour sustainability agenda Free cash flow Order intake Key strategic objectives Earnings per share Relative Total Shareholder Return Cash flow Return on capital employed Environmental, social and governance Earnings per share Implementation of our policy in the year ending 31 December 2024 For the purposes of the Companies Act 2006, the Directors’ remuneration policy (the Policy) has been operating in practice since the date of its approval on 4 May 2023 at the 2023 AGM (and is available on the Company’s website). The remuneration for 2024 will be implemented as follows: – The salary of the executive directors with effect from 1 January 2024 is: Chief Executive £1,233,764; Chief Financial Officer £783,907; andthe President and Chief Executive Officer of BAE Systems, Inc. $1,143,314. – Annual and Long-Term Incentive opportunity levels are in line with the 2023 Policy as set out on page 114. – Long-Term Incentive awards of Performance Shares only for UK executive directors, and Performance Shares andRestricted Shares forourUS executive director. – The performance metrics applicable to the 2024 Annual Incentive will remain 75% on financial metrics relating to earnings, cash and order intake at a Group level, and additionally, in the case of the US executive director, at a BAE Systems, Inc. level. Thecash metric will bemeasured on free cash flow, replacing the former net cash/(debt) metric. The remaining 25% will continue to be based on the achievement of key strategic objectives. The weightings of the financial metrics are: For UK executive directors: For US executive director: Group EPS – 45% Group EPS – 15% Group free cash flow – 22.5% Group free cash flow – 7.5% Group order intake – 7.5% Group order intake – 2.5% BAE Systems, Inc. EBIT – 30% BAE Systems, Inc. free cash flow – 15% BAE Systems, Inc. order intake – 5% Key strategic objectives designed to support the Group’s strategy and with Safety and Diversity, Equity and Inclusion (DEI) applying as adownward underpin onthiselement – 25%. The Committee is of the view that bonus targets for the Annual Incentive are commercially sensitive and that it would be detrimental tothe Company to disclose them in advance. The targets will be disclosed retrospectively after the end of the relevant financial year. – The performance measures and weightings for 2024 for the Long-Term Incentives are set out on pages 114 and 125. 119 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Financial statements Additional informationGovernanceStrategic report Annual remuneration report continued ‘Single figure’ of remuneration – executive directors (audited) The following table shows the single total figure of remuneration for each executive director in respect of qualifying services for the 2023 financial year, together with comparatives for 2022. Fixed Variable LTIP 5 Base salary 1 £’000 Benefits 2 £’000 Pension 3 £’000 Total fixed £’000 AIP 4 £’000 Face value £’000 Share appreciation £’000 Total LTIP £’000 Other 6 £’000 Total variable £’000 Total £’000 2023 Charles Woodburn 1,181 41 165 1,387 2,613 4,012 5,438 9,450 1 12,064 13,451 Brad Greve 750 36 60 846 1,472 2,041 2,766 4,807 1 6,280 7,126 Tom Arseneault 880 60 14 954 1,940 2,129 2,886 5,015 1,350 8,305 9,259 2022 Charles Woodburn 1,135 37 184 1,356 2,490 3,626 4,535 8,161 1 10,652 12,008 Brad Greve 657 31 53 741 1,025 2,043 2,556 4,599 1 5,625 6,366 Tom Arseneault 851 56 89 996 1,865 2,057 2,572 4,629 1,261 7,755 8,751 The above table has been subject to audit. The single figure table of remuneration for the Chair and non-executive directors is on page 130. 1. This column relates to the base salary received by the executive directors. Tom Arseneault is paid in US dollars with the disclosed figures being converted into pounds sterling at the required exchange rate. TomArseneault’s 2023 salary reflects his 4% increase and the exchange rate fluctuations experienced during 2023. 2. The benefits received by the executive directors are detailed on page 121. 3. The figures for Charles Woodburn and Brad Greve relate to a salary supplement in lieu of Company pension contributions and the added pension value received in the year from their defined contribution schemes in respect of the employer contributions. The figures for Tom Arseneault include company contributions paid into his Section 401(k) defined contribution arrangements. The figures for Tom Arseneault also reflect defined benefit arrangements calculated in line with the method set out in Section 229 of the Finance Act 2004 using a capitalisation factor of 20 for the life pension, a x10 factor for the ten-year pension and a x1 factor for the lump sum benefit (see page 121). 4. Further detail on bonus payments is provided on pages 122 and 123. One-third of the net bonus paid will be deferred compulsorily into BAESystems shares for a three-year period, without additional performance conditions. 5. These columns relate to the estimated or actual value of Long-Term Incentive Plans for which the performance period ended in the relevant financial year. The 2023 values in the LTIP columns are calculated on the basis of the three-month average share price of £10.6475 as at 31 December 2023 and relates to the vesting portion including shares deriving from notional reinvested dividends, of the 2021 Performance Share award for which the performance period ended on 31 December 2023. Vesting is 97.9% overall for UKdirectors and 97.9% overall for the US director. See page 124 for further detail. As required by regulation, the estimated vesting values for the awards shown in the 2022 columns (which were calculated in the 2022 AnnualReport on the basis of the three-month average share price of £8.1272 as at 31 December 2022) have been adjusted to reflect the actual value on the vesting of the Performance Share award in March 2023 based on the then share price of £9.73 and excludes the value ofthe shares deriving from notional reinvested dividends in respect of Performance Share awards already disclosed in a prior year’s single figure remuneration table. The figures reported in the 2022 column in the 2022 Annual Report on the estimated basis were Charles Woodburn: £6,846k; Brad Greve: £3,842k and Tom Arseneault: £3,869k. The respective figures in the 2022 Total and Total variable remuneration columns have been recast accordingly. Additionally, theChief Executive’s single total figure for 2022 as referenced on pages 112, 113, 132 and 133 has been recast. 6. This column includes (i) the value of Free Share awards under the UK all-employee Share Incentive Plan (SIP) of £629 for Charles Woodburn andBrad Greve, and their respective Matching Shares under voluntary investment in the SIP; and (ii) for Tom Arseneault, the value of the 2023 grant of Restricted Shares (£1,350k). This award formed part of Tom Arseneault’s 2023 LTIP allocation but is required to be reported under ‘Other’ as it has no performance conditions attached. There were no payments to former directors in 2023. 120 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Directors’ report Benefits (audited) Benefits received by the executive directors are detailed below. Transportation benefits 1 Financial and tax advice support Medical benefits 2 Total 2023 £’000 2022 £’000 2023 £’000 2022 £’000 2023 £’000 2022 £’000 2023 £’000 2022 £’000 Charles Woodburn 25 25 8 6 8 6 41 37 Brad Greve 20 19 8 6 8 6 36 31 Tom Arseneault 25.5 21.5 12 12 22.5 22 60 55.5 1. For UK executive directors includes Company car or cash allowance. For US executive director includes private use of chauffeur-driven car and Company aircraft. 2. For UK executive directors includes private medical insurance and medical benefits. For US executive director includes private medical and executive medical benefits,dental benefits, insured life cover and disability benefits. Pension entitlements Total pension entitlements (audited) Figures included in the remuneration table on page 120 Director Age Normal retirement age Accrued benefit at 1January 2023 1 £ Accrued benefit at 31 December 2023 1 £ Added pension value received in the year from defined benefit scheme £ Added pension value received in the year from defined contribution scheme £ Total £ Charles Woodburn 52 65 66,229 80,485 n/a 8,500 8,500 Brad Greve 56 65 27,30 4 38,424 n/a 8,500 8,500 Tom Arseneault 60 65 See notes below – 14,317 14,317 1. Accrued benefit for Charles Woodburn and Brad Greve is the total value of their defined contribution account, including employee contributions and investment returns. The above table has been subject to audit. Charles Woodburn participates in the Mercer Master Trust – BAE Systems Retirement Savings Plan (BAESRSP), which is a defined contribution arrangement. The Company contributes the maximum into the BAESRSP arrangement as permitted by the Annual Allowance (£4,000 per annum to 5 April 2023; £10,000 per annum from 6 April 2023). A 14% salary supplement is paid in lieu of the Company contributions in excessof those permitted by the Annual Allowance which are paid into the BAESRSP. Brad Greve also participates in the BAESRSP. The Company contributes the maximum into the BAESRSP arrangement as permitted by the Annual Allowance (£4,000 per annum to 5 April 2023; £10,000 per annum from 6 April 2023). An 8% salary supplement is paid in lieu oftheCompany contributions in excess ofthose permitted by the Annual Allowance which are paid into the BAESRSP. Tom Arseneault participates in US defined benefit and Section 401(k) arrangements as follows: Arrangement Accrued benefit at 1January 2023 Accrued benefit at 31 December 2023 BAE Systems ERP Qualified Plan – life pension $39,348 per annum $39,348 per annum BAE Systems ERP 2006 Qualified Plan – lump sum $84,000 $85,000 12/31/2004 BRP Restoration Plan – life pension $5,283 per annum $5,283 per annum 2007 BRP – ten-year pension $101,177 per annum $97,416 per annum Section 401(k) $1,421,754 $1,719,441 The accrued defined benefit for Tom Arseneault is an annual pension and lump sum payable at retirement prior to any reduction forearly retirement. Tom Arseneault also participates in a Section 401(k) defined contribution arrangement set up for US employees in which the Company will match his contributions up to a maximum contribution of 6% of salary, up to USregulatory limits (2024 $23,000; 2023 $22,500). In 2023, theCompany paid contributions of $18,250 into this arrangement. The accrued Section 401(k) benefit for Tom Arseneault is the total value of hisSection 401(k) account including both employee and company contributions as well as investment returns. 121 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Financial statements Additional informationGovernanceStrategic report Annual remuneration report continued Annual bonus (audited) The 2023 annual bonuses are based on performance for the year ended 31 December 2023. 75% of the bonus opportunity is determined byfinancial performance, and 25% is based on the achievement of key strategic objectives. The figures in the table below represent the total annual bonus amounts to be paid, including the cash amount payable in March 2024 (two-thirds of total), and the amount deferred into BAE Systems shares for a further three years to be released in March 2027 subject to malusand clawback provisions (one-third of total). 2023 annual bonus for Charles Woodburn and Brad Greve 2023 performance range and outcome Weighted vested outcome (%) Performance measure Threshold (20% max) Target (50% max) Stretch (100% max) Actual Percentage ofmaximum achieved Weighting Charles Woodburn Brad Greve Financial Group underlying EPS 54.2p 57.0p 58.7p 63.5p 100% x 45% = 45% 45% Group net cash/(debt) £(2,942)m £(2,542)m £(2,142)m £(1,108)m 100% x 22.5% = 22.5% 22.5% Group order intake £19.7bn £20.8bn £21.8bn £37.3bn 100% x 7.5% = 7.5% 7.5% Non-financial Key strategic objectives See page 123 Charles Woodburn 93.5% x 25% = 23.375% Brad Greve 92.5% x 23.125% Total (% of maximum) 100% = 98.375% 98.125% x x Maximum bonus opportunity (% salary) 225% 200% x x 2023 base salary £1,180,635 £750,150 = = 2023 annual bonus £2,613,261 £1,472,169 2023 annual bonus for Tom Arseneault 2023 performance range and outcome Weighted vested outcome (%) Performance measure Threshold (20% max) Target (50% max) Stretch (100% max) Actual Percentage ofmaximum achieved Weighting Tom Arseneault Financial Group underlying EPS 54.2p 57.0p 58.7p 63.5p 100% x 15% = 15% Group net cash/(debt) £(2,942)m £(2,542)m £(2,142)m £(1,108)m 100% x 7.5% = 7.5% Group order intake £19.7bn £20.8bn £21.8bn £37.3bn 100% x 2.5% = 2.5% BAE Systems, Inc. underlying EBIT $1,580.9m $1,650.9m $1,695.9m $1,715.8m 100% x 30% = 30% BAE Systems, Inc. net cash/(debt) $2,383m $2,608m $2,833m $3,210m 100% x 15% = 15% BAE Systems, Inc. order intake $11.3bn $11.9bn $12.4bn $19.8bn 100% x 5% = 5% Non-financial Key strategic objectives See page 123 Tom Arseneault 92% x 25% 23% Total (% of maximum) 100% = 98% x Maximum bonus opportunity 225% x 2023 base salary $1,094,080 = 2023 annual bonus $2,412,446 £1,939,686 A Safety and DEI underpin applies to the non-financial element, with the requirement to uphold and deliver our commitment tohigh standards of safety and a diverse and inclusive workforce. Performance in respect of this underpin was determined by the Environmental, Social and Governance Committee (whose composition is stated on page 102). For 2023, improvements in our overall safety requirements were met. The overall safety performance of our operations improved with our recordable accident rate reducing by more than 12% and the majority ofthis improvement relating to a reduction in recordable injuries within our US business. There has been continued year on year improvement indiversity for both increased gender diversity in mid-management roles and increased proportion of employees from minority ethnic backgrounds. The Committee therefore concluded that the underpin requirements had been met and there would be no reduction to theexecutive directors’ bonuses for 2023. 122 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Directors’ report Key strategic objectives Achievement against key strategic objectives represents 25% of the annual bonus opportunity. These objectives relate to the delivery of the Group’s strategy centred on maintaining and growing our business, securing growth opportunities through advancing our strategic priorities including our sustainability agenda, anddemonstrating leadership behaviours. An underpin applies to the outturn ofthenon-financial element, with a requirement to uphold and deliver our commitment to high standards ofsafety, and a diverse and inclusive workforce. Executive directors and Executive Committee members are collectively responsible for, and required to support, a set of shared common strategic objectives. Shared strategic objective Assessment of strategic objective Sustain and grow our defence and security business – Improve project outcomes – Increase internal collaboration – Increase supply chain collaboration – Resource for future growth – Increased project management capability, understanding and application ofLife CycleManagement (LCM). – Leveraged capabilities across geographies to develop new cross-sector products andservices. – Early adoption of sub-tier supply chain process improvements. – Improved the effectiveness of our recruitment process to deliver accurate in-year recruitment demand plan to support programme delivery resourcing and capabilities. Continue to grow our business in adjacent markets – Evolve new technology opportunities – Significant progress achieved against our strategic technology growth themes demonstrated through major internal development milestones against certain advanced projects. Develop and expand our international business – Pursue growth – Win new orders – Delivered significant progress against our non-home or non-core market growthambitions. – Exceeded targets to win and progress specific international orders. Inspire and develop a diverse workforce to drive success – Grow our talent and succession pipeline – Increase Diversity & Inclusion – Increased diversity of experience in our talent pipeline through increased mobilityacross the Company. – Improvements in diversity of talent in relation to gender, ethnicity and people ofcolourrepresentation. Enhance financial performance and deliver sustainable shareholder growth – Increase our efficiency and effectiveness – Improve project performance – Reduced day to day costs of running the business as percentage of revenue. – Delivered net improved project performance margins per Group salients. Advance and integrate our sustainability agenda Environment – Progress towards net zero – Increase supply chain environmental engagement – Technology emissions Social – Improve safety performance – Increase diversity Governance – Enhance our risk management performance – Increase our investor ratings – Decarbonisation of own operations (scope 1 and 2) ahead of SBTi milestone. – Launched global supply chain decarbonisation strategy and supply chain engagementprogramme. – Completed assessment of Scope 3 product use SBTi emissions baseline forour products and services. – Year on year improvements in safety performance and safety training compliance. – Linked to objective to inspire and develop a diverse workforce to drivesuccess. – Reduced overall significant Group risk rating. – Increased investor ESG ratings through improved data, progress in key ESG material areas and transparency of reporting. Charles Woodburn Chief Executive Brad Greve Chief Financial Officer Tom Arseneault President and Chief Executive OfficerofBAE Systems, Inc. Payout (% of maximum): 93.5% Payout (% of maximum): 92.5% Payout (% of maximum): 92.0% Safety and DEI underpin: 100% Safety and DEI underpin: 100% Safety and DEI underpin: 100% Overall non-financial outturn: 93.5% Overall non-financial outturn: 92.5% Overall non-financial outturn: 92.0% Key Below target Target At or exceeds stretch 123 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Financial statements Additional informationGovernanceStrategic report Annual remuneration report continued Long-Term Incentive Plan (LTIP) performance (audited) The 2021 LTIP award is dependent upon performance of Earnings Per Share (EPS), Total Shareholder Return (TSR), Cash Flow and a Strategic Progress metric, each in equal measure, over the three years ended 31 December 2023. The following table summarises the achievement of thevesting outcomes of the respective performance conditions. Actual performance against targets Percentage of maximum achieved Weight (percentage of maximum) Weighted vested outcome (%) Key performance indicators Threshold (25%vesting) Target (50%vesting) Stretch (100%vesting) Actual UK executive directors US executive director UK executive directors US executive director Annual average EPS growth (three-year) 3% pa 5% pa 7% pa 13.3% pa 100% 25% 25% 25% 25% TSR vs FTSE 100 13.6% median 53.5% 80th percentile 144.8% 100% 25% 25% 25% 25% Free cash flow £3.7bn £4.0bn £4.2bn £6.2bn 100% 25% 25% BAE Systems, Inc. operating cash flow $3,754m $3,979m $4,429m $4,985m 100% 25% 25% Strategic progress metrics – Operational excellence (on time delivery) UK executive directors –5% Improvement in 3-year average +3% 6.4% 100% 8.3% – 8.3% – – Operational excellence (on time delivery) US executive director –5% Improvement in 3-year average +3% 5.8% 100% – 8.3% – 8.3% – Return on capital employed 14.98% 15.23% 15.48% 17.22% 100% 8.3% 8.3% 8.3% 8.3% – Advance technology 50% 75% 100% 87.5% 75% 8.3% 8.3% 6.3% 6.3% 100% 100% Overall vesting 97.9% 97.9% 2021 Performance Shares For the EPS performance measure, in line with theCommittee’s agreed principles, measurement in constant currency is used to ensure that the calculation of EPS is not impacted by currency exchange rate fluctuations, upwards or downwards. In reviewing the composition of EPS growth, no one-off amounts were deemed relevant inthe overall consideration of the achievement of the EPS outturn. The Committee was therefore satisfied that the performance condition was achieved at a vesting level of 100% of the EPS portion. TSR performance exceeded the upper quintile (top 20%) of the FTSE 100 comparator group, and therefore vesting is atmaximum. In confirming this outcome, the Committee also considered the secondary condition and determined that there had been a sustainedimprovement in the Company’s underlying financial performance. Group free cash flow exceeded stretch requirements over the performance period and will therefore vest at maximum. In the case of BAESystems, Inc. operating cash flow, which applies to our US executive director, the stretch performance requirements were also met andwill vest at maximum. As set out in the table above, Strategic Progress is based equally on the three metrics of operational excellence, ROCE and advance technology metrics. Operational excellence, measured by the metric of on-time delivery, achieved improvements in the three-year average which were inexcess of stretch performance for all sectors. Return on capital employed over the period exceeded the stretch performance requirement. Inrelation to the advance technology metric, not all the key project milestones were met in relation to the advanced technology programmes, andaccordingly this metric will vest at 75%. Before approving the outcomes, the Committee considered the overall financial performance and whether there had been a windfall gain due to market volatility at around the time of grant in March 2021. Having considered the share price movements at the time of grant, and also having retrospectively reviewed share price performance since grant, the Committee was satisfied that the level of vesting and values for the 2021 Performance Shares are appropriate. Therefore, given the Company’s underlying business performance over the three-year performance period and share price history, the Committee believes the vesting outturn of 97.9% for the 2021 Performance Share award is appropriate. 124 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Directors’ report Description of share plans Long-term incentives operate under the BAE Systems LTIP approved by shareholders at the 2014 AGM and the BAESystems Long-Term Incentive Plan 2023. The latter was approved by shareholders at the 2023 AGM, the terms ofwhich remain substantially the same as the BAE Systems Long-Term Incentive Plan 2014. The main vehicles in use arePerformance Shares and Restricted Shares. From 2018 executive directors no longer receive share option awards. Up to and including 2022, share options have beenused below executive director level without performance conditions and are generally exercisable between three andten years from grant. LTIP Performance Shares Since 2018, awards to UK executive directors are subject to a three-year performance period but will not vest until the fifth anniversary of grantand will be exercisable until the seventh anniversary of grant. For US executive directors, the awards are automatically delivered in three equal tranches at the end of years three, four and five, subject to the performance condition being achieved. Shares under award attract notional reinvested dividends prior to tranche vesting. For existing awards granted up to and including 2024 the following metrics and weightings apply. Metric Awards granted up to and including 2020 Awards granted in 2021 and 2022 Awards granted from 2023 Earnings per share (EPS) 50% 25% 30% Total Shareholder Return (TSR) 50% 25% 15% Free or Operational cash flow 25% 30% Operational excellence 8.3% Return on Capital Employed (ROCE) 8.3% 15% Advance technology 8.3% Environmental, social and governance (ESG) 10% The description of the performance conditions are shown below. Details of the performance conditions attached to the 2019 award are set out in the 2021 Annual Report and those in respect of the 2020 award are set out in the 2022 Annual Report, available on the Company’s website. Metric Performance condition EPS Rate of average annual diluted underlying EPS growth over the three-year performance period, with 25% vesting at3% average growth per annum, 50% vesting at 5% average growth per annum and 100% vesting at 7% average growth per annum, with vesting on a straight-line basis between these parameters. TSR The proportion of the award capable of vesting is determined by: (i) The Company’s TSR measured against a single comparator group of the companies in the FTSE100 index. No shares vest ifthe Company’s TSR is less than the median TSR achieved by the comparator group, with 25% vesting at median, 100% vesting if the Company’s TSR is in the top quintile and vesting on astraight-line basis between these two parameters; and (ii) whether there has been a sustained improvement in the Company’s underlying financial performance. In taking such a view, the Committee may consider (but not exclusively) the following financial metrics: net cash/debt; EBIT¹; order book; turnover; risk; and project performance. Free or Operational cash flow Three-year cumulative free cash flow (FCF) at a Group level for UK executive directors, and three-year Operating Cash Flow (OCF) in respect of BAE Systems, Inc. business for the US executive director. 25% vesting at threshold, 50% vesting at target and 100% vesting at stretch, with vesting on a straight-line basis between these parameters. Due to commercial sensitivity, the targets will be disclosed retrospectively after the end of the relevant financial year. Operational excellence Focuses on the adherence to project plans of mission-critical projects. Measured by the metric of On Time Delivery, evaluated against an approved set of customer contracts, in a manner consistent with the normal course of business. Contracts are representative of each main business sector, having regard to execution risk, scale and duration. For our US executive director, On Time Delivery will be measured against BAE Systems, Inc. contracts only. The Company’s robust quality and safety processes will continue to apply. Target performance achieved for equal orbetter than aggregated On Time Delivery three-year average. Threshold and stretch performance levels will also apply, with final vesting outturn between 0% and 100% of this element. ROCE 25% vesting for 25bps reduction in ROCE compared to prior year IBP, 50% vesting for three-year ROCE consistent with prior year IBP and 100% vesting for 25bps improvement in ROCE compared to prior year IBP, with vesting on a straight-line basis between these parameters. Due to commercial sensitivity, the targets will be disclosed retrospectively after the end of the relevant financial year. Advance technology Effective programme delivery for major technology programmes will be used to measure our effectiveness at driving technology adoption. Over the three-year performance period, the selected projects will be measured against their key project milestones. The vesting outcome will be derived from the outturn of each of the projects (between 0% and 100% of this element). Due tocommercial sensitivity, the projects will be disclosed retrospectively after the end of the relevant financial year. ESG Objective to reduce Group GHG emissions (Scope 1 and 2) aligned to a science-based pathway of 1.5°C, year-on-year over ten years. Measurement over three-year performance period. 25% vesting for minimum 5% reduction, 50%vesting for 12.6% reduction and 100% vesting for 14% reduction. Vesting on a straight-line basis between these targets. 1. With effect from 2021, the Group adopted the underlying EBIT profitability measure in place of the previously reported EBITA measure. Details of this areprovided in the Alternative performance measures section on page 227. Note that in accordance with the Directors’ remuneration policy, Performance Share awards granted to executive directors are subject toapplication of reasonableness discretion in light of other important factors in the business. 125 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Financial statements Additional informationGovernanceStrategic report Annual remuneration report continued Description of share plans continued LTIP Restricted Shares Restricted Shares are not subject to a performance condition as they are designed to help ensure remuneration for seniorUS executives is competitive in the local market and also to assist in mitigating retention risks in respect of certain key executives. The shares are subject only tothe condition that the participant remains employed by the Group at the vesting date (three years after the award date). Shares under award attract notional reinvested dividends prior to vesting. Awards made to the US executive director are subject to a further two-year clawback period after the initial three-year vesting period. Share interests Scheme interests awarded during the financial year (audited) Scheme Type of interest Date of grant Number of shares Basis of award (%of salary) Face value of award 1 £ Exercise price £ Date to which performance ismeasured (three years to) Performance condition Percentage ofinterests receivable ifminimum performance achieved 2 Charles Woodburn LTIP PS TSR Performance Shares/nil costoption 24.03.23 67, 205 55.5% 655,249 nil 31.12.25 TSR/secondary financial measure 25% LTIP PS EFRG Performance Shares/nil costoption 24.03.23 380,830 314.5% 3,713,092 nil 31.12.25 EFRG 25% Brad Greve LTIP PS TSR Performance Shares/nil costoption 24.03.23 38,661 50.25% 376,945 nil 31.12.25 TSR/secondary financial measure 25% LTIP PS EFRG Performance Shares/nil costoption 24.03.23 219,082 284.75% 2,136,049 nil 31.12.25 EFRG 25% Tom Arseneault LTIP PS TSR Performance Shares 24.03.23 41,260 44.7% 402,285 n/a 31.12.25 TSR/secondary financial measure 25% LTIP PS EORG Performance Shares 24.03.23 233,804 253.3% 2,279,589 n/a 31.12.25 EORG 25% LTIP PS TSR Performance Shares 05.05.23 18,864 21.3% 187,357 n/a 31.12.25 TSR/secondary financial measure 25% LTIP PS EORG Performance Shares 05.05.23 106,898 120.7% 1,061,711 n/a 31.12.25 EORG 25% LTIP RS Retention 24.03.23 138,455 150% 1,349,936 n/a n/a n/a n/a 1. The value of the award is calculated on the date of grant by reference to the middle market quotation at the close of the preceding day (£9.75 for the grants made on24 March 2023 and £9.932 for the grants made on 5 May 2023). 2. Each of the four performance conditions in the EFRG and EORG metrics are measured separately. Key: LTIP – Long-Term Incentive Plan. PS – Performance Shares. RS – Restricted Shares. TSR – Total Shareholder Return. EFRG – Earnings per share, Free cash flow, Return onCapital Employed and ESG measure. EORG – Earnings per share, BAE Systems, Inc. Operating Cash Flow, Return on Capital Employed and ESG measure. The Performance Share awards set out above have five performance conditions with these conditions weighted as follows: EPS: 30%; TSR: 15%; Cash generation: 30%; ROCE: 15%; and ESG measure: 10%. Further detail on these performance conditions is set out on page 125. Tom Arseneault’s May 2023 Performance Share grant reflects the increase in Performance Share award level from 298% of salary to 440% ofsalary in the 2023 Remuneration Policy agreed by shareholders at the 2023 AGM. Note: Performance Shares and Restricted Shares – Shares under award attract notional reinvested dividends prior to vesting. Performance Shares areintended to be free share awards and for UK executive directors are structured as a nil cost option to give the participant more flexibility as tothetiming of the benefit. For the US executive director, awards of Performance Shares are classified as conditional share awards (rather than shareoptions) and are deliverable on the third, fourth and fifth anniversary ofgrant, subject to attainment of the performance condition. For the UKexecutive directors, shares vest on the fifth anniversary of grant. The table above has been subject to audit. 126 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Directors’ report Statement of directors’ shareholdings and share interests Minimum Shareholding Requirement (MSR) Executive directors are required to establish and maintain a minimum personal shareholding equal to a set percentage of base salary as set outin the table below. Executive directors are required to achieve their Initial Value as quickly as possible, and achieve their Subsequent Value within a five-year time period. Where an executive director has not achieved their MSR, the consequence is a restriction on the number ofshares that can be sold on exercise or release, until their MSR Subsequent Value is met. Where an executive director has met less than the Initial Value (50% of their MSR), they must retain 50% of the net value (i.e. the value after the deduction of exercise/sale costs and tax) of shares acquired through the various share schemes; if they have met the Initial Value but not the Subsequent Value (i.e. between 50% and 100% of their MSR), they must retain 25% of the net value. In the event that the executive director has not met the Subsequent Value at the end of the five-year period, the Committee will set out their proposed remedial actions at that time. The Committee has discretion to increase the Initial Value and/or Subsequent Value. Shares owned beneficially by the director and his/her spouse count towards the MSR. Where an executive director leaves employment for any reason, a post-cessation shareholding policy will apply. For UK executive directors, thepolicy is based on the full MSR continuing to apply for a period of two years. For US executive directors, the policy is based on the MSR of300% of salary applying for a period of one year. Executive directors will be required to sign acontract on leaving employment to ensure compliance with this policy. Any case of non-compliance would be dealt with by the Committee. The following table sets out MSR Initial Value and Subsequent Value and actuals as at 31 December 2023. Charles Woodburn and Tom Arseneault have shareholdings in excess of their respective MSRs. Brad Greve has been gradually building up his shareholding. His first LTI award will vest in 2025, having already met the performance condition, and being subject to continued employment. Initial Value Subsequent Value Actual Achieved MSR Charles Woodburn 150% 300% 485% Yes Brad Greve 100% 200% 150% Expected within the required 5 years Tom Arseneault 212.5% 425% 1,176% Yes The actual MSR figures in the table are provided as at 31 December 2023, based on the year-end share price of £11.105. The higher MSR values applicable to Tom Arseneault recognise the higher LTI opportunity and broader US market practice. There are MSR requirements in place for the majority of the employee population who receive LTIPs. There are no shareholding requirements for the Chair or the non-executive directors. 127 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Financial statements Additional informationGovernanceStrategic report Annual remuneration report continued Statement of directors’ shareholdings and share interests continued Share interests as at 31 December 2023 (audited) The interests of the directors who served during the year ended 31 December 2023 in the shares of BAE Systems plc, orscheme interests inrelation to those shares, were as follows: Shares Scheme interests: Options and awards over shares Share awards with performance conditions Share awards without performance conditions Share options with performance conditions Share options with performance conditions, vested but unexercised Share options without performance conditions Total scheme interests Charles Woodburn 515,815 – – 3,563,332 – – 3,563,332 Brad Greve 101,802 – – 1,386,630 – – 1,386,630 Tom Arseneault 908,712 1,477,502 521,305 – – 1,435,729 3,434,536 Note: The share options without performance conditions were granted to Tom Arseneault prior to him being appointed as an executive director. These options are vested but unexercised. The related breakdown of these options is shown on page 129. The interests of the non-executive directors who served during the year ended 31 December 2023 in the shares ofBAESystems plc were as follows: Shares Chair Sir Roger Carr 1 166,549 C M Hogg – Non-executive directors N J Anderson 14,000 C E Ashby – A G Cockburn 2 2,000 Dame Elizabeth Corley 19,000 J V Griffiths 10,117 C M Grigg 3 24,555 E M Kirk – S T Pearce 10,000 N W Piasecki – Lord Sedwill – 1. Figures shown as at 4 May 2023, the date of retirement from the Board. 2. Appointed to the Board on 6 November 2023. 3. Retired from the Board on 31 December 2023. The interests of directors include those of their connected persons. Details of the share interests in options and awards held by the executivedirectors as at 31 December 2023 are given on page 129 together with details of options exercised in 2023. Performance Shares granted under the LTIP are classified as share awards with performance conditions for the US executive director andasnil-cost options with performance conditions for the UK executive directors. Since 31 December 2023, both Charles Woodburn and Brad Greve have each acquired an additional 37 shares under the Partnership andMatching Shares elements of the Share Incentive Plan so that their beneficial shareholdings at the dateof this report stood at 515,852and101,839 respectively. There have been no other changes in the interests of the directors in the shares of BAE Systems plc between 31 December 2023 and 20 February 2024 (the latest practicable date for inclusion in this report). 128 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Directors’ report Breakdown of scheme interests (audited) Charles Woodburn Options and awards held as at 31 December 2023 31 December 2023 Date of grant Exercise price £ Date from which exercisable or part exercisable LTIP PS TSR 285,227 1 20.03.18 nil 20.03.23 LTIP PS EPS 285,227 1 20.03.18 nil 20.03.23 LTIP PS TSR 55,416 2 20.03.19 nil 20.03.24 LTIP PS EPS 350,737 2 20.03.19 nil 20.03.24 LTIP PS TSR 373,737 2 25.03.20 nil 25.03.25 LTIP PS EPS 373,737 2 25.03.20 nil 25.03.25 LTIP PS TSR 204,936 2 25.03.21 nil 25.03.26 LTIP PS EFS 614,806 3 25.03.21 nil 25.03.26 LTIP PS TSR 142,869 4 24.03.22 nil 24.03.27 LTIP PS EFS 428,605 4 24.03.22 nil 24.03.27 LTIP PS TSR 67,205 4 24.03.23 nil 24.03.28 LTIP PS EFRG 380,830 4 24.03.23 nil 24.03.28 3,563,332 Brad Greve Options and awards held as at 31 December 2023 31 December 2023 Date of grant Exercise price £ Date from which exercisable or part exercisable LTIP PS TSR 210,626 2 25.03.20 nil 25.03.25 LTIP PS EPS 210,627 2 25.03.20 nil 25.03.25 LTIP PS TSR 104,239 2 25.03.21 nil 25.03.26 LTIP PS EFS 312,718 3 25.03.21 nil 25.03.26 LTIP PS TSR 72,669 4 24.03.22 nil 24.03.27 LTIP PS EFS 218,008 4 24.03.22 nil 24.03.27 LTIP PS TSR 38,661 4 24.03.23 nil 24.03.28 LTIP PS EFRG 219,082 4 24.03.23 nil 24.03.28 1,386,630 Tom Arseneault Options and awards held as at 31 December 2023 31 December 2023 Date of grant Exercise price £ Date from which exercisable or part exercisable LTIP PS TSR 4,560 2 20.03.19 n/a 20.03.24 LTIP PS EPS 28,858 2 20.03.19 n/a 20.03.24 LTIP PS TSR 141,331 2 25.03.20 n/a 25.03.24 LTIP PS EPS 141,331 2 25.03.20 n/a 25.03.24 LTIP PS TSR 108,764 2 25.03.21 n/a 25.03.24 LTIP PS EOS 326,290 3 25.03.21 n/a 25.03.24 LTIP PS TSR 81,386 4 24.03.22 n/a 24.03.25 LTIP PS EOS 24 4,156 4 24.03.22 n/a 24.03.25 LTIP PS TSR 41,260 4 24.03.23 n/a 24.03.26 LTIP PS EORG 233,804 4 24.03.23 n/a 24.03.26 LTIP PS TSR 18,864 4 05.05.23 n/a 05.05.26 LTIP PS EORG 106,898 4 05.05.23 n/a 05.05.26 1,477,502 LTIP SO 258,380 25.03.15 5.43 25.03.18 LTIP SO 289,258 23.03.16 4.99 23.03.19 LTIP SO 267,026 21.03.17 6.49 21.03.20 LTIP SO 268,594 20.03.18 5.82 20.03.21 LTIP SO 352,471 20.03.19 4.85 20.03.22 1,435,729 LTIP RS 218,987 25.03.21 n/a 25.03.24 LTIP RS 163,863 24.03.22 n/a 24.03.25 LTIP RS 138,455 24.03.23 n/a 24.03.26 521,305 Share Options – options exercised during 2023 Exercised during the year Exercise price £ Date of grant Date of exercise Market price on exercise £ LTIP SO 304,245 4.12 26.03.14 27.03.23 9.81 Note: The Share Options granted to Tom Arseneault between 2014 and 2019 as setoutabove were granted prior to him being appointed as an executive director anddo not have performance conditions attached to them. Options are normally exercisable between the third and tenth anniversary of their grant. Share options granted to him from 2015 onwards are subject to a two-year clawback period afterthe initial three-year vesting period. 1. All shares vested in accordance with agreed terms. 2. Subject to a performance condition that has been met. 3. A small portion of the outstanding option or award will partially lapse after the end of the financial year having not met the full performance condition. 4. Subject to a performance condition that is yet to be tested. Note: As reported in the Remuneration Committee Chair’s report in the 2021Annual Report, in light of the volatility in the market during March 2021, theCommittee attached an additional condition to the 2021 awards to retain theability to exercise discretion to ensure that the value of the 2021 awards atvesting is appropriate. Theoutcome is reported on page 124. The tables above have been subject to audit. Performance conditions for the LTIP are detailed on pages 125 to 126. Executive directors’ service contracts All executive directors have rolling service agreements which may be terminated in accordance with the terms of those agreements. Dates of appointment for executive directors: Name Date of appointment Expiry of current term Charles Woodburn 1 1 July 2017 12 months either party Brad Greve 1 April 2020 12 months either party Tom Arseneault 2 1 April 2020 60 days either party 1. Appointed to the Board as Chief Operating Officer on 9 May 2016; appointed as Chief Executive with effect from 1 July 2017. 2. Tom Arseneault’s contract of employment automatically renews for a one-year period from 31 December each year, unless one party gives the other at least 60days’notice. Details of notice periods and terms of the Chair and non-executive directors are on page 131. In accordance with the UK Corporate Governance Code, all directors are subject to annual election or re-election at the Company’s AGM. 129 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Financial statements Additional informationGovernanceStrategic report Annual remuneration report continued ‘Single figure’ of remuneration for the Chair and non-executive directors (audited) Fixed Variable Committee membership as at 31December 2023 Fees £’000 Benefits £’000 Other £’000 Total fixed remuneration £’000 Total variable remuneration £’000 Total £’000 2023 2022 2023 2022 2023 2022 2023 2022 2023 2022 2023 2022 Chair Sir Roger Carr 1 – 243 700 – – – – 243 700 – – 243 700 C M Hogg 2 N 486 14 – – – – 486 14 – – 486 14 Non-executive directors N J Anderson E I N 110 85 8 1 – 9 118 95 – – 118 95 C E Ashby E N 99 85 6 4 9 9 114 98 – – 114 98 A G Cockburn 3 A N 16 n/a – n/a – n/a 16 n/a – – 16 n/a Dame Elizabeth Corley A I N R 121 85 2 1 – 9 123 95 – – 123 95 Dame Carolyn Fairbairn 4 – n/a 30 n/a 1 n/a – n/a 31 – – n/a 31 J V Griffiths E N 120 110 3 1 – 9 123 120 – – 123 120 C M Grigg 5 A N R 143 110 – – – 9 143 119 – – 143 119 E M Kirk I N R 131 110 3 1 – 9 134 120 – – 134 120 S T Pearce A N 120 110 1 1 – 9 121 120 – – 121 120 N W Piasecki E I N R 143 101 11 6 9 14 163 121 – – 163 121 Lord Sedwill 6 E N 99 14 – – – – 99 14 – – 99 14 I P Tyler 4 – n/a 38 n/a 1 n/a – n/a 39 – – n/a 39 1. Retired from the Board and as Chair on 4 May 2023. 2. Appointed to the Board on 1 November 2022 and as Chair on 4 May 2023. 3. Appointed to the Board on 6 November 2023. 4. Retired from the Board on 5 May 2022. 5. Retired from the Board on 31 December 2023. 6. Appointed to the Board on 1 November 2022. Committee Chair A Audit Committee E Environmental, Social and GovernanceCommittee I Innovation and Technology Committee N Nominations Committee R Remuneration Committee The amounts in the ‘Benefits’ column relate to travel expenses and subsistence and theamounts in the ‘Other’ column relate to the travel allowance discontinued from 1 April 2023. There were no payments to former directors in 2023. Chair of the Board The fee for the Chair of the Board is set by the Remuneration Committee. Sir Roger Carr’s fee was at the rate of £700,000 per annum through to his retirement at the close of the 2023 AGM. Cressida Hogg succeeded Sir Roger Carr as Chair on 4 May 2023, and receives the same fee and benefits as her predecessor. Her fee will not be reviewed again until 1 April 2025. Non-executive directors Fees for the non-executive directors, which are reviewed periodically, were reviewed in February 2024 by the Board without any of the non-executive directors present, i.e. by the Chair and executive directors. It was agreed that from 1 April 2024, the base fee paid to each non-executive director should be increased by 4.6%;the supplementary fee paid to the Senior Independent Director and each of the Committee Chairs (except the Nominations Committee Chair) be increased by 4.3%; and the Committee membership fee be increased by 33.3% to better reflect the time commitment and bring them more in line with the market. The fee structure on a per annum basis is as follows: Fee per annum up to 31 March 2023 Fee per annum from 1 April 2023 Fee per annum from 1 April 2024 Fee paid to all non-executive directors £85,000 £88,400 £92,500 Supplementary fees Senior Independent Director £25,000 £35,000 £36,500 Audit Committee Chair £25,000 £35,000 £36,500 Remuneration Committee Chair £25,000 £35,000 £36,500 Environmental, Social and Governance Committee Chair £25,000 £35,000 £36,500 Innovation and Technology Committee Chair £25,000 £35,000 £36,500 Committee membership fee (per Committee except Nominations) nil £15,000 £20,000 Travel allowance per meeting for air travel of more than five hours (one way) subject to a maximum of six travel allowances per annum £4,500 nil nil The single figure table of remuneration for the executive directors is on page 120. 130 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Directors’ report Annual percentage change in directors’ remuneration As required by regulations, thetable below shows the percentage change in remuneration between the years ended 31 December 2023 and2022, andprior years, for executive directors, non-executive directors and average employee remuneration. As required by legislation, employees are those employed by the BAE Systems plc entity on a full-time equivalent basis. The percentage increases represent the change intotal remuneration between each reported year, and therefore may indicate significant increases when comparing with a prior part-year. 2022/2023 % change 2021/2022 % change 2020/2021 % change 2019/2020 % change Salary/ fees Benefits¹ Annual bonus Salary/ fees Benefits 1 Annual bonus Salary/ fees Benefits¹ Annual bonus Salary/ fees Benefits¹ Annual bonus Executive directors C N Woodburn +4.0 +11.0 +4.9 +2.5 +56.4 +2.9 +12.7 +17.7 +39.1 +6.9 –3.9 –12.1 B M Greve 2 +14.1 +14 .2 +43.6 +5.6 +79.3 +6.0 +36.0 +44.2 +68.7 n/a n/a n/a T A Arseneault 2 +3.3 +7.1 +4.0 +15.0 +24.1 +15.8 +27.9 +156.9 +115.4 n/a n/a n/a Current non-executive directors C M Hogg 3 +3,333.6 n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a N J Anderson 2 +29.5 +642.4 n/a 0.0 –42.7 n/a +500.0 +81.0 n/a n/a n/a n/a C E Ashby 4 +16.2 +51.7 n/a +200.0 n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a A G Cockburn 5 n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a Dame Elizabeth Corley +42.7 +69.7 n/a 0.0 – 47.6 n/a +1.5 0.0 n/a +4.7 –100.0 n/a J V Griffiths 2 +9.1 +288.3 n/a 0.0 –82.2 n/a +72.5 0.0 n/a n/a n/a n/a E M Kirk 4 +19. 4 +101.7 n/a +75.8 +92.6 n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a S T Pearce 6 +9.1 –20.3 n/a 0.0 –50.0 n/a +1.1 +90.4 n/a +133.0 –4.0 n/a N W Piasecki 6 +40.7 +72.2 n/a +19.2 n/a n/a +1.5 –100.0 n/a +79.5 –35.5 n/a Lord Sedwill 3 +597.4 n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a Former non-executive directors Sir Roger Carr 5 –65.2 0.0 n/a 0.0 0.0 n/a 0.0 0.0 n/a 0.0 0.0 n/a Dame Carolyn Fairbairn 3,4 n/a n/a n/a –58.2 n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a C M Grigg +29.6 n/a n/a 0.0 n/a n/a +7.3 0.0 n/a +28.1 –100.0 n/a I P Tyler 3 n/a n/a n/a –65.2 –8.8 n/a +1.1 +8.9 n/a +3.6 –64.7 n/a Average employee 7 +6.0 +6.0 +63.3 +4.5 +4.5 +9.2 +1.5 +1.5 +28.4 +2.5 +2.5 –2.0 1. Where benefit figures are £nil as is often the case for non-executive directors, the benefits percentage change is shown as n/a. 2. 2020 remuneration for Brad Greve, Tom Arseneault, Nick Anderson and Jane Griffiths reflects their part-year from joining the Board during 2020. 3. 2023 remuneration for Cressida Hogg reflects her appointment as Chair on 4 May 2023; 2022 remuneration for Cressida Hogg and Lord Sedwill reflects their part-year from joining the Board during 2022; and reflects part-year for Dame Carolyn Fairbairn andIan Tyler on stepping down from the Board during 2022. 4. 2021 remuneration for Crystal Ashby, Dame Carolyn Fairbairn and Ewan Kirk reflects their part-year from joining the Board during 2021. 5. 2023 remuneration for Angus Cockburn reflects his part-year from joining the Board during 2023; and reflects part-year for Sir Roger Carr on stepping down from theBoard during 2023. 6. 2019 remuneration for Stephen Pearce and Nicole Piasecki reflects their part-year from joining the Board during 2019. 7. Figures are provided in respect of the relevant median average employee of BAE Systems plc as determined on a full-time equivalent basis and with the annual bonus estimated on the accrued expected financial outturn in respect of 2023. The relatively large change in average employee annual bonus for 2023 partly reflects the increasein bonus opportunity for our executive grades in line with the market. Chair and non-executive directors – letters of appointment The appointment of Cressida Hogg as Chair is documented in a letter of appointment. Her appointment as Chair will automatically terminate if she ceases to be a director of the Company. Her appointment is for three years ending on 4 May 2026 unless terminated earlier in accordance with the Company’s Articles of Association or by the Company or by the Chair giving not less than six months’ notice. The Chair’s appointment is to be reviewed by the Nominations Committee prior to the end of the three-year term and the Chair may be invited to serve for an additional period. Non-executive directors do not have service contracts but do have letters of appointment detailing the basis of their appointment. The non- executive directors are normally appointed for an initial three-year term that, subject to review, may be extended subsequently for further suchterms. Non-executive directors do not have notice periods. The dates of their original appointment and expiry of their current term are shown below: Name Date of appointment Expiry of current term Nick Anderson 1 November 2020 31 October 2026 Crystal E Ashby 1 September 2021 31 August 2024 Angus Cockburn 6 November 2023 5 November 2026 Dame Elizabeth Corley 1 February 2016 31 January 2025 Jane Griffiths 1 April 2020 31 March 2026 Ewan Kirk 1 June 2021 31 May 2024 Stephen Pearce 1 June 2019 1 June 2025 Nicole Piasecki 1 June 2019 1 June 2025 Lord Sedwill 1 November 2022 31 October 2025 In accordance with the UK Corporate Governance Code, all directors are subject to annual election or re-election at the Company’s AGM. Details of service contracts and notice periods of the executive directors are on page 129. 131 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Financial statements Additional informationGovernanceStrategic report Annual remuneration report continued Pay comparisons Pay ratio of Chief Executive to UK average employee The Committee is mindful of the relationship between the Chief Executive’s remuneration and the remuneration of BAESystems’ employees more generally. The table below shows the ratio of total remuneration for the Chief Executive tothat of other UK employees at 25th percentile, median (50th percentile) and 75th percentile. Year Method 25th percentile pay ratio Median pay ratio 75th percentile pay ratio 2023 Option B 264:1 191:1 181:1 2022 Option B 256:1 185:1 168:1 2021 Option B 171:1 140:1 99:1 2020 Option B 121:1 103:1 89:1 2019 Option B 90:1 72:1 59:1 2018 Option B 61:1 48:1 38:1 The reporting regulations permit three different calculation methodologies for determining the pay ratio: – Option A – using actual remuneration for all UK employees to determine median, 25th and 75th percentiles for the relevant financial year; – Option B – using representative data points for median, 25th and 75th percentiles (consistent with our gender pay gapreporting); and – Option C – using any other available pay data. The table above has been calculated using Option B, which is considered the most appropriate and consistent methodology for reporting. Thecalculations for the relevant representative employees were undertaken as at 31 December 2023. BAESystems has around 40,000 employees in the UK, operating on different human resources and payroll systems, with 2023 bonus amounts for some employees not able tobe determined until after publication of this report. Accordingly, it is not possible to determine the exact 2023 total remuneration for all employees within the reporting timescale, and therefore it is not possible to accurately report using Option A. To ensure Option B provides a sufficiently accurate representation of the UK workforce, we consider the total pay and benefits for a number ofemployees centred around each of the quartiles. This allows any anomalies that may arise (such as if an employee left part way through theyear) to be adjusted or excluded. Taking an average of the remaining figures provides a robust representation of each quartile. The total full-time equivalent pay and benefits for the relevant employees have been calculated on the same basis as the Chief Executive’s singletotal figure remuneration. For pension-related benefits, employer pension costs have been estimated using the employer contribution rates applicable to the member’s pension scheme. No other estimates or adjustments have been used in the calculation and no remuneration items have been omitted. Our reward framework across the Group is based on a consistent set of principles, including managing reward by reference to external competitor benchmarks (see page 116). Our Chief Executive’s total remuneration comprises a significant proportion in variable pay and thereforethe single total figure will vary considerably depending on the outturn of the Annual and Long-Term Incentive Plans. The employees inthe calculation would not typically participate in any long-term incentive plans and receive a significantly higher proportion of their remuneration in the form of fixed pay. The ratio at the three quartiles is consistent with our market-based approach to reward, with the ratio increasing as the Chief Executive’s remuneration is compared with that of more junior employees. The overall picture presented by the ratios isalso consistent with our pay, reward and progression policies. £ 25th percentile 50th percentile 75th percentile Total pay and benefits 50,923 70,473 74,344 Salary component 39,087 45,527 57,34 4 The pay ratio in 2023 has increased by approximately 3% at 25th and 50th percentiles, and 8% at the 75th percentile relative to 2022. Thetotal pay and benefits figures have increased at each quartile in part reflecting the actions taken by the Company to address the increased cost of living and other salary and incentive improvements. The pay ratio has been impacted by the increase in the Chief Executive’s remuneration for 2023, primarily as a resultof share price appreciation on the 2021 Performance Share award between the grant and vesting dates. In considering the median pay ratio since 2018, the recent upward trend corresponds to the increased LTI vesting payouts as shown on page 133. Gender pay The BAE Systems 2023 gender pay gap report is available on the Company’s website atbaesystems.com. The average (mean) gender pay gapfor ourUKworkforce was 7.7% in favour of men (2022 8.6%). Werely onemploying large numbers of employees with STEM qualifications and we, likeothercompanies, face challenges recruiting women with thesequalifications because there are significantly fewer women who study and work in these fields. As a result, a greater proportion ofourworkforce and our senior leadership population are men and this is a major factor inour gender pay gap. We continue to work hard toimproveour gender balance and remain steadfast in our commitment to delivering the plans we have in place to increase the number ofwomen in BAE Systems and support the progression of women into senior executive positions. Ethnicity pay BAE Systems voluntarily published its first UK ethnicity pay gap report in December 2023. We are committed to progressing racial and ethnic minority representation and in order to do this, we need to understand our ethnicity pay gap and supporting data. For 2023, we have an average (mean) ethnicity pay gap of 3.9%. 86.3% of our employees have voluntarily disclosed their ethnicity; 82.3% identify as White and 4%identify as All Other Ethnic Groups. We already have a number of programmes underway to progress racial and ethnic minority talent, andare committing to growing our ethnic minority population year-on-year. 132 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Directors’ report Total Shareholder Return (TSR) performance and Chief Executive pay The chart below shows the value as at 31 December 2023 of £100 invested in BAE Systems shares on 31 December 2013, compared to £100 invested in the FTSE 100 on the same date. If invested in BAE Systems that shareholding would be worth £381.74 on 31 December 2023, compared to £167.98 if invested in the FTSE 100. The FTSE 100 was chosen as the comparator because it is a broad equity index of which BAE Systems is a constituent member, and reflects theinvestment interests of our UK shareholder base. In addition, the FTSE 100 forms 100% of the TSR performance measure for Long-Term Incentive (LTI) awards made since 2021, and 50% for LTI awards between 2016 and 2020. The chart demonstrates the strong long-term alignment of our Chief Executive pay with the returns to shareholders. This alignment is achieved by ensuring a high proportion of the Chief Executive’s remuneration is in shares, with performance conditions based on measures that directly support the implementation of our strategy. Value at 31 December 2023 of £100 investment at 31 December 2013 2013 2014 2015 2016 2017 1 2018 2019 2020 2021 2022 2023 Change in Chief Executive’s remuneration over ten years 2014 2015 2016 2017 1 2018 2019 2020 2021 2022 2023 Chief Executive’s single totalfigure(£’000) Charles Woodburn – – – 1,279 2,416 3,747 3 6,080 7,071 12,008 13,451 Ian King 3,519 2,929 3,463 2,086 n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a 3,519 2,929 3,463 3,365 2,416 3,747 3 6,080 7,071 12,008 13,451 Bonus paid as a percentage ofmaximum Charles Woodburn – – – 75.8% 65.6% 95.6% 78.7% 97.1% 97.5% 98.4% Ian King 74.3% 72.4% 82.3% 75.9% n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a LTI as a percentage ofmaximumvesting Charles Woodburn – – – n/a nil 10.9% 3 100% 57.9% 100% 97.9% Ian King 16.8% nil nil 11.3% n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a 1. In 2017, Charles Woodburn succeeded Ian King as Chief Executive on the latter’s retirement. Ian King’s remuneration is shown from thestart of 2017 until 30 June 2017 and Charles Woodburn’s remuneration is shown from 1 July 2017 to the end of thatyear. 2. Plotted as a bar chart on the secondary y-axis. 3. Total remuneration includes the value of share plans vesting that were granted prior to appointment as Chief Executive. Relative importance of spend on pay The chart below shows the relative importance of expenditure on pay 1 compared to returns toshareholders 2 . Underlying EBIT 3 is shown forinformation. Underlying EBIT £0m £2,000m £4,000m £6,000m £8,000m £ 10,000m 2022 £2,479m £2,682m 2023 Returns to shareholders 2022 £1,590m £1,418m 2023 Total employee costs 2022 £7,495m £8,091m 2023 1. Wages and salaries increased by approximately 5.45% per employee in 2023, excluding the impact of exchange translation. 2. Returns to shareholders comprise dividends to ordinary shareholders paid in the year and share repurchases in 2022 (£788m) and 2023 (£561m). 3. Underlying EBIT is the Group’s principal measure of operational profitability as defined in the Alternative performance measures section on page 227. £0 0 £50 £100 1,000 £150 £200 2,000 3,000 £300 4,000 £350 £400 5,000 11,000 7,000 8,000 9,000 10,000 6,000 £450 £500 £550 £250 BAE Systems FTSE 100 Chief Executive remuneration 2 12,000 13,000 £’000 133 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Financial statements Additional informationGovernanceStrategic report Annual remuneration report continued Remuneration Committee composition and advisers The Committee members comprise Nicole Piasecki as Chair, Angus Cockburn (from 1 January 2024), Dame Elizabeth Corley, and Ewan Kirk (from1 March 2023). Chris Grigg also served as a Committee member throughout the year until he retired from the Board on 31 December 2023. Committee attendance is shown on page 83. Advisers to the Remuneration Committee are shown below. During the year under review, the Committee received material assistance and advice on remuneration policy from the Group Reward Director, Roger Fairhead, and the Group Human ResourcesDirector, Tania Gandamihardja. Charles Woodburn in his role as Chief Executive alsoprovided advice that was of material assistance to the Committee. Adviser Services provided Appointment Governance Fees (in respect of services provided to the Committee) Willis Towers Watson (WTW) Since July 2022, independent adviser tothe Committee, including attendance at Remuneration Committee meetings. Also provided information on remuneration market practice, market trends and benchmarking of the remuneration packages for the senior executive population. Committee appointment. By the Company attherequest of theCommittee. The Committee is aware that WTW provides unrelated services to theCompany in the areas of benefits andpensions. The Committee is satisfied that the WTWlead adviser and team who provide remuneration advice to the Committee do not have connections with the Group, or the individual directors, that could impair their independence or objectivity. WTW is a member of the Remuneration Consultants Group (RCG) and is a signatory tothe RCG’s code of conduct. £101,510 Fee basis: Fixed fee/hourly Linklaters Provided legal services principally advice relating to remuneration policy. By the Company with the approval of the Committee. Only provides legal compliance, legal drafting and review services, and does notadvise the Committee. The Committee is aware that Linklaters is one of a number of legal firms that provide legal advice and services to the Company on a range of matters. Linklaters is regulated by the Law Society. £4,559 Fee basis: Hourly January Committee (Videoconference) – Assessed outturn of 2022 annual incentivekey strategic objectives. – Agreed 2023 annual incentive key strategicobjectives. – Received an update on provisional 2022financial performance for incentivepurposes. – Approved 2023 weightings remuneration for ExecutiveCommittee members. February Committee (London, UK) – Determined 2022 bonuses for executive directors andExecutive Committee members forpayment in March 2023. – Approved 2022 Group All-Employee FreeShare Plans payments. – Determined vesting outcome for Spring 2020 Long-Term Incentive awards. – Approved grant of 2023 Long-Term Incentive awards and associated performance targets. – Reviewed feedback from shareholder consultation on proposed 2023 Policy. – Approved 2022 Directors’ remunerationreport. May Committee (London, UK) – Reviewed feedback from shareholder consultation and May 2023 Annual General Meeting. – Noted the findings of the Gender Pay Gap and Ethnicity Pay Gap reports. – Received a performance update on annualincentive and in-flight long-term incentive awards. November Committee (West Sussex, UK) – Received a deep-dive into specific areas ofwider workforceremuneration. – Provided feedback on the proposed re-structure and key features of the draft 2023 Directors’ remuneration report. – Reviewed level of executive directors’ andExecutive Committee members’ shareholdings relative to their Minimum Shareholding Requirement. – Received an executive remuneration marketand regulatory update. – Noted the performance update on annualincentive and in-flight long-term incentive awards. December Committee (Videoconference) – Approved executive directors’ salary increases from 1 January 2024. – Agreed the structure and financial metricsfor the 2024 annual incentiveplan. – Agreed the structure, weightings andmetrics for the 2024 Long-Term Incentive awards. February Committee May Committee November Committee December Committee The Remuneration Committee’s year January Committee Directors’ Remuneration Report The Directors’ Remuneration Report was approved by the Board of directors on 20 February 2024. Nicole Piasecki Chair, Remuneration Committee 134 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Directors’ report Statutory and other regulatory information Other information that is relevant to the Directors’ report, andwhich isincorporated by reference into this report Company registration BAE Systems plc is a public company limited by shares registered in England and Wales with the registered number 01470151. Directors The current directors who served during the2023 financial year are listed on pages 81to 83. On 6 November 2023, Angus Cockburn was appointed to the Board as anon-executive director. Cressida Hogg, who was appointed to the Board as a non-executive director and Chair designate on 1 November 2022, succeeded Sir Roger Carr as Chair at the conclusion ofthe Company’s Annual General Meeting (AGM) on 4 May 2023 when Sir Roger retired from the Board. Chris Grigg also served on the Board until 31 December 2023. Dividend An interim dividend of 11.5p per share was paid on 30 November 2023. The directors propose a final dividend of 18.5p per ordinary share. Subject to shareholder approval, the final dividend will be paid on 3 June 2024 toshareholders on the share register on 19April 2024. AGM The Company’s AGM will be held on 9May2024. Disclosures required under Listing Rule 9.8.4 There are no disclosures required to be made under the FCA’s Listing Rule 9.8.4 which have not already been disclosed elsewhere in this Report. Details of Long-term incentives can be found within the Annual Remuneration Report on page 115 and details of dividend waivers can be found in note 26 of the Consolidated financial statements on page204. Office of Fair Trading undertakings As a consequence of the merger between British Aerospace and the former Marconi Electronic Systems businesses in 1999, the Company gave certain undertakings to the Secretary of State for Trade and Industry (nowthe Secretary of State for Business andTrade). In February 2007, the Company was released from the majority of these undertakings and the remainder have been superseded and varied by a new set of undertakings. Compliance with the undertakings is monitored by a compliance officer. Further information regarding the undertakings and the contact details of thecompliance officer may be obtained through the Company Secretary atthe Company’s registered office or through theCompany’s website. Trades Unions We have structures in place to work with Trades Union representatives in our local markets, where it is appropriate and legally acceptable. Of our UK workforce, 71% are covered by collective bargaining agreements. Approximately 55% of the UK workforce areTrades Union members. In the US, approximately 12% of the workforce is covered by a collective bargaining agreement. In Australia, approximately 20% of the workforce is covered by a collective bargaining agreement. Profit forecast In its half year results announcement published on 2 August 2023, the Group made the following statement in respect of the year ending 2023, which is regarded as a profit forecast for the purposes of the FCA’s Listing Rule 9.2.18 and which replaced the profit forecast made in the Company’s 2022 AnnualReport. “While the Group is subject togeopolitical and other uncertainties, the following upgraded guidance is provided on current expected operational performance. The guidance is based on the measures usedto monitor the underlying financial performance of the Group. Guidance is provided on the basis of an exchange rate of $1.24:£1, which is in line with the actual 2022 exchange rate, therefore guidance is the same for both reported and constant exchange rates. For the year ending 31 December 2023, underlying EBIT is expected to increase in therange of 6% to 8%. Underlying earnings per share is expected to increase in the rangeof 10% to 12%.” For the year ended 31 December 2023, Underlying EBIT was £2,682m and Underlying earnings per share was 63.2p. See Financial review on pages 28 to 33 for more information. Political donations No political donations were made in 2023. Issued share capital As at 31 December 2023, BAE Systems’ issued share capital of £80,964,698 comprised 3,238,587,861 ordinary shares of2.5p each and one Special Share of £1. This figure includes 360,315 ordinary sharespurchased under the share buyback programme immediately prior to the year end, but not yet settled at that point, which the Company deems to have been cancelled on purchase. Further information Reference Disclosures in relation to the use of financialinstruments Financial statements Page 181 Particulars of important events affecting theGroupwhich have occurred since 31 December2022 Chief Executive’s review Page 8 Segmental review Page 35 An indication of likely future developments inthebusiness of the Group Chief Executive’s review Page 8 Our investment in technology Page 20 Segmental review Page 35 An indication of the activities of the Group inthefield of research and development Our business model Page 14 Actions taken to introduce, maintain or developarrangements aimed at employees Social Page 56 GHG emissions Other sustainability information Page 234 Employee engagement (including regarding employee interests and encouraging employees tobe shareholders) Social Page 56 Fostering business relationships with suppliers,customers and others Our stakeholders Page 24 Policy in relation to employment ofdisabledpersons Social Page 56 135 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Financial statements Additional informationGovernanceStrategic report Statutory and other regulatory information continued Share buyback During the year, 58,689,756 ordinary sharesof 2.5p each were repurchased underthe buyback programme of up to £1.5bn announced on 28 July 2022 and suchrepurchased shares have been cancelled. The total consideration for the purchase of these shares, including commission and stamp duty, was £557,736,206. The percentage of called up share capital (excluding treasury shares) as at 31 December 2023, which the shares repurchased in 2023 represents, is 1.93%. Treasury shares As at 1 January 2023, the number of shares held in treasury totalled 220,086,959 (having a total nominal value of £5,502,174 and representing 6.7% of the Company’s called up share capital as at 31 December 2022). During 2023, the Company used 16,045,254 treasury shares (having a total nominal valueof £401,131 and representing 0.5% ofthe Company’s called up share capital asat31 December 2023) to satisfy awards under the Free and Matching elements of theShare Incentive Plan (4,131,918 shares inaggregate), awards under the Free and Matching elements of the International Share Incentive Plan (412,848 shares in aggregate), awards vested under the Performance Shares element of the Long-Term Incentive Plan (4,897,752 shares), awards vested under the Restricted Shares element of the Long-Term Incentive Plan (1,895,084 shares) and options exercised under the Share Options element ofthe Long-Term Incentive Plan and Executive Share Option Plan (4,707,652 shares). Thetreasury shares utilised in respect of the Share Incentive Plan, the International Share Incentive Plan, and the Performance and Restricted Shares elements of the Long-Term Incentive Plan were disposed of by the Company for nil consideration. The 4,707,652 shares disposed of by the Company in respect of the Share Options element of the Long-Term Incentive Plan and the Executive Share Option Plan were disposed of by the Company for an aggregate consideration of£23,367,600. As at 31 December 2023, the number of shares held in treasury totalled 204,041,705 (having a total nominal value of£5,101,043 and representing 6.3% of theCompany’s called up share capital at 31 December 2023). The rights to treasury shares are restricted inaccordance with the Companies Act and,in particular, the voting and dividend rights attaching to these shares are automatically suspended. Rights and obligations ofordinaryshares On a show of hands at a general meeting every holder of ordinary shares present in person and entitled to vote shall have one vote, and every proxy entitled to vote shall have one vote (unless the proxy is appointed by more than one member in which case the proxy has one vote for and one vote against ifthe proxy has been instructed by one or more members to vote for the resolution and by one or more members to vote against the resolution; or if the proxy has been instructed by one or more shareholders to vote either for or against a resolution and by one or more of those shareholders to use their discretion how to vote). On a poll, every member present in person or by proxy and entitled to vote shall have one vote for every ordinary share held. Subject to the relevant statutory provisions and the Company’s Articles of Association, holders of ordinary shares are entitled to a dividend where declared or paid out of profits available forsuch purposes. Subject to the relevant statutory provisions and the Company’s Articles of Association, on a return of capital on a winding-up, holders of ordinary shares are entitled, after repayment of the £1 Special Share, to participate in such a return. There are no redemption rights in relation to the ordinary shares. Rights and obligations oftheSpecialShare The Special Share is held on behalf of the Secretary of State for Business and Trade (the‘Special Shareholder’). Certain provisions of the Company’s Articles of Association cannot be amended without the consent ofthe Special Shareholder. These provisions include the requirement that no foreign person, or foreign persons acting in concert, can have more than a 15% voting interest inthe Company, the requirement that the majority of the directors are British, and therequirement that the Chief Executive orany executive Chair are British. The holder of the Special Share is entitled toattend a general meeting, but the Special Share carries no right to vote or any other rights at any such meeting, other than to speak in relation to any business in respect ofthe Special Share. Subject to the relevant statutory provisions and the Company’s Articles of Association, on a return of capital on a winding-up, the holder of the Special Share shall be entitled to repayment of the £1capital paid up on the Special Share in priority to any repayment of capital to any other members. The holder of the Special Share has the rightto require the Company to redeem the Special Share at par or convert the Special Share into one ordinary share at any time. Restrictions on transfer of securities The restrictions on the transfer of shares inthe Company are as follows: – the Special Share may only be issued to,held by and transferred to the Special Shareholder or their successor or nominee; – the directors shall not register any allotment or transfer of any shares to aforeign person, or foreign persons acting in concert, who at the time have more than a 15% voting interest in the Company, or who would, following such allotment or transfer, have such an interest; – the directors shall not register any person as a holder of any shares unless they have received: (i) a declaration stating that upon registration, the share(s) will not be held byforeign persons or that upon registration the share(s) will be held by a foreign person or persons; (ii) such evidence (if any) as thedirectors may require of the authority of the signatory of the declaration; and (iii)such evidence or information (if any) as to the matters referred to in the declaration as the directors consider appropriate; – the directors may also refuse to register any instrument of transfer of shares unless the instrument of transfer is in respect of only one class of share and it is lodged at the place where the register of members is kept, accompanied by a relevant certificate or such other evidence as the directors may reasonably require to show the right of the transferor to make the transfer; – the directors may refuse to register an allotment or transfer of shares in favour ofmore than four persons jointly; – where a shareholder has failed to provide the Company with certain information relating to their interest in shares, the directors can, in certain circumstances, refuse to register a transfer of such shares; – certain restrictions may from time to timebe imposed by laws and regulations (for example, insider trading laws); – restrictions may be imposed pursuant to the Listing Rules of the Financial Conduct Authority whereby certain of the Group’s employees require the Company’s approval to deal in shares; and – awards of shares made under the Company’s Long-Term Incentive Plan 2023, Long-Term Incentive Plan 2014, Deferred Bonus Plan, Share Incentive Plan, International Share Incentive Plan, Group All-Employee Free Shares Plan and International Profit Sharing Scheme are subject to restrictions on the transfer of shares prior to vesting and/or release. The Company is not aware of any arrangements between its shareholders thatmay result in restrictions on the transfer of shares and/or voting rights. 136 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Directors’ report Significant direct and indirect holdersof securities As at 31 December 2023, the Company hadbeen advised of the following significant direct and indirect interests in the issued ordinary share capital of the Company: Name of shareholder Percentage notified Barclays PLC 3.98% BlackRock, Inc. 9.90% The Capital Group Companies, Inc. 12.98% Investco Limited 4.97% Silchester International Investors LLP 3.01% WCM Investment Management, LLC 3.00% No disclosable interests have been notified tothe Company between 31 December 2023 and 20 February 2024 (the latest practicable date for inclusion in this report). As far as BAESystems plc is aware, all of the shareholders listed in the table above have held more than 3% of, or 3% of voting rightsattributable to BAE Systems plc’s ordinary shares. Exercise of rights of shares inemployee share schemes The trustees of the employee trusts do not seek to exercise voting rights on shares held in the employee trusts other than on the direction of the underlying beneficiaries. Novoting rights are exercised in relation to shares unallocated to individual beneficiaries. The trustees of the employee trusts also waive their entitlement to receive dividends inrespect of shares that are the beneficial property of the trusts. Restrictions on voting deadlines The notice of any general meeting shall specify the deadline for exercising voting rights and appointing a proxy or proxies to vote in relation to resolutions to be proposed at the general meeting. The number of proxy votes for, against or withheld in respect of each resolution are publicised on the Company’s website after the meeting. Appointment and replacement ofdirectors Subject to certain nationality requirements mentioned below, the Company may by ordinary resolution appoint any person to bea director. The directors also have the power to make appointments to the Board at any time. Any individual so appointed will hold office until the next AGM and shall then be eligible for re-election. The majority of directors holding office must be British. Otherwise, the directors who are not British shall vacate office in such order that those who have been in office for the shortest period since their appointment shall vacate their office first, unless all of the directors otherwise agree among themselves. Any director who holds the office of either Chair (in an executive capacity) or Chief Executive shall also be British. The Company must have not less than six directors holding office at all times. If the number is reduced to below six, then such number of persons shall be appointed as directors as soon as is reasonably practicable to reinstate the number of directors to six. The Company may by ordinary resolution from time to time vary the minimum numberof directors. All directors will stand for election or re-election in 2024 as required by the Company’s Articles of Association and incompliance with the UK Corporate Governance Code. Amendment of the Company’s Articles of Association The Company’s Articles of Association may only be amended by a special resolution at ageneral meeting of shareholders. Where class rights are varied, such amendments must be approved by the members of each class of shares separately. In addition, certain provisions of the Articles of Association cannot be amended without the consent of the Special Shareholder. These provisions include the requirement that no foreign person, or foreign persons acting in concert, can have more than a 15% voting interest in the Company, the requirement that the majority of the directors are British, and the requirement that the Chief Executive or any executive Chair are British. Powers of the directors The directors are responsible for the management of the business of the Company and may exercise all powers of the Company subject to applicable legislation and regulation, and the Articles of Association. At the 2023 AGM, the directors were given the power to buy back a maximum number of 305,567,916 ordinary shares at a minimum price of 2.5p each. The maximum price was the higher of (i) an amount equal to 105% of the average of the middle market quotations of the Company’s ordinary shares as derivedfrom the London Stock Exchange Daily Official List for the five business days immediately preceding the day on which suchordinary shares are contracted to be purchased, and (ii) the higher of the price ofthe last independent trade and the highestcurrent independent bid on the London Stock Exchange. This power will expire at the earlier of theconclusion of the 2024 AGM or if earlier, at the close of business on 30 June 2024. Aspecial resolution will be proposed at the 2024 AGM to renew the Company’s authority to acquire its own shares. At the 2023 AGM, the directors were given the power to issue new shares up to a nominal amount of £25,461,446. This power will expire on the earlier of the conclusion of the 2024 AGM or if earlier, at the close of business on 30 June 2024. Accordingly, a resolution will be proposed at the 2024 AGM to renew the Company’s authority toissue further new shares. Conflicts of interest As permitted under the Companies Act 2006, the Company’s Articles of Association contain provisions which enable the Board to authorise conflicts or potential conflicts that individual directors may have. To avoid potential conflicts of interest the Board requires the Nominations Committee to check that any individuals it nominates forappointment to the Board are free of potential conflicts. In addition, the Board’s procedures and the induction programme for new directors emphasise a director’s personal responsibility for complying with the duties relating to conflicts of interest. The procedure adopted by the Board for the authorisation ofconflicts reminds directors of the need toconsider their duties as directors and notgrant an authorisation unless they believe, in good faith, that this would be likelyto promote the success of the Company. As required by law, the potentially conflicted director cannot vote on an authorisation resolution or be counted in the quorum. Anyauthorisation granted may be terminated at any time and the director is informed of the obligation to inform the Company without delay should there be any material change in the nature of the conflict or potential conflict so authorised. Directors’ indemnities The Company has entered into deeds of indemnity with all of its current directors and those persons who were directors for any part of 2023 which are qualifying indemnity provisions for the purpose of the Companies Act 2006. The directors of BAE Systems Pension Funds Trustees Limited, BAE Systems 2000 Pension Plan Trustees Limited, BAE Systems Executive Pension Scheme Trustees Limited and AlvisPension Scheme Trustees Limited benefitfrom indemnities in the governing documentation of the BAE Systems Pension Scheme, the BAE Systems 2000 Pension Plan, the BAE Systems Executive Pension Scheme and the Alvis Pension Scheme, respectively, which are qualifying indemnity provisions forthe purpose of the Companies Act 2006. All such indemnity provisions are in force asat the date of this Directors’ report. 137 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Financial statements Additional informationGovernanceStrategic report Statutory and other regulatory information continued Change of control – significantagreements The following significant agreements contain provisions entitling the counterparties to exercise termination, alteration or other similar rights in the event of a change of control of the Company: – The Company and BAE Systems Holdings Inc. have entered into a £2bn Revolving Credit Facility dated 27 September 2023. The facility provides that,in the event ofachange of control ofthe Company, thelenders are entitled torenegotiate terms, orif no agreement isreached on negotiated terms within a certain period, tocall for the repayment orcancellation ofthe facility. The Revolving Credit Facility was undrawn as at 31 December 2023. – The Company and BAE Systems Holdings Inc. have entered into a $5.525bn Bridge Loan Facility dated 21 August 2023, as amended on 8 December 2023. The facility provides that, in the event of a change of control of the Company, the lenders are entitled to renegotiate terms, or if no agreement is reached on negotiated terms within a certain period, to call for the repayment or cancellation of the facility. The Bridge Loan Facility was undrawn as at31 December 2023. – The Company has entered into a Restated and Amended Shareholders Agreement with European Aeronautic Defence and Space Company EADS N.V. (EADS) and Finmeccanica S.p.A. (Finmeccanica) relating to MBDA S.A.S. dated 18 December 2001 (as amended). In the event that control of the Company passes to certain specified third-party acquirors, the agreement allows EADS and Finmeccanica to exercise an option to terminate certain executive management level nomination and voting rights, and certain shareholder information rights of the Company in relation to the MBDA joint venture. Following the exercise of this option, the Company would have the right to require the other shareholders to purchase its interest in MBDA at fair market value. – The Company and EADS have agreed thatif Finmeccanica acquires a controlling interest in the Company, EADS will increase its shareholding in MBDA to 50% by purchasing the appropriate number of shares in MBDA at fair market value. – The Company, BAE Systems, Inc., BAESystems (Holdings) Limited and BAESystems Holdings Inc. entered into arenewed Special Security Agreement, effective date of 5 January 2023, with theUS Department of Defense regarding the management of BAE Systems, Inc. in order to comply with the US government’s national security requirements. In the event of a change of control of the Company, the Agreement may be terminated or altered by the US Department of Defense. – In June 2017, BAE Systems Surface Ships Limited entered into a contract with the UKMinistry of Defence (MoD) for the manufacture of the first batch of three Type26 frigates. This contract was amended and restated in November 2022 to include the manufacture of the second batch offive Type 26 frigates. Where the MoD considers that a proposed change of control of BAE Systems Surface Ships Limited (or its direct or indirect holding company) would be contrary to the defence, national security or national interest of the UK or where the change ofcontrol would result in increased costs tothe MoD under the contract, then the change of control shall not proceed until agreement with the MoD is established. Ifthere is a change of control without notice or notwithstanding the objection ofthe MoD on such grounds, then the MoD may terminate the contract with immediate effect. – The FMSP Ships Engineering Management and Delivery agreement between BAESystems Surface Ships Limited and theMoD was entered into on 31 March 2021 for the provision of surface ship engineering management and delivery services relating to HM Naval Base Portsmouth. Where the MoD considers that a proposed change of control of BAESystems Surface Ships Limited (oritsdirect or indirect holding company) would be contrary to the defence, nationalsecurity or national interest of theUK, then the change of control shall not proceed until agreement with the MoDisestablished. If there is a change of control without notice or notwithstanding the objection of the MoD on such grounds, the MoD shall be entitled to terminate theagreement. – In November 2020, BAE Systems Global Combat Systems Munitions Limited and the MoD entered into a 15-year agreement for the provision of ammunition to UK forces (the Next Generation Munitions Solution (NGMS) agreement) from 2023 to 2037. Where the MoD has any concerns regarding a proposed change of control ofBAE Systems Global Combat Systems Munitions Limited (or its direct or indirect holding company) and such concerns arenot resolved, then if the change of control proceeds, the MoD may terminate the contract. – In November 2015, BAE Systems Marine Limited entered into a contract with the MoD for the design, construction, testing and commissioning of Boat 5 of the AstuteClass programme. In March 2016, BAE Systems Marine Limited entered into acontract with the MoD for the design, construction, testing and commissioning ofBoat 6 of the Astute Class Programme. In March 2018, BAE Systems Marine Limited entered into a contract with the MoD for the design, construction, testing and commissioning of Boat 7 of the AstuteClass Programme. Where the MoDconsiders that a proposed change ofcontrol of BAE Systems Marine Limited (or its direct or indirect holding company) would be contrary to the defence, national security or national interest of the UK, thenthe change of control shall not proceed until agreement is established withthe MoD. In the event that there is achange of control notwithstanding the objection of the MoD on such grounds, theMoD shall be entitled to terminate theagreements immediately. – In December 2011, BAE Systems Marine Limited entered into a contract with the MoD for the design of the Dreadnought submarines. Where the MoD considers thata proposed change of control of BAESystems Marine Limited (or its direct orindirect holding company) would be contrary to the defence, national interest ornational security of theUK, then the change of control shall not take place untilagreement is reached with the MoD on how to proceed. In the event that there is a change of control notwithstanding theobjection of the MoD on such grounds, the MoD shall be entitled to terminate the contract with immediate effect. – In September 2016, BAE Systems Marine Limited entered into a contract with the MoD for the initial phase of manufacturing activities for the Dreadnought Class programme. This contract was extended and amended in March 2022 to include continuation of manufacturing and associated activities on all four boats intheclass. Where the MoD considers thataproposed change of control of BAESystems Marine Limited (or its direct orindirect holding company) would be contrary to the defence, national security ornational interest of the UK, then the change of control shall not proceed until agreement is established with the MoD. In the event that there is a change of control, notwithstanding the objection of the MoD on such grounds, theMoD shall be entitled to terminate theagreements immediately. 138 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Directors’ report – In June 2023, BAE Systems Marine Limited entered into a contract with the MoD for the funding of facilities required for the SSN-AUKUS Class programme. In July 2023, BAE Systems Marine Limited entered into a contract with the MoD for the development of the design of the SSN- AUKUS Class of submarines and long lead item procurement for that programme. In each contract where the MoD considers that a proposed change of control of BAE Systems Marine Limited (or its direct or indirect holding company) would be contrary to the defence, national security or national interest of the UK, then the change of control shall not proceed until agreement isestablished with the MoD. In the event that there is a change of control notwithstanding the objection of the MoD on such grounds, the MoD shall be entitled to terminate the agreements immediately. – In December 2018, BAE Systems’ subsidiary, ASC Shipbuilding Pty Limited, entered into a contract providing the framework for the design and manufacture of Hunter Class Frigates for the Royal Australian Navy (Head Contract). As part ofthe acquisition of ASC Shipbuilding Pty Limited from the Australian Commonwealth, BAE Systems Australia Limited entered into a Sovereign Capability and Option Deed (SCOD). Under the Head Contract and theSCOD, if there is a change of control ofASC Shipbuilding Pty Limited or BAESystems Australia Limited or, in the case of the Head Contract, there is a change of control of the Company as guarantor, consent is required from the Australian Commonwealth Government prior to any change of control occurring. Ifthere is a change of control without notice or notwithstanding an objection, theCommonwealth may terminate the Head Contract, take any action to mitigate an actual or potential threat to Australia’s national security interests, or exercise its call option under the SCOD and regain ownership of ASC Shipbuilding Pty Limited. – In March 2022, the Hawk Integrated Support contract was entered into between BAE Systems (Operations) Limited and the MoD for the provision of support services to the Royal Air Force’s fleet of Hawk fast jet trainer aircraft and the Royal Air Force Aerobatic Team Aircraft. Where the MoD has any concerns about the actual or proposed change of control of BAE Systems (Operations) Limited (or its direct or indirect holding company), which may include, but not limited to, potential threats of national security, then the MoD shall advise the contractor in writing of any concerns itmay have. The MoD may terminate the contract within six months of such actual orproposed change of control. – In June 2021, BAE Systems Australia Limitedentered into a contract providing the framework for the provision of in-service support for the Hawk aircraft until June 2031. If there is a change of control of BAE Systems Australia Limited orBAE Systems plc without consent from the Australian Commonwealth Government, the Australian Commonwealth may terminate the contract. – In April 2019, BAE Systems (Operations) Limited, Rolls Royce, MBDA and Leonardo entered into a contract with the MoD forthe Tempest Programme to develop andmature future combat air-related technologies and concepts. Since then further contract funding has been awarded. This contract provides that wherethe MoD has any concerns about the actual or proposed change of control ofBAE Systems (Operations) Limited (or its direct or indirect holding company), which may include, but not limited to, such change of control having an impact on thereputation or public perception of theMOD or national security, then the MoD shall advise the contractor in writing of any concerns it may have and the MoD may terminate the contract. – In June 2021, BAE Systems (Operations) Limited entered into a contract with the MoD for the Future Combat Air System Acquisition Programme Concept and Assessment Phase Contract to advance theconcepting and technology of the next-generation Combat aircraft. In 2023, additional MoD funding of approximately £800m was awarded. This contract provides that where the MoD has any concerns about the actual or proposed change of control of BAE Systems (Operations) Limited (or its direct or indirect holding company), which may include, but not limited to, potential threats of national security, then the MoD shall advise the contractor in writing of any concerns it may have. The MoD may terminate the contract within six months of it being notified of such actual or proposed change of control. – In May 2024, BAE Systems Hägglunds AB entered into a contract with Försvarets Materielverk and the Ministry of Defence of the Czech Republic (MoD Czech Republic) for the manufacture of 246 CV90 MkIV infantry fighting vehicles. The contract provides that any change of control of BAESystems Hägglunds AB (or its direct orindirect holding company) is subject tothe MoD Czech Republic’s consent. In addition, the Company’s share plans contain provisions as a result of which options and awards may vest and become exercisable on a change of control of the Company in accordance with the rules of the plans. Auditor Deloitte LLP has indicated its willingness to be re-appointed as the Company’s auditor and a resolution proposing its re-appointment will be put to the 2024 AGM. Statement of directors’ responsibilities in respect of the Annual Report and the financial statements The directors are responsible for preparing the Annual Report, and the Group and parent company financial statements in accordance with applicable law and regulations. Company law requires the directors to prepare Group and parent company financial statements for each financial year. Under that law, they are required to prepare the Group financial statements in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards asadopted by the UK (IFRS) and applicable law, and have elected to prepare the parent company financial statements in accordance with UK accounting standards, including Financial Reporting Standard (FRS) 101, Reduced Disclosure Framework. Under company law, the directors must not approve the financial statements unless they are satisfied that they give a true and fair view of the state of affairs of the Group and parent company, and of their profit or loss forthat period. In preparing each of the Group and parent company financial statements, the directors are required to: – select suitable accounting policies and then apply them consistently; – make judgements and estimates that are reasonable, relevant, reliable and prudent; – for the Group financial statements, state whether they have been prepared in accordance with IFRSs as adopted by theUK; – for the parent company financial statements, state whether applicable UK accounting standards have been followed, subject to any material departures disclosed and explained in the parent company financial statements; – assess the Group and parent company’s ability to continue as a going concern, disclosing, as applicable, matters related togoing concern; and – use the going concern basis of accounting unless they either intend to liquidate the Group or the parent company or to cease operations, or have no realistic alternative but to do so. The directors are responsible for keeping adequate accounting records that are sufficient to show and explain the parent company’s transactions and disclose with reasonable accuracy at any time the financial position of the parent company and enable them to ensure that its financial statements comply with the Companies Act 2006. 139 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Financial statements Additional informationGovernanceStrategic report Statutory and other regulatory information continued Directors’ report The Directors’ report was approved by the Board of directors on 20 February 2024. David Parkes Company Secretary Responsibility statement of the directors in respect oftheAnnual Report and financial statements Each of the directors listed belowconfirms that to the best oftheir knowledge: – the financial statements, prepared in accordance with the applicable set ofaccounting standards, give a true andfair view of the assets, liabilities, financialposition and profit orloss oftheCompany, and the undertakings included in the consolidation taken as awhole; and – the Strategic report and Directors’ report (which together comprise a management report for the purposes of DTR 4.1.8R), taken together, include a fair review of the development and performance of the business, and the position of the Company and the undertakings included in the consolidation taken as a whole, together with a description of the principal risks and uncertainties that they face. In addition, each of the directors considers that the Annual Report, taken as a whole, isfair, balanced and understandable, andprovides the information necessary forshareholders to assess the Company’s position and performance, business modeland strategy. Cressida Hogg Chair Charles Woodburn Chief Executive Tom Arseneault President and Chief Executive Officer ofBAESystems, Inc. Brad Greve Chief Financial Officer Nick Anderson Non-executive director Crystal Ashby Non-executive director Angus Cockburn Non-executive director Dame Elizabeth Corley Non-executive director Jane Griffiths Non-executive director Ewan Kirk Non-executive director Stephen Pearce Non-executive director Nicole Piasecki Non-executive director Lord Sedwill Non-executive director On behalf of the Board Cressida Hogg Chair 20 February 2024 The directors are responsible for such internalcontrol as they determine is necessaryto enable the preparation of financial statements that are free from material misstatement, whether due to fraudor error, and have general responsibility for taking such steps as are reasonably opento them to safeguard the assets oftheGroup and to prevent and detect fraudand other irregularities. Under applicable law and regulation, thedirectors are also responsible for preparing a strategic report, directors’ report,directors’ remuneration report andcorporate governance statement that comply with that law and regulation. The directors are responsible for the maintenance and integrity of the corporate and financial information included on the Company’s website. Legislation in the UK governing the preparation and dissemination of financial statements may differ from legislation in other jurisdictions. Controls over financial reporting Through implementation of the Operational Framework, internal control procedures are in place to support the approval of the financial statements of the Group. Management is responsible for reviewing thefinancial reports and disclosures to ensure that they have been subject to adequate verification and comply with applicable standards and legislation (including reviewing data for consolidation into the Group’s financial statements to ensure that it gives atrue and fair view of the Group’s results incompliance with applicable accounting policies). Where appropriate, management reports its conclusions to the Audit Committee, which debates such conclusions and provides further challenge. Finally, the Board scrutinises and approves results announcements and the Annual Report and ensures that appropriate disclosures have been made. This governance process ensures that both management and the Board are given sufficient opportunity to debate and challenge the financial statements of the Group and other significant disclosures before they are made public. Statement of disclosure ofinformationto auditor The directors who held office at the date ofapproval of this Directors’ report confirm that, so far as they are each aware, there is no relevant audit information of which the Company’s auditor is unaware; and each director has taken all the steps that he/she ought to have taken to make himself/herself aware of any relevant audit information and to establish that the Company’s auditor is aware of that information. 140 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Directors’ report Financial statements Auditor’s report Independent Auditor‘s report 142 Consolidated financial statements Consolidated income statement 152 Consolidated statement of comprehensive income 153 Consolidated statement of changes in equity 154 Consolidated balance sheet 155 Consolidated cash flow statement 156 1. Preparation of the Consolidated financial statements 157 2. Segmental analysis and revenue recognition 160 3. Operating costs 165 4. Employees 166 5. Other income 166 6. Net finance costs 167 7. Tax expense 168 8. Earnings per share 170 9. Intangible assets 171 10. Property, plant and equipment 174 11. Leases 176 12. Equity accounted investments 178 13. Other investments 180 14. Trade, contract and other receivables 180 15. Other financial assets and liabilities andfinancial risk management 181 Group accounting policies Material accounting policies are included within therelevant note to the Consolidated financial statements. 16. Deferred tax 186 17. Inventories 188 18. Current tax 188 19. Cash and cash equivalents 188 20. Geographical analysis of assets 189 21. Loans and overdrafts 189 22. Contract liabilities 190 23. Trade and other payables 190 24. Post-employment benefits 191 25. Provisions 203 26. Share capital and other reserves 204 27. Movement in assets and liabilities arising from financing activities 207 28. Fair value measurement 208 29. Share-based payments 209 30. Related party transactions 210 31. Contingent liabilities 211 32. Acquisition of businesses 211 33. Business disposals 212 34. Events after the reporting period 213 35. Information about related undertakings 214 Company financial statements Company statement of changes in equity 218 Company balance sheet 219 Notes to the Company financial statements 220 141 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Additional informationGovernance Financial statementsStrategic report Independent Auditor’s report to the members of BAE Systems plc Report on the audit of thefinancial statements 1. Opinion In our opinion: – the financial statements of BAE Systems plc (the “Company”) and its subsidiaries (the “Group”) give a true and fair view of the state of the Group’s and of the Company’s affairs as at 31 December 2023 and of the Group’s profit for the year then ended; – the Group financial statements have been properly prepared in accordance with United Kingdom adopted international accounting standards; – the Company financial statements have been properly prepared in accordance with United Kingdom Generally Accepted Accounting Practice, including Financial Reporting Standard 101 “Reduced Disclosure Framework”; and – the financial statements have been prepared in accordance with the requirements of the Companies Act2006. We have audited the financial statements which comprise: – the Consolidated income statement; – the Consolidated and Company statementsof comprehensive income; – the Consolidated and Company statementsof changes in equity; – the Consolidated and Company balancesheets; – the Consolidated cash flow statement; – the related notes 1 to 35 in the Consolidated financial statements; and – the related notes 1 to 13 in the Company financial statements. The financial reporting framework that has been applied in the preparation of the Group financial statements is applicable law and United Kingdom adopted international accounting standards. The financial reporting framework that has been applied in the preparation of the Company financial statements is applicable law and United Kingdom Accounting Standards, including FRS 101 “Reduced Disclosure Framework” (United Kingdom Generally Accepted Accounting Practice). 2. Basis for opinion We conducted our audit in accordance with International Standards on Auditing (UK) (“ISAs (UK)”) and applicable law. Our responsibilities under those standards arefurther described in the Auditor’s responsibilities for the audit of the financial statements section of our report. We are independent of the Group and the Company in accordance with the ethical requirements that are relevant to our audit ofthe financial statements in the UK, including the Financial Reporting Council’s (the “FRC’s”) Ethical Standard as applied to listed public interest entities, and we have fulfilled our other ethical responsibilities in accordance with these requirements. The non-audit services provided to the Group and Company for the year are disclosed in note 3 to the financial statements. We confirm that we have not provided any non-audit services prohibited by the FRC’s Ethical Standard to the Group or the Company. We believe that the audit evidence we have obtained is sufficient and appropriate to provide a basis for our opinion. 142 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Auditor’s report 3. Summary of our audit approach Key audit matters The key audit matters that we identified inthe current year were: – revenue and margin recognition on long-term contracts; and – valuation of post-employment benefitobligations. Within this report, key audit matters are identified as follows: Increased level of risk Similar level of risk Decreased level of risk Materiality The materiality that we used for the audit of the Group financial statements was £100.0m (2022: £87.5m) which was determined on the basis of profit before tax excluding adjusting items and fair value and foreign exchange movements relating to financial instruments, as described further in section 6 below. Scoping We performed a combination of full scope audit procedures and audits of specified account balances on certain components. Together these procedures addressed: – 85% of revenue (2022 – 89%); – 85% of profit before tax (2022 – 86%); and – and 91% of total assets (2022 – 91%). The remaining components were subject toother procedures, including conducting analytical reviews, making enquiries of management, and evaluating the Group’s control environment. Significant changes in our approach Last year goodwill was included as a key auditmatter. As a result of the level of headroom, we consider the risk to have significantly reduced and concluded the valuation of goodwill no longer represents akey audit matter. 4. Conclusions relating togoingconcern In auditing the financial statements, we have concluded that the directors’ use of the going concern basis of accounting in the preparation of the financial statements is appropriate. Our evaluation of the directors’ assessment ofthe Group’s and Company’s ability to continue to adopt the going concern basis ofaccounting included: – obtaining an understanding of the directors’ process for determining the appropriateness of the going concern basis; – evaluating the Group’s existing access tosources of financing, including existingdebt, undrawn committed bankfacilities and financing for the BallAerospace acquisition; – obtaining an understanding of relevant controls over the going concern models prepared by management, including the review of the inputs and assumptions usedin those models; – testing the accuracy of management’s models, including agreement to the mostrecent Board approved budgets andforecasts; – challenging the key assumptions underpinning these forecasts by: – reading analyst reports, industry dataand other external information andcomparing these with management’sestimates; – comparing forecast revenue with theGroup’s order book and historicalperformance; – evaluating the historical accuracy of forecasts prepared by management; – considering potential macro-economic impacts on the forecasts as a consequence of the current geo-political environment; – assessing the sensitivity of the headroom to key assumptions; and – assessing the appropriateness of theGroup’s disclosure concerning thegoing concern basis. Based on the work we have performed, we have not identified any material uncertainties relating to events or conditions that, individually or collectively, may cast significant doubt on the Group’s and Company’s ability to continue as a going concern for a period ofat least twelve months from when the financial statements are authorised for issue. In relation to the reporting on how the Group has applied the UK Corporate Governance Code, we have nothing material to add or draw attention to in relation to the directors’ statement in the financial statements aboutwhether the directors considered itappropriate to adopt the going concern basis of accounting. Our responsibilities and the responsibilities ofthe directors with respect to going concernare described in the relevant sectionsof this report. 5. Key audit matters Key audit matters are those matters that, in our professional judgement, were of most significance in our audit of the financial statements of the current period and include the most significant assessed risks of material misstatement (whether or not due to fraud) that we identified. These matters included those which had the greatest effect on the overall audit strategy, the allocation of resources in the audit, and directing the efforts of the engagement team. These matters were addressed in the context of our audit of the financial statements as a whole, and in forming our opinion thereon, and we do not provide a separate opinion onthese matters. 143 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Additional informationGovernance Financial statementsStrategic report Independent Auditor’s report continued 5.1. Revenue and margin recognition onlong-term contracts Refer to page 97 (Audit Committee Report), Note 1 (key sources of estimation uncertainty) and Note 2 (accounting policy and financial disclosures) Revenue: £23,078m (2022: £21,258m) Operating profit: £2,573m (2022: £2,384m) Key audit matter description The estimation of both overall lifetime contract margin and the appropriate level ofrevenue and profit to recognise in any single accounting period requires the exercise of judgement. Within the Group’s contract portfolio there are a number of programmes where there is a high degree of estimation required in reaching these judgements. Key estimates include forecast costs to complete on contracts, the impact of assumed learning efficiencies over the life of a programme, theschedule completion dates, and the appropriateness of contingency held against the risk of future cost growth. Consequently, we consider that revenue and margin recognition represent a key audit matter. We focussed a greater proportion of audit effort on a number of contracts where weconsider there to be a higher degree ofjudgement required and designed contract-specific procedures to mitigate theassociated risks. In order to identify contracts where there isthe greatest risk of material misstatement, we undertook a contract risk assessment process at each reporting unit utilising data analytics, the latest contract information, ourunderstanding of the business, the resultsof prior audits and review of external information about market and geo-political conditions which might impact certain contracts. We held meetings with key finance and contract managers, attended quarterly business review meetings and other key management meetings, read and understood underlying contract documentation and obtained support for key contract judgements. In addition, we looked for contracts that might have higher levels of judgement associated with the risk of schedule delivery or technical complexity, fixed price contracts which increase the risk of contract losses and other indicators that could increase the risk of a material impact onthe financial statements. As a result of our risk assessment, weidentified one contract where we considerthere to be an elevated risk of misstatement, owing to the high degree ofjudgement required in estimating the trading margin position impacting the 2023financial statements. How the scope of our audit respondedto the key audit matter Our contract testing approach included: Testing the relevant controls – We obtained an understanding of and tested relevant financial and IT controls across the Group’s project accounting processes established to ensure that contracts are appropriately forecast, managed, controlled and reported. – We observed the controls in operation byattending a sample of project contract status review meetings, quarterly business review meetings and Group-level meetings to validate the various levels of challenge applied to the forecasts. Challenging assumptions andestimates To gain assurance over the contract judgements and estimates made, our workincluded: – inspection of customer contracts – inspecting customer contracts to gain an understanding of key contractual terms; – enquiry – making enquiries of programme management and other operational personnel to obtain an understanding ofthe performance of the projects throughout the year and at year-end; – historical forecasting accuracy – evaluating historical forecasting accuracy ofcosts against actual costs, including on similar programmes, and challenging future cost expectations with reference to those data points; – site visits – conducting production site visits to inform our challenge of the cost tocomplete estimates and understanding of contract status; – tests of detail of costs to date and estimates to complete – testing the underlying calculations used in the contract assessments for sensitivity, accuracy and completeness, including the estimated costs to complete the contract alongside associated contingencies and testing a sample of expenditure to date. In auditing the cost to complete, we have challenged the key assumptions with reference to previous programmes and current run-rate data, resource availability, supply chain issues (such as inflation and contract delivery schedule) and other factors that could impact on contract and schedule risk; – inspection and validation of external evidence – examining external evidence toassess contract status, timeframe for delivery and any variation of consideration (including associated recoverability of contract balances), such as customer correspondence. For certain contracts, thisevidence was validated by meeting with the customer directly; – legal – enquiring with in-house legal counsel regarding contract-related litigation and claims and analysing legal opinions where applicable; and – stand back assessment – considering whether there were any indicators of management override of controls or bias inarriving at their reported position, including a stand back assessment of thecontract position. Key observations As a result of the audit procedures outlined above, we consider the judgements made by the Group in recognising revenue and profit to be reasonable. 144 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Auditor’s report 5.2. Valuation of post-employment benefit obligations Refer to page 97 (Audit Committee report), Note 1 (key sources of estimation uncertainty) and Note 24 (accounting policy and financial disclosures) The Group’s share of the net IAS 19 Employee benefits surplus was: £229m (2022: £646m net surplus), and comprised scheme assets of £23,985m (2022: £25,343m) and defined benefit obligations of £23,247m (2022: £23,868m). Key audit matter description The post-employment schemes are held across the group in the UK and US, as well asan end of service benefit provided to employees in Saudi Arabia and other locations. The key audit matter set out belowis in relation to the UK post- employment schemes. We identified the following two areas offocus of our procedures as a key audit matter in the current year: Scheme assets Given the size and nature of the schemes’ assets, there is significant audit effort required in ensuring the valuation of assets isappropriate. Certain asset classes are inherently more judgmental to value and have a higher level of associated valuation risk, namely: – Private Equity investments; – Pooled Investment Vehicles without published market prices; – Private Placements; – Longevity swap derivatives; and – Property assets. In addition, on 1 December 2023, the Groupmoved its primary investment manager to a third-party service provider. This has resulted in a transfer of the established control environment to the third-party service provider. Defined benefit obligations The key judgements relating to the post- employment benefit obligation liabilities include: – discount rates; – inflation assumptions for the UK schemes, including the basis for determining the inflation risk premium; and – mortality assumptions. Given the significant size of the post- employment benefit obligations at year-end, small changes to these input assumptions can lead to material changes in the net surplus. How the scope of our audit respondedto the key audit matter Scheme assets In relation to asset valuations, we have performed the following procedures with increased focus on those assets with a highervaluation risk as noted above: – we obtained a detailed understanding and performed walkthroughs of management’s process and reviewed relevant internal controls reports from service providers, with specific focus on understanding key controls relating to the valuation of certain asset classes; – we tested the pension asset valuation controls for a number of the asset classes operated both by management and relevant service providers; – we sought and obtained third party confirmations from asset managers and/or custodians or other supporting evidence to test existence and valuation as appropriate; – in conjunction with our actuarial specialists, we challenged the fair value assumptions used to value the longevity swaps including the future projected mortality rates and discount rates; – we assessed publicly available information on the assets (including fact sheets and prospectuses), comparing to internal andexternal benchmarks (i.e. market prices, relevant indices or comparably priced instruments); – in the case of specialist asset classes, such as properties, we involved our specialists tochallenge the third-party valuations performed with reference to recent market transactions, rental yields, and movements in relevant indices; and – we tested relevant controls and performedsubstantive procedures over thetransfer of data to the new third-party service provider. Defined benefit obligations In relation to post-employment benefit obligations, we have performed the followingprocedures: – we obtained a detailed understanding andperformed walkthroughs of management’s process, with specific focus on understanding relevant controls relating to the valuation of the post-employment benefit obligation; – we assessed the relevant control environment of the third-party administrators who maintain membership data on behalf of the Group through review of their ISAE 3402 controls reporting, and considered and responded to any findings therein; – we assessed the competence, capability and objectivity of the actuaries engaged bymanagement to perform the valuations of the schemes; – in conjunction with our actuarial specialists, we challenged the assumptions used in the valuation of the defined benefit obligation, including assessing and challenging the reasonableness of the assumptions against available market data and benchmarking against peers; – we made enquiries regarding the climate impact on the underlying assumptions; – we considered the adjustment made to the Continuous Mortality Investigation (“CMI”) 2022 mortality projections that applies an increased weighting factor to reflect the potential long-term impacts of Covid-19 onfuture mortality rates, with reference toadvice the Group has received from itsactuaries; and – we agreed a sample of cash contributions made into the pension funds. Key observations We concluded our testing of the assets andare satisfied that they are appropriately valued. When taken together, we consider the discount rate, inflation and other key pension assumptions used in calculating theUK post-employment benefit obligation to be within our independently developed reasonable range. 145 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Additional informationGovernance Financial statementsStrategic report Independent Auditor’s report continued 6. Our application of materiality 6.1. Materiality We define materiality as the magnitude of misstatement in the financial statements that makes it probable that the economic decisions of a reasonably knowledgeable person would be changed or influenced. We use materiality both in planning the scope of our audit work and in evaluating the results of our work. Based on our professional judgement, we determined materiality for the financial statements as a whole as follows: Group financial statements Company financial statements Materiality £100.0m (2022: £87.5m) £65.0m (2022: £34.2m) Basis for determining materiality 4.3% of adjusted profit before tax of £2,352m (2022: 4.3% ofadjusted profit before tax of £2,034m). This metric excludes adjusting items of £40m and fair value adjustments and foreign exchange movements on financial instruments of £66m, as detailed in note 2 and 6 of the financialstatements. 0.4% of total assets of £18,369m, capped at 65% of group materiality (2022: 0.7% of net assets of £4,712m). Rationale for the benchmark applied Adjusted profit before tax was considered to be the most relevantbenchmark as it is considered the most stable and comparable profit metric. The adjustments relate to items weconsider appropriate to exclude and not reflective of theunderlying performance of the business. We consider the measure suitable having also considered the otherrelevant benchmarks such as revenue, where our materiality equates to 0.8%, and net assets, where our materiality equates to1.0%. We consider total assets to be the key benchmark usedbymembers of the Company in assessing financial position as the primary purpose of the entity is to holdinvestments. Component materiality The work performed on components identified in our Group audit scope (excluding the Company) was completed to acomponent materiality level between £20.4m and £40.9m (2022: £20.0m and £33.7m). Component materiality range £20.4m to £40.9m Audit Committee reporting threshold £5.0m Adjusted profit before tax £2,352m Group materiality £100.0m 6.2. Performance materiality We set performance materiality at a level lower than materiality to reduce the probability that, in aggregate, uncorrected and undetected misstatements exceed the materiality for the financial statements as a whole. Group financial statements Company financial statements Performance materiality 70% (2022: 70%) of Group materiality 70% (2022: 70%) of Company materiality Basis and rationale fordetermining performance materiality In determining performance materiality, we considered the following factors: – the quantum and nature of the uncorrected misstatements identified in the prior year audit; – our assessment of the potential for uncorrected misstatements in the current year; – our risk assessment, including our assessment of the overall control environment; – no substantial changes to the business have been noted from the prior year; and – the size and nature of the contract-based significant risks of material misstatement identified. 6.3. Error reporting threshold We agreed with the Audit Committee that we would report to the Committee all audit differences in excess of £5m (2022: £4.375m), as well asdifferences below that threshold that, in our view, warranted reporting on qualitative grounds. We also report to the Audit Committee on disclosure matters that we identified when assessing the overall presentation of the financial statements. 146 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Auditor’s report 7. An overview of the scope ofouraudit 7.1. Identification and scoping ofcomponents We performed our scoping of the Groupaudit by obtaining an understanding of the Group and its environment, including Group-wide controls, and assessing the audit risks. This exercise has considered the relative size of each reporting unit’s contribution to revenue, profit before tax and adjusted profitbefore tax, alongside further financial or contractual risks, which we consider to bepresent. We determined which reporting units arefinancially significant by reference to anumber of factors, including financial contribution and risk profile. This resulted in us performing full scope audits for six (2022: six) reporting units located in the UK, Saudi Arabia and the US, and included the Group’s largest joint venture, MBDA S.A.S. (“MBDA”). Additionally, our audit planning identified twenty-one non-financially significant reporting units, located in the UK, Saudi Arabia, Australia, Sweden and the US, where we considered there to be a reasonable possibility of material misstatement in specific balances within the financial statements. As a result of our risk assessment procedures and the detailed scoping exercise performed at the planning stage of our audit, we determined that it was appropriate to rotate certain non-financially significant reporting units in and out of our Group audit scope in the current year. We directed component auditors to perform an audit of specified account balances or specified audit procedures on the respective income statements and balance sheets for these reporting units. For all other reporting units not included infull scope, specified account balance scopeor specified audit procedure scope, we performed centrally directed analytical review procedures to confirm our conclusion that there was no significant risk of material misstatement in the residual population. We also audited the consolidation process and performed audit procedures on centrally managed balances including treasury, post-employment benefit obligations, litigation and claims, goodwill, tax, and headoffice costs. As each of the reporting units maintains separate financial records, we engaged component auditors from the Deloitte member firms in the US, UK, Saudi Arabia, Sweden and Australia to perform procedures at all the wholly owned components under our direction, supervision and review. This approach also allowed us to engage local in-scope auditors who have appropriate knowledge of local regulations to perform the audit work, under a common Deloitte audit approach. In respect of MBDA, we engaged with the entity’s non-Deloitte auditors to perform a full scope audit under our direction, supervision and review. The Company is located in the United Kingdom and audited directly by the Groupaudit team. The twenty-six reporting units within eitherfull or specified account balance scopecontribute the following proportions tototal Group results. Revenue C A B A Full audit scope 41% B Specified account balances 44% C Specified audit procedures andreviewatGroup level 15% Profit before tax C A B A Full audit scope 49% B Specified account balances 36% C Specified audit procedures andreviewatGroup level 15% Total assets C A B A Full audit scope 51% B Specified account balances 40% C Specified audit procedures andreviewatGroup level 9% 147 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Additional informationGovernance Financial statementsStrategic report Independent Auditor’s report continued 7.2. Our consideration of the controlenvironment We focussed our controls assessment on theGroup’s contract accounting processes. For each reporting unit where revenue is inscope, we obtain an understanding of keycontract controls, such as with respect tothe estimation of contract costs and the amount of contract revenue to recognise in the period. We also tested certain relevant revenue controls. At each reporting unit we also considered key controls relevant to other income statement and balance sheet items where they were considered relevant to our audit for risk assessment purposes. The Group operates a range of IT systems which underpin the financial reporting process. These vary by business and/or bygeography. For all reporting units that were subject to either a full scope or audit ofspecified balances, we identified relevant IT systems for the purpose of our audit work. These were typically the principal Enterprise Resource Planning (“ERP”) systems for each reporting unit that underpin the general ledger and contract accounting balances, andin some cases also included ancillary/ feeder systems into the main ERP. In the current year our controls approach wasprincipally designed to inform our risk assessment and also to allow us to test the operating effectiveness of certain relevant revenue controls. We also assessed relevant general IT controls. The Group continues toinvest in its IT systems and there is an ongoing programme of remediating any control findings where they are identified through its own assurance framework, including Internal Audit, or through the external audit. As part of our controls work, we identified certain control deficiencies that management is in the process of remediating as disclosed in the Audit Committee report on page 97. Where deficiencies have been identified and the remediation activity remained ongoing during the year, or the remediated controls were not effective throughout the whole accounting period, wedid not seek to place reliance on those relevant controls for the purpose of our audit. We also considered head office controls relating to central balances and processes such as post-employment benefit obligations, consolidation and financial reporting, treasury, tax, and the Group’s planning andbudgeting process. During the course of our audit, we placed reliance on a number of relevant contract accounting controls and certain valuation controls in relation to pension scheme assets. 7.3. Our consideration of climate- relatedrisks We have engaged with both the central finance and sustainability functions to gain an understanding of the Group’s assessment of, and the process undertaken to both identify and quantify, the Group’s climate-related risks. We have engaged our climate specialists in our assessment to consider broader industry and market-wide practice. We completed an independent climate-based risk assessment in order to consider the potential impact of climate change on the Group’s financial statements incorporating both business specific knowledge and wider industry awareness. We used this to assess the completeness of the Group’s identified risks. In addition, component teams have considered the local regulatory and legal environment, and therefore the likelihood ofunidentified environmental claims arising. As set out by management in pages 158 and159 to the financial statements, the areas of financial reporting principally impacted arethose reliant on future forecasts or futureperformance, notably recoverability ofgoodwill. In relation to the Group’s future forecasts, weconsidered the appropriateness of amounts included by management in relation to climate change in the context of the underlying businesses’ specific needs and existing asset base, including engaging with segment management to understand the process undertaken to identify required activities to achieve the Group’s Net Zero target. We also assessed whether these disclosures reflect our understanding of theGroup’s approach to climate. With respect to the financial statements, we considered whether the current assessed impact of climate change required further orenhanced disclosure as part of critical accounting estimates. However, we concluded the current presentation as afactor within the estimate of goodwill, ratherthan a material driver of these estimates, is proportionate to the relative riskof the Group and currently assessed potential financial impact. 7.4. Working with other auditors Our oversight of component auditors included directing the planning of their audit work and understanding their risk assessment process to identify key areas of estimates andjudgement, as well as supervising the execution of their audit work. We issued detailed referral instructions to the component auditors, reviewed and supervised their work through a number ofvisits to each of the component auditors during the planning and performance stages of our audit, alongside frequent remote communication. Further, we challenged the related component inter-office reporting and findings from their work, reviewed underlying audit files, attended component audit closing meetings in person, or virtually where in person attendance was not possible, and heldregular remote communication to interact on any related audit and accounting matters which arose. Additionally, all teams were involved in our annual planning workshop, which was led by the Group auditteam. Visits to meet with component teams in the UK, US, Australia and Kingdom of Saudi Arabia were also conducted by either the leadaudit partner or senior members of theengagement team. The BAE Systems, Inc. reporting units in the US and businesses owned via BAE Systems, Inc., such as Hägglunds a Swedish subsidiary, are subject to a Department of Defence Special Security Arrangement (“SSA”), which is a USgovernment requirement setting out specific protocols that foreign controlled companies must comply with in order to beable to undertake government defence contracts. As part of this there is restriction on the flow of information outside of the US. Therefore, for the US and related reporting units there are restrictions around access to the audit files and specific workpapers for non-US nationals. As such, and consistent with previous years, we have designed alternative procedures, including involvementof an additional independent USnational partner, to ensure appropriate direction, supervision and review of the UScomponent team. 148 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Auditor’s report 8. Other information The other information comprises the information included in the annual report, other than the financial statements and ourauditor’s report thereon. The directors areresponsible for the other information contained within the annual report. Our opinion on the financial statements doesnot cover the other information and, except to the extent otherwise explicitly stated in our report, we do not express anyform of assurance conclusion thereon. Our responsibility is to read the other information and, in doing so, consider whether the other information is materially inconsistent with the financial statements, orour knowledge obtained in the course ofthe audit, or otherwise appears to be materially misstated. If we identify such material inconsistencies orapparent material misstatements, we are required to determine whether this gives rise to a material misstatement in the financial statements themselves. If, based on the workwe have performed, we conclude thatthere is a material misstatement of this other information, we are required to report that fact. We have nothing to report in this regard. 9. Responsibilities of directors As explained more fully in the directors’ responsibilities statement, the directors areresponsible for the preparation of the financial statements and for being satisfied that they give a true and fair view, and forsuch internal control as the directors determine is necessary to enable the preparation of financial statements that arefree from material misstatement, whetherdue to fraud or error. In preparing the financial statements, thedirectors are responsible for assessing theGroup’s and the Company’s ability tocontinue as a going concern, disclosing asapplicable, matters related to going concern and using the going concern basis ofaccounting unless the directors either intend to liquidate the Group or the Companyor to cease operations, or have norealistic alternative but to do so. 10. Auditor’s responsibilities for the audit of the financial statements Our objectives are to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements as a whole are free from material misstatement, whether due to fraud or error,and to issue an auditor’s report that includes our opinion. Reasonable assurance isa high level of assurance but is not aguarantee that an audit conducted in accordance with ISAs (UK) will always detecta material misstatement when it exists.Misstatements can arise from fraud orerror and are considered material if, individually or in the aggregate, they could reasonably be expected to influence the economic decisions of users taken on the basis of these financial statements. A further description of our responsibilities for the audit of the financial statements islocated on the FRC’s website at: www.frc.org.uk/auditorsresponsibilities. Thisdescription forms part of our auditor’sreport. 149 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Additional informationGovernance Financial statementsStrategic report Independent Auditor’s report continued 11. Extent to which the audit was considered capable of detecting irregularities, including fraud Irregularities, including fraud, are instances ofnon-compliance with laws and regulations. We design procedures in line with our responsibilities, outlined above, to detect material misstatements in respect of irregularities, including fraud. The extent towhich our procedures are capable of detecting irregularities, including fraud isdetailed below. 11.1. Identifying and assessing potential risks related to irregularities In identifying and assessing risks of material misstatement in respect of irregularities, including fraud and non-compliance withlaws and regulations, we considered thefollowing: – the nature of the industry and sector, control environment and business performance including the design of the Group’s remuneration policies, key drivers for directors’ remuneration, bonus levels and performance targets; – the Group’s own assessment of the risks that irregularities may occur either as a result of fraud or error; – results of our enquiries of management, internal legal counsel, internal audit, directors and the Audit Committee about their own identification and assessment of the risks of irregularities, including those that are specific to the Group’s industry; – the matters discussed among the audit engagement team including significant component audit teams and involving relevant internal specialists, including tax, valuations, pensions and IT specialists regarding how and where fraud might occur in the financial statements and any potential indicators of fraud; and – any matters we identified having obtained and reviewed the Group’s documentation of their policies and procedures relating to: – identifying, evaluating and complying with laws and regulations and whether they were aware of any instances of non-compliance; – detecting and responding to the risks offraud and whether they have knowledge of any actual, suspected oralleged fraud; and – the internal controls established to mitigate risks of fraud or non-compliance with laws and regulations, including obtaining an understanding of the Group’s bribery and corruption and whistleblowing policies. As a result of these procedures, we considered the opportunities and incentives that may exist within the organisation for fraud and identified the greatest potential forfraud in the level of judgement involved inestimating costs to complete on long-term contracts and the subsequent impact on revenue and margin recognition. In common with all audits under ISAs (UK), we are also required to perform specific procedures to respond to the risk of management override. We also obtained an understanding of the legal and regulatory frameworks that the Group operates in, focusing on provisions ofthose laws and regulations that had a direct effect on the determination of material amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. The key laws and regulations weconsidered in this context included the UKCompanies Act, Listing Rules, pension legislation, and taxation legislation. In addition, we considered provisions of otherlaws and regulations that do not have adirect effect on the financial statements but compliance with which may be fundamental to the Group’s ability to operate or to avoid amaterial penalty, including in respect of export controls, defence contracting and anti-bribery and corruption legislation. 11.2. Audit response to risks identified As a result of performing the above, we identified revenue and margin recognition onlong-term contracts as a key audit matter, and identified the contract with the greatest judgement related to the potential risk of fraud owing to the level of estimation uncertainty and exercise of management judgement required. The key audit matters section of our report explains the matter in more detail and also describes the specific procedures we performed in response to thatkey audit matter. In addition to the above, our procedures torespond to risks identified included thefollowing: – reviewing the financial statement disclosures and testing to supporting documentation to assess compliance with provisions of relevant laws and regulations described as having a direct effect on the financial statements; – enquiring of management, the Audit Committee, in-house legal counsel and where appropriate, circularising external legal counsel, concerning actual and potential litigation and claims; – performing analytical procedures to identify any unusual or unexpected relationships that may indicate risks of material misstatement due to fraud; – reading minutes of meetings of those charged with governance, reviewing internal audit reports, and reviewing correspondence with relevant regulatory authorities; and – in addressing the risk of fraud through management override of controls, testing the appropriateness of journal entries and other adjustments; assessing whether the judgements made in making accounting estimates are indicative of a potential bias; and evaluating the business rationale of any significant transactions that are unusual or outside the normal course of business. We also communicated relevant identified laws and regulations and potential fraud risks to all engagement team members including internal specialists and significant component audit teams and remained alert to any indications of fraud or non-compliance with laws and regulations throughout the audit. 150 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Auditor’s report Report on other legal and regulatory requirements 12. Opinions on other matters prescribed by the Companies Act2006 In our opinion the part of the directors’ remuneration report to be audited has been properly prepared in accordance with the Companies Act 2006. In our opinion, based on the work undertaken in the course of the audit: – the information given in the strategic report and the directors’ report for the financial year for which the financial statements are prepared is consistent with the financial statements; and – the strategic report and the directors’report have been prepared inaccordance with applicable legalrequirements. In the light of the knowledge and understanding of the Group and the Company and their environment obtainedin the course of the audit, wehave not identified any material misstatements in the strategic report orthe directors’ report. 13. Corporate Governance Statement The Listing Rules require us to review the directors’ statement in relation to going concern, longer-term viability and that part ofthe Corporate Governance Statement relating to the Group’s compliance with the provisions of the UK Corporate Governance Code specified for our review. Based on the work undertaken as part ofour audit, we have concluded that eachof the following elements of the Corporate Governance Statement is materially consistent with the financial statements and our knowledge obtained during the audit: – the directors’ statement with regards tothe appropriateness of adopting the going concern basis of accounting and any material uncertainties identified setout on page 79; – the directors’ explanation as to its assessment of the Group’s prospects, the period this assessment covers and why the period is appropriate set out onpage 78; – the directors’ statement on fair, balanced and understandable set outonpage 140; – the board’s confirmation that it has carried out a robust assessment of the emerging and principal risks set out onpage 68; – the section of the annual report that describes the review of effectiveness ofrisk management and internal control systems set out on page 90;and – the section describing the work of the Audit Committee set out on page 97. 14. Matters on which we are required to report by exception 14.1. Adequacy of explanations received and accounting records Under the Companies Act 2006 we are required to report to you if, in our opinion: – we have not received all the information and explanations we require for our audit;or – adequate accounting records have not been kept by the Company, or returns adequate for our audit have not been received from branches not visited by us; or – the Company financial statements are not in agreement with the accounting records and returns. We have nothing to report in respect ofthese matters. 14.2. Directors’ remuneration Under the Companies Act 2006 we are alsorequired to report if in our opinion certain disclosures of directors’ remuneration have not been made or the part of the directors’ remuneration report to be audited is not in agreement with the accounting records and returns. We have nothing to report in respect ofthese matters. 15. Other matters which we are required to address 15.1. Auditor tenure Following the recommendation of the AuditCommittee, we were appointed by themembers on 10 May 2018 to audit the financial statements for the year ending 31 December 2018 and subsequent financial periods. The period of total uninterrupted engagement including previous renewals andreappointments of the firm is six years covering the years ended 31 December 2018 to 31 December 2023. 15.2. Consistency of the audit reportwiththe additional report totheAudit Committee Our audit opinion is consistent with the additional report to the Audit Committee we are required to provide in accordance with ISAs (UK). 16. Use of our report This report is made solely to the Company’s members, as a body, in accordance with Chapter 3 of Part 16 of the Companies Act 2006. Our audit work has been undertaken so that we might state to the Company’s members those matters we are required tostate to them in an auditor’s report and forno other purpose. To the fullest extent permitted by law, we do not accept or assume responsibility to anyone other than the Company and the Company’s members as a body, for our audit work, for this report, or for the opinions we have formed. As required by the Financial Conduct Authority (FCA) Disclosure Guidance and Transparency Rule (DTR) 4.1.15R – DTR 4.1.18R, these financial statements will formpart of the Electronic Format Annual Financial Report filed on the National Storage Mechanism of the FCA in accordance with DTR 4.1.15R – DTR 4.1.18R. This auditor’s report provides no assurance over whether the Electronic Format Annual Financial Reporthas been prepared in compliance withDTR 4.1.15R – DTR 4.1.18R. We have been engaged to provide assurance on whether the Electronic Format Annual Financial Report has been prepared in compliance with DTR 4.1.15R – DTR 4.1.18R and will publicly report separately to the members on this. Claire Faulkner Senior Statutory Auditor For and on behalf of Deloitte LLP Statutory Auditor London, United Kingdom 20 February 2024 151 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Additional informationGovernance Financial statementsStrategic report Consolidated income statement for the year ended 31 December 2023 2022 Total Total Note £m £m £m £m Continuing operations Revenue 2 2 3,07 8 21, 2 5 8 Operating costs 3 (20,91 7) (19, 2 6 9) Other income 5 204 2 15 Share of results of equity accounted investments 2,12 20 8 18 0 Operating profit 2 2 ,573 2, 38 4 Finance income 17 2 47 Finance costs (41 9) (4 42) Net finance costs 6 (2 47) (395) Profit before tax 2, 326 1, 9 8 9 Tax expense 7 (38 6) (3 15) Profit for the year 1,9 4 0 1, 6 74 Attributable to: Equity shareholders 1, 85 7 1, 59 1 Non-controlling interests 83 83 1,9 4 0 1, 6 74 Earnings per share 8 Basic earnings per share 61. 3p 51 .1p Diluted earnings per share 60.4p 50 .5p 152 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Consolidated financial statements Consolidated statement of comprehensive income for the year ended 31 December 2023 2022 Other Retained Other Retained reserves earnings Total reserves earnings Total Note £m £m £m £m £m £m Profit for the year – 1, 9 4 0 1,9 4 0 – 1 , 6 74 1, 6 74 Other comprehensive income Items that will not be reclassified to the income statement: Consolidated: Remeasurements on post-employment benefit schemes andotherinvestments 13,24 – (6 69) (6 69) – 2 , 8 51 2 , 8 51 Tax on items that will not be reclassified to the income statement 7 – 4 4 – (357) (357) Share of the other comprehensive (expense)/income of associates and joint ventures accounted for using the equity method (netoftax) 12 – (25) (2 5) – 11 6 11 6 Items that may be reclassified to the income statement: Consolidated: Currency translation on foreign currency net investments (510) – (510) 1,17 2 – 1 ,17 2 Reclassification of cumulative currency translation reserve ondisposal of subsidiaries 33 – – – (17) – (17) Fair value loss arising on hedging instruments during theyear 15 (4) – (4) (1 02) – (10 2) Cumulative fair value (gain)/loss on hedging instruments reclassified tothe income statement (19) – (19) 5 – 5 Tax on items that may be reclassified to the income statement 7 3 – 3 24 – 24 Share of the other comprehensive income/(expense) of associates and joint ventures accounted for using the equity method (net of tax) 12 11 – 11 (8) – (8) Total other comprehensive (expense)/income for the year (netof tax) (51 9) (6 90) (1, 2 0 9) 1, 0 74 2 , 61 0 3,6 8 4 Total comprehensive (expense)/income for the year (519) 1, 2 50 731 1, 0 74 4, 28 4 5, 358 Attributable to: Equity shareholders (511) 1 ,17 5 66 4 1, 0 5 3 4 ,1 8 6 5,23 9 Non-controlling interests (8) 75 67 21 98 11 9 (51 9) 1, 25 0 731 1, 0 74 4, 28 4 5,35 8 1. An analysis of other reserves is provided in note 26. 1 1 153 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Additional informationGovernance Financial statementsStrategic report Consolidated statement of changes in equity for the year ended 31 December Attributable to equity holders of BAE Systems plc Issued Non- share Share Other Retained controlling Total capital premium reserves earnings Total interests equity Note £m £m £m £m £m £m £m At 1 January 2022 85 1, 2 5 2 5,8 87 212 7, 4 3 6 232 7, 6 6 8 Profit for the year – – – 1, 5 91 1, 5 91 83 1, 6 74 Total other comprehensive income for the year – – 1, 0 5 3 2,59 5 3, 6 4 8 36 3,6 8 4 Total comprehensive income for the year – – 1, 0 5 3 4 ,1 8 6 5, 239 119 5, 358 Share-based payments (inclusive of tax) 29 – – – 12 7 127 – 12 7 Cumulative fair value loss on hedging instruments transferred to the balance sheet (net of tax) – – 8 – 8 – 8 Ordinary share dividends 26 – – – (8 02) (8 02) (16 6) (9 68) Purchase of own shares 26 (3) – 3 (793) (793) – (793) At 31 December 2022 82 1, 2 5 2 6 , 9 51 2,93 0 11 , 2 1 5 18 5 11, 4 0 0 Profit for the year – – – 1, 85 7 1,8 57 83 1, 9 4 0 Total other comprehensive expense for the year – – (5 11) (6 82) (1 ,1 9 3) (1 6) (1, 2 0 9) Total comprehensive (expense)/income for the year – – (511) 1 ,17 5 664 67 7 31 Share-based payments (inclusive of tax) 29 – – – 13 2 13 2 – 13 2 Cumulative fair value gain on hedging instruments transferred to the balance sheet (net of tax) – – (3 8) – (38) – (38) Ordinary share dividends 26 – – – (85 7) (857) (8 8) (9 45) Purchase of own shares 26 (1) – 1 (558) (558) – (558) Proceeds from unclaimed asset programme – 1 – – 1 – 1 At 31 December 2023 81 1, 253 6,403 2 ,822 10,559 16 4 10 ,72 3 1. An analysis of other reserves is provided in note 26. 1 154 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Consolidated financial statements 2023 2022 Note £m £m Non-current assets Intangible assets 9 12 , 0 9 9 12 , 6 4 4 Property, plant and equipment 10 3,635 3,235 Right-of-use assets 11 1 , 3 11 1, 4 2 5 Investment property 57 63 Equity accounted investments 12 832 787 Other investments 13 84 99 Contract and other receivables 14 6 33 618 Post-employment benefit surpluses 24 804 1, 2 9 7 Other financial assets 15 2 27 322 Deferred tax assets 16 609 33 8 20 20 , 291 20, 828 Current assets Inventories 17 1 ,1 5 6 976 Trade, contract and other receivables 14 6 ,1 8 5 6 ,1 6 6 Current tax 18 16 0 13 3 Other financial assets 15 205 252 Cash and cash equivalents 19 4, 067 3 ,1 0 7 11 , 7 7 3 10 , 6 3 4 Total assets 32, 064 31, 4 6 2 Non-current liabilities Loans 21 (4 , 4 32) (5, 189) Lease liabilities 11 (1, 2 73) (1, 3 7 5) Contract liabilities 22 (1 , 9 5 5) (9 45) Other payables 23 (1, 5 9 4) (1, 4 4 1) Post-employment benefit obligations 24 (575) (6 51) Other financial liabilities 15 (227) (272) Deferred tax liabilities 16 (10) (5) Provisions 25 (332) (33 8) (10,398) (10 , 216) Current liabilities Loans and overdrafts 21 (679) (53) Lease liabilities 11 (14 7) (2 41) Contract liabilities 22 (3, 865) (3, 8 82) Trade and other payables 23 (5, 43 6) (4 ,99 0) Other financial liabilities 15 (295) (328) Current tax 18 (2 85) (10 3) Provisions 25 (236) (249) (10 , 9 4 3) (9, 8 4 6) Total liabilities (21, 3 41) (20,0 62) Net assets 10,7 23 11, 4 0 0 Capital and reserves Issued share capital 26 81 82 Share premium 1, 25 3 1, 25 2 Other reserves 26 6,403 6 , 9 51 Retained earnings 2,8 22 2,930 Total equity attributable to equity holders of BAE Systems plc 10,559 11 , 2 1 5 Non-controlling interests 16 4 18 5 Total equity 10,7 23 11, 4 0 0 Approved by the Board of BAE Systems plc on 20 February 2024 and signed on its behalf by: C N Woodburn B M Greve Chief Executive Chief Financial Officer Consolidated balance sheet as at 31 December 155 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Additional informationGovernance Financial statementsStrategic report Note 2023 2022 £m £m Profit for the year 1,9 4 0 1, 6 74 Tax expense 7 386 3 15 Adjustment in respect of research and development expenditure credits 5 (53) (35) Share of results of equity accounted investments 2,12 (208) (18 0) Net finance costs 6 2 47 3 95 Depreciation, amortisation and impairment 3 787 76 7 Net gain on disposal of property, plant and equipment, and investment property 3,5 (1 0) (3) Gain in respect of business disposals 3,5 – (93) Gain on disposal of non-current investments 5 – (7) Cost of equity-settled employee share schemes 4 11 0 101 Movements in provisions – (5 4) Difference between pension funding contributions paid and the pension charge (1 6 9) 1 (Increase)/decrease in working capital: Inventories (2 23) (93) Trade, contract and other receivables (287) (1, 0 6 9) Trade and other payables, and contract liabilities 1,6 35 1, 4 8 5 Tax paid net of research and development expenditure credits received (395) (3 65) Net cash flow from operating activities 3, 760 2,8 39 Dividends received from equity accounted investments 12 13 4 94 Interest received 12 6 32 Principal element of finance lease receipts 10 9 Purchase of property, plant and equipment, and investment property (826) (599) Purchase of intangible assets (1 31) (9 4) Purchase of non-current other investments – (8) Proceeds from funding related to assets 14 9 15 7 Proceeds from sale of property, plant and equipment, and investment property 19 18 Proceeds from sale of non-current other investments – 7 Purchase of subsidiary undertakings and equity accounted investments, net of cash and cash equivalents acquired 12,32 (14) (16 2) Cash flow in respect of business disposals, net of cash and cash equivalents disposed 33 (8) 12 4 Net cash flow from investing activities (5 41) (42 2) Interest paid (356) (269) Equity dividends paid 26 (857) (8 02) Purchase of own shares 26 (5 61) (788) Dividends paid to non-controlling interests (88) (1 6 6) Principal element of lease payments (29 2) (236) Cash inflow from derivative financial instruments (excluding cash flow hedges) 193 533 Cash outflow from derivative financial instruments (excluding cash flow hedges) (3 89) (20 5) Cash inflow from draw-down of loans 162 – Cash outflow from repayment of loans – (4 0 0) Net cash flow from financing activities 27 (2, 188) (2,333) Net increase in cash and cash equivalents 1,0 31 84 Cash and cash equivalents at 1 January 3 ,1 0 7 2 , 9 17 Effect of foreign exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents (7 1) 10 6 Cash and cash equivalents at 31 December 19 4 ,0 67 3 ,1 0 7 Consolidated cash flow statement for the year ended 31 December 156 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Consolidated financial statements 1. Preparation of the Consolidated financial statements Basis of preparation BAE Systems plc (the parent company) is a public company limited by shares incorporated in the United Kingdom under the Companies Act and is registered in England and Wales. The address of the parent company’s registered office is shown on page 236. Following review, the directors have concluded that it is appropriate to adopt the going concern basis for these financial statements and have not identified any material uncertainties concerning the Group’s ability to do so in the 12-month period from the date of approving them. Accordingly, the Consolidated financial statements of BAE Systems plc have been prepared on a going concern basis, and in accordance with UK-adopted international accounting standards and the Companies Act 2006. The Consolidated financial statements are presented in pounds sterling and, unless stated otherwise, rounded to the nearest million. They have been prepared under the historical cost convention, as modified by the revaluation of certain financial assets and financial liabilities (including derivative financial instruments). Transactions in foreign currencies are translated at the exchange rates ruling at the date of the transactions. Monetary assets and liabilities denominated in foreign currencies are retranslated at the exchange rates ruling at the balance sheet date, with the resulting exchange differences recognised in the income statement. Material accounting policies The material accounting policies applied in the preparation of these Consolidated financial statements are set out in the relevant notes. These policies have been applied consistently to all the years presented, unless otherwise stated. The directors believe that the Consolidated financial statements reflect appropriate judgements and estimates, and provide a true and fair view of the Group’s financial performance and position. Key sources of estimation uncertainty The application of the Group’s accounting policies requires the use of estimates. In response to the potential impact of risks and uncertainties, the Group undertakes risk assessments and scenario planning in order to be able to respond to potential rapid changes in circumstances. The Group considers a range of estimates and assumptions in the application of its accounting policies and management’s assessment of the carrying value of assets and liabilities. In the event that these estimates or assumptions prove to be inaccurate, there may be an adjustment to the carrying values of assets and liabilities within the next year. Potential areas of the Group’s financial statements which could be materially impacted may include, but are not limited to: Accounting policy Description Note Revenue and profit recognition The Group accounts for revenue in accordance with IFRS 15 Revenue from Contracts with Customers. For most of the Group’s contracts, revenue and associated margin are recognised progressively over time as costs are incurred, and as risks have been mitigated or retired. The ultimate profitability of contracts is based on estimates of revenue and costs, including allowances for technical and other risks which are reliant on the knowledge and experience of the Group’s project managers, engineers and finance and commercial professionals. Material changes in these estimates could affect the profitability of individual contracts. Revenue and cost estimates are reviewed and updated at least quarterly, or more frequently as determined by events or circumstances. The long-term nature of many of the Group’s contracts means that judgements are made in estimating future costs on a contract, as well as when risks will be mitigated or retired. The impact of global supply chain issues, volatility in global gas and energy prices, and the ongoing response to climate change, have increased uncertainty in relation to these judgements and estimates. The Group continues to work closely and collaboratively with its key customers to deliver effectively on its contracts and commitments. However, the volume, scale, complexity and long-term nature of its programmes mean that potential sensitivities would be wide-ranging and not practicable to calculate. Owing to the potential future impact of current uncertainties, the Group’s estimates and assumptions related to revenue recognition could be impacted by issues such as reduced productivity as a result of operational disruption, production delays and increased costs as a result of disruption to the supply chain, changing working practices to move towards our net zero ambitions, or where there is uncertainty as to the recovery from customers of programme costs incurred. The Group has recognised £0.3bn of revenue in respect of performance obligations satisfied or partially satisfied in previous years (2022 £0.3bn). This continues to provide an approximation of the potential revenue sensitivity arising as a result of management’s estimates and assumptions for variable consideration, future costs, and technical and other risks, however it may not reflect the full potential impact on the contract receivables and contract liabilities balances. 2 Notes to the Consolidated financial statements 157 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Additional informationGovernance Financial statementsStrategic report Notes to the Consolidated financial statements continued 1. Preparation of the Consolidated financial statements continued Accounting policy Description Note Post-employment benefit obligations A number of actuarial assumptions are made in assessing the value of post-employment benefit obligations, including the discount rate, inflation rate and mortality assumptions. For each of the actuarial assumptions used, there is a wide range of possible values and management estimates a point within that range that most appropriately reflects the Group’s circumstances. If estimates relating to these actuarial assumptions are no longer valid or change due to changing economic and social conditions, then the potential obligations due under these schemes could change significantly. Discount and inflation rates could change significantly as a result of a prolonged economic downturn, monetary policy decisions and interventions or other macroeconomic issues. The impact of estimates made with regard to mortality projections may also change. Similarly, the values of many assets are subject to estimates and assumptions, in particular those which are held in unquoted pooled investment vehicles. The associated fair value of these unquoted pooled investments is estimated with consideration of the most recently available valuations provided by the investment or fund managers. These valuations inherently incorporate a number of assumptions, including the impact of climate change, on the underlying investments. The overall level of estimation uncertainty in valuing these assets could therefore give rise to a material change in valuation within the next 12 months. Furthermore, estimates are required around the Group’s ability to access its defined benefit surpluses, and on what basis, which then determines the associated rate of tax to apply. Depending on the outcome, judgement is then required to determine the presentation of any tax payable in recovering a surplus. Note 24 provides information on the key assumptions and analysis of their sensitivities. 24 Critical judgements made in applying accounting policies In the course of preparing the Consolidated financial statements and when applying its accounting policies, the Group has been required to make judgements with regard to the actions required to enable the business to continue to meet customers’ requirements in an operating environment still dominated by global economic uncertainties. No critical judgements have been made in the process of applying the Group’s accounting policies, other than those involving estimates, that have had a significant effect on the amounts recognised in the Consolidated financial statements. Impact of climate ambitions on the Consolidated financial statements In preparing the Consolidated financial statements management has considered the potential impact of climate change, both in the context of the disclosures included in the Strategic report, and the impact of climate-related risks and opportunities and the Group’s net zero ambitions and decarbonisation activities on the Group’s financial results. As a responsible defence business, sustainability is embedded in our strategic framework, with one of the Group’s long-term objectives to advance and integrate our ESG agenda. The products and services we provide are complex, diverse and developed over extended periods of time. Sustainability and the impact of our operations is considered in the planning and ongoing production of our products and services, including incorporation of the impact of the Group’s net zero ambitions and decarbonisation activities. These are embedded in our financial reporting, forecasting and governance processes. Estimates and judgement are required in determining how the Group will pursue its net zero ambitions. These, as well as mitigating actions required from the detailed review of climate risks and opportunities identified within the TCFD disclosures on page 53, have been factored into the current and future plans of the Group through the Integrated Business Plan (IBP). The IBP is the Group’s annual long-term strategy review and five-year plan for each segment, including the investment case to decarbonise. There are a number of core practices and processes that support the business to remain resilient and adapt to the impacts of climate change, whilst controlling the financial impacts to the Group. These include: – Maintenance and investment in our infrastructure – our products are designed and built to remain in service for decades to come, and require development and construction over a significant period of time. In order to deliver complex engineering and technologically advanced products, we continuously invest in the maintenance and upkeep of our global sites and facilities. The Group regularly invests in its facilities to ensure they are maintained and adapted to enable our operations. Regular maintenance and investing in Group infrastructure is embedded in our strategy, and the expected associated costs are reflected in our IBP. Insurance also provides underlying cover for more immediate and unexpected impacts of climate change. – Investment in renewable energy – during the year, the Group has entered into a number of Power Purchase Agreements (PPAs) to invest in renewable energy, providing long-term security of energy and pricing. – Proactive estate management – a large part of our business is based on sites that are leased to the Group, as reflected in our right-of- use assets in the Consolidated financial statements. Although some facilities, such as shipyards, are required to be in certain locations, many of our operations are not tied to a particular location. Given the long-term outlook of our business, future physical impacts of climate change could be mitigated through movement of activities on these sites to facilities that will be less impacted by climate change. As and when sites are identified that would benefit from relocation, the associated costs are reflected within the IBP. We have not currently identified any sites which require relocation due to climate change. We also use opportunities of new building and refurbishment to upgrade energy efficiency. The more immediate financial impacts of climate-related risks, and the actions being taken to address them, are reflected in the financial results of the Group for the year. These are not considered to have had a material impact. Areas impacted by climate-related risks and opportunities include: – Intangible assets – the annual impairment review uses cash flow projections from the IBP, which incorporates any financial impact of climate-related risks and opportunities identified. This includes product repair and adaptation, as well as investment in facilities to progress the Group’s net zero ambitions. All Cash-Generating Units showed sufficient headroom after incorporation of climate-related costs and opportunities. 158 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Consolidated financial statements 1. Preparation of the Consolidated financial statements continued – Property, plant and equipment – the useful economic life of existing capitalised assets across the Group has been reviewed in light of any repairs, upgrades to existing infrastructure, or future investment in facilities that will be required as a result of the climate-related risks and opportunities identified across our sites. No significant impairment of assets has been identified from this review. – Right-of-use assets, lease liabilities, and financial assets and liabilities – the Group has entered into a number of PPAs during the year to provide more sustainable energy from renewable sources, including a new wind farm development and a number of solar projects across our UK enterprise, which will be completed in Q4 2026 and 2024 respectively. Once the projects are completed, and where the accounting for these agreements falls within the scope of IFRS 16 Leases, the relevant right-of-use assets and corresponding liabilities will be recognised in the Consolidated financial statements. The associated costs of the arrangement will be recognised in line with the term of the agreement. The Group has also considered whether any embedded derivatives have arisen, within the scope of IFRS 9 Financial Instruments, as a result of the PPAs entered into during the year. None are considered to exist at the balance sheet date, however this will continue to be monitored as the associated contractual arrangements are refined and the construction of the facility approaches completion. – Pension plans – in assessing the value of pension assets for the UK schemes, the Group has considered the impact of climate change which is incorporated into the cash flow projections used in valuing infrastructure investment assets and pooled investment vehicle cash flows upon which the Group bases its assessment. There is also alignment between the UK Main Scheme and the Group’s climate change objectives with consistent long-term net zero ambitions. This has not materially impacted the Group’s net pension position during the year. – Deferred tax assets – the recoverability of deferred tax assets are dependent on the future availability of profits, which in turn could be impacted by climate-related matters. The recoverability of deferred tax assets have been reviewed against the Group’s future forecasts resulting from the IBP process, which incorporate identified climate-related risks and opportunities. No material risk to the recoverability of deferred tax assets has been identified. – Recoverability of contract and trade receivables – our customers are also impacted by climate-related matters. The Group actively monitors credit risk in relation to defence-related sales to government customers or subcontractors to governments, which is considered extremely low as the probability of default is insignificant. For non-government commercial customers the Group assesses the impact of any credit losses but this is not considered to be material to the financial statements. – Share-based payments – the award of Performance Shares within the 2023 Director’s Long-Term Incentive framework has a 10% weighting based on the reduction of Group GHG emissions (Scope 1 and 2) aligned to a science-based pathway. The ability to meet this target will impact the amount and timing of any share-based payments over the term of the policy. The introduction of this condition has not materially impacted the financial results of the Group for the current year. Changes in accounting policies The following standards, interpretations and amendments to existing standards became effective on 1 January 2023 and have not had a material impact on the Group: – IFRS 17 Insurance Contracts, effective from 1 January 2023; – Amendments to IAS 1: Presentation of Financial Statements, effective from 1 January 2023; – Amendments to IFRS Practice Statement 2: Disclosure of Accounting Policies, effective from 1 January 2023; – Amendments to IAS 8: Accounting Policies, Changes in Accounting Estimates and Errors, effective from 1 January 2023; and – Amendments to IAS 12: Income Taxes, effective from 1 January 2023. The following other standards, interpretations and amendments to existing standards have been issued but were not mandatory for accounting periods beginning on 1 January 2023. These either have been, or are expected to be, endorsed by the UK Endorsement Board and are not expected to have a material impact on the Group: – Amendments to IAS 1: Classification of Liabilities as Current or Non-current, effective from 1 January 2024; – Amendments to IAS 1: Non-current Liabilities with Covenants, effective from 1 January 2024; – Amendments to IAS 7 and IFRS 7: Supplier Finance Arrangements, effective from 1 January 2024; – Amendments to IFRS 10 and IAS 28: Sale or Contribution of Assets between an Investor and its Associate or joint venture; and – Amendments to IFRS 16: Lease Liability in a Sale and Leaseback, effective from 1 January 2024. Consolidation The financial statements of the Group consolidate the results of the Company and its subsidiary entities, and include its share of results of equity accounted investments accounted for under the equity method. A subsidiary is an entity controlled by the Group. The Group controls a subsidiary when it is exposed, or has the rights, to variable returns from its involvement with the subsidiary and has the ability to affect those returns through its power over the subsidiary. The results of subsidiaries are included in the income statement from the date of acquisition, or up until the date of disposal. Intra-group balances and transactions, and any unrealised income and expenses arising from intra-group transactions, are eliminated in preparing the Consolidated financial statements. Joint ventures are accounted for under the equity method and the Consolidated income statement includes the Group’s share of their profits and losses, the Consolidated statement of comprehensive income includes its share of their other comprehensive income and expense, and the Consolidated balance sheet includes its share of their net assets within equity accounted investments. The assets and liabilities of overseas subsidiaries and equity accounted investments are translated at the exchange rates ruling at the balance sheet date. The income statements of such entities are translated at average rates of exchange during the year. All resulting exchange differences are recognised directly in a separate component of equity. Translation differences that arose before the transition date to IFRS (1 January 2004) are presented in equity, but not as a separate component. When a foreign operation is sold, the cumulative exchange differences recognised in equity since 1 January 2004 are recognised in the income statement as part of the profit or loss on sale. 159 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Additional informationGovernance Financial statementsStrategic report Notes to the Consolidated financial statements continued 2. Segmental analysis and revenue recognition Revenue and profit recognition Revenue represents income derived from contracts for the provision of goods and services, over time or at a point in time, by the Group to customers in exchange for consideration in the ordinary course of the Group’s activities. The Group accounts for revenue in accordance with IFRS 15 Revenue from Contracts with Customers. For most of the Group’s contracts, revenue and associated margin are recognised progressively over time as costs are incurred, and as risks have been mitigated or retired. The ultimate profitability of contracts is based on estimates of revenue and costs, including allowances for technical and other risks which are reliant on the knowledge and experience of the Group’s project managers, engineers, and finance and commercial professionals. Revenue and cost estimates are reviewed and updated at least quarterly, or more frequently as determined by events and circumstances. The Group typically enters into the following types of contracts with customers: – to design, build or create assets uniquely available to the customer such as ships and aircraft; – to service or maintain assets over a period of time; – to give access to software and licences; and – to offer bespoke services to customers, for example through training or the offering of cyber, intelligence and security capabilities. Revenue is recognised against each of these types of contracts in line with the following accounting policies. Performance obligations Upon approval by the parties to a contract, the contract is assessed to identify each promise to transfer either a distinct good or service or a series of distinct goods or services that are substantially the same and have the same pattern of transfer to the customer. Goods and services are distinct and accounted for as separate performance obligations in the contract if the customer can benefit from them either on their own or together with other resources that are readily available to the customer and they are separately identifiable in the contract. In some cases, the Group provides warranties to its customers to give them assurance that its products and services will function in line with agreed-upon specifications. Warranties are not provided separately and, therefore, do not represent separate performance obligations. As they are not provided separately, these are not considered to be insurance contracts in scope of IFRS 17 Insurance Contracts. A provision for warranties is recognised when the underlying products and services are sold (see note 25 for further details). Transaction price At the start of the contract, the total transaction price is estimated as the amount of consideration to which the Group expects to be entitled in exchange for transferring the promised goods and services to the customer, excluding sales taxes. Variable consideration, such as variable price mechanisms, is included based on the expected value or most likely amount only to the extent that it is highly probable that there will not be a reversal in the amount of cumulative revenue recognised. The transaction price does not include estimates of consideration resulting from contract modifications, such as change orders, until they have been approved by the parties to the contract. The total transaction price is allocated to the performance obligations identified in the contract in proportion to their relative stand-alone selling prices. Given the bespoke nature of many of the Group’s products and services, which are designed and/or manufactured under contract to the customer’s individual specifications, there are typically no observable stand-alone selling prices. Instead, stand-alone selling prices are typically estimated based on expected costs plus contract margin consistent with the Group’s pricing principles. Whilst payment terms vary from contract to contract, on many of the Group’s contracts, an element of the transaction price is received in advance of delivery. When cash is received in advance of goods or services being delivered a contract liability is recognised. The Group therefore has significant contract liabilities (note 22). The Group’s contracts are not considered to include significant financing components on the basis that there is no difference between the consideration and the cash selling price. UK Ministry of Defence contracting rules prohibit the inclusion of financing in the sales price. Negotiations on competitive international export contracts do not make allowance for the cash payment profile. Revenue and profit recognition Revenue is recognised as performance obligations are satisfied and control of the goods and services is transferred to the customer. For each performance obligation within a contract, the Group determines whether it is satisfied over time or at a point in time. Performance obligations are satisfied over time if one of the following criteria is satisfied: – the customer simultaneously receives and consumes the benefits provided by the Group’s performance as it performs; – the Group’s performance creates or enhances an asset that the customer controls as the asset is created or enhanced; or – the Group’s performance does not create an asset with an alternative use to the Group and it has an enforceable right to payment for performance completed to date. The Group has determined that most of its contracts satisfy the over-time criteria, either because the customer simultaneously receives and consumes the benefits provided by the Group’s performance as it is performed (typically services or support contracts, for example in the case of ongoing maintenance and support of aircraft and flying capability), or the Group’s performance does not create an asset with an alternative use to the Group and it has an enforceable right to payment for performance completed to date (typically development or production contracts, such as in the production of ships or aircraft to customers’ unique specifications). 160 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Consolidated financial statements 2. Segmental analysis and revenue recognition continued For each performance obligation to be recognised over time, the Group recognises revenue using an input method, based on costs incurred in the year. Revenue and attributable margin are calculated by reference to reliable estimates of the transaction price and total expected costs, after making suitable allowances for technical and other risks including the impact of global economic uncertainties and climate change. Revenue and associated margin are therefore recognised progressively as costs are incurred and as risks have been mitigated or retired. The Group has determined that this method appropriately depicts the Group’s performance in transferring control of the goods and services to the customer. If the over-time criteria for revenue recognition are not met, revenue is recognised at the point in time that control is transferred to the customer which is usually when legal title passes to the customer and the business has the right to payment, for example, on delivery. When it is probable that total contract costs will exceed total contract revenue the expected loss is recognised immediately as an expense. Software licences The Group sells software licences either separately or together with other goods and services, including computer hardware and implementation, hosting and support. Revenue recognition in respect of software licences sold as part of a bundle of goods and services is considered separately when the licence is determined to be a separate performance obligation. Software licences either represent a right to access the Group’s intellectual property as it exists throughout the licence period or a right to use the Group’s intellectual property as it exists at the point in time at which the licence is granted. Revenue in respect of a right to access licence is recognised over the licence term or, in relation to perpetual licences, over the related customer relationship. Revenue in respect of a right to use licence is recognised on delivery of the software to the customer or, if the customer chooses not to access and take delivery of the software, on expiry of the licence arrangement. A software licence is considered to be a right to access the Group’s intellectual property as it exists throughout the licence period if all of the following criteria are satisfied: – the contract requires, or the customer reasonably expects, that the Group will undertake activities that significantly affect the intellectual property; – the licence directly exposes the customer to the effects of those activities; and – those activities do not result in the transfer of a good or service to the customer. Contract modifications The Group’s contracts are often amended for changes in customers’ requirements and specifications. A contract modification exists when the parties to the contract approve a modification that either changes existing, or creates newly enforceable, rights and obligations. The effect of a contract modification on the transaction price, and the Group’s measure of progress towards the satisfaction of the performance obligation to which it relates, is recognised in one of the following ways: 1. prospectively, as an additional, separate contract; 2. prospectively, as a termination of the existing contract and creation of a new contract; or 3. as part of the original contract using a cumulative catch-up. The majority of the Group’s contract modifications are treated under either 1 (for example, the requirement for additional distinct goods or services) or 3 (for example, a change in the specification of the distinct goods or services for a partially completed contract), although the facts and circumstances of any contract modification are considered individually as the types of modifications will vary and may result in different accounting outcomes. Costs to obtain a contract The Group expenses pre-contract bidding costs which are incurred regardless of whether a contract is awarded. The Group does not typically incur costs to obtain contracts that it would not have incurred had the contracts not been awarded, such as sales commission. Costs to fulfil a contract Contract fulfilment costs in respect of over-time contracts are expensed as incurred. Contract fulfilment costs in respect of point in time contracts are accounted for under IAS 2 Inventories. Reporting segments The Group has five sectors which, together with HQ, make its six reporting segments as defined by IFRS 8 Operating Segments: – Electronic Systems comprises the US- and UK-based electronics activities, including electronic warfare systems, navigation systems, electro-optical sensors, military and commercial digital engine and flight controls, precision guidance and seeker solutions, next-generation military communications systems and data links, persistent surveillance capabilities, space electronics and electric drive propulsion systems. – Platforms & Services, with operations in the US, Sweden and UK, manufactures and upgrades combat vehicles, weapons and munitions, and delivers services and sustainment activities, including naval ship repair, and the management and operation of two government-owned ammunition plants. – Air comprises the Group’s UK-based air build and support activities for European and international markets, US programmes, development of Future Combat Air Systems and FalconWorks ® , alongside our business in the Kingdom of Saudi Arabia and interests in our European joint ventures: Eurofighter and MBDA. – Maritime comprises the Group’s UK-based maritime and land activities, including major submarine, ship build and support programmes as well as our Australian business. 161 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Additional informationGovernance Financial statementsStrategic report Notes to the Consolidated financial statements continued 2. Segmental analysis and revenue recognition continued Reporting segments continued – Cyber & Intelligence comprises the US-based Intelligence & Security business and UK-headquartered Digital Intelligence business, which have been aggregated together due to the similarities of the services offered. Together, they cover the Group’s cyber security activities for national security, central government and government enterprises. – HQ comprises the Group’s head office and UK-based shared services activities, together with a 49% interest in Air Astana as at 31 December 2023. The Board (the chief operating decision maker as defined by IFRS 8 Operating Segments) monitors the results of these reporting segments to assess performance and make decisions about the allocation of resources. Segmental performance is evaluated based on key performance indicators – sales 1 and underlying EBIT 1 . Net finance costs and tax expense are managed on a Group basis. Sales 1 and revenue by reporting segment 1 Deduct Add Group’s share of revenue Subsidiaries’ revenue of equity accounted from equity accounted Sales investments investments Revenue 2023 2022 2023 2022 2023 2022 2023 2022 £m £m £m £m £m £m £m £m Electronic Systems 5,458 5,057 (255) (73) 253 73 5,456 5,057 Platforms & Services 3,922 3,688 (80) (90) – – 3,842 3,598 Air 8,058 7,698 (2,946) (2,651) 1,405 1,239 6,517 6,286 Maritime 5,536 4,598 (150) (119) 5 5 5,391 4,484 Cyber & Intelligence 2,321 2,205 – – – – 2,321 2,205 HQ 471 420 (461) (410) – – 10 10 25,766 23,666 (3,892) (3,343) 1,663 1,317 23,537 21,640 Intra-group sales/revenue (482) (410) – 1 23 27 (459) (382) 25,284 23,256 (3,892) (3,342) 1,686 1,344 23,078 21,258 Revenue from Intra-group revenue external customers 2023 2022 2023 2022 £m £m £m £m Electronic Systems 157 115 5,299 4,942 Platforms & Services 46 43 3,796 3,555 Air 33 29 6,484 6,257 Maritime 86 71 5,305 4,413 Cyber & Intelligence 127 114 2,194 2,091 HQ 10 10 – – 459 382 23,078 21,258 Sales 1 and revenue by customer location Sales Revenue 2023 2022 2023 2022 2 £m £m £m £m UK 6,629 5,428 6,102 4,918 Rest of Europe 2,706 2,201 1,533 1,230 US 10,672 10,166 10,700 10,157 Canada 177 125 177 125 Kingdom of Saudi Arabia 2,688 2,539 2,687 2,540 Qatar 711 1,156 450 885 Rest of Middle East 225 263 178 225 Australia 949 854 943 853 Rest of Asia and Pacific 421 420 264 283 Africa, and Central and South America 106 104 44 42 25,284 23,256 23,078 21,258 1 2 1. Sales and underlying EBIT are alternative performance measures defined in the Alternative performance measures section on page 227. Sales includes both revenue from the Group’s own subsidiaries as well as recognising the strategic importance in its industry of its equity accounted investments. It is presented here as our internal measure of segmental performance and to provide additional information on performance to the user. 2. Sales and revenue figures for 2022 to UK and Rest of Europe have been re-presented to reflect the workshare on the Typhoon programme. 162 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Consolidated financial statements 2. Segmental analysis and revenue recognition continued Revenue from external customers by domain 2023 2022 Air Maritime Land Cyber Total Air Maritime Land Cyber Total £m £m £m £m £m £m £m £m £m £m Electronic Systems 4,611 170 518 – 5,299 4,404 145 393 – 4,942 Platforms & Services 37 1,099 2,660 – 3,796 41 1,043 2,471 – 3,555 Air 6,380 104 – – 6,484 6,223 34 – – 6,257 Maritime 200 4,714 391 – 5,305 268 3,778 367 – 4,413 Cyber & Intelligence 637 305 234 1,018 2,194 250 274 127 1,440 2,091 11,865 6,392 3,803 1,018 23,078 11,186 5,274 3,358 1,440 21,258 Revenue by major customer Revenue from the Group’s three principal customers, which individually represent over 10% of total revenue, is as follows: 2023 2022 £m £m US Department of Defense 7,518 7,439 UK Ministry of Defence 5,766 4,721 Kingdom of Saudi Arabia Ministry of Defence and Aviation 2,607 2,425 Revenue from the UK Ministry of Defence and the US Department of Defense was generated by the five reporting segments, excluding HQ. Revenue from the Kingdom of Saudi Arabia Ministry of Defence and Aviation was generated by the Air segment. Operating profit/(loss) by reporting segment 3 Amortisation of programme, customer- related and other intangible Finance and tax expense assets, and impairment of equity accounted Operating Underlying EBIT Adjusting items of intangibles investments profit/(loss) 2023 2022 2023 2022 2023 2022 2023 2022 2023 2022 £m £m £m £m £m £m £m £m £m £m Electronic Systems 878 838 21 – (93) (91) – – 806 747 Platforms & Services 354 326 21 – – – (2) (4) 373 322 Air 949 849 – (1) – (1) (1) (38) 948 809 Maritime 425 356 – – – – (2) (4) 423 352 Cyber & Intelligence 199 232 – 78 (20) (19) – – 179 291 HQ (123) (122) (2) 14 (3) – (28) (29) (156) (137) 2,682 2,479 40 91 (116) (111) (33) (75) 2,573 2,384 Net finance costs (247) (395) Profit before tax 2,326 1,989 Tax expense (386) (315) Profit for the year 1,940 1,674 163 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Additional informationGovernance Financial statementsStrategic report Notes to the Consolidated financial statements continued 2. Segmental analysis and revenue recognition continued Share of results of equity accounted investments within reporting segments 3 Amortisation of programme, customer- related and other intangible assets, and impairment Net finance and Share of results of equity Underlying EBIT Adjusting items of intangibles tax expense accounted investments 2023 2022 2023 2022 2023 2022 2023 2022 2023 2022 £m £m £m £m £m £m £m £m £m £m Electronic Systems 10 4 – – – – – – 10 4 Platforms & Services (1) 11 – – – – (2) (4) (3) 7 Air 164 164 – – – – (1) (38) 163 126 Maritime 13 11 – – – – (2) (4) 11 7 HQ 55 65 – – – – (28) (29) 27 36 241 255 – – – – (33) (75) 208 180 3. Underlying EBIT is an alternative performance measure defined in the Alternative performance measures section on page 227. It provides a measure of operating profitability, excluding one-off events or adjusting items that are not considered to be part of the ongoing operational transactions of the business, to enable management to monitor the performance of recurring operations over time, and which is comparable across the Group. It is presented here as our internal measure of segmental performance and to provide additional information on performance to the user. Adjusting items Adjusting items are items of financial performance which have been determined by management as being material by their size or incidence and not relevant to an understanding of the Group’s underlying business performance. Adjusting items include profit or loss on business transactions, the impact of substantively enacted tax rate changes, and costs incurred which are one-off in nature, for example non-routine costs or income relating to post-retirement benefit schemes, and other items which management has determined as not being relevant to an understanding of the Group’s underlying business performance. 2023 Adjusting items in 2023 comprises a £60m settlement gain on a US pension annuity buy-out recognised within Electronic Systems, Platforms & Services and Cyber & Intelligence, partially offset by £13m costs related to the Ball Aerospace acquisition in Electronic Systems, and £7m related to current and historical business acquisitions in Cyber & Intelligence and HQ. 2022 Adjusting items in 2022 comprises a £94m gain on the disposal of the Financial Services business in Digital Intelligence, £16m costs related to current and historical business transactions, and a £13m gain related to past service on the pension schemes. Performance obligations The Group’s order book, which represents its unsatisfied performance obligations, as at 31 December 2023 was £58.0bn (2022 £48.9bn). The Group expects that approximately 34% (2022 33%) of the order book will be recognised as revenue during the next year, with the remainder largely recognised over the following four (2022 four) years. For each performance obligation to be recognised over time, the Group recognises revenue using an input method, based on costs incurred in the year. Revenue and attributable margin are calculated by reference to reliable estimates of transaction price and total expected costs, after making suitable allowances for technical and other risks. Revenue and associated margin are therefore recognised progressively as costs are incurred, and as risks have been mitigated or retired. The Group has determined that this method appropriately depicts the Group’s performance in transferring control of the goods and services to the customer. Accordingly, revenue of £0.3bn (2022 £0.3bn) was recognised during the year in respect of performance obligations satisfied or partially satisfied in previous years. 164 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Consolidated financial statements 3. Operating costs Research and development The Group undertakes research and development activities either on its own behalf or on behalf of customers, including research and development expenditure in relation to the Group’s Sustainability Accelerator Fund. Group-funded expenditure on research, and on development activities not meeting the conditions for capitalisation, is written off as incurred and charged to the income statement. 2023 2022 Note £m £m Inventories recognised as an expense 7,873 7,094 Staff costs 4 8,091 7,495 Depreciation 564 549 Amortisation 9 218 215 Impairment – intangible assets 9 5 1 Impairment – property, plant and equipment and right-of-use assets 10,11 – 2 Current and historical business transaction costs 32 20 16 Loss on disposal of property, plant and equipment, and investment property 1 2 Other operating charges 4,145 3,895 Operating costs 20,917 19,269 Operating costs includes research and development expenditure of £274m (2022 £276m) funded by the Group. Development investment of £8m (2022 £11m) was capitalised during the year (see note 9). Fees payable to the Company’s auditor and its associates included in operating costs 2023 2022 UK Overseas Total UK Overseas Total £’000 £’000 £’000 £’000 £’000 £’000 Fees payable to the Company’s auditor for the audit of the Company’s annual accounts 3,043 – 3,043 2,963 – 2,963 Fees payable to the Company’s auditor and its associates for other services to the Group: The audit of the Company’s subsidiaries 5,444 6,953 12,397 5,184 7,413 12,597 Total audit fees 8,487 6,953 15,440 8,147 7,413 15,560 Audit-related assurance services 1,281 52 1,333 805 3 808 Other non-audit services 13 – 13 1 – 1 Total non-audit fees 1,294 52 1,346 806 3 809 Total fees payable to the Company’s auditor and its associates 9,781 7,005 16,786 8,953 7,416 16,369 1 2 1. Audit-related assurance services principally comprises fees in respect of the review of the Group’s half-yearly report, along with ESEF, controls and ESG assurance work. 2. In addition to the amounts shown above, the auditor received fees of £518k (2022 £446k) for the audit of the BAE Systems UK pension schemes and £423k (2022 £534k) for the audit of BAE Systems pension schemes in the US. 165 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Additional informationGovernance Financial statementsStrategic report Notes to the Consolidated financial statements continued 4. Employees The average and year-end numbers of employees, excluding employees of equity accounted investments, were as follows: Average At year end 2023 2022 2023 2022 Number Number Number Number ’000 ’000 ’000 ’000 Electronic Systems 17 16 18 16 Platforms & Services 12 12 12 12 Air 20 19 20 19 Maritime 26 23 28 24 Cyber & Intelligence 11 11 11 11 HQ 3 2 3 2 89 83 92 84 The aggregate staff costs of Group employees, excluding employees of equity accounted investments, were as follows: 2023 2022 Note £m £m Wages and salaries 6,983 6,350 Social security costs 536 485 Share-based payments 29 110 101 Pension costs – defined contribution plans 24 309 299 Pension costs – defined benefit plans 24 128 230 Other post-employment benefit costs 24 25 30 8,091 7,495 5. Other income 2023 2022 Note £m £m Research and development expenditure credits 53 35 Operating lease income from investment property 3 3 Operating lease income from subleasing right-of-use assets 1 1 Profit on disposal of businesses 33 – 94 Profit on disposal of non-current investment – 7 Gain on sale of property, plant and equipment – 1 Profit on disposal of investment property 11 4 Management recharges to equity accounted investments 30 8 8 Royalties 28 30 Pensions settlement gain 24 60 – Other 40 32 Other income 204 215 166 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Consolidated financial statements 6. Net finance costs Finance income and finance costs Finance income and finance costs are recognised in the income statement in the year in which they are incurred. 2023 2022 Note £m £m Interest income on cash and other financial instruments 130 34 Interest income on finance lease receivables 11 1 1 Net present value gains on provisions and other payables – 12 Net interest income on post-employment benefit obligations 24 41 – Finance income 172 47 Interest expense on loans and other financial instruments (286) (221) Facility fees (14) (4) Interest expense on lease liabilities 11 (53) (48) Net present value expenses on provisions and other payables (9) (4) Net interest expense on post-employment benefit obligations 24 – (37) (Loss)/gain on remeasurement of financial instruments at fair value through profit or loss (267) 396 Foreign exchange gains/(losses) 210 (524) Finance costs (419) (442) Net finance costs (247) (395) 1,2 2,3 1. Comprises gains and losses on derivative financial instruments, principally held to manage the Group’s exposure to interest rate fluctuations on current and anticipated external borrowings and exchange rate fluctuations on balances with the Group’s subsidiaries and equity accounted investments. 2. The net gain or loss on remeasurement of financial instruments at fair value through profit or loss and the net gain or loss on foreign exchange are presented within finance costs as the gains and losses relate to the same underlying transactions. 3. The foreign exchange gains/losses primarily reflects exchange rate movements on US dollar-denominated borrowings. 167 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Additional informationGovernance Financial statementsStrategic report Notes to the Consolidated financial statements continued 7. Tax expense Income tax expense comprises current and deferred tax. Current and deferred tax is recognised in the Consolidated income statement, except to the extent that it relates to a business combination or items recognised directly in equity or other comprehensive income. Current tax Current tax is the expected tax payable or receivable on the taxable profit or loss for the year, using tax rates enacted or substantively enacted at the reporting date, and any adjustment to tax payable in respect of previous years. Deferred tax Deferred tax is recognised in respect of temporary differences between the carrying amounts of assets and liabilities for financial reporting purposes and the amounts used for tax purposes. Deferred tax is not recognised for temporary differences: – on the initial recognition of assets and liabilities in a transaction that is not a business combination and that affects neither accounting nor taxable profit or loss, except for transactions giving rise to equal taxable and deductible temporary differences, or to temporary differences associated with right-of-use assets and lease liabilities; – related to investments in subsidiaries and equity accounted investments to the extent that it is probable that they will not reverse in the foreseeable future; and – arising on the initial recognition of goodwill. Deferred tax is measured at the tax rates that are expected to be applied to temporary differences when they reverse, based on the laws that have been enacted or substantively enacted by the reporting date. The Group’s underlying effective tax rate is sensitive to the geographical mix of profits and shall be impacted, from 2024 onwards, by the UK’s enactment of the Organisation for Economic Co-operation and Development’s Global Anti-Base Erosion Model Rules (Pillar Two). The Group has applied the temporary exemption issued by the International Accounting Standards Board from the accounting for deferred taxes under IAS 12. Accordingly the Group neither recognises nor discloses information about deferred tax assets and liabilities related to Pillar Two income taxes. Whilst the Group does not anticipate a material quantitative impact from Pillar Two legislation for the 2024 financial year there are expected to be significant and complex compliance obligations. Tax expense 2023 2022 £m £m Current tax UK: Current year (103) (115) Adjustments in respect of prior years (8) (1) (111) (116) Overseas: Current year (477) (354) Adjustments in respect of prior years (132) (15) (609) (369) Total current tax (720) (485) Deferred tax UK: Origination and reversal of temporary differences (11) 11 Adjustments in respect of prior years (13) (3) Tax rate adjustment 1 4 (23) 12 Overseas: Origination and reversal of temporary differences 228 132 Adjustments in respect of prior years 129 27 Tax rate adjustment – (1) 357 158 Total deferred tax 334 170 Tax expense (386) (315) UK (134) (104) Overseas (252) (211) Tax expense (386) (315) 168 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Consolidated financial statements 7. Tax expense continued Reconciliation of tax expense The following table reconciles the theoretical income tax expense, using the UK corporation tax rate, to the reported tax expense. The UK corporation tax rate increased from 19% to 25% with effect from 1 April 2023. A blended rate of 23.5% is used in the reconciliation below to reflect this change (2022 19.0%). The reconciling items represent, besides the impact of tax rate differentials and changes, non-taxable benefits or non-deductible expenses arising from differences between the local tax base and the reported financial statements. 2023 2022 £m £m Profit before tax 2,326 1,989 UK corporation tax rate 23.5% 19.0% Expected income tax expense (547) (378) Effect of tax rates in foreign jurisdictions, including US state taxes (7) (54) Expenses not tax effected (19) (19) Income not subject to tax 125 68 Research and development tax credits 22 15 Adjustments in respect of prior years (24) 8 Adjustments in respect of equity accounted investments 48 34 Tax rate adjustment 1 3 Other 15 8 Tax expense (386) (315) Tax recognised in other comprehensive income 2023 2022 Tax Tax Before benefit/ Before (expense)/ tax (expense) Net of tax tax benefit Net of tax £m £m £m £m £m £m Items that will not be reclassified to the income statement: Consolidated: Remeasurements on post-employment benefit schemes and other investments (669) 4 (665) 2,851 (285) 2,566 Tax rate adjustment – – – – (72) (72) Share of the other comprehensive (expense)/income of associates and joint ventures accounted for using the equity method (25) – (25) 140 (24) 116 Items that may be reclassified to the income statement: Consolidated: Currency translation on foreign currency net investments (510) – (510) 1,172 – 1,172 Reclassification of cumulative currency translation reserve on disposal of subsidiary – – – (17) – (17) Fair value loss arising on hedging instruments during the year (4) 1 (3) (102) 25 (77) Cumulative fair value (gain)/loss on hedging instruments reclassified to the income statement (19) 2 (17) 5 (1) 4 Share of the other comprehensive income/(expense) of associates and joint ventures accounted for using the equity method 12 (1) 11 (9) 1 (8) (1,215) 6 (1,209) 4,040 (356) 3,684 169 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Additional informationGovernance Financial statementsStrategic report Notes to the Consolidated financial statements continued 7. Tax expense continued Tax recognised in other comprehensive income continued 2023 2022 Other Retained Other Retained reserves earnings Total reserves earnings Total £m £m £m £m £m £m Current tax Consolidated: Remeasurements on post-employment benefit schemes and other investments – 76 76 – 57 57 – 76 76 – 57 57 Deferred tax Consolidated: Remeasurements on post-employment benefit schemes and other investments – (72) (72) – (342) (342) Tax rate adjustment – – – – (72) (72) Fair value loss arising on hedging instruments during the year 1 – 1 25 – 25 Cumulative fair value gain/(loss) on hedging instruments reclassified to the income statement 2 – 2 (1) – (1) Share of the other comprehensive income of associates and joint ventures accounted for using the equity method (1) – (1) 1 (24) (23) 2 (72) (70) 25 (438) (413) Tax on other comprehensive (expense)/income 2 4 6 25 (381) (356) 8. Earnings per share The weighted average number of ordinary shares used in calculating earnings per share is the number of ordinary shares outstanding at the start of the year, less the weighted average number of shares repurchased, plus the weighted average number of shares issued within the year (including those issued from treasury), and those shares held in trust that are no longer contingently returnable (i.e. all performance conditions attached to them are met, excluding the passage of time). The number of ordinary shares outstanding at the start of the year is calculated by taking the total number of ordinary shares in issue, less treasury shares and shares held in trust which are contingently returnable (i.e. where the performance conditions attached to those shares have not been met, excluding the passage of time). The weighted average number of ordinary shares purchased, issued or released is calculated by reference to the day on which each transaction occurred. The weighted average number of ordinary shares used in calculating diluted earnings per share is the weighted average number of ordinary shares outstanding, plus the number of ordinary shares which are considered potentially dilutive ordinary shares in respect of share incentive schemes, should the vesting conditions have been met as at the year end. 2023 2022 Basic Diluted Basic Diluted pence pence pence pence £m per share per share £m per share per share Profit for the year attributable to equity shareholders 1,857 61.3 60.4 1,591 51.1 50.5 2023 2022 Millions Millions Ordinary shares in issue as at 1 January 3,297 3,404 Less: Treasury shares as at 1 January (220) (237) Shares held in trust which were contingently returnable as at 1 January (22) (23) Number of ordinary shares outstanding as at 1 January 3,055 3,144 Net weighted average number of ordinary shares repurchased in year (24) (32) Weighted average number of ordinary shares used in calculating basic earnings per share 3,031 3,112 Incremental ordinary shares in respect of employee share schemes 41 41 Weighted average number of ordinary shares used in calculating diluted earnings per share 3,072 3,153 170 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Consolidated financial statements 9. Intangible assets Intangible assets are carried at cost or valuation, less accumulated amortisation and impairment losses. Cost or valuation Goodwill Under the acquisition method for business combinations, goodwill is the acquisition-date fair value of the consideration transferred, less the net of the acquisition-date fair values of the identifiable assets acquired and liabilities assumed. Goodwill on acquisition of subsidiaries is included in intangible assets. Goodwill on acquisition of joint ventures and associates is included in the carrying value of equity accounted investments. Gains and losses on the disposal of an entity include the carrying amount of goodwill relating to the entity sold. Software Software includes: – Computer software licences acquired for use within the Group are capitalised as an intangible asset on the basis of the costs incurred to acquire and bring to use the specific software; – Software development costs that are directly associated with the production of identifiable and unique software products controlled by the Group, and that will probably generate economic benefits exceeding costs beyond one year, are recognised as intangible assets. Group-funded expenditure associated with enhancing or maintaining computer software programmes for sale is recognised as an expense as incurred; and – Software as a service cloud computing arrangements are not deemed to be controlled by the Group, and costs associated with the implementation and ongoing receipt of these services are expensed as the costs are incurred. Development costs Development costs funded by the Group on activities applied to a plan or design for the production of new or substantially improved products are capitalised as an internally generated intangible asset if certain conditions are met. The costs capitalised include materials, direct labour and related overheads. Programme and customer-related Intangible assets recognised by the Group include those relating to ongoing programmes within businesses acquired, mainly in respect of customer relationships and order backlog. These assets are initially recognised at their fair value at the acquisition date. Other Other intangible assets includes patents, trademarks and licences. Amortisation Goodwill is not amortised, but is tested annually for impairment, and carried at cost less accumulated impairment losses. Amortisation on intangible assets, excluding goodwill, is charged to the income statement on a straight-line basis over their estimated useful lives. For programme-related intangibles, amortisation is set on a programme-by-programme basis over the life of the individual programme. Amortisation for customer-related intangibles is also set on an individual basis. The estimated useful lives are as follows: Software up to 5 years Development costs up to 10 years Programme and customer-related up to 15 years Other up to 20 years The Group has no indefinite-life intangible assets other than goodwill. Impairment of intangible assets, property, plant and equipment, right-of-use assets, investment property and equity accounted investments The carrying amounts of the Group’s intangible assets (excluding goodwill), property, plant and equipment, right-of-use assets, investment property and equity accounted investments are reviewed at each balance sheet date to determine whether there is any indication of impairment, as required by IAS 36 Impairment of Assets. If any such indication exists, the asset’s recoverable amount is estimated. For goodwill and intangible assets that are not yet available for use, impairment testing is performed annually. In estimating the asset’s recoverable amount, the Group takes into consideration the impact of the Group’s sustainability ambitions. Goodwill is tested annually for impairment. For the purposes of impairment testing, goodwill is allocated to Cash-Generating Units (CGUs), or a group of CGUs on a consistent basis. The impairment calculations require the use of estimates of the future profitability and cash- generating ability of the CGU to determine its value in use based on the Group’s five-year IBP and the pre-tax discount rate used in discounting these projected cash flows. An impairment loss is recognised whenever the carrying amount of an asset or its CGU exceeds its recoverable amount, which is the greater of its value in use and its fair value less cost of disposal. In assessing value in use, the estimated future cash flows are discounted to their present value using an appropriate pre-tax discount rate. For an asset that does not generate largely independent cash flows, the recoverable amount is determined for the CGU to which the asset belongs. Impairment losses are recognised in the income statement. An impairment loss in respect of goodwill is not reversed. An impairment loss in respect of other intangible assets, property, plant and equipment, investment property and equity accounted investments is reversed if the subsequent increase in recoverable amount can be related objectively to an event occurring after the impairment loss was recognised or if there has been a change in the estimate used to determine the recoverable amount. An impairment loss is reversed only to the extent that the asset’s carrying amount does not exceed the carrying amount that would have been determined, net of depreciation or amortisation, if no impairment loss had been recognised. 171 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Additional informationGovernance Financial statementsStrategic report Notes to the Consolidated financial statements continued 9. Intangible assets continued Development Programme and Goodwill Software costs customer-related Other Total Note £m £m £m £m £m £m Cost or valuation At 1 January 2022 15,624 893 116 551 110 17,294 Additions: Acquired separately – 76 – – – 76 Internally developed – 6 11 – – 17 Business acquisitions 32 91 – – 66 5 162 Disposals – (34) – – – (34) Business disposals (191) – – – – (191) Transfer from property, plant and equipment – 5 – – – 5 Foreign exchange adjustments 1,069 27 14 71 15 1,196 At 31 December 2022 16,593 973 141 688 130 18,525 Additions: Acquired separately – 111 – – 1 112 Internally developed – 11 8 – – 19 Business acquisitions 32 3 – – – 8 11 Disposals – (49) – (3) (2) (54) Foreign exchange adjustments (545) (25) (8) (39) (4) (621) At 31 December 2023 16,051 1,021 141 646 133 17,992 Amortisation and impairment At 1 January 2022 4,714 569 79 170 46 5,578 Amortisation – 106 2 95 15 218 Impairment charge – 1 – – – 1 Disposals – (34) – – – (34) Business disposals 33 (168) – – – – (168) Foreign exchange adjustments 228 21 10 21 6 286 At 31 December 2022 4,774 663 91 286 67 5,881 Amortisation – 103 4 97 14 218 Impairment charge – 5 – – – 5 Disposals – (49) – (3) (2) (54) Foreign exchange adjustments (109) (20) (7) (18) (3) (157) At 31 December 2023 4,665 702 88 362 76 5,893 Net book value At 31 December 2023 11,386 319 53 284 57 12,099 At 31 December 2022 11,819 310 50 402 63 12,644 At 1 January 2022 10,910 324 37 381 64 11,716 1 1 1 1 1. Includes intangible assets with £nil net book value no longer used by the Group. 172 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Consolidated financial statements 9. Intangible assets continued Impairment testing The recoverable amount of the Group’s goodwill is based on value in use, estimated using risk-adjusted future cash flow projections from the five-year Integrated Business Plan (IBP) and a terminal value based on the projections for the final year of that plan, with a long-term growth rate of 2% applied for each significant group of Cash-Generating Units (CGUs). The IBP process includes the use of historical experience, available government spending data and the Group’s order backlog, as well as the impact of evolving issues such as global economic uncertainty and climate change. Pre-tax discount rates, derived from the Group’s post-tax weighted average cost of capital and adjusted for factors specific to the market in which the CGU operates, have been used in discounting these projected risk-adjusted cash flows. Significant CGUs A summary of the significant CGUs is presented below. Allocated goodwill Pre-tax discount rate 2023 2022 2023 2022 Cash-Generating Unit Key assumptions £bn £bn % % Electronic Systems Continued demand from the US Government for electronic 5.0 5.2 9 9 warfare systems (where the business has a leadership position), other technology-based solutions and growth in the commercial avionics market Platforms & Services Continued demand in the Group’s principal markets for 3.6 3.8 9 9 existing and successor military tracked vehicles, naval guns, missile launchers, artillery systems, munitions, upgrade programmes and support, and in the US for complex infrastructure, maritime and aviation services Maritime Continued demand, primarily from the UK and Australian 1.5 1.5 10 10 Governments, for existing and successor programmes for submarines, complex warships and munitions. This includes upgrade and sustainment programmes in these areas as well as in the field of air, electronic systems and wide-area surveillance The headroom, calculated as the difference between net assets including allocated goodwill as at 31 December 2023 and the value in use calculations, for the CGUs listed above is shown below. The table also shows the headroom assuming a 1% reduction in the terminal value growth rate assumption, a 2% increase in the discount rate and a 1% reduction in the operating margin used in the value in use calculations, considered to be reasonable worst-case scenarios in the current economic climate. Headroom assuming a 1% reduction in the Headroom assuming Headroom assuming Headroom as at terminal value growth a 2% increase in the a 1% reduction in 31 December rate assumption discount rate operating margin 2023 2022 2023 2022 2023 2022 2023 2022 Cash-Generating Unit £bn £bn £bn £bn £bn £bn £bn £bn Electronic Systems 6.0 5.4 4.3 3.8 2.5 2.0 5.2 4.5 Platforms & Services 2.5 2.1 1.6 1.3 0.6 0.3 1.9 1.5 Maritime 5.7 4.2 4.8 3.5 2.6 1.7 4.8 3.5 Other CGUs The remaining goodwill balance of £1.3bn (2022 £1.3bn) is allocated across multiple CGUs. No individual CGU exceeds 10% of the Group’s total goodwill balance. The majority of the projected cash flows within these CGUs is primarily underpinned by expected levels of government spending on defence, aerospace and security, and the Group’s ability to capture a broadly consistent market share. Capital commitments At 31 December 2023, capital expenditure of £44m (2022 £41m) in respect of intangible assets was contracted for but not provided for in the accounts. 173 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Additional informationGovernance Financial statementsStrategic report Notes to the Consolidated financial statements continued 10. Property, plant and equipment Cost Items of property, plant and equipment are stated at cost less accumulated depreciation and impairment losses. The cost of self-constructed assets includes the cost of materials, direct labour and an appropriate proportion of production overheads. The cost of demonstration assets is written off as incurred. The reimbursement of the cost of an item of property, plant and equipment by way of a government grant is presented as deferred income and recognised in the income statement on a basis consistent with the depreciation of the asset over its estimated useful life. Assets held for leasing out under operating leases are included in property, plant and equipment at cost less accumulated depreciation and impairment losses. Depreciation Depreciation is provided, normally on a straight-line basis, to write off the cost of items of property, plant and equipment over their estimated useful lives to any estimated residual value, using the following rates: Buildings up to 50 years, or the lease term if shorter Plant and machinery: Computing equipment and motor vehicles 4 to 5 years Other equipment 10 to 20 years, or the project life if shorter No depreciation is provided on freehold land and assets in the course of construction. The assets’ residual values, useful lives and depreciation methods are reviewed, and adjusted if appropriate, at each balance sheet date, taking into consideration the impact on the assets’ useful economic lives as a result of the Group’s sustainability ambitions. Impairment The carrying amounts of the Group’s property, plant and equipment are reviewed at each balance sheet date to determine whether there is any indication of impairment in accordance with the policy shown in note 9. 174 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Consolidated financial statements 10. Property, plant and equipment continued Land and Plant and buildings machinery Total Note £m £m £m Cost At 1 January 2022 2,754 3,756 6,510 Additions 302 289 591 Business acquisitions 32 – 1 1 Transfer to intangible assets – (5) (5) Reclassification between categories 16 (16) – Disposals (45) (131) (176) Foreign exchange adjustments 143 227 370 At 31 December 2022 3,170 4,121 7,291 Additions 413 411 824 Reclassification between categories (38) 38 – Disposals (33) (104) (137) Foreign exchange adjustments (82) (127) (209) At 31 December 2023 3,430 4,339 7,769 Depreciation and impairment At 1 January 2022 1,191 2,467 3,658 Depreciation charge for the year 109 218 327 Impairment charge – 2 2 Disposals (40) (125) (165) Foreign exchange adjustments 79 155 234 At 31 December 2022 1,339 2,717 4,056 Depreciation charge for the year 112 232 344 Disposals (30) (100) (130) Foreign exchange adjustments (47) (89) (136) At 31 December 2023 1,374 2,760 4,134 Net book value At 31 December 2023 2,056 1,579 3,635 At 31 December 2022 1 1,831 1,404 3,235 At 1 January 2022 1,563 1,289 2,852 1 1. Includes £1,145m (2022 £991m) of assets at Barrow-in-Furness, UK funded by the UK government. Assets in the course of construction Included in the above analysis, the following balances relate to those assets which are still in the course of construction: Land and Plant and buildings machinery Total £m £m £m At 31 December 2023 750 394 1,144 At 31 December 2022 547 292 839 Capital commitments At 31 December 2023, capital expenditure of £442m (2022 £403m) in respect of property, plant and equipment was contracted for but not provided for in the Consolidated financial statements. Assets pledged as security Within the Land and buildings balance, there are assets with a carrying amount of £62m (2022 £nil) which the Group cannot pledge as security for borrowings, or sell to another entity. 175 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Additional informationGovernance Financial statementsStrategic report Notes to the Consolidated financial statements continued 11. Leases The Group as lessee All leases in which the Group is lessee are recognised as a right-of-use asset and a corresponding lease liability at the date at which the leased asset is available for use by the Group. Each lease payment is allocated between repayment of the lease liability and finance cost. The finance cost is charged to the income statement over the lease term to produce a constant periodic rate of interest on the lease liability. The right-of-use asset is depreciated over the shorter of the asset’s useful life and the lease term on a straight-line basis. The lease liability is initially measured as the present value of future lease payments, discounted using the interest rate implicit in the lease. Where this rate is not determinable, the Group’s incremental borrowing rate is used, which is the interest rate the Group would have to pay to borrow the amount necessary to obtain an asset of similar value, in a similar economic environment with similar terms and conditions. The right-of-use asset is initially measured at cost, comprising the initial value of the lease liability, any lease payments made (net of any incentives received from the lessor) before the commencement of the lease, any initial direct costs and any restoration costs. The carrying amounts of the Group’s right-of-use assets are reviewed at each balance sheet date to determine whether there is any indication of impairment in accordance with the policy shown in note 9. Payments in respect of short-term leases, low-value leases and leases of intangible assets are charged to the income statement on a straight-line basis over the lease term. The Group leases land, buildings, vehicles and equipment under non-cancellable lease arrangements. The leases have varying terms, including escalation clauses, renewal rights and purchase options. None of these terms represents unusual arrangements or creates material onerous or beneficial rights or obligations. Right-of-use assets 2023 2022 Land and Plant and Land and Plant and buildings machinery Total buildings machinery Total Note £m £m £m £m £m £m Net book value at 1 January 1,400 25 1,425 1,075 16 1,091 Additions during the year 115 19 134 397 20 417 Business acquisitions 32 – – – 1 – 1 Lease modifications during the year 20 (1) 19 50 1 51 Depreciation charge for the year (202) (12) (214) (205) (12) (217) Business disposals 33 – – – (3) – (3) Foreign exchange adjustments (53) – (53) 85 – 85 Net book value at 31 December 1,280 31 1,311 1,400 25 1,425 176 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Consolidated financial statements 11. Leases continued Lease liabilities A maturity analysis of the future undiscounted lease payments in respect of the Group’s lease liabilities is presented in the table below: 2023 2022 £m £m Payments due: Within one year 197 290 Between one and five years 537 632 Later than five years 1,229 1,227 Total undiscounted gross payments 1,963 2,149 Deduct: Impact of discounting (543) (533) Lease liabilities 1,420 1,616 The Group is also committed to future undiscounted lease payments of £68m in respect of leases which had not yet commenced at 31 December 2023 (2022 £5m). The total cash outflow for leases in the year ended 31 December 2023, including short-term leases and low-value leases, amounted to £376m (2022 £314m). Amounts recognised in the Consolidated income statement 2023 2022 £m £m Included in operating costs: Depreciation on right-of-use assets (214) (217) Short-term lease expense (25) (25) Low-value lease expense (5) (5) (244) (247) Included in net finance costs: Interest income on finance lease receivables 1 1 Interest expense on lease liabilities (53) (48) (52) (47) 177 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Additional informationGovernance Financial statementsStrategic report Notes to the Consolidated financial statements continued 12. Equity accounted investments Equity accounted investments comprise joint ventures and associates. A joint venture is a joint arrangement whereby the parties that have joint control have rights to the net assets of the arrangement. An associate is an entity over which the Group has significant influence but not control or joint control. The Group recognises its share of the profit or loss and other comprehensive income of equity accounted investments as a separate line in the Consolidated income statement and Consolidated statement of comprehensive income, respectively. The carrying value of an equity accounted investment comprises the Group’s share of net assets and purchased goodwill, and is assessed for impairment as a single asset. The carrying amounts of the Group’s equity accounted investments are reviewed at each balance sheet date to determine whether there is any indication of impairment, in accordance with the policy shown in note 9. Group summary The Group has two individually material joint ventures which are Eurofighter Jagdflugzeug and MBDA, the carrying values of which are included on the next page. The Group also has a number of individually immaterial joint ventures and associates, the carrying values of the most significant at 31 December 2023 are as follows: Rheinmetall BAE Systems Land (RBSL) (£84m); Air Astana (£84m); FADEC International (£47m); Panavia Aircraft (£20m); and FNSS (£16m). The following table shows a reconciliation of the opening to closing carrying values for both the Group’s principal and other joint ventures and associates. Principal equity accounted Other joint Other investments ventures associates Total £m £m £m £m At 1 January 2022 354 115 85 554 Group’s share of profit for the year 126 46 8 180 Group’s share of remeasurements on post-employment benefit schemes 140 – – 140 Tax on items that will not be reclassified to the income statement (24) – – (24) Foreign exchange adjustments (10) – (1) (11) Amounts (debited)/credited to hedging reserve (2) 4 – 2 Tax on items that may be reclassified to the income statement 1 – – 1 Group’s share of total comprehensive income for the year 231 50 7 288 Dividends received from equity accounted investments (83) (11) – (94) Foreign exchange adjustments 26 13 – 39 At 31 December 2022 528 167 92 787 Group’s share of profit for the year 165 39 4 208 Group’s share of remeasurements on post-employment benefit schemes (24) (1) – (25) Foreign exchange adjustments 3 3 – 6 Amounts credited to hedging reserve 2 4 – 6 Tax on items that may be reclassified to the income statement (1) – – (1) Group’s share of total comprehensive income for the year 145 45 4 194 Acquisition of equity accounted investments – 5 – 5 Dividends received from equity accounted investments (110) (24) – (134) Foreign exchange adjustments (12) (8) – (20) At 31 December 2023 551 185 96 832 178 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Consolidated financial statements 12. Equity accounted investments continued Principal equity accounted investments Principally Joint venture Principal activities Shareholding operates in Eurofighter Jagdflugzeug Management and control of the European Typhoon programme 33% Germany MBDA Development and manufacture of guided weapons 37.5% Europe The following tables summarise the financial information of the Group’s principal equity accounted investments included in their own financial statements, as adjusted for fair value adjustments at acquisition and differences in accounting policies, and reconcile this to the Group’s interest in those equity accounted investments. 2023 2022 Eurofighter Eurofighter Jagdflugzeug MBDA Jagdflugzeug MBDA £m £m £m £m Revenue (100%) 4,169 3,871 3,693 3,590 Underlying EBIT 1 excluding depreciation and amortisation 23 568 19 574 Depreciation and amortisation (4) (138) (4) (152) Finance income 3 145 2 25 Finance costs (3) (13) (2) (13) Tax expense (9) (130) (6) (105) Profit for the year (100%) 10 432 9 329 Remeasurements on post-employment benefit schemes, net of tax – (65) – 310 Amounts credited/(debited) to hedging reserve, net of tax – 4 – (4) Foreign exchange adjustments – 8 (5) (24) Total comprehensive income for the year (100%) 10 379 4 611 Group’s share of total comprehensive income for the year 3 142 1 230 Non-current assets 29 2,717 30 2,464 Cash and cash equivalents 43 4,109 42 2,650 Current assets excluding cash and cash equivalents 9,089 4,626 8,591 4,697 Current assets 9,132 8,735 8,633 7,347 Non-current financial liabilities excluding trade and other payables, and provisions – (15) – (10) Other non-current liabilities (45) (85) (47) (20) Non-current liabilities (45) (100) (47) (30) Current financial liabilities excluding trade and other payables, and provisions (9) – (10) – Other current liabilities (9,077) (9,942) (8,581) (8,416) Current liabilities (9,086) (9,942) (8,591) (8,416) Net assets (100%) 30 1,410 25 1,365 1. Underlying EBIT is an alternative performance measure defined in the Alternative performance measures section on page 227. 2023 2022 Eurofighter Eurofighter Jagdflugzeug MBDA Total Jagdflugzeug MBDA Total £m £m £m £m £m £m Group’s share of net assets 10 529 539 8 512 520 Goodwill adjustment – 12 12 – 8 8 Carrying value 10 541 551 8 520 528 2023 2022 Eurofighter Eurofighter Jagdflugzeug MBDA Total Jagdflugzeug MBDA Total £m £m £m £m £m £m Dividends received 2 108 110 3 80 83 Contingent liabilities The Group is not aware of any material contingent liabilities in respect of its equity accounted investments. 179 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Additional informationGovernance Financial statementsStrategic report Notes to the Consolidated financial statements continued 13. Other investments Other investments are carried at fair value through other comprehensive income. 2023 2022 £m £m Other investments at fair value through other comprehensive income 84 99 14. Trade, contract and other receivables Trade and contract receivables are measured at amortised cost under IFRS 9 Financial Instruments as they are held within a business model to collect contractual cash flows and these cash flows consist solely of payments of principal and interest on the principal amount outstanding. Contract receivables represent amounts for which the Group has an unconditional right to consideration in respect of unbilled revenue recognised at the balance sheet date and comprise costs incurred plus attributable margin. Trade receivables, contract receivables, amounts owed by equity accounted investments and finance lease receivables include a provision for expected credit losses. The Group measures the provision at an amount equal to lifetime expected credit losses, estimated by reference to past experience and relevant forward-looking factors. The Group writes off a receivable when there is objective evidence that the debtor is in significant financial difficulty and there is no realistic prospect of recovery, for example, when a debtor enters bankruptcy or financial reorganisation. US deferred compensation plan assets are measured at fair value in accordance with IAS 19 Employee Benefits. 2023 2022 Note £m £m Non-current Contract receivables 18 20 Prepayments 215 201 Accrued income – 1 US deferred compensation plan assets 340 328 Finance lease receivables 15 24 Other receivables 45 44 633 618 Current Contract receivables 3,377 3,473 Trade receivables 1,196 1,506 Amounts owed by equity accounted investments 30 77 75 Prepayments 933 509 Accrued income 19 62 US deferred compensation plan assets 42 39 Finance lease receivables 9 10 Other receivables 532 492 6,185 6,166 1 1. Includes £231m (2022 £329m) in relation to VAT receivable in the Kingdom of Saudi Arabia. Trade receivables are stated net of a provision for expected credit losses. Disclosures relating to the ageing of trade receivables and movements in the provision for expected credit losses are provided in note 15. 180 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Consolidated financial statements 15. Other financial assets and liabilities and financial risk management Derivative financial instruments and hedging activities The international nature of the Group’s business means it is exposed to volatility in currency exchange rates. In order to protect itself against currency fluctuations, the Group’s policy is to hedge all material firm transactional exposures. The Group uses interest rate derivative instruments to manage the Group’s exposure to interest rate fluctuations on its borrowings and deposits by varying the proportion of fixed rate debt relative to floating rate debt over the forward time horizon. The Group uses foreign exchange derivative instruments to manage the Group’s exposure to currency fluctuations on its borrowings and deposits with the Group’s subsidiaries and equity accounted investments. In accordance with its Treasury Policy, the Group does not hold derivative financial instruments for trading purposes. The Group aims to achieve hedge accounting treatment for all derivatives that hedge material foreign currency exposures. Derivative financial instruments are recognised initially at fair value. Subsequent to initial recognition, such instruments are stated at fair value at the balance sheet date. The fair values are estimated by discounting expected future cash flows based on reputable third-party forecast data, and then adjusting for credit risk, including the Group’s own credit risk, and market risk. Fair value through profit or loss Gains and losses on derivative financial instruments that are not designated as cash flow hedges are recognised within net finance costs in the income statement for the year. Cash flow hedges Where a derivative financial instrument is designated as a hedge of the exposure to variability in cash flows relating to a highly-probable forecast transaction (income or expense) or recognised asset or liability, the effective portion of any change in the fair value of the instrument is recognised in other comprehensive income and presented in the hedging reserve in equity. Amounts recognised in equity are removed from the hedging reserve and included in the cost of the underlying transaction or reclassified to the income statement when the underlying transaction affects profit or loss. These amounts are presented within the same line item in the income statement as the underlying transaction, typically revenue or operating costs. The ineffective portion of any change in the fair value of the instrument is recognised in the income statement within net finance costs immediately. The Group treats the foreign currency basis element of the designated foreign exchange derivative hedging instruments as a cost of hedging and as such it is excluded from the hedge designation. Any hedges entered into on behalf of equity accounted investments (note 30) are classified as cash flow hedges. 2023 2022 Assets Liabilities Assets Liabilities £m £m £m £m Non-current Cash flow hedges – foreign exchange contracts 127 (170) 175 (237) Debt-related derivative financial instruments 100 (57) 147 (35) 227 (227) 322 (272) Current Cash flow hedges – foreign exchange contracts 162 (184) 229 (249) Debt-related derivative financial instruments – (21) – – Other foreign exchange/interest rate contracts 43 (90) 23 (79) 205 (295) 252 (328) Debt-related derivative financial instruments The debt-related derivative financial instruments represent the fair value of cross-currency, interest rate and foreign exchange derivatives relating to the US$800m 3.8% bond, repayable 2024, the US$500m 7.5% bond, repayable 2027, the US$1,300m 3.4% bond, repayable 2030, and the US$400m 5.8% bond, repayable 2041 (see note 21). 181 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Additional informationGovernance Financial statementsStrategic report Notes to the Consolidated financial statements continued 15. Other financial assets and liabilities and financial risk management conti nued Interest rate risk The Group’s objective is to manage its exposure to interest rate fluctuations on borrowings through varying the proportion of fixed-rate debt relative to floating rate debt with derivative instruments, including interest rate and cross-currency swaps. The Group’s interest rate management policy is that a minimum of 50% (2022 50%) and a maximum of 90% (2022 90%) of borrowings is maintained at fixed interest rates. At 31 December 2023, the Group had 86% (2022 85%) of fixed-rate debt and 14% (2022 15%) of floating rate debt based on a gross debt of £5.1bn (2022 £5.0bn), including debt-related derivative financial assets. Based on contracted maturities and/or repricing dates, the following amounts are exposed to interest rate risk over the future as shown below: 2023 2022 Within Between one Later than Within Between one Later than one year and two years two years one year and two years two years £m £m £m £m £m £m Cash and cash equivalents 4,067 – – 3,107 – – Loans and overdrafts 703 – – 745 745 – The floating rate debt has been predominantly achieved by entering into interest rate swaps which swap the fixed-rate US dollar interest payable on debt into either floating rate sterling or US dollars. At the end of 2023, the Group had a total of $0.9bn (2022 $0.9bn) of this type of swap outstanding with a weighted average duration of 0.8 years (2022 1.8 years). In respect of the fixed-rate debt, the weighted average period in respect of which interest is fixed was 12.4 years (2022 12.9 years). Given the level of short-term interest rates during the year, the average cost of the floating rate debt was 7.7% (2022 4.2%) on US dollars. The cost of the fixed-rate debt was 3.7% (2022 3.7%). Additionally, the Group has entered into $1.0bn (£0.8bn) of interest rate derivatives to partially manage the Group’s exposure to fixed interest rate risk on the anticipated raising of capital in 2024. IBOR reform The Group has interest rate swaps that reference USD LIBOR, with a combined notional value of $0.9bn, that mature in October 2024. During the year, the Group adhered to the International Swaps and Derivatives Association (ISDA) 2020 IBOR Fallbacks Protocol, which will be used to calculate the USD floating rates applicable for these interest rate swaps between the period post cessation of USD LIBOR and maturity of the swaps. The Group has no other derivatives that reference IBOR benchmarks. Sensitivity analysis A change of 100 basis points in short-term rates applied to the average fixed/floating mix and level of borrowings would vary the interest cost to the Group by approximately £7m (2022 £7m). In respect of cash deposits, given the fluctuation in the Group’s working capital requirements, cash is generally invested for short-term periods based at floating-interest rates. A change of 100 basis points in the average interest rates during the year applied to the average cash deposits would vary the interest receivable by approximately £29m (2022 £19m). Should interest rates fluctuate by a different rate to those disclosed, the impact can be linearly interpolated. 182 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Consolidated financial statements 15. Other financial assets and liabilities and financial risk management conti nued Liquidity risk Contractual cash outflows on financial liabilities The contracted cash outflows on loans and overdrafts, derivative financial instruments and other financial instruments at the reporting date are shown below, classified by maturity. The cash outflows are shown on a gross basis, are not discounted, are translated at the spot rate and include estimated interest payments where applicable. Contracted cash outflows reflect the gross cash outflow on derivative financial instruments and exclude the broadly offsetting cash inflows for the receive leg of derivatives that are settled separately to the pay leg. 2023 2022 Contracted cash outflow Contracted cash outflow Between Later Between Later Within one and than Within one and than Carrying one five five Carrying one five five amount year years years Total amount year years years Total £m £m £m £m £m £m £m £m £m £m Cash outflows without directly offsetting inflows Accruals 1 (1,758) (1,739) (19) – (1,758) (2,025) (1,997) (28) – (2,025) Trade and other payables (2,681) (2,660) (21) – (2,681) (2,154) (2,126) (28) – (2,154) Lease liabilities (1,420) (197) (537) (1,229) (1,963) (1,616) (290) (632) (1,227) (2,149) Loans and overdrafts (5,111) (825) (1,585) (4,794) (7,204) (5,242) (199) (2,377) (4,893) (7,469) (10,970) (11,037) Cash outflows with largely offsetting inflows Cash flow hedges – financial assets 289 (6,003) (4,623) (135) (10,761) 404 (7,434) (4,444) (443) (12,321) Cash flow hedges – financial liabilities (354) (6,775) (6,127) (477) (13,379) (486) (8,258) (5,758) (741) (14,757) Other foreign exchange/interest rate contracts – financial assets 43 (2,674) – – (2,674) 23 (2,364) – – (2,364) Other foreign exchange/interest rate contracts – financial liabilities (90) (1,468) – – (1,468) (79) (1,693) – – (1,693) Debt-related derivatives – financial assets 100 (23) (370) (36) (429) 147 (58) (534) (1,124) (1,716) Debt-related derivatives – financial liabilities (78) (92) (141) (1,053) (1,286) (35) (47) (47) – (94) (90) (26) (11,060) (11,063) 2 3 1. Accruals presented in the table excludes £910m (2022 £719m) of accruals which are non-financial liabilities. 2. Trade and other payables excludes other taxes and social security costs, deferred income and US deferred compensation plan liabilities (see note 23) on the basis that these are non-financial liabilities. 3. Cash outflows in relation to derivatives presented in this table do not include the cash inflows which would be received when closing out the trades. These cash inflows are expected to largely offset all outflows presented within this table. Borrowing facilities The Group’s objective is to maintain adequate undrawn committed borrowing facilities. At 31 December 2023, the Group had a committed Revolving Credit Facility (RCF) of £2bn (2022 £2bn). The RCF was undrawn throughout the year. The RCF also acts as a backstop to Commercial Paper issued by the Group. In 2023, the Group entered into a new five-year RCF, with two one-year extension options, taking the expected maturity of the facility to 2030. At 31 December 2023, the Group had no Commercial Paper in issue (2022 £nil). At 31 December 2023, the Group also had a committed undrawn bridge loan facility of US$4.0bn (£3.1bn) to support the Group’s financing requirements for the acquisition of Ball Aerospace which completed on 16 February 2024. Prior to completion, the full bridging facility was drawn down. See note 34 on page 213. 183 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Additional informationGovernance Financial statementsStrategic report Notes to the Consolidated financial statements continued 15. Other financial assets and liabilities and financial risk management conti nued Currency risk The Group’s objective is to reduce its exposure to transactional volatility in earnings and cash flows from movements in foreign currency exchange rates, mainly the US dollar, euro, Saudi riyal and Australian dollar. The Group is exposed to movements in foreign currency exchange rates in respect of foreign currency-denominated transactions. All material firm transactional exposures are hedged using foreign exchange forward contracts and the Group aims, where possible, to apply cash flow hedge accounting to these transactions. The currency and notional amount of the designated hedging instruments match the currency and principal amounts of the forecast transactions being hedged, therefore the hedging instruments and hedged items have values which will generally move in opposite directions because of the same hedged risk. As the critical terms of the hedging instruments match those of the hedged items, an economic relationship can be demonstrated on an ongoing basis. The hedge ratio is 1:1 on the basis that the notional amount of the designated hedging instruments matches the principal amount of the forecast foreign currency sales/purchases designated as the hedged items. The Group does not designate groups of items with offsetting risk positions as hedged items. The Group considers the potential sources of hedge ineffectiveness to be: – valuation adjustments for credit risk made to derivative hedging instruments at each hedge effectiveness measurement date; – changes to the timing and amount of forecast transactions; and – non-occurrence of the designated hedged items. Ineffectiveness due to foreign currency basis was highly immaterial. The Group enters into derivative contracts with varying maturities up to 2032. The following table presents the sterling nominal amounts of the foreign currency contracts used to hedge foreign currency risk, split by maturity profile, along with the exchange rate: 2023 2022 Currency purchased Currency sold Currency purchased Currency sold Notional Notional Notional Notional Weighted value of Weighted value of Weighted value of Weighted value of average currency average currency average currency average currency hedged purchased hedged sold hedged purchased hedged sold (Purchase)/sale contracts Maturity date rate £m rate £m rate £m rate £m Sterling/US dollar Within one year 1.26 (2,762) 1.27 2,657 1.23 (2,790) 1.24 3,060 Between one and five years 1.26 (1,608) 1.27 1,898 1.28 (1,423) 1.30 2,171 Later than five years 1.33 (13) 1.40 5 1.40 (31) 1.29 19 Sterling/euro Within one year 1.12 (2,725) 1.12 2,525 1.12 (3,689) 1.12 3,299 Between one and five years 1.10 (2,913) 1.09 2,702 1.09 (2,576) 1.09 2,583 Later than five years 1.07 (136) 1.07 133 1.08 (383) 1.07 388 Other Within one year n/a (2,208) n/a 2,209 n/a (2,873) n/a 2,869 Between one and five years n/a (1,795) n/a 1,781 n/a (1,437) n/a 1,455 Later than five years n/a (333) n/a 326 n/a (379) n/a 378 Cash flow hedges (14,493) 14,236 (15,581) 16,222 The effect of cash flow hedges on the Group’s financial position and performance for the year is as follows: 2023 2022 Change in the Change in Change in the Change in value of the value value of the value hedging of hedged hedging of hedged instruments items since Notional Carrying instruments items since Notional Carrying since 1 January 1 January amount amount since 1 January 1 January amount amount (Purchase)/sale contracts £m £m £m £m £m £m £m £m Sterling/US dollar 44 (44) 177 (29) (106) 106 1,006 (102) Sterling/euro (5) 5 (414) (2) 9 (9) (378) 17 Other (43) 43 (20) (34) (5) 5 13 3 Cash flow hedges (4) 4 (257) (65) (102) 102 641 (82) 184 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Consolidated financial statements 15. Other financial assets and liabilities and financial risk management conti nued Currency risk continued Sensitivity analysis The Group is exposed to movements in foreign currency exchange rates in respect of the translation of net assets and income statements of foreign subsidiaries and equity accounted investments. The Group does not hedge the translation effect of exchange rate movements on the income statements or balance sheets of foreign subsidiaries and equity accounted investments it regards as long-term investments. The estimated impact on foreign exchange gains and losses in net finance costs of a ten cent movement in the closing sterling to US dollar exchange rate on the retranslation of US dollar-denominated bonds held by BAE Systems plc is approximately £229m (2022 £258m). The Group enters into cash flow hedges in order to manage all material firm transactional exposures. The estimated impact on fair value gains and losses in other reserves of a ten cent movement in the closing sterling to US dollar exchange rates on the transactional cash flow hedges is approximately £16m (2022 £94m). The estimated impact of a ten cent movement in the closing sterling to euro exchange rate on the transactional cash flow hedges is approximately £35m (2022 £35m). Credit risk For trade receivables, contract receivables, amounts due from equity accounted investments and finance lease receivables, the Group measures a provision for expected credit losses at an amount equal to lifetime expected credit losses, estimated by reference to past experience and relevant forward-looking factors. The Group’s assessment is that credit risk in relation to defence-related sales to government customers or subcontractors to governments is extremely low as the probability of default is insignificant; therefore the provision for expected credit losses is immaterial in respect of receivables from these customers. For all non-government commercial customers, the Group assesses expected credit losses, including risk arising from global economic uncertainty; however, this is not considered material to the financial statements. The Group considers that default has occurred when a receivable is past 180 days overdue, because historical experience indicates that these receivables are generally not recoverable. The Group recognises a provision of 100% against all receivables over 180 days past due unless there is evidence that individual receivables in this category are recoverable. The carrying amount of the Group’s financial assets represents the maximum exposure to credit risk. Movements on the provision for expected credit losses are as follows: 2023 2022 £m £m At 1 January 20 15 Net remeasurement of loss allowance 3 7 Amounts written off (3) (2) At 31 December 20 20 For contract receivables, amounts due from equity accounted investments and finance lease receivables the expected credit loss provision is immaterial as the probability of default is considered insignificant. The Group writes off a receivable when there is evidence that the debtor is in significant financial difficulty and there is no realistic prospect of recovery, for example, when a debtor enters bankruptcy or financial reorganisation. None of the trade receivables that were written off during the year are still subject to enforcement activity. The ageing of trade receivables is detailed below: 2023 2022 Gross Provision Net Gross Provision Net £m £m £m £m £m £m Not past due 822 – 822 969 – 969 Up to 180 days overdue 336 (1) 335 499 (1) 498 Past 180 days overdue 58 (19) 39 58 (19) 39 1,216 (20) 1,196 1,526 (20) 1,506 Cash management Cash flow forecasting is performed by the businesses on a monthly basis. The Group monitors a rolling forecast of its liquidity requirements to ensure that there is sufficient cash to meet operational needs and maintain adequate headroom. Surplus cash held by the businesses over and above balances required for working capital management is loaned to the Group’s centralised treasury department. Surplus cash is invested in instant-access current accounts, short-term deposits and money market funds, choosing instruments with appropriate maturities or sufficient liquidity to provide adequate headroom as determined by cash flow forecasts. The Group’s objective is to monitor and control counterparty credit risk and credit limit utilisation. The Group adopts a conservative approach to the investment of its surplus cash which is deposited for short periods with financial institutions with investment-grade (BBB- and above) credit ratings. The cash and cash equivalents balance at 31 December 2023 of £4,067m (2022 £3,107m) was invested with 42 (2022 44) financial institutions. A credit limit is allocated to each institution taking account of its market capitalisation, credit rating and credit default swap price. The cash and cash equivalents of the Group are invested in non-speculative financial instruments which are usually highly liquid, such as short-term deposits. Therefore, the Group believes it has reduced its exposure to counterparty credit risk through this process. 185 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Additional informationGovernance Financial statementsStrategic report Notes to the Consolidated financial statements continued 15. Other financial assets and liabilities and financial risk management conti nued Credit risk continued The cash and cash equivalents balance is subject to review for impairment under IFRS 9, and due to the high credit ratings of the counterparties set out below, no impairment has been recognised within the year: Counterparty credit rating at 31 December 2023 2022 AAA to AA- 60% 67% A+ to A- 39% 32% BBB+ to BBB- 1% 1% Offsetting financial assets and liabilities Financial assets and liabilities are offset, and the net amount reported in the balance sheet, when there is a legally enforceable right to offset the recognised amounts. The following table sets out the Group’s financial assets and financial liabilities which are subject to a master netting agreement. The master netting agreements regulate settlement amounts in the event a party defaults on their obligations. 2023 2022 Balance Amounts Net Balance Amounts Net sheet not offset balances sheet not offset balances £m £m £m £m £m £m Assets Other financial assets 432 (382) 50 574 (455) 119 Liabilities Other financial liabilities (522) 382 (140) (600) 455 (145) 16. Deferred tax A deferred tax asset is recognised for unused tax losses, tax credits and deductible temporary differences to the extent that it is probable that future taxable profits will be available against which they can be utilised. Deferred tax assets are reviewed at each reporting date and reduced to the extent that it is no longer probable that the related tax benefit will be realised. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are offset if there is a legally enforceable right to offset current tax liabilities and assets, and they relate to income taxes levied by the same tax authority on the same taxable entity, or on different taxable entities, but they intend to settle current tax liabilities and assets on a net basis or their tax assets and liabilities will be realised simultaneously. Deferred tax assets/(liabilities) Net balance at Deferred tax assets Deferred tax liabilities 31 December 2023 2022 2023 2022 2023 2022 £m £m £m £m £m £m Property, plant and equipment 17 48 (118) (126) (101) (78) Intangible assets 41 15 (2) (2) 39 13 Capitalised research and development 458 149 – – 458 149 Provisions and accruals 229 233 – – 229 233 Goodwill – – (352) (352) (352) (352) Pension/post-employment schemes: Deficits 80 97 – – 80 97 UK additional pension contributions – 60 – – – 60 US deferred compensation plans 106 102 – – 106 102 Share-based payments 94 64 – – 94 64 Financial instruments 21 17 (1) (1) 20 16 Other items, including tax losses carried forward 28 45 (2) (16) 26 29 Deferred tax assets/(liabilities) 1,074 830 (475) (497) 599 333 Set off of tax (465) (492) 465 492 – – Net deferred tax assets/(liabilities) 609 338 (10) (5) 599 333 186 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Consolidated financial statements 16. Deferred tax continued Movement in temporary differences during the year At Foreign At 1 January exchange Acquisitions Recognised Recognised 31 December 2023 adjustments and disposals in income in equity 2023 £m £m £m £m £m £m Property, plant and equipment (78) 7 – (30) – (101) Intangible assets 13 – – 26 – 39 Capitalised research and development 149 (17) – 326 – 458 Provisions and accruals 233 (13) – 9 – 229 Goodwill (352) 21 – (21) – (352) Pension/post-employment schemes: Deficits 97 (3) – (2) (12) 80 UK additional pension contributions 60 – – – (60) – US deferred compensation plans 102 (6) – 10 – 106 Share-based payments 64 – – 13 17 94 Financial instruments 16 – – 1 3 20 Other items, including tax losses carried forward 29 (5) – 2 – 26 333 (16) – 334 (52) 599 At Foreign At 1 January exchange Acquisitions Recognised Recognised 31 December 2022 adjustments and disposals in income in equity 2022 £m £m £m £m £m £m Property, plant and equipment (59) (12) – (7) – (78) Intangible assets 15 2 (13) 9 – 13 Capitalised research and development – 4 – 145 – 149 Provisions and accruals 203 25 – 5 – 233 Goodwill (302) (39) – (11) – (352) Pension/post-employment schemes: Deficits 430 3 – 20 (356) 97 UK additional pension contributions 118 – – – (58) 60 US deferred compensation plans 110 13 – (21) – 102 Share-based payments 28 – – 12 24 64 Financial instruments (9) 1 – 3 21 16 Other items, including tax losses carried forward 11 3 – 15 – 29 545 – (13) 170 (369) 333 Unrecognised deferred tax assets and liabilities Deferred tax assets have not been recognised in respect of the following items: 2023 2022 Unrecognised Unrecognised Gross deferred Gross deferred amount tax asset amount tax asset £m £m £m £m Deductible temporary differences, including tax credits 2 2 9 9 Tax losses carried forward 438 89 464 93 440 91 473 102 These assets have not been recognised as the incidence of future profits in the relevant countries and legal entities cannot be accurately predicted at this time. The Group has not recognised any deferred tax liability on temporary differences totalling £211m (2022 £189m) relating to potentially taxable unremitted earnings of overseas subsidiaries and equity accounted investments because the Group is in a position to control the timing of the reversal of the temporary differences and none are expected to reverse in the foreseeable future. Both the recognised and unrecognised UK deferred tax balances at 31 December 2023 have been calculated at 25% (2022 blended rate of 24.2%). This reflects the increase in the UK corporation tax rate from 19% to 25% with effect from 1 April 2023. An adjustment has been made to reflect the fact that UK deferred tax balances are expected to unwind at 25%. 187 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Additional informationGovernance Financial statementsStrategic report Notes to the Consolidated financial statements continued 17. Inventories Inventories are stated at the lower of cost, including all relevant overhead expenditure, and net realisable value. Inventory cost is valued using the most appropriate method based on the business use of inventory. In the majority of cases this is moving average unit cost, with some businesses using standard cost or first in first out (FIFO) as methods more indicative of their use of inventory. 2023 2022 £m £m Raw materials and consumables 646 535 Work-in-progress 437 372 Finished goods and goods for resale 73 69 1,156 976 The Group recognised £4m (2022 £26m) as a write down of inventories to net realisable value. 18. Current tax Current tax for the current and prior years is recognised as a liability to the extent that it has not yet been settled, and as an asset to the extent that the amounts already paid exceed the amount due or the benefit of a tax loss can be carried back to recover current tax of a prior year. Current tax assets and liabilities are measured at the amount expected to be paid to or recovered from tax authorities, using the rates that have been enacted or substantively enacted by the balance sheet date. 2023 2022 £m £m Tax provisions (370) (145) Research and development expenditure credits receivable 156 131 Other tax receivables 89 44 (125) 30 Represented by: Current tax assets 160 133 Current tax liabilities (285) (103) (125) 30 Tax provisions of £370m (2022 £145m) are in respect of known tax issues, of which £299m (2022 £87m) relates to the US, £71m (2022 £56m) relates to the UK and £nil (2022 £2m) relates to other territories. The majority of the current tax provisions relate to the timing of tax reliefs. Corresponding deferred tax assets are therefore recognised in relation to the same tax judgements, including in relation to most of the increase in the year. 19. Cash and cash equivalents Cash and cash equivalents includes cash in hand, call and term deposits, investments in money market funds and other short-term liquid investments with original maturities of three months or less and which are subject to an insignificant risk of change in value. For the purpose of the cash flow statement, cash and cash equivalents also includes bank overdrafts that are repayable on demand and which form an integral part of the Group’s cash management. 2023 2022 £m £m Cash 502 484 Money market funds 1,375 1,149 Short-term deposits 2,190 1,474 4,067 3,107 Cash and cash equivalents includes £59m (2022 £55m) which is subject to regulatory restrictions and is therefore not available for general use by other entities within the Group. 188 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Consolidated financial statements 20. Geographical analysis of assets Analysis of non-current assets by geographical location Asset location Note 2023 2022 £m £m UK 4,877 4,563 Rest of Europe 2,065 1,965 US 10,167 10,719 Kingdom of Saudi Arabia 533 586 Australia 499 518 Rest of Asia and Pacific 8 5 18,149 18,356 Other investments 13 84 99 Other receivables 14 418 416 Post-employment benefit surpluses 24 804 1,297 Other financial assets 15 227 322 Deferred tax assets 16 609 338 Non-current assets 20,291 20,828 21. Loans and overdrafts Loans and overdrafts are recognised initially at fair value, less attributable transaction costs. Subsequent to initial recognition, loans and overdrafts are stated at amortised cost. Any difference between the amount initially recognised and the redemption value is recognised in the income statement over the period of the borrowings. 2023 2022 £m £m Non-current US$800m 3.8% bond, repayable 2024 – 664 US$750m 3.85% bond, repayable 2025 587 621 US$500m 7.5% bond, repayable 2027 392 415 US$1,300m 3.4% bond, repayable 2030 1,013 1,073 US$1,000m 1.9% bond, repayable 2031 778 824 US$400m 5.8% bond, repayable 2041 311 330 US$550m 4.75% bond, repayable 2044 423 447 US$1,000m 3% bond, repayable 2050 770 815 US$200m 5.5%, private placement, repayable 2050 158 – 4,432 5,189 Current US$800m 3.8% bond, repayable 2024 627 – Accrued interest 52 53 679 53 The proceeds received under the US$200m private placement are being used in the construction of a modern shiplift at our Jacksonville, Florida ship repair facility. US$500m of the US$800m 3.8% bond, repayable 2024, has been converted to a floating rate bond by utilising interest rate swaps that mature in October 2024 and had an effective rate during 2023 of 5.7%. The US$500m 7.5% bond, repayable 2027, was converted at issue to a sterling fixed rate bond by utilising cross-currency swaps and had an effective rate during 2023 of 7.7%. US$1,237m of the US$1,300m 3.4% bond, repayable 2030, was converted at issue to a sterling fixed rate bond by utilising cross-currency swaps and had an effective rate during 2023 of 3.5%. The US$400m 5.8% bond, repayable 2041, has been converted to a floating rate bond by utilising interest rate swaps that mature in October 2024 and had an effective rate during 2023 of 8.8%. 189 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Additional informationGovernance Financial statementsStrategic report Notes to the Consolidated financial statements continued 22. Contract liabilities Contract liabilities represent the obligation to transfer goods or services to a customer for which consideration has been received, or consideration is due, from the customer. 2023 2022 £m £m Non-current Contract liabilities 1,955 945 Current Contract liabilities 3,865 3,882 5,820 4,827 Revenue recognised in the year includes £3,573m (2022 £2,393m) that was included in the opening contract liabilities balance. Non-current and current contract liabilities as at 1 January 2022 were £519m and £2,874m, respectively. The increase in contract liabilities since 2022 is primarily due to customer advances received during the year. 23. Trade and other payables Trade and other payables are stated at amortised cost. US deferred compensation plan liabilities represent the present value of expected future payments required to settle the obligation to employees in accordance with IAS 19 Employee Benefits. 2023 2022 Note £m £m Non-current Accruals 68 50 Amounts owed to equity accounted investments 30 10 8 Deferred income 1,144 1,006 US deferred compensation plan liabilities 361 357 Other payables 11 20 1,594 1,441 Current Trade payables 866 839 Amounts owed to equity accounted investments 30 1,534 1,061 Other taxes and social security costs 73 76 Accruals 2,600 2,679 Deferred income 61 109 US deferred compensation plan liabilities 42 39 Other payables 260 187 5,436 4,990 1 1 1. Includes £1,192m (2022 £1,041m) of funding received from the UK Government for property, plant and equipment at Barrow-in-Furness, UK. 190 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Consolidated financial statements 24. Post-employment benefits Pension schemes Defined contribution Obligations for contributions are recognised as an expense in the income statement as incurred. Defined benefit The cost of providing benefits is determined periodically by independent actuaries and charged to the income statement in the year in which those benefits are earned by the employees. Remeasurements, including actuarial gains and losses, are recognised in the Consolidated statement of comprehensive income in the year in which they occur. Past service costs resulting from a plan amendment or curtailment are recognised immediately in the income statement. The post-employment benefit surpluses and obligations recognised in the Group’s balance sheet represent the fair value of scheme assets, less the present value of the defined benefit obligations calculated using a number of actuarial assumptions as set out on page 195. The bid values of scheme assets are not intended to be realised in the short term and may be subject to significant change before they are realised. The present values of scheme liabilities are derived from cash flow projections over long periods and are, therefore, inherently uncertain. IAS 19 Employee Benefits limits the measurement of a defined benefit surplus to the lower of the surplus in the defined benefit scheme and the asset ceiling. The asset ceiling is the present value of any economic benefits available in the form of refunds from the scheme or reductions in future contributions to the scheme. IFRIC 14 – The Limit on a Defined Benefit Asset, Minimum Funding Requirements and their Interaction, issued in 2007, provides an interpretation of the requirements of IAS 19, clarifying that a refund is available if the entity has an unconditional right to a refund in certain circumstances. The Group has applied IFRIC 14 and has determined that there is no limit on the recognition of the surpluses in its defined benefit pension schemes as at 31 December 2023. In the UK the surpluses have been recognised on the basis that the future economic benefits are unconditionally available to the Group, which is assumed to be via a refund. These have been recognised after deducting a 35% withholding tax which would be levied prior to the future refunding of any surplus and have been presented on a net basis as this is not deemed to be an income tax. MBDA participates in the Group’s defined benefit schemes and, as these are multi-employer schemes, the Group has allocated a share of the IAS 19 pension surpluses and deficits to MBDA based on the relative payroll contributions of active members or actual obligations where known. Whilst this methodology is intended to reflect a reasonable estimate of the share of the surplus or deficit, it may not accurately reflect the obligations of the participating employers. In the event that an employer who participates in the Group’s pension schemes fails or cannot be compelled to fulfil its obligations as a participating employer, the remaining participating employers are obliged to collectively take on its obligations. The Group considers the likelihood of this event arising as remote. The Group’s share of the IAS 19 pension surplus or deficit allocated to equity accounted investments is included in the balance sheet within equity accounted investments. Background Pension schemes BAE Systems plc operates pension schemes for the Group’s qualifying employees in the UK, US and other countries. The UK and US operate a number of funded defined benefit schemes, and the assets are held in separate trustee-administered funds. The largest funded defined benefit scheme is the BAE Systems Pension Scheme – BAE Systems Section (Main Scheme) which represents 93% (2022 93%) of the UK IAS 19 defined benefit obligation at 31 December 2023. The schemes in other countries are primarily defined contribution schemes. At 31 December 2023, the weighted average durations of the UK and US defined benefit pension obligations were 13 years (2022 13 years) and 11 years (2022 12 years), respectively. The split of the defined benefit pension liability on a funding basis between active, deferred and pensioner members for the Main Scheme and US schemes in aggregate is set out below: Active Deferred Pensioner % % % Main Scheme 1 28 21 51 US schemes 24 16 60 2 1. Source: 31 March 2021 actuarial valuation reports. 2. Source: Annual updates of the US schemes as at 1 January 2023. 191 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Additional informationGovernance Financial statementsStrategic report Notes to the Consolidated financial statements continued 24. Post-employment benefits continued Regulatory framework The funded UK schemes are registered and subject to the statutory scheme-specific funding requirements outlined in UK legislation, including the payment of levies to the Pension Protection Fund as set out in the Pension Act 2004. These schemes were established under trust and the responsibility for their governance lies jointly with the Trustees and the Group. The funded US schemes are tax-qualified pension schemes regulated by the Pension Protection Act 2006 and insured by the Pension Benefit Guaranty Corporation (PBGC) up to certain limits. These schemes were established under, and are governed by, the US Employee Retirement Income Security Act 1974 and the BAE Systems Administrative Committee is a named fiduciary with the authority to manage their operation. The schemes’ assets are held in the BAE Systems Master Pension Investment Trust and the trustee is The Northern Trust Company. The US schemes received a favourable determination letter from the Internal Revenue Service (IRS) dated 6 July 2017, stating that the US schemes and related Master Trust are designed in accordance with applicable sections of the IRS Code and, therefore, are exempt from taxation. Once qualified, the US schemes are required to operate in conformity with the Code to maintain qualification. Benefits The UK defined benefit schemes provide benefits to members in the form of a set level of pension payable for life based on members’ final salaries. The benefits attract inflation-related increases both in deferment and payment. All UK defined benefit schemes are closed to new entrants, with benefits for new employees being provided through a defined contribution scheme. The Normal Retirement Age for the majority of active members of the Main Scheme is 65. Specific benefits applicable to members differ between schemes. Further details on the benefits provided by each scheme are provided on the BAE Systems Pensions website: baesystems.com/en-pensions/home The US defined benefit schemes cover eligible employees of BAE Systems, Inc. and certain adopting affiliates providing benefits based on each employee’s final salary and service. The US defined benefit schemes ceased to be final salary schemes in January 2013. Since then an annual accrual of $1,000 is credited to participants’ accumulated plan benefits. Vested benefits are payable upon retirement, death, disability, and in certain circumstances upon termination of employment. The Normal Retirement Age for the US pension schemes is 65. Other post-employment benefits The Group operates a number of non-pension retirement benefit schemes, under which certain employees are eligible to receive benefits after retirement or on leaving the Group, the majority of which relate to the provision of medical benefits to retired employees of the Group’s subsidiaries in the US. Funding Introduction Disclosures in respect of pension funding are provided below. Disclosures in respect of pension accounting under IAS 19 are provided on pages 195 to 202. The majority of the UK and US defined benefit pension schemes are funded by the Group’s subsidiaries and equity accounted investments. The individual pension schemes’ funding requirements are based on actuarial measurement frameworks set out in their funding policies. For funding valuation purposes, pension scheme assets are included at market value at the valuation date, whilst the liabilities are measured on an actuarial funding basis using the projected unit credit method and discounted to their present value based on prudent assumptions set by the Trustees following consultation with scheme actuaries. The funding valuations are performed by professionally qualified independent actuaries and include assumptions which differ from the actuarial assumptions used for IAS 19 accounting purposes shown on page 195. The purpose of the funding valuations is to design funding plans which ensure that the schemes have sufficient funds available to meet future benefit payments. 192 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Consolidated financial statements 24. Post-employment benefits continued Funding contin ued UK valuations Funding valuations of the Group’s UK defined benefit pension schemes are performed at least every three years. Following the accelerated payment in 2021 of the remaining sponsor deficit reduction contributions under the previously agreed deficit recovery plan, the Group and Trustees agreed to carry out an early triennial funding valuation for the Main Scheme as at 31 March 2021. This valuation was concluded and signed off on 30 June 2022. The results of the most recent triennial valuation for the Main Scheme are shown below. This valuation was agreed with the Trustees and certified by the Scheme Actuary after consultation with The Pensions Regulator in the UK. Main Scheme as at 31 March 2021 £bn Market value of assets 22.9 Present value of liabilities (22.9) Funding surplus – Percentage of accrued benefits covered by the assets at the valuation date 100% The other UK schemes were all in surplus at their most recent triennial valuations. The valuations were determined using the following mortality assumptions: Life expectancy of a male currently aged 65 (years) 86 – 89 Life expectancy of a female currently aged 65 (years) 88 – 90 Life expectancy of a male at age 65, currently aged 45 (years) 88 – 91 Life expectancy of a female at age 65, currently aged 45 (years) 90 – 93 As part of the process of the Main Scheme’s 2021 valuation, the Trustees and the Group agreed to update the methodology to use a cash flow matching strategy, such that assets are invested with the aim of the expected income directly matching the expected benefit payments of the Main Scheme. The cash flow matching strategy aims to manage risk through a defined amount of risk buffer assets, which equate to the agreed prudence margin in the valuation. The risk buffer assets are measured over time to ensure the Main Scheme is sufficiently funded. The asset portfolio is currently invested in a selection of bonds designed to match the pension payments for current pensioners, as well as a mix of growth-seeking assets aimed to generate returns for the pension payments for future pensioners. Over time, assets from the return-seeking portfolio will be realised to purchase additional, lower-risk assets to match the increasing current pensioner payments. The valuations for the other schemes use a different method in that discount rates were directly based on prudent levels of expected returns for the assets held by the schemes, reflecting the planned investment strategies and maturity profiles of each scheme. The discount rates are curves which provide a different rate for each year into the future. Under IAS 19, the discount rate for accounting purposes is based on third-party AA corporate bond yields. The inflation assumptions for each of the valuations were derived based on the difference between the yields, on index-linked and fixed-interest long-term government bonds. The inflation assumption is a curve which provides a different rate for each year into the future. There have been no changes to the contributions or benefits, as set out in the rules of the schemes, for pension scheme members as a result of the new funding valuations. The results of future triennial valuations and associated funding requirements will be impacted by a number of factors, including the future performance of investment markets and anticipated members’ longevity. US valuations The Group’s US pension schemes are valued annually, with the latest valuations performed as at 1 January 2023. The actuarial present value of accumulated plan benefits is determined by an independent actuary and uses actuarial assumptions to adjust the accumulated plan benefits earned by participants to reflect the time value of money and the probability of payment between the valuation date and the expected date of payment. 193 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Additional informationGovernance Financial statementsStrategic report Notes to the Consolidated financial statements continued 24. Post-employment benefits continued Funding contin ued Contributions Under the terms of the trust deeds of the UK schemes, the Group is required to have a funding plan determined at the conclusion of the triennial funding valuations. Equity accounted investments make regular contributions to the schemes in which they participate in line with the schedule of contributions and are allocated a share of funding contributions. In 2023, total employer contributions to the Group’s pension schemes were £274m (2022 £267m), including amounts funded by equity accounted investments of £30m (2022 £23m), and included approximately £68m (2022 £45m) of payments associated with the share buyback programme in respect of the Main Scheme. Contributions in 2024 to the Group’s pension schemes are expected to be at a similar level to 2023. Risk management The defined benefit pension schemes expose the Group to actuarial risks, including market (investment) risk, interest rate risk, inflation risk and longevity risk. Risk Mitigation Market (investment) risk The investment portfolios are highly diversified, investing in a wide range of assets, in order to reduce Asset returns may not move the exposure of the total portfolio to a materially adverse impact from a single security or type of in line with the liabilities and security. To reduce volatility, certain assets are held in a matching portfolio, which largely consists may be subject to volatility. of index-linked bonds, gilts and swaps, designed to mirror movements in corresponding liabilities. Some 36% (2022 42%) of the Group’s pension scheme assets are held in equities and pooled investment vehicles due to the higher expected level of return over the long term. The UK Main Scheme reduced its allocation to equities significantly over the course of 2023, and closed out its equity option strategy to reflect its limited resultant exposure to equity markets. Environmental (including exposure to climate related risks), Social and Governance (ESG) factors are incorporated into the investment analysis and decision-making process carried out by the Trustees of the UK schemes. There is alignment between the UK Main Scheme and Company’s climate change objectives with consistent long-term net zero ambitions. Interest rate risk As part of the funding valuation finalised during 2022, the main UK Scheme has adopted a cash flow Liabilities are sensitive to matching strategy, whereby contractual income from assets is designed to directly match benefits paid movements in interest rates, to members each year. A portfolio of assets with contractual income has been structured to match with lower interest rates leading to an benefits already in payment, representing around half of the liabilities. This inherently hedges the increase in the valuation of liabilities. associated interest rate risk. As members retire and become pensioners, additional matching assets will be purchased to keep pace. Interest rate risk associated with the remaining purchase of matching assets is mitigated via a hedging strategy involving mainly physical assets and derivatives. The overall level of interest rate hedging on the funding basis has increased compared to 2022. Inflation risk The main UK Scheme’s cash flow matching strategy includes aligning asset income to the inflation- Liabilities are sensitive to linked members’ benefit payments. Inflation risk is mitigated by the presence of caps on most inflation- movements in inflation, with linked benefits and via a hedging strategy, executed with several banks to reduce counterparty risk. higher inflation leading to an increase The overall level of inflation hedging on the funding basis has increased compared 2022. in the valuation of liabilities. The Group’s US scheme benefits are not indexed with inflation. In 201 4, the Main Scheme implemented a pension increase exchange to allow retired members to elect for a higher current pension in exchange for foregoing certain rights to future pension increases. Longevity risk Longevity adjustment factors are used in the majority of the UK pension schemes in order to adjust Liabilities are sensitive to the pension benefits payable so as to share the cost of people living longer with employees. life expectancy, with increases In 201 3, with the agreement of the Company, the Trustees of the 2000 Plan, Royal Ordnance Pension in life expectancies leading Scheme and Shipbuilding Industries Pension Scheme (SIPS) entered into arrangements with Legal & to an increase in the valuation General to insure against longevity risk for the current pensioner population, covering a total of £4.4bn of liabilities. of pension scheme liabilities. These arrangements reduce the funding volatility relating to increasing life expectancy. This longevity risk cover with Legal & General remains in place following the 2019 merger of the 2000 Plan and SIPS into the Main Scheme. Virgin Media case The Company is aware of the ongoing ‘Virgin Media v NTL Pension Trustees Ltd and others’ case and that there is a potential for the outcome of the case to have an impact on the UK schemes. The case affects defined benefit schemes that provided contracted-out benefits before 6 April 2016 based on meeting the reference scheme test. Where scheme rules were amended, potentially impacting benefits accrued from 6 April 1997 to 6 April 2016, schemes needed the actuary to confirm that the reference scheme test was still being met by providing written confirmation under Section 37 of the Pension Schemes Act 1993. In the Virgin Media case the judge ruled that alterations to the scheme rules were void and ineffective because of the absence of written actuarial confirmation required under Section 37 of the Pension Schemes Act 1993. The case has been taken to The Court of Appeal, with the hearing set for June 2024. The potential impact on the UK schemes is not yet known but continues to be assessed. 194 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Consolidated financial statements 24. Post-employment benefits continued IAS 19 accounting The disclosures below relate to post-retirement benefit schemes in the UK, US and other countries which are accounted for as defined benefit schemes in accordance with IAS 19. Principal actuarial assumptions The assumptions used are estimates chosen from a range of possible actuarial assumptions which, due to the long-term nature of the obligation covered, may not necessarily occur in practice. UK US 2023 2022 2021 2023 2022 2021 Financial assumptions Discount rate – past service (%) 4.5 4.8 1.9 4.8 5.0 2.8 Discount rate – future service (%) 4.6 4.8 1.9 4.8 5.0 2.8 Retail Prices Index (RPI) inflation (%) 2.8 3.0 3.1 n/a n/a n/a Rate of increase in salaries (%) 2.8 3.0 3.1 n/a n/a n/a Rate of increase in deferred pensions (CPI/RPI) (%) 2.1/2.8 2.3/3.0 2.4/3.1 n/a n/a n/a Rate of increase in pensions in payment (%) 1.6 – 3.6 1.7 – 3.6 1.7 – 3.7 n/a n/a n/a Demographic assumptions Life expectancy of a male currently aged 65 (years) 85 – 89 86 – 89 86 – 89 88 87 87 Life expectancy of a female currently aged 65 (years) 88 – 89 88 – 90 88 – 90 89 89 89 Life expectancy of a male currently aged 45 (years) 86 – 89 87 – 90 86 – 90 87 87 87 Life expectancy of a female currently aged 45 (years) 89 – 90 89 – 91 89 – 91 89 89 89 Discount rate The discount rate assumptions are derived through discounting the projected benefit payments using a third-party AA corporate bond yield curve to produce a single equivalent discount rate for the UK and US territories. This inherently captures the maturity profile of the expected benefit payments. For the UK territory, the discount rate used for future service differs from that used for past service as it only uses the cash flows relating to active members, which have a different duration. Further information on the duration of the schemes is detailed on page 191. Retail Prices Index (RPI) and Consumer Prices Index (CPI) inflation In the UK, the inflation assumptions are derived by reference to the difference between the yields on index-linked and fixed-interest long-term government bonds. Index-linked government bond prices contain a premium that investors are willing to pay to mitigate the risk that RPI inflation is higher than expected. To account for this, the RPI assumption includes an inflation risk premium deduction. The inflation risk premium deduction has been set at 0.55% per annum (2022 0.55%) and the CPI assumption has been set at 0.7% per annum (2022 0.7%) lower than RPI. The resulting RPI assumption is 2.8% per annum and the CPI assumption is 2.1% per annum. The 0.7% per annum RPI-CPI differential is a weighted average of a 1% per annum differential pre-2030 and 0.1% per annum differential post-2030; this reflects the anticipated change to the RPI index from 2030. In the US, inflation assumptions are not relevant as the Group’s US pension schemes are not indexed with inflation. Rate of increase in salaries The rate of increase in salaries for the UK schemes is assumed to be RPI inflation of 2.8% (2022 RPI inflation of 3.0%), plus a promotional scale. From 1 January 2013, employees in the US schemes no longer accrue salary-related benefits. Rate of increase in deferred pensions The rate of increase in deferred pensions for the UK schemes is based on CPI inflation of 2.1% (2022 CPI inflation of 2.3%), with the exception of the legacy 2000 Plan, which is based on RPI inflation of 2.8% (2022 RPI inflation of 3.0%). For all UK schemes, the rate of increase in deferred pensions is subject to inflation caps. Rate of increase in pensions in payment The rate of increase in pensions in payment differs between UK schemes. Different tranches of the schemes’ benefits increase at rates based on either RPI or CPI inflation, and some are subject to an inflation cap. With the exception of two smaller schemes, the rate of increase in pensions in payment is based on RPI inflation. Life expectancy For its UK pension schemes, the Group has used the Self-Administered Pension Schemes S3 mortality tables based on year of birth (as published by the Institute and Faculties of Actuaries) for both pensioner and non-pensioner members, in conjunction with the results of an investigation into the actual mortality experience of scheme members and information on the demographic profile of the scheme’s membership. In addition, to allow for future improvements in longevity, the Continuous Mortality Investigation 2022 tables (published by the Institute of Actuaries) have been used (in 2022, the Continuous Mortality Investigation 2021 tables were used), with an assumed long-term rate of mortality improvements of 1.0% per annum (2022 1.0%), an initial rate adjustment parameter (‘A’) of 0.2% (2022 0.25%), a smoothing parameter (‘Sk’) of 7 (2022 7) and the following weighting (‘W’) parameters: W2022 35% (2022 n/a); W2021 0% (2022 7.5%); and W2020 0% (2022 7.5%). For the majority of the US schemes, the mortality tables used at 31 December 2023 are a blend of the fully generational PRI-2012 White Collar table and the PRI-2012 Blue Collar table, both projected using Scale MP-2021. 195 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Additional informationGovernance Financial statementsStrategic report Notes to the Consolidated financial statements continued 24. Post-employment benefits continued IAS 19 accounting continued US healthcare schemes The latest valuations of the principal schemes, covering retiree medical and life insurance schemes in certain US subsidiaries, were performed by independent actuaries as at 1 January 2023. These valuations were rolled forward to reflect the information at 31 December 2023. The method of accounting for these is similar to that used for defined benefit pension schemes. Long-term healthcare cost is assumed to increase at 5.0% per annum (2022 4.7%). This is based on an assumed increase in 2023 of 7.75% for pre-retirement and 6.25% for post-retirement, with both rates then reducing to 4.5% by 2033 and remaining at 4.5% per annum each year thereafter. Summary of movements in post-employment benefit obligations US and UK other Total £m £m £m Total net IAS 19 surplus/(deficit) at 1 January 2023 (net of withholding tax) 1,236 (483) 753 Add back: withholding tax on surpluses 722 – 722 Total net IAS 19 surplus/(deficit) at 1 January 2023 1,958 (483) 1,475 Actual return on assets excluding amounts included in net finance costs (608) 124 (484) Increase in liabilities due to changes in financial assumptions (376) (52) (428) Decrease/(increase) in liabilities due to changes in demographic assumptions 38 (1) 37 Experience losses (111) (22) (133) Contributions in excess of/(less than) service cost 151 (12) 139 Settlements – 60 60 Net interest income/(expense) 106 (20) 86 Foreign exchange adjustments – 19 19 Movement in other schemes – (33) (33) Total net IAS 19 surplus/(deficit) at 31 December 2023 1,158 (420) 738 Withholding tax on surpluses (441) – (441) Total net IAS 19 surplus/(deficit) at 31 December 2023 (net of withholding tax) 717 (420) 297 Allocated to equity accounted investments (68) – (68) Group’s share of net IAS 19 surplus/(deficit) excluding Group’s share of amounts allocated to equity accounted investments at 31 December 2023 649 (420) 229 Settlement gain In May 2023, $1.2bn (£1.0bn) of the US defined benefit obligation liabilities were settled via a transfer to an insurance company. The premium of $1.1bn (£0.9bn) was approximately 95% of the IAS 19 liability carrying value, creating a one-off accounting gain. Since the half-year 2023 results, the asset valuations for the settlement have been finalised, resulting in an additional gain of £9m. The total gain is now $75m (£60m). This gain has been recognised in the Consolidated income statement, and as an adjusting item. Surplus recognition A number of schemes are in an accounting surplus position. The surpluses have been recognised on the basis that the future economic benefits are unconditionally available to the Group, which is assumed to be via a refund. On 22 November 2023, the UK government announced that the authorised surplus payments charge would be reduced from 35% to 25% from 6 April 2024. The legislation had not been legally enacted as at the date of issue of these financial statements. The surplus has been recognised net of withholding tax of 35% at 31 December 2023 (2022: 35%) based on the enacted legislation at that date. Should the legislation have been enacted at year-end, this would have resulted in an £0.1bn increase in the pension surplus. This tax would be levied prior to the future refunding of any surplus and therefore the surplus has been presented on a net basis as this is not deemed to be an income tax of the Group. 196 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Consolidated financial statements 24. Post-employment benefits continued IAS 19 accounting continued Amounts recognised on the balance sheet The table below shows a reconciliation between the gross assets and liabilities of the Group’s UK, US and other post-employment benefit schemes and the amounts recognised on the Group’s balance sheet after allocation to equity accounted investments. 2023 Kingdom UK defined US and of Saudi benefit other US Arabia end pension pension healthcare of service schemes schemes schemes benefit Total £m £m £m £m £m Present value of unfunded obligations (105) (98) – (168) (371) Present value of funded obligations (19,913) (2,838) (125) – (22,876) Fair value of scheme assets 21,176 2,629 180 – 23,985 Total net IAS 19 surplus/(deficit) 1,158 (307) 55 (168) 738 Withholding tax on surpluses (441) – – – (441) Allocated to equity accounted investments (68) – – – (68) Group’s share of net IAS 19 surplus/(deficit) 649 (307) 55 (168) 229 Represented by: Post-employment benefit surpluses 747 2 55 – 804 Post-employment benefit obligations (98) (309) – (168) (575) 649 (307) 55 (168) 229 Group’s share of net IAS 19 surplus of equity accounted investments 22 – – – 22 The US unfunded pension obligations have associated assets held in deferred compensation schemes with a fair value of £53m (2022 £57m), which are shown in Other Investments. The funds held in these trusts can be used solely for the satisfaction of the unfunded obligations. 2022 Kingdom UK defined US and of Saudi benefit other US Arabia end pension pension healthcare of service schemes schemes schemes benefit Total £m £m £m £m £m Present value of unfunded obligations (104) (105) – (142) (351) Present value of funded obligations (19,462) (3,927) (128) – (23,517) Fair value of scheme assets 21,524 3,629 190 – 25,343 Total net IAS 19 surplus/(deficit) 1,958 (403) 62 (142) 1,475 Withholding tax on surpluses (722) – – – (722) Allocated to equity accounted investments (107) – – – (107) Group’s share of net IAS 19 surplus/(deficit) 1,129 (403) 62 (142) 646 Represented by: Post-employment benefit surpluses 1,224 11 62 – 1,297 Post-employment benefit obligations (95) (414) – (142) (651) 1,129 (403) 62 (142) 646 Group’s share of net IAS 19 surplus of equity accounted investments 38 – – – 38 Total cumulative actuarial losses recognised in equity since the transition to IFRS are £1.8bn (2022 £1.1bn). 197 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Additional informationGovernance Financial statementsStrategic report Notes to the Consolidated financial statements continued 24. Post-employment benefits continued IAS 19 accounting continued Changes in the fair value of scheme assets before allocation to equity accounted investments Kingdom UK defined US and of Saudi benefit other US Arabia end pension pension healthcare of service schemes schemes schemes benefit Total £m £m £m £m £m Value of scheme assets at 1 January 2022 26,947 4,415 218 – 31,580 Interest income 490 132 6 – 628 Actual return on assets excluding amounts included in interest income (5,094) (1,199) (48) – (6,341) Actual return on assets (4,604) (1,067) (42) – (5,713) Contributions by employer 257 10 – 14 281 Contributions by employer in respect of employee salary sacrifice arrangements 72 – – – 72 Total contributions by employer 329 10 – 14 353 Members’ contributions 5 – – – 5 Administrative expenses (18) (7) (1) – (26) Foreign exchange translation – 521 26 – 547 Benefits paid (1,135) (243) (11) (14) (1,403) Value of scheme assets at 31 December 2022 21,524 3,629 190 – 25,343 Interest income 1,010 170 9 – 1,189 Actual return on assets excluding amounts included in interest income (608) 124 3 – (481) Actual return on assets 402 294 12 – 708 Contributions by employer 265 9 – 13 287 Contributions by employer in respect of employee salary sacrifice arrangements 72 – – – 72 Total contributions by employer 337 9 – 13 359 Members’ contributions 5 – – – 5 Settlements – (894) – – (894) Administrative expenses (24) (15) (1) – (40) Foreign exchange translation – (185) (11) – (196) Benefits paid (1,068) (209) (10) (13) (1,300) Value of scheme assets at 31 December 2023 21,176 2,629 180 – 23,985 198 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Consolidated financial statements 24. Post-employment benefits continued IAS 19 accounting continued Assets of defined benefit pension schemes 2023 UK US and other Total Quoted Unquoted Total Quoted Unquoted Total Quoted Unquoted Total £m £m £m £m £m £m £m £m £m Equities: UK 1 – 1 – – – 1 – 1 Overseas 226 – 226 – – – 226 – 226 Pooled investment vehicles – 7,706 7,706 655 – 655 655 7,706 8,361 Fixed-interest securities: UK gilts 2,376 – 2,376 – – – 2,376 – 2,376 UK corporates 2,884 1,752 4,636 – – – 2,884 1,752 4,636 Overseas government 35 – 35 595 – 595 630 – 630 Overseas corporates 1,721 – 1,721 1,276 – 1,276 2,997 – 2,997 Index-linked securities: UK gilts 2,193 – 2,193 – – – 2,193 – 2,193 UK corporates 1,084 – 1,084 – – – 1,084 – 1,084 Overseas government – – – – – – – – – Overseas corporates 41 – 41 – – – 41 – 41 Property – 1,441 1,441 – 29 29 – 1,470 1,470 Derivatives – (1,285) (1,285) – 5 5 – (1,280) (1,280) Cash: Sterling 577 174 751 – – – 577 174 751 Foreign currency 244 – 244 69 – 69 313 – 313 Other – 6 6 – – – – 6 6 Total 11,382 9,794 21,176 2,595 34 2,629 13,977 9,828 23,805 1 2 3 4 2022 UK US and other Total Quoted Unquoted Total Quoted Unquoted Total Quoted Unquoted Total £m £m £m £m £m £m £m £m £m Equities: UK 209 – 209 – – – 209 – 209 Overseas 624 – 624 – – – 624 – 624 Pooled investment vehicles 3 8,892 8,895 793 – 793 796 8,892 9,688 Fixed-interest securities: UK gilts 2,397 – 2,397 – – – 2,397 – 2,397 UK corporates 1,832 2,416 4,248 – – – 1,832 2,416 4,248 Overseas government 29 – 29 599 – 599 628 – 628 Overseas corporates 1,248 56 1,304 2,105 – 2,105 3,353 56 3,409 Index-linked securities: UK gilts 2,050 – 2,050 – – – 2,050 – 2,050 UK corporates – 952 952 – – – – 952 952 Overseas corporates 9 – 9 – – – 9 – 9 Property – 1,731 1,731 – 37 37 – 1,768 1,768 Derivatives – (1,595) (1,595) – – – – (1,595) (1,595) Cash: Sterling 566 84 650 – – – 566 84 650 Foreign currency 12 (1) 11 95 – 95 107 (1) 106 Other – 10 10 – – – – 10 10 Total 8,979 12,545 21,524 3,592 37 3,629 12,571 12,582 25,153 1 2 3 4 1. Includes £nil (2022 £3m) of the Company’s own ordinary shares. 2. Primarily invested in private markets and exchange traded funds. The amounts classified as unquoted primarily comprise investments in private markets, with the majority held in infrastructure, alternatives and direct funds, valued in accordance with International Private Equity and Venture Capital Valuation Guidelines. 3. Valued on the basis of open market value at the end of the year determined in accordance with the Royal Institution of Chartered Surveyors’ Appraisal and Valuation Standards and the Practice Note contained therein. Includes £233m (2022 £223m) of property occupied by Group companies. 4. Includes forward foreign exchange contracts, futures, and interest rate, inflation and longevity swaps. In addition, the total derivative figures shown are net of £449m (2022 £520m) of repurchase agreements. The valuations are based on valuation techniques using underlying market data and discounted cash flows. 199 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Additional informationGovernance Financial statementsStrategic report Notes to the Consolidated financial statements continued 24. Post-employment benefits continued IAS 19 accounting continued Longevity swap The Group holds longevity insurance contracts for some of its UK defined benefit pension schemes. These provide long-term protection and income to the underlying pension scheme in the event that insured members live longer than expected. The value of the longevity insurance contracts held by the Group are calculated by an actuary. They are measured by discounting the difference between the projected fixed and floating cash flows payable under the contracts, excluding the value of future projected fees. The significant assumptions used for this valuation are the discount rate and mortality assumptions; fair values for these assumptions are advised by an actuary based on external data and characteristics of the insured member population. At 31 December 2023, the longevity swap valuation leads to a negative adjustment to the assets which reflects that experience to date on the contracts has been higher than expected deaths. Changes in the present value of the defined benefit obligations before allocation to equity accounted investments UK defined US and Kingdom of benefit other US Saudi Arabia pension pension healthcare end of service schemes schemes schemes benefit Total £m £m £m £m £m Defined benefit obligations at 1 January 2022 (28,920) (4,643) (150) (153) (33,866) Current service cost (231) (12) (1) (27) (271) Contributions by employer in respect of employee salary sacrifice arrangements (72) – – – (72) Total current service cost (303) (12) (1) (27) (343) Members’ contributions (5) – – – (5) Past service cost – plan amendments 14 2 (1) – 15 Actuarial gain due to changes in financial assumptions 10,745 1,067 32 47 11, 891 Actuarial loss due to changes in demographic assumptions (39) – – – (39) Experience (losses)/gains (1,672) (6) 3 (4) (1,679) Interest expense (521) (138) (4) (5) (668) Foreign exchange translation – (545) (18) (14) (577) Benefits paid 1,135 243 11 14 1,403 Defined benefit obligations at 31 December 2022 (19,566) (4,032) (128) (142) (23,868) Current service cost (90) (6) (2) (20) (118) Contributions by employer in respect of employee salary sacrifice arrangements (72) – – – (72) Total current service cost (162) (6) (2) (20) (190) Members’ contributions (5) – – – (5) Past service cost – plan amendments – – (2) – (2) Settlements – 954 – – 954 Actuarial loss due to changes in financial assumptions (376) (52) (4) (13) (445) Actuarial gain/(loss) due to changes in demographic assumptions 38 (1) – – 37 Experience losses (111) (22) (1) (5) (139) Interest expense (904) (190) (6) (8) (1,108) Foreign exchange translation – 204 8 7 219 Benefits paid 1,068 209 10 13 1,300 Defined benefit obligations at 31 December 2023 (20,018) (2,936) (125) (168) (23,247) 200 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Consolidated financial statements 24. Post-employment benefits continued IAS 19 accounting continued Amounts recognised in the income statement after allocation to equity accounted investments 2023 UK defined US and benefit other pension pension Other schemes schemes schemes Total £m £m £m £m Included in operating costs: Current service cost (85) (6) (22) (113) Past service cost – plan amendments – – (2) (2) Administrative expenses (22) (15) (1) (38) (107) (21) (25) (153) Included in other income: Pensions settlement gain – 60 – 60 Included in net finance costs: Net interest income/(expense) on post-employment benefit obligations 66 (20) (5) 41 Group defined benefit schemes included in share of results of equity accounted investments: Group’s share of equity accounted investments’ operating costs (5) – – (5) Group’s share of equity accounted investments’ net finance income 3 – – 3 2022 UK defined US and benefit other pension pension Other schemes schemes schemes Total £m £m £m £m Included in operating costs: Current service cost (210) (12) (28) (250) Past service cost – plan amendments 13 2 (1) 14 Administrative expenses (16) (7) (1) (24) (213) (17) (30) (260) Included in net finance costs: Net interest expense on post-employment benefit obligations (28) (6) (3) (37) Group defined benefit schemes included in share of results of equity accounted investments: Group’s share of equity accounted investments’ operating costs (10) – – (10) Group’s share of equity accounted investments’ net finance costs (1) – – (1) Defined contribution schemes The Group incurred a charge of £309m (2022 £299m) in relation to defined contribution schemes for employees. 201 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Additional informationGovernance Financial statementsStrategic report Notes to the Consolidated financial statements continued 24. Post-employment benefits continued IAS 19 accounting continued Sensitivity analysis The sensitivity information has been derived using scenario analysis from the actuarial assumptions as at 31 December 2023 and keeping all other assumptions as set out on page 195. The pension schemes hold a number of unquoted pooled investment vehicles, which are investments in private markets. These are valued based on latest available valuation reports, and as noted on page 158, these valuations are subject to estimation uncertainty as their valuation techniques incorporate a number of assumptions, including those associated with the impact of climate change. Should these funds’ actual valuations at 31 December 2023 be on average 2% different to those assumed, this would result in a £0.2bn (2022 £0.2bn) change in the valuation of the assets. Financial assumptions The estimated impact of changes in the discount rate and inflation assumptions on the defined benefit pension obligation, together with the estimated impact on scheme assets, is shown in the table below. The estimated impact on scheme assets takes into account the Group’s risk management activities in respect of interest rate and inflation risk. The sensitivity analysis on the defined benefit obligation is measured on an IAS 19 accounting basis. Decrease/(increase) (Decrease)/increase in pension obligation in scheme assets £bn £bn Discount rate: 0.5 percentage point increase/decrease 1.3/(1.5) (1.3)/1.5 1.0 percentage point increase/decrease 2.5/(3.1) (2.5)/3.2 2.0 percentage point increase/decrease 4.6/(6.9) (4.5)/7.1 3.0 percentage point increase/decrease 6.3/(11.8) (6.1)/12.0 1 1 (Increase)/decrease Increase/(decrease) in pension obligation in scheme assets £bn £bn Inflation: 0.1 percentage point increase/decrease (0.1)/0.1 0.2/(0.2) 0.5 percentage point increase/decrease (0.7)/0.7 0.8/(0.8) 1.0 percentage point increase/decrease (1.4)/1.3 1.8/(1.5) 1 1 Demographic assumptions Changes in the life expectancy assumption, including the benefit of longevity swap arrangements (see longevity risk on page 194), would have the following effect on the total net IAS 19 surplus: (Decrease)/increase in net surplus £bn Life expectancy: One-year increase/decrease (0.8)/0.8 1 1. Before allocation to equity accounted investments and deduction of withholding tax. 202 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Consolidated financial statements 25. Provisions A provision is recognised in the balance sheet when the Group has a present legal or constructive obligation as a result of a past event, it is probable that an outflow of economic benefits will be required to settle the obligation and the amount has been reliably estimated. If the effect is material, provisions are determined by discounting the expected future cash flows at an appropriate pre-tax risk-free discount rate. Warranties and after-sales services Where warranties and after-sales services are provided in the normal course of business, provisions for associated costs are made based on an assessment of future claims with reference to past experience. A provision for warranties is recognised when the underlying products and services are sold. The provision is based on historical warranty data and a weighting of possible outcomes against their associated probabilities. Reorganisations A provision for restructuring is recognised when the Group has approved a detailed and formal restructuring plan, and the restructuring has either commenced or has been announced to those affected. The costs associated with the reorganisation programmes are supported by detailed plans and based on previous experience as well as other known factors. Future operating costs are not provided for. Legal, contractual and environmental The Group holds provisions for expected legal, contractual and environmental costs that it expects to incur over an extended period. Management exercises judgement to determine the amount of these provisions. Provision is made for known issues based on past experience of similar items and other known factors. Each provision is considered separately and the amount provided reflects the best estimate of the most likely amount, being the single most likely amount in a range of possible outcomes. Warranties Legal, and contractual after-sales and services Reorganisations environmental Other Total £m £m £m £m £m Non-current 57 9 244 28 338 Current 52 25 129 43 249 At 1 January 2023 109 34 373 71 587 Created 43 8 106 43 200 Utilised (27) (15) (77) (10) (129) Transfer from other balance sheet categories 2 – – – 2 Released (18) (8) (37) (19) (82) Net present value adjustments – – 7 1 8 Foreign exchange adjustments (4) (1) (10) (3) (18) At 31 December 2023 105 18 362 83 568 Represented by: Non-current 55 7 236 34 332 Current 50 11 126 49 236 105 18 362 83 568 Warranties and after-sales services Warranty and after-sales services provisions are generally utilised within three years post-delivery. Whilst actual events could result in potentially significant differences to the value, but not the timing, of the outflows in relation to the provisions, management has reflected current knowledge in assessing the provision levels. Reorganisations Reorganisation provisions are generally utilised within one to three years. There is limited volatility around the timing and amount of the ultimate outflows related to these provisions. Legal, contractual and environmental Reflecting the inherent uncertainty within many legal proceedings, the amount of the outflows could differ significantly from the amount provided. While the timing of the outflows is also uncertain, the Group expects these provisions to be utilised over a period of approximately 25 years. Other There are no individually significant provisions included within other provisions. 203 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Additional informationGovernance Financial statementsStrategic report Notes to the Consolidated financial statements continued 26. Share capital and other reserves Share capital Equity Non-equity Total Ordinary shares of 2.5p each Special Share of £1 Number of Nominal Number of Nominal Nominal shares value shares value value m £m £ £m Issued and fully paid At 1 January 2022 3,404 85 1 1 85 Shares cancelled (107) (3) – – (3) At 31 December 2022 3,297 82 1 1 82 Shares cancelled (58) (1) – – (1) At 31 December 2023 3,239 81 1 1 81 Special Share One Special Share of £1 in the Company is held on behalf of the Secretary of State for Business and Trade (the Special Shareholder). Certain provisions of the Company’s Articles of Association cannot be amended without the consent of the Special Shareholder. These provisions include the requirement that no foreign person, or foreign persons acting in concert, can have more than a 15% voting interest in the Company, the requirement that the majority of the directors are British, and the requirement that the Chief Executive or any executive Chair are British. The effect of these requirements can also be amended by regulations made by the directors and approved by the Special Shareholder. The Special Shareholder may require the Company at any time to redeem the Special Share at par or to convert the Special Share into one ordinary voting share. The Special Shareholder is entitled to attend a general meeting, but has no right to vote or any other rights at such meeting, other than to speak in relation to any business in respect of the Special Share. Treasury shares As at 31 December 2023, 204,041,705 (2022 220,086,959) ordinary shares of 2.5p each with an aggregate nominal value of £5,101,043 (2022 £5,502,174) were held in treasury. During 2023, 16,045,254 (2022 16,720,072) treasury shares were used to satisfy awards and options under the Share Incentive Plan, International Share Incentive Plan, Performance Share Plan, the Performance Shares and Restricted Shares elements of the Long-Term Incentive Plan, the Executive Share Option Plan, the Group Free Shares Plan and the International Profit Sharing Scheme. BAE Systems Employee Share Option Plan (ESOP) Trust The Group has an ESOP discretionary trust to administer the share plans and to acquire Company shares, using funds loaned by the Group, to meet commitments to Group employees. Dividend waivers were in operation for shares within the ESOP Trust, other than those owned beneficially by the participants, for the dividends paid in the year. At 31 December 2023, the ESOP Trust held 8,665,966 (2022 7,268,002) ordinary shares of 2.5p each, with a market value of £96m (2022 £62m). The shares held by the ESOP Trust are recorded at cost and deducted from retained earnings until such time as the shares vest unconditionally to employees. A dividend waiver was also in operation for the dividends paid in the year over shares within the Company’s share incentive plan trusts other than those shares owned beneficially by the participants. Own shares held Own shares held, including treasury shares and shares held by BAE Systems ESOP Trust, are recognised as a deduction from retained earnings. 204 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Consolidated financial statements 26. Share capital and other reserves continued Equity dividends Equity dividends on ordinary share capital are recognised as a liability on the date that the shareholder’s right to receive payment is established. 2023 2022 £m £m Final 16.6p dividend per ordinary share paid in the year (2022 15.2p) 508 480 Interim 11.5p dividend per ordinary share paid in the year (2022 10.4p) 349 322 857 802 After the balance sheet date, the directors proposed a final dividend of 1 8.5p per ordinary share. The dividend proposed amounts to approximately £599m, although the final payment is likely to be lower as a result of the impact of share repurchases. The dividend, which is subject to shareholder approval, will be paid on 3 June 2024 to shareholders registered on 19 April 2024. The ex-dividend date is 18 April 2024. The payment of this dividend will not have any tax expense consequences for the Group. Shareholders who do not at present participate in the Company’s Dividend Reinvestment Plan and wish to receive the final dividend in shares rather than cash should complete a mandate form for the Dividend Reinvestment Plan and return it to the registrars no later than 10 May 2024. Other reserves Capital Merger Statutory Revaluation redemption Hedging Translation reserve reserve reserve reserve reserve reserve Total £m £m £m £m £m £m £m At 1 January 2022 4,589 202 10 5 51 1,030 5,887 Subsidiaries: Currency translation on foreign currency net investments – – – – – 1,151 1,151 Reclassification of cumulative currency translation reserve on disposal of subsidiary – – – – – (17) (17) Net amounts debited to hedging reserve – – – – (65) – (65) Equity accounted investments (net of tax) – – – – 3 (11) (8) Purchase of own shares – – – 3 – – 3 At 31 December 2022 4,589 202 10 8 (11) 2,153 6,951 Subsidiaries: Currency translation on foreign currency net investments – – – – – (502) (502) Net amounts debited to hedging reserve – – – – (58) – (58) Equity accounted investments (net of tax) – – – – 5 6 11 Purchase of own shares – – – 1 – – 1 At 31 December 2023 4,589 202 10 9 (64) 1,657 6,403 205 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Additional informationGovernance Financial statementsStrategic report Notes to the Consolidated financial statements continued 26. Share capital and other reserves continued Other reserves con tinued Merger reserve The merger reserve arose on the acquisition of the Marconi Electronic Systems (MES) business by British Aerospace in 1999 to form BAE Systems, and represents the amount by which the fair value of the shares issued by British Aerospace as consideration exceeded their nominal value. Statutory reserve Under Section 4 of the British Aerospace Act 1980, this reserve may only be applied in paying up unissued shares of the Company to be allotted to members of the Company as fully paid bonus shares. Revaluation reserve The revaluation reserve relates to the revaluation at fair value of the net assets of the BVT joint venture previously held as an equity accounted investment on the acquisition of the remaining 45% interest in 2009. Capital redemption reserve The capital redemption reserve represents the cumulative nominal value of the Company’s ordinary shares repurchased and subsequently cancelled. Hedging reserve The hedging reserve comprises the effective portion of the cumulative net change in the fair value of cash flow hedging instruments related to hedged transactions that have not yet occurred. Translation reserve The translation reserve comprises all foreign currency differences arising from the translation of the financial statements of foreign operations. Capital The Group funds its operations through a mixture of equity funding and debt financing, including bank and capital market borrowings. At 31 December 2023, the Group’s capital was £10,787m (2022 £11,411m), which comprised total equity of £10,723m (2022 £11,400m), excluding amounts accumulated in equity relating to cash flow hedges of £(64)m (2022 £(11)m). Net debt (excluding lease liabilities) was £1,022m (2022 £2,023m). The capital structure of the Group reflects the judgement of the directors of an appropriate balance of funding required. The Group’s policy is to maintain an investment grade credit rating and ensure operating flexibility, whilst: – meeting its pension obligations; – investing in research and technology and pursuing other organic investment opportunities; – paying dividends in line with the Group’s policy of long-term sustainable cover of around two times underlying earnings (see page 228); – making accelerated returns of capital to shareholders when the balance sheet allows and when the return from doing so is in excess of the Group’s Weighted Average Cost of Capital; and – investing in value-enhancing acquisitions, where market conditions are right and where they deliver on the Group’s strategy. Purchase of own shares On 29 July 2021, the Company announced the details of a share buyback programme to repurchase up to £500m of its own shares over the following 12 months (the 2021 share buyback programme). The 2021 share buyback programme was completed on 2 February 2022. During 2022, 24,253,065 shares were repurchased under the 2021 share buyback programme for a total price, including transaction costs, of £132m. In July 2022, the directors approved a new share buyback programme (the 2022 share buyback programme) of up to £1.5bn over the next three years under the same terms as the 2021 buyback programme. During 2022, 82,997,065 shares were repurchased under the 2022 share buyback programme for a total price, including transaction costs, of £664m. In total during 2022, 107,250,130 shares were repurchased under the 2021 and 2022 share buyback programmes for a total price, including transaction costs, of £796m. During 2023, the total number of shares repurchased under the 2022 share buyback programme was 58,689,756 for a total price, including transaction costs, of £558m. All ordinary shares acquired have been subsequently cancelled, with the nominal value of ordinary shares cancelled deducted from share capital against the capital redemption reserve. As part of the 2021 and 2022 buyback programmes, it was agreed that should a better alternative use for the Company’s cash reserves be identified, the share buyback programmes would be ceased, and the money instead used for the alternative purpose. Therefore, when the Company issued a mandate to the brokers to purchase shares on their behalf, the mandates were structured such that they could be revoked at any point. As such, no financial liability has been recognised for shares not yet purchased under the 2022 programme. In August 2023, the directors approved a further share buyback programme (the 2023 share buyback programme) of up to £1.5bn, which is expected to commence after completion of the 2022 share buyback programme and conclude within three years of its commencement. 206 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Consolidated financial statements 27. Movement in assets and liabilities arising from financing activities Non-cash movements As at Foreign Net As at 1 January exchange Fair value finance Other 31 December 2023 Cash flow movements Leases adjustments costs movements 2023 £m £m £m £m £m £m £m £m Assets Other financial assets 170 (200) – – 166 7 – 143 170 (200) – – 166 7 – 143 Liabilities Loans (5,242) 35 299 – – (203) – (5,111) Lease liabilities (1,616) 346 60 (157) – (53) – (1,420) Other financial liabilities (114) 406 – – (441) (19) – (168) (6,972) 787 359 (157) (441) (275) – (6,699) 587 Other interest paid 95 Purchase of own shares 561 Equity dividends paid 857 Dividends paid to non-controlling interests 88 Net cash flow from financing activities 2,188 1 2 3 3 Non-cash movements As at Foreign Net As at 1 January exchange Fair value finance Other 31 December 2022 Cash flow movements Leases adjustments costs movements 2022 £m £m £m £m £m £m £m £m Assets Other financial assets 122 (550) – – 581 17 – 170 122 (550) – – 581 17 – 170 Liabilities Loans (5,061) 615 (584) – – (212) – (5,242) Lease liabilities (1,295) 284 (95) (464) – (48) 2 (1,616) Other financial liabilities (163) 205 – – (155) (1) – (114) (6,519) 1,104 (679) (464) (155) (261) 2 (6,972) 554 Other interest paid 23 Purchase of own shares 788 Equity dividends paid 802 Dividends paid to non-controlling interests 166 Net cash flow from financing activities 2,333 1 2 3 3 1. Cash flow movements represent both payments or receipts of principal and payments of interest, which are presented separately in the Consolidated cash flow statement. 2. Other movements includes movements arising on the acquisition or disposal of businesses. 3. Excluding cash flow hedges, for which the cash flow is reported in line with the underlying transaction. See note 15 for an analysis of other financial assets and liabilities. 207 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Additional informationGovernance Financial statementsStrategic report Notes to the Consolidated financial statements continued 28. Fair value measurement Fair value of financial instruments Certain of the Group’s financial instruments are held at fair value. The fair value of a financial instrument is the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants at the balance sheet date. The fair values of financial instruments held at fair value have been determined based on available market information at the balance sheet date, and the valuation methodologies listed below: – the fair values of forward foreign exchange contracts are calculated by discounting the contracted forward values and translating at the appropriate balance sheet rates; – the fair values of both interest rate and cross-currency swaps are calculated by discounting expected future principal and interest cash flows and translating at the appropriate balance sheet rates; and – the fair values of money market funds are calculated by multiplying the net asset value per share by the investment held at the balance sheet date. The derivative fair values are based on reputable third party forecast data, and then adjusted for credit risk, including the Group’s own credit risk, and market risk. Due to the variability of the valuation factors, the fair values presented at 31 December may not be indicative of the amounts the Group will realise in the future. Fair value hierarchy The fair value measurement hierarchy is as follows: – Level 1 – Quoted prices (unadjusted) in active markets for identical assets or liabilities; – Level 2 – Inputs other than quoted prices included within level 1 that are observable for the asset or liability, either directly (i.e. as prices) or indirectly (i.e. derived from prices); and – Level 3 – Inputs for the asset or liability that are not based on observable market data (i.e. unobservable inputs). Carrying amounts and fair values of certain financial instruments 2023 2022 Carrying Fair Carrying Fair amount value amount value Note £m £m £m £m Financial instruments measured at fair value: Non-current Other investments at fair value through other comprehensive income 13 84 84 99 99 Other financial assets 15 227 227 322 322 Other financial liabilities 15 (227) (227) (272) (272) Current Other financial assets 15 205 205 252 252 Money market funds 19 1,375 1,375 1,149 1,149 Other financial liabilities 15 (295) (295) (328) (328) Financial instruments not measured at fair value: Non-current Loans 21 (4,432) (4,045) (5,189) (4,588) Current Loans 21 (679) (672) (53) (53) All of the financial assets and liabilities measured at fair value are classified as level 2 using the fair value hierarchy, except for money market funds, which are classified as level 1, and other investments, which are at a combination of level 1 and level 3. The total value of investments classified as level 3 is immaterial. There were no transfers between levels during the year. Alternative valuation techniques would not materially change the valuations presented. Financial assets and liabilities in the Group’s Consolidated balance sheet are either held at fair value or at amortised cost. With the exception of loans, the carrying value of financial instruments measured at amortised cost approximates their fair value. For the bonds included within loans the fair value of loans presented in the table above is derived from market prices as of 31 December, classified as level 1 using the fair value hierarchy. The fair value of the private placement included within loans has been valued based on the interest yield on an equivalent observable bond, applied to the private placement cash flows, and has been classified as level 3 using the fair value hierarchy. 208 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Consolidated financial statements 29. Share-based payments The Group has granted equity-settled share options and Long-Term Incentive Plan arrangements which are measured at fair value at the date of grant using an option pricing model. The fair value is expensed on a straight-line basis over the vesting period, based on the Group’s estimate of the number of shares that will actually vest. Details of the terms and conditions of each share-based payment plan are given in the Annual remuneration report on pages 107 to 134. Expense in year 2023 2022 £m £m Executive Share Option Plan 8 10 Performance Share Plan 43 35 Restricted Share Plan 12 10 63 55 The Group also incurred a charge of £47m (2022 £46m) in respect of the equity-settled all-employee Free Shares and Matching Partnership Shares elements of the Share Incentive Plan. Executive Share Option Plan 2023 2022 Weighted Weighted average average Number of exercise Number of exercise shares price shares price ’000 £ ’000 £ Outstanding at 1 January 34,814 5.58 47,280 5.16 Granted during the year – – 8,141 7.39 Exercised during the year (9,380) 5.01 (18,020) 5.30 Expired during the year (1,012) 6.10 (2,587) 5.50 Outstanding at 31 December 24,422 5.78 34,814 5.58 Exercisable at 31 December 8,284 5.21 8,271 5.38 2023 2022 Range of exercise price of outstanding options (£) 4.12 – 7.83 3.89 – 7.83 Weighted average remaining contracted life (years) 7 7 Weighted average fair value of options granted (£) – 1.87 Performance Share Plan and Restricted Share Plan Performance Share Plan Restricted Share Plan 2023 2022 2023 2022 Number of Number of Number of Number of shares shares shares shares ’000 ’000 ’000 ’000 Outstanding at 1 January 27,343 27,915 5,805 5,413 Granted during the year 10,897 6,799 1,705 2,205 Exercised during the year (4,293) (3,719) (1,688) (1,383) Expired during the year (942) (3,652) (241) (430) Outstanding at 31 December 33,005 27,343 5,581 5,805 Exercisable at 31 December 1,508 387 108 38 2023 2022 2023 2022 Weighted average remaining contracted life (years) 5 5 5 5 Weighted average fair value of awards granted (£) 9.73 7.32 9.78 7.49 The exercise price for the Performance Share Plan and Restricted Share Plan is £nil (2022 £nil). 209 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Additional informationGovernance Financial statementsStrategic report Notes to the Consolidated financial statements continued 29. Share-based payments continued Details of options/awards granted in the year The fair value of equity-settled options/awards granted in the year has been measured using the weighted average inputs below and the following valuation models: Executive Share Option Plan – Binomial Performance Share Plan – Monte Carlo Restricted Share Plan – Dividend valuation 2023 2022 Range of share price at date of grant (£) 9.75 – 10.14 7.35 – 7.83 Expected option/award life (years) 3 – 7 3 – 10 Volatility (%) 31 29 Risk-free interest rate (%) 3 – 4 1 – 3 Volatility was calculated with reference to the Group’s weekly share price volatility, after allowing for dividends, for the greater of 30 weeks or for the period until vest date. The average share price in the year was £9.77 (2022 £7.53). 30. Related party transactions The Group has a related party relationship with its directors and key management personnel (see below), equity accounted investments (note 12) and pension schemes (note 24). Transactions with related parties occur in the normal course of business, are priced on an arm’s-length basis and settled on normal trade terms. The more significant transactions are disclosed below: Sales to Purchases from Amounts owed by Amounts owed to Management related parties related parties related parties related parties recharges 1 2023 2022 2023 2022 2023 2022 2023 2022 2023 2022 Related party £m £m £m £m £m £m £m £m £m £m Eurofighter Jagdflugzeug GmbH 1,377 1,219 303 442 32 67 116 91 – – FADEC International LLC 118 73 – – 26 – – – – – MBDA SAS 15 19 258 76 2 6 1,390 949 8 8 Panavia Aircraft GmbH 33 22 38 49 1 1 1 2 – – BAE Systems Pension Schemes – – 24 20 – – 202 193 – – Other 143 11 35 28 18 3 37 27 – – 1,686 1,344 658 615 79 77 1,746 1,262 8 8 1 1. Also relates to disclosures under IAS 24 Related Party Disclosures, for the parent company, BAE Systems plc. At 31 December 2023, £1,509m (2022 £1,021m) was owed by BAE Systems plc and £237m (2022 £241m) by other Group subsidiaries. The Group also manages certain treasury functions on behalf of some of their equity accounted investments. This includes entering into foreign exchange derivatives on their behalf. As at 31 December 2023, we entered into forward contracts to purchase €297m, purchase $47m and purchase £12m worth of other currencies (2022 purchase €313m, sell $21m and purchase £14m worth of other currencies) on their behalf. No service fee is charged for these arrangements. The Group considers key management personnel, as defined under IAS 24 Related Party Disclosures, to be the members of the Group’s Executive Committee and the Company’s non-executive directors. Fuller disclosures on directors’ remuneration are set out in the Annual remuneration report on pages 115 to 134. Total emoluments for directors and key management personnel charged to the Consolidated income statement were: 2023 2022 £’000 £’000 Short-term employee benefits 22,146 22,238 Post-employment benefits 1,534 677 Share-based payments 15,655 12,023 39,335 34,938 210 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Consolidated financial statements 31. Contingent liabilities Contingent liabilities are potential future cash outflows which are either not probable or cannot be measured reliably. The Group has entered into a number of guarantee and performance bond arrangements in the normal course of business. Various Group undertakings are parties to legal actions and claims which arise in the normal course of business. Provision is made for any amounts that the directors consider may become payable (see note 25). The Group believes that any significant liability in respect of its guarantees and performance bond arrangements, and legal actions and claims not already provided for, is remote. 32. Acquisition of businesses Businesses acquired during 2023 Eurostep acquisition On 31 October, the Group acquired 100% of the share capital of Eurostep, a secure data sharing company headquartered in Sweden, for consideration of £9m. The company will form part of the Cyber & Intelligence segment, within the Digital Intelligence business. The results and financial position of the acquired businesses have been consolidated from the date of acquisition. Businesses acquired during 2022 On 11 November 2021, the Group announced its intention to acquire 100% of the share capital of BIS Invest S.a.r.l. and its subsidiaries, together the Bohemia Interactive Simulations Group (BISim Group) for a consideration of $200m (£151m). On 4 March 2022, this deal passed all required pre-closing activities, and the acquisition was completed. Using the latest game-based technology, the experienced BISim team of engineers develops high-fidelity, cost-effective training and simulation software products and components to meet the growing demand for defence applications. BISim forms part of the Cyber & Intelligence segment. The results and financial position of the acquired business have been consolidated from the date of acquisition. The purchase price allocation exercise was finalised in the year, with no changes, and is summarised below. Acquisition consideration and fair value of net assets acquired £m Intangible assets 71 Property, plant and equipment 1 Right-of-use assets 1 Receivables 10 Deferred tax assets 1 Lease liabilities (1) Payables (8) Deferred tax liabilities (14) Provisions (6) Cash and cash equivalents 5 Net identifiable assets acquired 60 Goodwill 91 Net assets acquired 151 Satisfied by: Cash consideration 151 Total consideration 151 211 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Additional informationGovernance Financial statementsStrategic report Notes to the Consolidated financial statements continued 32. Acquisition of businesses continued The net outflow of cash in respect of the acquisition is as follows: £m Cash consideration 151 Cash and cash equivalents acquired (5) Net cash outflow in respect of the acquisition of the business 146 The goodwill recognised is primarily attributable to expected synergies. No goodwill is expected to be deductible for tax purposes. Goodwill has been allocated to the Intelligence & Security business. No impairment losses have been recognised in respect of goodwill in the year ended 31 December 2022. The acquisition contributed £38m to the Group’s revenue and £8m to the Group’s underlying EBIT 1 between the date of acquisition and 31 December 2022. If it had been completed on 1 January 2022, the Group’s revenue from the acquisition would have been £42m, and the Group’s underlying EBIT 1 would have been £8m for the year ended 31 December 2022. Contractual cash flows on trade, other and contract receivables are recognised net of expected credit losses. No contingent liabilities have been recognised or require disclosure in respect of this acquisition. 1. Underlying EBIT is an alternative performance measure defined in the Alternative performance measures section on page 227. It is presented here as our internal measure of segmental performance, to provide additional information on performance to the user. 33. Business disposals Business disposals during 2023 There were no business disposals in 2023. The Group incurred cash outflows of £8m in the current year relating to the 2022 disposal of the financial crime detection business from Digital Intelligence, which had been fully provided for in 2022. Business disposals during 2022 On 9 July 2022, the Group entered into an agreement for the sale of BAE Systems’ financial crime detection business from the Digital Intelligence business in our Cyber & Intelligence segment. The sale to SymphonyAI completed on 28 October 2022. Disposal costs of £25m were incurred in relation to the sale, relating to costs incurred in the sale and operational separation of the business. The gain recognised on disposal was as follows: £m Cash received or receivable: Cash 131 Total disposal consideration 131 Carrying amount of net assets sold (see below) (29) Disposal costs (25) Cumulative currency translation gain 17 Gain on sale before tax 94 Net cash inflow arising on disposal: Cash consideration received 131 Less: cash and cash equivalents disposed (17) Less: disposal costs (13) 101 Assets and liabilities presented as at the date of disposal were as follows: £m Intangible assets including goodwill 23 Right-of-use assets 3 Trade, other and contract receivables 26 Cash and cash equivalents 17 Total assets 69 Lease liabilities (3) Contract liabilities (9) Trade and other payables (27) Provisions (1) Total liabilities (40) Net assets disposed 29 212 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Consolidated financial statements 34. Events after the reporting period Ball Aerospace acquisition On 17 August 2023, the Group announced its intention to acquire 100% of the share capital of the Ball Aerospace division for consideration of $5.5bn (£4.4bn), of which $0.75bn is expected to be recoverable under a tax benefit associated with the acquisition. The acquisition completed on 16 February 2024. Upon completion, the Group drew down $4.0bn (£3.2bn) under a bridge finance facility, and paid $1.5bn (£1.2bn) in cash from the Group’s existing cash resources, in initial settlement of the transaction. Ball Aerospace is a leading provider of spacecraft, mission payloads, optical systems, and antenna systems. Headquartered in Colorado, with more than 5,200 employees, it has existing customer relationships among the Intelligence Community, US Department of Defense, and civilian space agencies. It is well positioned across several markets; military and civil space, C4ISR, and missile and munitions. The space market exposure extends across positions in defence, intelligence, and scientific missions. The Tactical Solutions business is well positioned to capture expected increases in demand for missiles and munitions. Given the limited time since the acquisition date and the size and complexity of the transaction, the Group is working through the accounting under IFRS 3 Business Combinations and is unable to reasonably estimate and determine the fair value of net assets acquired and resulting goodwill at the date of this report. The Group will work through the fair value exercise under IFRS 3 and provisional disclosures will be reported in the Group’s 2024 half-year results. Air Astana IPO On 12 January 2024, Air Astana announced its intention to proceed with a joint initial public offering (IPO) on the London Stock Exchange, the Astana International Exchange in Kazakhstan, and the Kazakhstan Stock Exchange. On 9 February 2024, the IPO was launched. As a result of the IPO, it is expected that the total shareholding held by BAE Systems in Air Astana will be between 15% and 17%, with proceeds from the sale of shares of between $227m (£180m) and $207m (£164m). The Group will continue to equity account for the remaining investment. At 31 December 2023, the Group held a 49% shareholding in Air Astana, with a carrying value of £84m. At that time, management did not consider that the IPO was highly probable as the listing was not being actively marketed, the Air Astana Board of Directors had not approved the IPO, and it was not reasonably certain that the intended offering value would be achieved. Consequently, the investment was not held for sale as at 31 December 2023 and the subsequent completion of the IPO is considered to be a non-adjusting post balance sheet event. Malloy Aeronautics acquisition On 31 January 2024 the Group acquired 100% of the share capital of Malloy Aeronautics for £60m cash consideration, plus adjustments for working capital and contingent consideration, for which the fair value is still being assessed. Malloy Aeronautics designs and supplies all-electric uncrewed aerial systems to both civil and military customers. Their range of uncrewed, heavy lift quadcopters are capable of lifting payloads from 68kg to 300kg over short-range missions. Malloy Aeronautics will form part of FalconWorks ® , the research and development business within the Air segment. 213 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Additional informationGovernance Financial statementsStrategic report Notes to the Consolidated financial statements continued 35. Information about related undertakings In accordance with Section 409 of the Companies Act 2006, a full list of subsidiaries, joint ventures, associated undertakings, and significant holdings in undertakings other than subsidiary undertakings of the Group at 31 December 2023 is disclosed below. All subsidiary undertakings are subsidiary undertakings of their immediate parent undertaking(s) pursuant to section 1162 (2) (a) of the Companies Act 2006 unless otherwise indicated. Unless otherwise stated, the aggregate percentage of capital held by the Group is 100%, the Group’s shareholding represents ordinary shares of equal value and voting rights held indirectly by BAE Systems plc, the year end is 31 December, the country of incorporation is the United Kingdom and the address of the registered office is Victory Point, Lyon Way, Frimley, Camberley, Surrey GU16 7EX, England. For companies incorporated outside of the United Kingdom, the country of incorporation is shown in the address. No subsidiary undertakings have been excluded from the consolidation. Subsidiary undertakings – wholly-owned 4219 Lafayette, LLC 1 4219 Lafayette Center Drive, Chantilly VA 20151, United States Aircraft Research Association Limited 2 Manton Lane, Bedford MK41 7PF, United Kingdom Alvis Limited Alvis Pension Scheme Trustees Limited 3 Alvis Vickers Limited Armstrong Whitworth Aircraft Limited 3 ASC Shipbuilding Pty Limited Bldg 01, Level 2, 640 Mersey Road North, Osborne SA 5017, Australia Australian Marine Engineering Corporation (Finance) Pty Limited Level 2, 80 Flinders Street, Adelaide SA 5000, Australia Avro International Aerospace Limited 3 BAE Systems (Al Diriyah C4i) Limited 3 BAE Systems (Canada) Inc. 220 Laurier Avenue West, Suite 1200, Ottawa ON K1P 5Z9, Canada BAE Systems (Combat and Radar Systems) Limited Charter Place, 23/27 Seaton Place, St. Helier, Jersey JE1 1JY BAE Systems (Corporate Air Travel) Limited BAE Systems (Defence Systems) Limited BAE Systems (Dynamics) Limited BAE Systems (Farnborough 3) Limited BAE Systems (Finance) Limited BAE Systems (Funding Four) Unlimited Company Riverside One, Sir John Rogerson’s Quay, Dublin D02 X576, Ireland BAE Systems (Funding Three) Limited BAE Systems (Funding Two) Limited BAE Systems (Gripen Overseas) Limited BAE Systems (Holdings) Limited 3 BAE Systems (International) Limited BAE Systems (Kazakhstan) Limited BAE Systems (Kuwait) Limited BAE Systems (Land and Sea Systems) Limited 4 BAE Systems (Malaysia) Sdn Bhd Level 25 Menara Hong Leong, No. 6 Jalan Damanlela, Bukit Damansara, 50490 Kuala Lumpur, Malaysia BAE Systems (MEH) Limited BAE Systems (Military Air) Overseas Limited BAE Systems (Nominees) Limited 3 BAE Systems (Oman) Limited BAE Systems (Operations) Limited 5 BAE Systems (Operations) Singapore Pte Limited One Marina Boulevard #28-00, Singapore 018989, Singapore BAE Systems (Overseas Holdings) Limited BAE Systems (Poland) Sp. z o.o. ul. Abp. A. Baraniaka 88, 61-131 Poznan, Poland BAE Systems (Projects) Limited BAE Systems (Property Investments) Limited BAE Systems 2000 Pension Plan Trustees Limited 3 BAE Systems AB 6 Box 5676, SE-114 86 Stockholm, Sweden BAE Systems Air Japan KK 7 1-1 Katamachi, Shinjuku-ku, Tokyo, Japan BAE Systems Applied Intelligence (Asia Pacific) Pte Limited United Square, 101 Thomson Road, #25-03/04, 307591, Singapore BAE Systems Applied Intelligence (Connect) A/S c/o Kromann Reumert, Sundkrogsgade 5, Copenhagen East, 2100, Denmark BAE Systems Applied Intelligence (GCS) Limited 8 c/o Interpath Limited, 10 Fleet Place, London EC4M 7RB, United Kingdom BAE Systems Applied Intelligence (Integration) Limited 8 c/o Interpath Limited, 10 Fleet Place, London EC4M 7RB, United Kingdom BAE Systems Applied Intelligence (International) Limited Priestley Road, Surrey Research Park, Guildford, Surrey GU2 7RQ, United Kingdom BAE Systems Applied Intelligence (Japan) KK 12/F Ark Mori Building, 1-12-32 Akasaka, Minato-ku, Tokyo, 107-6024, Japan BAE Systems Applied Intelligence (Spain) S.A. Paseo de la Castellana, 141, Cuzco IV, 28046 Madrid, Spain BAE Systems Applied Intelligence (UK) Limited BAE Systems Applied Intelligence A/S c/o Kromann Reumert, Sundkrogsgade 5, Copenhagen East, 2100, Denmark BAE Systems Applied Intelligence GCS Inc. 7 800 Towers Crescent Drive, 13th Floor #1382, Vienna VA 22182, United States BAE Systems Applied Intelligence Integrated Computer Solutions (Kuwait) (S.P.C.) Al Hamra Tower, Office Number 3503, 35th Floor, East Maqwa, Kuwait City, Kuwait BAE Systems Applied Intelligence Limited Surrey Research Park, Guildford, Surrey GU2 7RQ, United Kingdom BAE Systems Applied Intelligence LLC 1 8000 Towers Crescent Blvd, 13th Floor, Vienna VA 22182, United States BAE Systems Applied Intelligence Malaysia Sdn Bhd Level 25, Menara Hong Leong, No. 6 Jalan Damanlela, Bukit Damansara, 50490 Kuala Lumpur, Malaysia BAE Systems Australia (Electronic Systems) Pty Limited Level 2, 80 Flinders Street, Adelaide SA 5000, Australia BAE Systems Australia (NSW) Holdings Pty Limited Level 2, 80 Flinders Street, Adelaide SA 5000, Australia BAE Systems Australia (NSW) Pty Limited Level 2, 80 Flinders Street, Adelaide SA 5000, Australia BAE Systems Australia Datagate Pty Limited Level 2, 80 Flinders Street, Adelaide SA 5000, Australia BAE Systems Australia Defence Holdings Pty Limited Level 2, 80 Flinders Street, Adelaide SA 5000, Australia BAE Systems Australia Defence Pty Limited 9 Level 2, 80 Flinders Street, Adelaide SA 5000, Australia BAE Systems Australia Holdings Limited 3 Level 2, 80 Flinders Street, Adelaide SA 5000, Australia BAE Systems Australia Limited Level 2, 80 Flinders Street, Adelaide SA 5000, Australia BAE Systems Australia Logistics Pty Limited Level 2, 80 Flinders Street, Adelaide SA 5000, Australia BAE Systems Australia Sea Sentinel Project Pty Limited Level 2, 80 Flinders Street, Adelaide SA 5000, Australia BAE Systems Avionics Singapore Pte Limited One Marina Boulevard, #28-00, Singapore 018989, Singapore BAE Systems Bofors AB SE-691 80 Karlskoga, Sweden BAE Systems Bofors Holdings Sdn Bhd Level 21, Suite 21.01, The Gardens South Tower, Mid Valley City, Lingkaran Syed Putra, 59200 Kuala Lumpur, Malaysia BAE Systems C-ITS AB Repslagaregatan 25, Linkoping SE-58222, Sweden BAE Systems Communications Solutions LLC 1 Knowledge Oasis, Building 4, Second Floor, 0402-Z427, Knowledge Oasis Muscat, PO Box 16, Postal Code 135, Muscat, Oman BAE Systems Controls Inc. 10 2941 Fairview Park Drive, Suite 100, Falls Church, VA, 22042, United States BAE Systems Creole Inc. 11 2941 Fairview Park Drive, Suite 100, Falls Church, VA, 22042, United States BAE Systems Datagate Holdings Limited 8 c/o Interpath Limited, 10 Fleet Place, London EC4M 7RB, United Kingdom BAE Systems Deployed Systems Limited 12 BAE Systems Digital Intelligence Pty Limited Level 26, 459 Collins Street, Melbourne VIC 3000, Australia BAE Systems do Brasil Ltda SCN Quadra 5 Bloco A, Ed. Brasilia Shopping, Torre Norte, Sala 426, Brasilia, DF CEP:70715-900, Brazil BAE Systems Electronic Systems (Overseas) Limited BAE Systems Electronics Limited BAE Systems Enterprises Limited BAE Systems Executive Pension Scheme Trustees Limited 3 BAE Systems Finance Inc. 7 2941 Fairview Park Drive, Suite 100, Falls Church, VA, 22042, United States BAE Systems Flight Training (Australia) Pty Limited 13 Level 2, 80 Flinders Street, Adelaide SA 5000, Australia BAE Systems Funds Management 3,14 BAE Systems GCS International Limited BAE Systems Global Combat Systems Munitions Limited BAE Systems Global LLC 1 2941 Fairview Park Drive, Suite 100, Falls Church VA 22042, United States BAE Systems Hägglunds AB Bjornavagen 2, Ornskoldsvik SE-89182, Sweden BAE Systems Hawaii Shipyards Inc. 7 3049 Ualena Street, Suite 915, Honolulu, HI, 96819, United States 214 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Consolidated financial statements 35. Information about related undertakings continued Subsidiary undertakings – wholly-owned continued BAE Systems Holding GmbH Hauptstrasse 48, 82433 Bad Kohlgrub, Germany BAE Systems Holdings (South Africa) (Pty) Limited Central Office Park No. 5, 257 Jean Avenue, Centurion, Gauteng, 0157, South Africa BAE Systems Holdings B.V. c/o IQ-EQ, Hoogoorddreef 15, 1101 BA Amsterdam, Netherlands BAE Systems Holdings Inc. 10 2941 Fairview Park Drive, Suite 100, Falls Church, VA, 22042, United States BAE Systems Holdings International LLC 1 2941 Fairview Park Drive, Suite 100, Falls Church, VA, 22042, United States BAE Systems Imaging Solutions Inc. 10 1841 Zanker Road, Suite 50, San Jose, CA, 95112, United States BAE Systems India (Homeland Security) Private Limited 15 #201, 2nd Floor, World Mark 2, Asset No. 8, Aerocity, NH-8, New Delhi – 110037, India BAE Systems India (Services) Private Limited 15 #201, 2nd Floor, World Mark 2, Asset No. 8, Aerocity, NH-8, New Delhi – 110037, India BAE Systems India (Technology) Private Limited 15 #201, 2nd Floor, World Mark 2, Asset No. 8, Aerocity, NH-8, New Delhi – 110037, India BAE Systems India (Ventures) Private Limited 15 #201, 2nd Floor, World Mark 2, Asset No. 8, Aerocity, NH-8, New Delhi – 110037, India BAE Systems Information and Electronic Systems Integration Inc. 7 65 Spit Brook Road, Nashua, NH, 03061, United States BAE Systems Insurance (Isle of Man) Limited Tower House, Loch Promenade, Douglas, IM1 2LZ, Isle of Man BAE Systems Integrated System Technologies (KSA) Limited BAE Systems Integrated System Technologies (Overseas) Limited BAE Systems Integrated System Technologies Limited BAE Systems International Inc. 7 65 Spit Brook Road, Nashua, NH, 03061, United States BAE Systems Jacksonville Ship Repair LLC 1 8500 Hecksher Drive, Jacksonville FL 32226, United States BAE Systems Japan GK Ark Mori Building, 1-12-32 Akasaka, Minato-Ku, Tokyo, Japan BAE Systems Land & Armaments Holdings LLC 1 2941 Fairview Park Drive, Suite 100, Falls Church VA 22042, United States BAE Systems Land & Armaments Inc. 7 2941 Fairview Park Drive, Suite 100, Falls Church, VA, 22042, United States BAE Systems Land & Armaments L.P. 1 2941 Fairview Park Drive, Suite 100, Falls Church, VA, 22042, United States BAE Systems Land Systems (Finance) Limited BAE Systems Land Systems (Investments) Limited BAE Systems Land Systems ATF Limited BAE Systems Land Systems FMTV International Inc. 11 2941 Fairview Park Drive, Suite 100, Falls Church, VA, 22042, United States BAE Systems Land Systems Pinzgauer (Holdings) Limited BAE Systems Land Systems Pinzgauer Limited BAE Systems MAI Turkey Hava Sistemleri A.S¸ . Üniversiteler Mahallesi, Beytepe Lodumlu Köy Yolu Cad. No: 5/348 Çankaya, Ankara, Turkey BAE Systems Marine (Holdings) Limited BAE Systems Marine (YSL) Limited BAE Systems Marine Limited BAE Systems Netherlands B.V. c/o IQ-EQ, Hoogoorddreef 15, 1101 BA Amsterdam, Netherlands BAE Systems Norfolk Ship Repair Inc. 7 750 West Berkley Avenue, VA 23523, Norfolk, United States BAE Systems Oman LLC 1 PO Box 74, Postal Code 111, Seeb, Oman BAE Systems Ordnance Systems Inc. 7 4509 West Stone Drive, Kingsport, TN 37660-9982, United States BAE Systems Overseas Inc. 7 65 Spit Brook Road, Nashua, NH, 03061, United States BAE Systems Pension Funds CIF Trustees Limited 3 BAE Systems Pension Funds Investment Management Limited 3,16 BAE Systems Pension Funds Trustees Limited 3 BAE Systems Project Services Limited BAE Systems Projects (Canada) Limited BAE Systems Properties Limited BAE Systems Quest Limited 3,8 c/o Interpath Limited, 10 Fleet Place, London EC4M 7RB, United Kingdom BAE Systems Regional Aircraft Colombia SAS 17 c/o Brigard & Urrutia, Calle 70 A No. 4-41, Bogotá, Colombia BAE Systems Resolution Inc. 7 2941 Fairview Park Drive, Suite 100, Falls Church, VA, 22042, United States BAE Systems S&S Operations Inc. 7 2941 Fairview Park Drive, Suite 100, Falls Church, VA, 22042, United States BAE Systems San Diego Ship Repair Inc. 7 2205 East Belt Street, Foot of Sampson Street, CA 92113, San Diego, United States BAE Systems Saudi America Limited Riyadh Kingdom Centre 28th Floor (REGUS), PO Box 23088, Riyadh 11321, Central Province, Riyadh, Kingdom of Saudi Arabia BAE Systems Saudi Arabia (Maintenance and Equipment Services) Limited PO Box 1732, Riyadh 11441, Kingdom of Saudi Arabia BAE Systems Saudi Arabia (Vehicles and Equipment Holdings) Limited 3 BAE Systems Saudi Arabia (Vehicles and Equipment Nominees) Limited 3 BAE Systems Saudi Limited PO Box 1732, Riyadh 11441, Kingdom of Saudi Arabia BAE Systems Serviços de Aviônicos Ltda. Rua Ambrósio Molina, No. 1090. Bloco F, Eugênio de Melo, São José dos Campos, São Paulo 12.247-000, Brazil BAE Systems Share Plans Trustee Limited 3,8 c/o Interpath Limited, 10 Fleet Place, London EC4M 7RB, United Kingdom BAE Systems Services Limited BAE Systems Shared Services Inc. 7 11215 Rushmore Drive, Charlotte, NC, 28277, United States BAE Systems Ship Repair Inc. 7 750 West Berkley Ave., Norfolk, VA, 23523, United States BAE Systems Southeast Shipyards AMHC Inc. 7 8500 Heckscher Drive, Jacksonville, FL, 32226, United States BAE Systems Surface Ships (Holdings) Limited BAE Systems Surface Ships (Overseas) Limited BAE Systems Surface Ships (Projects) Limited BAE Systems Surface Ships Integrated Support Limited BAE Systems Surface Ships Intermediate Holdings Limited 8 BAE Systems Surface Ships International Limited BAE Systems Surface Ships Limited BAE Systems Surface Ships Maritime Limited BAE Systems Surface Ships Portsmouth Limited 8 BAE Systems Surface Ships Projects (Malaysia) Sdn Bhd Level 29 Menara Binjai, No 2 Jalan Binjai, Off Jalan Ampang, 50450 Kuala Lumpur, Malaysia BAE Systems Surface Ships Property Services Limited 8 c/o Interpath Limited, 10 Fleet Place, London EC4M 7RB, United Kingdom BAE Systems Surface Ships Support Limited 5 BAE Systems SWS Defence AB SE-691 80 Karlskoga, Sweden BAE Systems Tactical Vehicle Systems LP 1 2941 Fairview Park Drive, Suite 100, Falls Church VA 22042, United States BAE Systems Technology LLC Office No. 458, Building No. 47, 90th North Street, Section 1, New Cairo, 5th Settlement, Cairo, Egypt BAE Systems Technology Solutions & Services Inc. 7 520 Gaither Road, Rockville, MD, 20850, United States BAE Systems Training Services Limited 8 c/o Interpath Limited, 10 Fleet Place, London EC4M 7RB, United Kingdom BAE Systems TVS Holdings LLC 1 2941 Fairview Park Drive, Suite 100, Falls Church VA 22042, United States BAE Systems Ukraine LLC 23-A Building, Yaroslaviv Val Street, Kyiv City, 01054, Ukraine BAE Systems Zephyr Corporation 10 United Agent Group, Inc. 3411 Silverside Rd. Tatnall, Bldg. #104, Wilmington, DE, 19810, United States BAE Systems Zephyr Fifth Corporation 10 United Agent Group, Inc. 3411 Silverside Rd. Tatnall, Bldg. #104, Wilmington, DE, 19810, United States BAE Systems Zephyr Fourth Corporation 10 United Agent Group, Inc. 3411 Silverside Rd. Tatnall, Bldg. #104, Wilmington, DE, 19810, United States BAE Systems Zephyr Second Corporation 10 United Agent Group, Inc. 3411 Silverside Rd. Tatnall, Bldg. #104, Wilmington, DE, 19810, United States BAE Systems Zephyr Third Corporation 10 United Agent Group, Inc. 3411 Silverside Rd. Tatnall, Bldg. #104, Wilmington, DE, 19810, United States BAE Systems, Inc. 7 2941 Fairview Park Drive, Suite 100, Falls Church, VA, 22042, United States BIS Invest S.à.r.l. 2, Place de Strasbourg, L-2562, Luxembourg, Grand Duchy of Luxembourg Bohemia Interactive Australia Pty Ltd 18 Unit 2, Building A, 2 Technology Place, Williamtown NSW 2318, Australia Bohemia Interactive Simulations GK Karolinská, 654/2, Karin, 186 00 Prague 8, Czech Republic (incorporated in Japan) 215 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Additional informationGovernance Financial statementsStrategic report Notes to the Consolidated financial statements continued 35. Information about related undertakings continued Subsidiary undertakings – wholly-owned continued Bohemia Interactive Simulations GmbH Vistra Corporate Services, Westendstraße 28, 60325, Frankfurt am Main, Germany Bohemia Interactive Simulations, Inc. 7 3050 Technology Pkwy, Suite 110, Orlando, FL, 32746, United States Bohemia Interactive Simulations K.S. 1 Karolinská, 654/2, Karin, 186 00 Prague 8, Czech Republic Bohemia Interactive Simulations Korea Ltd Karolinská, 654/2, Karin, 186 00 Prague 8, Czech Republic (incorporated in the Republic of Korea) Bohemia Interactive Simulations sp z.o.o. Ul. Ostrobramska 101, 04-041, Warsaw, Poland Bohemia Interactive Simulations (UK) Limited 31 Hercules Way, Farnborough Aerospace Centre, Farnborough, Hampshire GU14 6UU, United Kingdom Bohemia Invest One Ltd Bohemia Invest Two Ltd Brabazon Limited 8 c/o Interpath Limited, 10 Fleet Place, London EC4M 7RB, United Kingdom British Aerospace (Far East) Limited 19 Level 54, Hopewell Centre, 183 Queen’s Road East, Hong Kong British Aerospace (Malaysia) Sdn Bhd 19 Unit 30-01, Level 30, Tower A, Vertical Business Suite, Avenue 3, Bangsar South, No.8, Jalan Kerinchi, 59200 Kuala Lumpur, Malaysia British Aircraft Corporation (Pension Fund Trustees) Limited 3 British Aircraft Corporation Limited 3 CPS International, Inc. 11 Benedetti & Benedetti, Comosa Building, 21st Floor, PO Box 850120, Panama 5, Panama Creole (Nigeria) Limited 5 9th Floor, St. Nicholas House, 26 Catholic Mission Street, Lagos, Nigeria Detica Group Limited Detica Mexico S. de R.L. de C.V. Torre Esmeralda II, Blvd Manuel Avila Camacho No. 36 Piso 18, Lomas de Chapultepec, 11000 D.F., Mexico Detica Services, Inc. 7 5th Floor, Suite 1920, 256 Franklin Street, Boston, MA 02110, United States Dividend Training Limited ETI Engineering, Inc. 7 1676 International Drive, 10th Floor, Suite 1000, McLean VA 22102, United States Eurostep AB Gustavslundsvägen 137, SE-167 51 Bromma, Sweden Eurostep Limited Unit 16 Ffordd Richard Davies, St. Asaph Business Park, St. Asaph, Denbighshire LL17 0LJ, Wales Eurostep Oy Metsänneidonkuja 12 02130 Espoo Finland Eurostep S.à.r.l. 8 rue Germain Soufflot 78180 Montigny-le-Bretonneux, France EVU Czech, S.R.O. Pernerova 691/42, Karlin, 186 00 Prague 8, Czech Republic Gloster Aircraft Limited 3 H-B Utveckling, H-B Development AB Nybrogatan 7, SE-114 34 Stockholm, Sweden Hadrian Holdings, Inc. 521 Fifth Avenue, New York NY 101075, United States Hadrian Trustees Limited 2 Hägglunds Vehicle GmbH Ernst-Grote Strasse 13, 30916 Isernhagen, Germany Hawker Siddeley Aviation Limited 3 Hawker Siddeley Dynamics Limited 3 HSA/HSD Pension Fund Trustees Limited 3 Hunter Aerospace Corporation Pty Limited Level 2, 80 Flinders Street, Adelaide SA 5000, Australia In-Space Missions Limited 8 Oriel Court, Omega Park, Alton GU34 2YT, England International Military Sales Limited Jetstream Aircraft Limited 3 Prestwick International Airport, Prestwick, Ayrshire KA9 2RW, United Kingdom MES Holdco Limited Charter Place, 23/27 Seaton Place, St. Helier, Jersey JE1 1JY MES Interco 14 Meslink Limited Newcombe Properties Limited Pitch Technologies AB Repslagaregatan 25, SE-582 22 Linköping, Sweden Pitch Technologies Limited Sweden House, 5 Upper Montagu Street, London W1H 2AG, United Kingdom Prismatic Limited 5 2 Omega Park, Alton GU34 2QE, England PT. BAE Systems Services 7 Wisma 46, Kota BNI, 34th Floor, Suite 34.01.A, Jl. Jenderal Sudirman Kavling 71, Jakarta 10220, Indonesia Pulse Power and Measurement Inc. 1717 Pennsylvania Avenue, NW Suite, 1025 Washington DC 20006, United States Pulse Power and Measurement Limited 20 65 Shrivenham Hundred Business Park, Watchfield, Swindon, Wiltshire SN6 8TY, United Kingdom Representaciones SSTS, CA 11 Ave Francisco de Miranda, Centro Lido El Rosal Oficina 71B, Caracas, Venezuela Riptide Autonomous Solutions Canada Company 600-1741 Lower Water Street, Halifax, N/A, NS, B3J 3P6, Canada Royal Ordnance (Crown Service) Pension Scheme Trustees Limited Royal Ordnance Senior Staff Pension Scheme Trustees Limited Scottish Aviation Limited 3 Prestwick International Airport, Prestwick, Ayrshire KA9 2RW, United Kingdom Sepia, LLC 1 4219 Lafayette Center Drive, Chantilly VA 20151, United States Shipbuilding (MSF) Pty Limited Level 2, 80 Flinders Street, Adelaide SA 5000, Australia Shipbuilding (VIC) Pty Limited Level 2, 80 Flinders Street, Adelaide SA 5000, Australia Simulation Technologies S.A.S. 8 rue de La Michodière, Paris, 75002, France Stewart & Stevenson Operations (Nigeria) Limited 11 9th Floor, St. Nicholas House, 26 Catholic Mission Street, Lagos, Nigeria Stewart & Stevenson TVS UK Limited Stratsec.net Sdn Bhd Unit F-3-1, Blok F, Third Floor, CBD Perdana 3, Jalan Perdana, Cyber 12, 63000 Cyberjaya, Selangor Darul Ehsan, Malaysia Support Solutions General Services and Contracting Company/Limited Liability company 1,17 House No. 145, Street No. 1, Qtr. 611, Al Andulous Area, Al Mansour, Baghdad, Iraq TDS International Holdings Pty Limited 21 Level 2, 80 Flinders Street, Adelaide SA 5000, Australia TDS International Pty Limited Level 2, 80 Flinders Street, Adelaide SA 5000, Australia Techmodal Limited Techmodal Ventures Limited TerraSim, Inc. 7 600 Grant Street, Suite 1080, Pittsburgh PA, 15219, United States The Blackburn Aeroplane & Motor Co Limited 3 The Bristol Aviation Company Limited 3 The British & Colonial Aeroplane Co. Limited 3 The Supermarine Aviation Works Limited 3,4 Thomas Sopwith Aviation Company Limited 3 TMB International Logistics Limited VSEL Birkenhead Limited Westover Controls Incorporated 7 1098 Clark Street, Endicott NY 13760, United States 216 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Consolidated financial statements 35. Information about related undertakings continued Subsidiary undertakings – not wholly-owned Advanced National Company for Aircraft Maintenance Limited (51%) PO Box 1732, Riyadh 11441, Kingdom of Saudi Arabia BAE Systems Saudi Development and Training Company Limited (50.98%) 22 PO Box 67775, Riyadh 11517, Kingdom of Saudi Arabia BAE Systems SDT (UK) Limited (51%) Flight Control System Management GmbH (66.6%) 23 PO Box 801109, 81663 Munich, Germany Granada Enterprises Limited (51%) PO Box 1732, Riyadh 11441, Kingdom of Saudi Arabia Hadrian Properties, Inc. (95%) 10 521 Fifth Avenue, New York NY 101075, United States International Systems Engineering Company Limited (46.2%) 24 PO Box 54002, Riyadh 11514, Kingdom of Saudi Arabia Overhaul and Maintenance Company Holding (51%) PO Box 1732, Riyadh 11441, Kingdom of Saudi Arabia Saudi Maintenance & Supply Chain Management Company Limited (51%) PO Box 1732, Riyadh 11441, Kingdom of Saudi Arabia Saudi Technology & Logistics Services Limited (65%) 3 PO Box 1732, Riyadh 11441, Kingdom of Saudi Arabia SMSCMC (UK) Limited (51%) Equity accounted investments Abercromby Property International (20.42%) 521 Fifth Avenue, New York NY 101075, United States Air Astana (49%) 10 4A Zakarpatskaya Street, Turksib District, Almaty, 050039, Republic of Kazakhstan AMSH B.V. (50%) 25 Coolsingel 61, 7th Floor – right, 3012 AB Rotterdam, Netherlands BAE Systems Strategic Aerospace Services WLL (49%) Building 58, Street 850, Area 23, Qatari Bin Al Fajaa, Doha, Qatar BAeHAL Software Limited (40%) 3,15 Airport Lane, HAL Estate, Bangalore 560010, India BHIC Bofors Defense Asia Sdn Bhd (49%) Level 21, Suite 21.01, The Gardens South Tower, Mid Valley City, Lingkaran Syed Putra, 59200 Kuala Lumpur, Malaysia Canadian Naval Support Limited (50%) 26 3099 Barrington Street, Halifax NS B3K 5M7, Canada Corsair Pty Ltd (51%) 27 Level 2, 80 Flinders Street, Adelaide SA 5000, Australia CTA International SAS (50%) 13 Route De La Miniere, 78034 Versailles Cedex, France Data Link Solutions L.L.C. (50%) 1,19 350 Collins Road, Northeast Cedar Rapids IA 52498, United States Eurofighter Jagdflugzeug GmbH (33%) 3 Am Soldnermoos 17, 85399 Hallbergmoos, Germany FADEC International LLC (50%) 1 1098 Clark Street, Endicott NY 13760, United States FAST Holdings Limited (50%) 15,21 FAST Training Services Limited (50%) 15 FNSS Savunma Sistemleri A.S (49%) 21 Og˘ ulbey Mahallesi, Og˘ ulbey Kumeevleri, No. 441/A, 441/B, Gölbas¸ ı, Ankara, Turkey Innovaero Holdings Pty Ltd (51%) 27 Level 2, 80 Flinders Street, Adelaide SA 5000, Australia Innovaero Operations Pty Ltd (51%) 27 Level 2, 80 Flinders Street, Adelaide SA 5000, Australia Innovaero Pty Ltd (51%) 27 Level 2, 80 Flinders Street, Adelaide SA 5000, Australia KBS Maritime Limited (50%) 28 Victory Building (Pp 72), Rm. 233, The Parade, HM Naval Base, Portsmouth PO1 3LS, England MBDA B.V. (37.5%) Coolsingel 61, 7th Floor – right, 3012 AB Rotterdam, Netherlands MBDA Holdings S.A.S. (25%) 1 avenue Réaumur, 92350 Le Plessis-Robinson, France MBDA S.A.S. (37.5%) 1 avenue Réaumur, 92350 Le Plessis-Robinson, France Nobeli Business Support AB (34%) SE-691 80 Karlskoga, Sweden Panavia Aircraft GmbH (42.5%) 3 Am Soldnermoos 17, 85399 Hallbergmoos, Germany Promoveo Solutions JV LLC (49%) 260 Peachtree Street NW, #2200, Atlanta GA 30303, United States Reaction Engines Limited (15.5%) Building F5, Culham Campus, Abingdon OX14 3DB, England Rheinmetall BAE Systems Land Limited (45%) Hadley Castle Works, PO Box 106, Telford TF1 6QW, England Saab Bofors Test Center AB (30%) Box 418, SE-691 27 Karlskoga, Sweden Sealand Support Services Limited (33.3%) 8,29 45 Gresham Street, London, EC2V 7BG, United Kingdom Winner Developments Limited (33.3%) Notes 1. Unincorporated entity for which the address given is the principal place of business. 2. Company limited by guarantee. 3. Directly owned by BAE Systems plc. 4. Ownership held in class of A shares, B shares and preference shares. 5. Ownership held in class of A shares and B shares. 6. Ownership held in ordinary shares and preference shares. 7. Ownership held in common shares. 8. In members’ voluntary liquidation (MVL). 9. Ownership held in ordinary shares and redeemable preference shares. 10. Ownership held in common stock. 11. Ownership held in authorized shares. 12. 40% directly owned by BAE Systems plc. 13. Ownership held in ordinary shares, ordinary A and ordinary B shares. 14. Unlimited company. 15. Year end 31 March. 16. Year end 5 April. 17. In liquidation. 18. Ownership held in ordinary A shares. 19. Year end 30 September. 20. Ownership held in class of A, B, C, D, E, F and G ordinary shares. 21. Ownership held in class of A shares. 22. 1% directly owned by BAE Systems plc. 23. 33.3% directly owned by BAE Systems plc. 24. Subsidiary due to unilateral controlling rights. 25. Ownership held in class of B shares. 26. Ownership held in common shares (50%) and B Preferred shares (100%). 27. Not deemed a subsidiary due to rights of other shareholder. 28. Ownership held in ordinary shares (50%) and preference shares (75%). 29. Ownership held in ordinary shares (33.3%) and A Cumulative Preference Shares (75%). 217 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Additional informationGovernance Financial statementsStrategic report Company statement of changes in equity for the year ended 31 December Note Issued share capital £m Share premium £m Other reserves £m Retained earnings 1 £m Total equity £m At 1 January 2022 85 1,252 206 2,798 4,341 Profit for the year – – – 1,648 1,648 Total other comprehensive income for the year – – 9 207 216 Total comprehensive income for the year – – 9 1,855 1,864 Share-based payments 10 – – – 102 102 Purchase of own shares 9 (3) – 3 (793) (793) Ordinary share dividends 2 – – – (802) (802) At 31 December 2022 82 1,252 218 3,160 4,712 Profit for the year – – – 1,264 1,264 Total other comprehensive expense for the year – – (5) (89) (94) Total comprehensive (expense)/income for the year – – (5) 1,175 1,170 Share-based payments 10 – – – 110 110 Purchase of own shares 9 (1) – 1 (558) (558) Ordinary share dividends 2 – – – (857) (857) Unclaimed asset programme proceeds – 1 – – 1 At 31 December 2023 81 1,253 214 3,030 4,578 1. The non-distributable portion of retained earnings is £1,037m (2022 £955m). 2. Details of ordinary share dividends are provided in note 26 to the Consolidated financial statements. 218 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Company financial statements Company balance sheet as at 31 December Note 2023 £m 2022 £m Non-current assets Intangible assets 10 44 Property, plant and equipment 1 2 Right-of-use assets 16 18 Investments in subsidiary undertakings and participating interests 2 9,272 9,191 Amounts owed by subsidiary undertakings 3 4,781 4,501 Other receivables 3 9 5 Post-employment benefit surpluses 8 105 167 Other financial assets 4 377 522 14,571 14,450 Current assets Trade and other receivables 3 126 80 Current tax 13 13 Other financial assets 4 356 448 Cash and cash equivalents 3,303 2,533 3,798 3,074 Total assets 18,369 17,524 Non-current liabilities Loans 5 (2,872) (3,042) Lease liabilities (16) (19) Other payables 6 (2) (3) Post-employment benefit obligations 8 (79) (75) Other financial liabilities 4 (332) (403) Provisions 7 (127) (126) (3,428) (3,668) Current liabilities Loans 5 (24) (25) Lease liabilities (4) (2) Trade and other payables 6 (9,908) (8,596) Other financial liabilities 4 (423) (504) Provisions 7 (4) (17) (10,363) (9,144) Total liabilities (13,791) (12,812) Net assets 4,578 4,712 Capital and reserves Issued share capital 9 81 82 Share premium 1,253 1,252 Other reserves 9 214 218 Retained earnings 1 3,030 3,160 Total equity 4,578 4,712 1. The Company’s profit for the year was £1,264m (2022 £1,648m). Approved by the Board of BAE Systems plc on 20 February 2024 and signed on its behalf by: C N Woodburn B M Greve Chief Executive Chief Financial Officer Registered number: 01470151 219 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Additional informationGovernance Financial statementsStrategic report Notes to the Company financial statements 1. Preparation of the Company financial statements Basis of preparation The directors have a reasonable expectation that the Company has adequate resources to continue its operational existence for at least 12 months from the signing of the accounts, notwithstanding the net current liabilities of £6,565m. Therefore, the financial statements ofBAESystems plc have been prepared on a going concern basis, as disclosed in the Strategic report on page 79, and in accordance withFinancial Reporting Standard (FRS) 101, Reduced Disclosure Framework. In preparing these financial statements, the Company applies therecognition, measurement and disclosure requirements of UK-adopted International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS), but makes amendments where necessary in order to comply withthe Companies Act 2006 and has set out below where advantage of the FRS 101 disclosure exemptions have been taken: – the requirements of paragraphs 45(b) and 46 to 52 of IFRS 2 Share-based Payment; – the requirements of paragraphs 62, B64(d), B64(e), B64(g), B64(h), B64(j) to B64(m), B64(n)(ii), B64(o)(ii), B64(p), B64(q)(ii), B66 andB67ofIFRS 3 Business Combinations; – the requirements of paragraph 33(c) of IFRS 5 Non-current Assets Held for Sale and Discontinued Operations; – the requirements of IFRS 7 Financial Instruments: Disclosures; – the requirements of paragraphs 91 to 99 of IFRS 13 Fair Value Measurement; – the requirements of the second sentence of paragraph 110 and paragraphs 113(a), 114, 115, 118, 119(a) to (c), 120 to 127 and 129 ofIFRS15Revenue from Contracts with Customers; – the requirement in paragraph 38 of IAS 1 Presentation of Financial Statements, to present comparative information in respect of: paragraph79(a)(iv) of IAS 1; paragraph 73(e) of IAS 16 Property, Plantand Equipment; paragraph 118(e) of IAS 38 Intangible Assets; andparagraphs 76 and 79(d) of IAS 40 Investment Property; – the requirements of paragraphs 10(d), 10(f), 16, 38A, 38B, 38C, 38D, 40A, 40B, 40C, 40D, 111 and 134 to 136 of IAS 1 Presentation ofFinancial Statements; – the requirements of IAS 7 Statement of Cash Flows; – the requirements of paragraphs 30 and 31 of IAS 8 Accounting Policies, Changes in Accounting Estimates and Errors; – the requirements of paragraphs 17 and 18A of IAS 24 Related Party Disclosures; – the requirements in IAS 24 Related Party Disclosures, to disclose related party transactions entered into between two or more members ofagroup, provided that any subsidiary which is a party to the transaction is wholly-owned by such a member; – the requirements of paragraphs 130(f)(ii), 130(f)(iii), 134(d) to 134(f) and 135(c) to 135(e) of IAS 36 Impairment of Assets; and – the requirements of paragraphs 88C and 88D of IAS 12 Income Taxes. The Company intends to continue to prepare its financial statements in accordance with FRS 101. In accordance with Section 408(3) of the Companies Act 2006, theCompany is exempt from the requirement to present its own incomestatement. The amount of profit for the year of the Company is disclosed in the Company balance sheet. The Company financial statements are presented in pounds sterling and, unless stated otherwise, rounded to the nearest million. The financial statements have been prepared under the historical cost convention, as modified by the revaluation of relevant financial assets and financial liabilities (including derivative instruments). 220 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Company financial statements 1. Preparation of the Company financial statements continued Material accounting policies The material accounting policies applied in the preparation of these individual financial statements are set out below. These policies have beenapplied consistently to all the years presented, unless otherwise stated. Investments in subsidiary undertakings and participating interests Fixed asset investments in shares in subsidiary undertakings and participating interests are stated at cost less provision for impairment. The Company recognises an increase in its investments in subsidiary undertakings in respect of the cost of share-based payment awards issuedby the Company to employees of the Company’s operating subsidiaries, with a corresponding entry to equity. Amounts owed by subsidiary undertakings Amounts owed by subsidiary undertakings are stated at amortised costincluding a provision for expected credit losses. For the purposes ofimpairment assessment, amounts to subsidiary undertakings are considered low credit risk and, therefore, the Company measures the provision at an amount equal to 12-month expected credit losses. Other significant accounting policies Other significant accounting policies are consistent with the Consolidated financial statements. Judgements and sources of estimation uncertainty In the course of preparing the financial statements, no judgements have been made in the process of applying the Company’s accounting policies, other than those involving estimates, that have had a significant effect on the amounts recognised in the Company financial statements. Key sources of estimation uncertainty Post-employment benefits A number of actuarial assumptions are made in assessing the value of post-employment benefit obligations, including discount rate, inflationrate and mortality assumptions. For each of the actuarial assumptions used there is a wide range of possible values and managementestimates a point within that range that most appropriately reflects the Group’s circumstances. If estimates relating to these actuarial assumptions are no longer valid or change due to changing economic and social conditions, thenthepotential obligations due under these schemes could change significantly. Discount and inflation rates could change significantly as a result ofaprolonged economic downturn, monetary policy decisions and interventions or other macroeconomic issues. The impact of estimates made with regard to mortality projections may also change. Similarly, the values of many assets are subject to estimates and assumptions, in particular those which are held in unquoted pooled investmentvehicles. The associated fair value of these unquoted pooled investments is estimated with consideration of the most recently available valuations provided by the investment or fund managers. These valuations inherently incorporate a number of assumptions includingthe impact of climate change on the underlying investments. The overall level of estimation uncertainty in valuing these assets couldtherefore give rise to a material change in valuation within the next 12 months. Furthermore, estimates are required around the Group’s ability to access its defined benefit surpluses, and on what basis, which then determines the associated rate of tax to apply. Depending on the outcome, judgement is then required to determine the presentation ofanytaxpayable in recovering a surplus. Note 24 of the Consolidated financial statements provides information on the key assumptions and analysis of their sensitivities. Changes in accounting policies Several standards, interpretations and amendments to existing standards became effective on 1 January 2023, as detailed on page 159 oftheConsolidated financial statements, none of which had a material impact on the Company. The Company has reviewed its parent company guarantee contracts following the issue of IFRS 17 Insurance Contracts, which came into effecton 1 January 2023. IFRS 17 establishes the principles for the recognition, measurement, presentation and disclosure of insurance contractswithin the scope of the Standard. Management have determined that a number of the Company’s parent company guarantees fall within the definition of IFRS 17 Insurance Contracts, and consider any insurance contract liability arising to be negligible. In determining this position, management have taken into consideration a number of factors including the fact that no claims have historically been made against the Company under these contracts, as well as factoring in scenarios which could result in a guarantee being called upon in the future, includingunder circumstances of insolvency within the Group. The probability weighted cash flows based on these scenarios were negligible and, as aresult, no liability has been recognised in respect of these contracts. 221 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Additional informationGovernance Financial statementsStrategic report Notes to the Company financial statements continued 2. Investments in subsidiary undertakings and participating interests £m Cost At 1 January 2023 9,197 Additions 82 Disposal (1) At 31 December 2023 9,278 Impairment provisions At 1 January 2023 and 31 December 2023 6 Net carrying value At 31 December 2023 9,272 At 31 December 2022 9,191 3. Trade and other receivables 2023 £m 2022 £m Non-current Amounts owed by subsidiary undertakings 1 4,781 4,501 Other receivables 9 5 4,790 4,506 Current Prepayments 13 16 Accrued income 34 36 Other receivables 79 28 126 80 1. Amounts owed by subsidiary undertakings are repayable on demand. Whilst the majority of these receivables are interest free, certain balances bear interest priced onanarm’s-length basis. Provision for expected credit losses is immaterial. 4. Other financial assets and liabilities 2023 2022 Assets £m Liabilities £m Assets £m Liabilities £m Non-current Cash flow hedges – foreign exchange contracts 2 – 7 – Other foreign exchange/interest rate contracts 275 (275) 368 (368) Debt-related derivative financial instruments 100 (57) 147 (35) 377 (332) 522 (403) Current Cash flow hedges – foreign exchange contracts 1 – 2 (1) Other foreign exchange/interest rate contracts 355 (402) 446 (503) Debt-related derivative financial instruments – (21) – – 356 (423) 448 (504) Included within other foreign exchange contracts are derivatives entered into on behalf of subsidiaries. These derivatives were passed down tothe hedging subsidiary using an internal derivative with equal but opposite terms to the external derivatives, and valued using the same methodology as the external derivatives. The majority of such derivatives were designated in cash flow hedges in the Consolidated financial statements. Disclosures in respect of the maturity profile and fair value of other financial assets and liabilities are provided in notes 15 and 28 tothe Consolidated financial statements. 222 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Company financial statements 5. Loans and overdrafts 2023 £m 2022 £m Non-current US$1,300m 3.4% bond, repayable 2030 1,013 1,073 US$1,000m 1.9% bond, repayable 2031 778 824 US$400m 5.8% bond, repayable 2041 311 330 US$1,000m 3.0% bond, repayable 2050 770 815 2,872 3,042 Current Accrued interest 24 25 24 25 6. Trade and other payables 2023 £m 2022 £m Non-current Other payables 2 3 Current Amounts owed to subsidiary undertakings 1 8,263 7,379 Amounts owed to equity accounted investments 1,509 1,021 Accruals 98 105 Deferred income 10 42 Other payables 28 49 9,908 8,596 1. Amounts owed to subsidiary undertakings are repayable on demand. Whilst the majority of these payables are interest free, certain balances bear interest priced onanarm’s-length basis. 7. Provisions Contractual and other £m Non-current 126 Current 17 At 1 January 2023 143 Created 1 Utilised (12) Released (6) Net present value adjustments 5 At 31 December 2023 131 Represented by: Non-current 127 Current 4 131 The Company holds provisions for contractual costs that it expects to incur over an extended period. These costs are based on past experience ofsimilar items and represent management’s best estimate of the likely outcome, but the timing and amount of the outflows could differ significantly from management’s estimates. The Company expects these provisions to be utilised over a period of approximately 25 years. 223 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Additional informationGovernance Financial statementsStrategic report Notes to the Company financial statements continued 8. Post-employment benefits The Company participates in all of the Group’s UK pension schemes. Regular contributions to the schemes are made in line with the schedule ofcontributions and a share of deficit funding is allocated to participating employers. The deficit allocation methodology is based on the historical allocation percentages applied for all retired and deferred scheme members, adjusted by the relative payroll contributions of active members. Full disclosures relating to these schemes are given in note 24 to the Consolidated financial statements. Amounts recognised on the balance sheet The table below shows the Company’s share of the Group’s UK pension schemes after allocation to other participating employers. 2023 £m 2022 £m Present value of unfunded obligations (79) (75) Present value of funded obligations (1,748) (1,676) Fair value of scheme assets 1,910 1,933 Total net IAS 19 surplus 83 182 Withholding tax on surpluses (57) (90) Company’s share of net IAS 19 surplus 26 92 Represented by: Post-employment benefit surpluses 105 167 Post-employment benefit obligations (79) (75) 26 92 Surplus recognition A number of schemes are in an accounting surplus position. The surpluses have been recognised on the basis that the future economic benefits are unconditionally available to the Company, which is assumed to be via a refund. On 22 November 2023, the UK government announced that the authorised surplus payments charge would be reduced from 35% to 25% from 6 April 2024. The legislation had not been legally enacted asat the date of issue of these financial statements. The surplus has been recognised net of withholding tax of 35% at 31 December 2023 (2022: 35%) based on the enacted legislation at that date. Should the legislation have been enacted at year-end, this would have resulted in an£16m increase in the pension surplus. This tax would be levied prior to the future refunding of any surplus and therefore the surplus has beenpresented on a net basis as this is not deemed to be an income tax. 9. Share capital and other reserves Share capital and equity dividends Disclosures in respect of the Company’s share capital and on equity dividends are provided in note 26 to the Consolidated financial statements. Other reserves Statutory reserve £m Capital redemption reserve £m Hedging reserve £m Total £m At 1 January 2022 202 5 (1) 206 Amounts credited to hedging reserve – – 9 9 Shares cancelled – 3 – 3 At 31 December 2022 202 8 8 218 Amounts debited to hedging reserve – – (5) (5) Shares cancelled – 1 – 1 At 31 December 2023 202 9 3 214 Statutory reserve Under Section 4 of the British Aerospace Act 1980, this reserve may only be applied in paying up unissued shares of the Company to be allotted to members of the Company as fully paid bonus shares. Capital redemption reserve The capital redemption reserve represents the cumulative nominal value of the Company’s ordinary shares repurchased and subsequently cancelled. Hedging reserve The hedging reserve comprises the effective portion of the cumulative net change in the fair value of cash flow hedging instruments related tohedged transactions that have not yet occurred. 224 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Company financial statements 9. Share capital and other reserves continued Purchase of own shares On 29 July 2021, the Company announced the details of a share buyback programme to repurchase up to £500m of its own shares over thefollowing 12 months (the 2021 share buyback programme). The 2021 share buyback programme was completed on 2 February 2022. During 2022, 24,253,065 shares were repurchased under the 2021 share buyback programme for a total price, including transaction costs, of£132m. In July 2022, the directors approved a new share buyback programme (the 2022 share buyback programme) of up to £1.5bn over the next threeyears under the same terms asthe 2021 buyback programme. During 2022, 82,997,065 shares were repurchased under the 2022 share buyback programme for a total price, including transaction costs, of £664m. In total during 2022, 107,250,130 shares were repurchased under the 2021 and 2022 share buyback programmes for a total price, including transaction costs, of £796m. During 2023, the total number of shares repurchased under the 2022 share buyback programme was 58,689,756 for a total price, including transaction costs, of £558m. All ordinary shares acquired have been subsequently cancelled, with the nominal value of ordinary shares cancelled deducted from share capital against the capital redemption reserve. As part of the buyback programmes, it was agreed that should a better alternative use for the Company’s cash reserves be identified, the sharebuyback programme would be ceased, and the money instead used for the alternative purpose. Therefore, when the Company issued amandate to the brokers to purchase shares on their behalf, the mandates were structured such that they could be revoked at any point. Assuch, no financial liability was recognised for shares not yet purchased under the programmes. On 2 August 2023, the directors approved a further share buyback programme (the 2023 share buyback programme) of up to £1.5bn, which isexpected to commence after completion of the 2022 share buyback programme and conclude within three years of its commencement. 10. Share-based payments Options over shares of the Company have been granted to employees of the Company under various plans. Details of the terms and conditions ofeach share-based payment plan are given in the Annual remuneration report on pages 115 to 134. 2023 2022 Range of exercise price of outstanding options £ Weighted average remaining contracted life Years Range of exercise price of outstanding options £ Weighted average remaining contracted life Years Executive Share Option Plan (ExSOP) 7.83 – 4.85 7 4.12 – 7.83 8 Performance Share Plan (PSP) – 5 – 5 Restricted Share Plan (RSP) – 5 – 5 The average share price in the year was £9.77 (2022 £7.53). 11. Employees The average and year-end numbers of employees of the Company at 31 December 2023 were 1,349 (2022 1,938) and 1,480 (2022 2,119) respectively. All of the Company’s employees work within head office functions. Total staff costs, excluding charges for share-based payments, were as follows: 2023 £m 2022 £m Wages and salaries 106 133 Social security costs 17 18 Pension costs – defined contribution plans 8 7 Pension costs – defined benefit plans 15 23 146 181 On 1 January 2023, 1,109 employees were transferred from BAE Systems plc to BAE Systems Services Limited, a wholly-owned subsidiary, as part of the Group’s reorganisation of its internal shared services activities. 225 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Additional informationGovernance Financial statementsStrategic report Notes to the Company financial statements continued 12. Other information Company audit fee Fees payable to the Company’s auditor for the audit of the Company’s annual accounts totalled £3,043,000 (2022 £2,963,000). Fees payable toDeloitteLLP and its associates for non-audit services to the Company are not required to be disclosed because the Consolidated financial statements disclose such fees on a consolidated basis (see note 3 to the Consolidated financial statements). Related party transactions Disclosures in respect of related party transactions are provided in note 30 to the Consolidated financial statements. Directors’ emoluments Under Schedule 5 of the Large and Medium-Sized Companies and Groups (Accounts and Reports) Regulations 2008 (Schedule 5), total directors’ emoluments, excluding Company pension contributions, were £11,064,996 (2022 £10,064,679); these amounts are calculated on a different basis to emoluments in the Annual remuneration report which are calculated under Schedule 8 of the Large and Medium-Sized Companies and Groups (Accounts and Reports) Regulations 2008 (Schedule 8). These emoluments were paid for their services on behalf ofthe BAE Systems Group. Noemoluments related specifically to their work for the Company. Under Schedule 5, the aggregate gains made bythe directors from the exercise of share options in 2023 as at the date of exercise was £1,732,675 (2022 £1,676,502) andthenet aggregate value ofassets received bydirectors in 2023 from Long-Term Incentive Plans as calculated at the date of vesting was £6,364,979 (2022 £5,073,406); these amounts arecalculated on a different basis from the valuation of share plan benefits under Schedule 8 in the Annual remuneration report. Retirement benefits are accruing to one director in respect of defined benefit schemes and to three directors in respect of defined contribution schemes. Subsidiary guarantees Borrowings by subsidiary undertakings totalling £2,215m (2022 £2,147m), which are included in the Group’s borrowings, have been guaranteed bytheCompany, with the guarantees measured initially at their fair values, and subsequently measured at the higher of the expected credit lossdetermined under IFRS 9 Financial Instruments and the amount initially recognised less cumulative amortisation. Information about related undertakings In accordance with Section 409 of the Companies Act 2006, a full list of the Company’s subsidiaries and significant holdings is included innote35to the Consolidated financial statements. 13. Events after the reporting period There were no events after the reporting period which would materially impact the balances reported in the Company financial statements. 226 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Company financial statements Alternative performance measures We monitor the underlying financial performance of the Group using alternative performancemeasures (APMs). Thesemeasures are not defined in IFRS and, therefore, areconsidered to be non-GAAP measures. Accordingly, therelevant IFRS measures arealsopresented where appropriate. The Group uses these APMs as a mechanism to support year-on-year business performance and cash generation comparisons, and to enhance management’s planning and decision-making on the allocation of resources. The APMs arealso used to provide information in line with the expectations of investors, and when setting guidance on expected future business performance. The Group presents these measures to the users to enhance their understanding of how thebusiness has performed within the year, and does not consider them to be more important than, or superior to, theirequivalent IFRS measures. As each APM is defined by the Group, they may not be directly comparable with equivalently-named measures in other companies. Purpose, definitions, breakdowns and reconciliations to the relevant statutory measure, where appropriate, are included below. Sales Purpose Enables management to monitor the revenue of both the Group’s own subsidiaries as well as recognising the strategic importance in its industry of its equity accounted investments, to ensure programme performance is understood and in line with expectations. Definition Revenue plus the Group’s share of revenue of equity accounted investments, excluding subsidiaries’ revenue from equity accounted investments. Reconciliation of sales to revenue 2023 £m 2022 £m Sales KPI 25,284 23,256 Deduct: Group’s share of revenue of equity accounted investments (3,892) (3,342) Add: Subsidiaries’ revenue from equity accounted investments 1,686 1,344 Revenue 23,078 21,258 Underlying EBIT Purpose Provides a measure of operating profitability, excluding one-off events or adjusting items that are not considered to be part of the ongoing operational transactions of the business, to enable management to monitor the performance of recurring operations over time, and which is comparable across the Group. Definition Operating profit excluding amortisation of programme, customer-related and other intangible assets (see note 9 to the Consolidated financial statements), impairment of intangible assets, net finance costs and tax expense of equity accounted investments (EBIT) and adjusting items. Theexclusion of amortisation of acquisition-related intangible assets is to allow consistent comparability internally and externally between our businesses, regardless of whether they have been grown organically or via acquisition. Reconciliation of underlying EBIT to operating profit 2023 £m 2022 £m Underlying EBIT KPI 2,682 2,479 Adjusting items 40 91 Amortisation of programme, customer-related and other intangible assets, and impairment of intangibles (116) (111) Net finance income/(costs) of equity accounted investments 14 (25) Tax expense of equity accounted investments (47) (50) Operating profit 2,573 2,384 Return on sales Purpose Provides a measure of operating profitability, excluding one-off events, to enable management to monitor the performance of recurring operations over time, and which is comparable across the Group. Definition Underlying EBIT as a percentage of sales. Also referred to as margin. 2023 £m 2022 £m Sales KPI 25,284 23,256 Underlying EBIT KPI 2,682 2,479 Return on sales 10.6% 10.7% 227 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Financial statementsGovernance Additional informationStrategic report Alternative performance measures continued Underlying earnings per share (EPS) Purpose Provides a measure of the Group’s underlying performance, which enables management to compare the profitability of the Group’s recurring operations over time. Definition Profit for the year attributable to shareholders, excluding post-tax impact of amortisation of programme, customer-related and other intangible assets, impairment of intangible assets, non-cash finance movements on pensions and financial derivatives, and adjusting items attributable to shareholders, being underlying earnings, divided by number of shares as defined for Basic EPS in accordance with IAS 33 Earnings per Share. Reconciliation of underlying earnings to profit attributable to equity shareholders 2023 £m 2022 £m Underlying earnings 1,916 1,728 Adjustments: Adjusting items 40 91 Amortisation of programme, customer-related and other intangible assets, and impairment of intangibles (116) (111) Net interest income/(expense) on post-employment benefit obligations 44 (38) Fair value and foreign exchange adjustments on financial instruments and investments (66) (136) Tax impact of adjustments 39 57 Profit for the year attributable to equity shareholders 1,857 1,591 Reconciliation of underlying EBIT to underlying earnings 2023 £m 2022 £m Underlying EBIT KPI 2,682 2,479 Group and equity accounted investments underlying net finance costs (see reconciliation page 229) (211) (246) Underlying tax expense (see reconciliation page 229) (472) (422) Underlying profit for the year 1,999 1,811 Deduct: Non-controlling interest (83) (83) Underlying earnings 1,916 1,728 Weighted average number of ordinary shares used in calculating basic earnings per share (note 8 to the Consolidated financial statements) 3,031 3,112 Underlying earnings per share – basic KPI 63.2p 55.5p Weighted average number of ordinary shares used in calculating diluted earnings per share (note 8 to the Consolidated financial statements) 3,072 3,153 Underlying earnings per share – diluted 62.4p 54.8p Adjusting items Purpose To adjust items of financial performance from the reported underlying results which have been determined by management as being material bytheir size or incidence andnot relevant to an understanding of the Group’s underlying business performance. Definition Adjusting items include profit or loss on business transactions, the impact of substantively enacted tax rate changes, and costs incurred which are one-off in nature, for example non-routine costs or income relating to post-retirement benefit schemes, and other items which management has determined as not being relevant to an understanding of the Group’s underlying business performance. 2023 £m 2022 £m Profit on business disposals – 94 Gain related to settlements and past service costs on the pension schemes 60 13 Acquisition-related costs (20) (16) Adjusting items 40 91 228 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Alternative performance measures Underlying net finance costs Purpose Provides a measure of net finance costs associated with the operational borrowings of the Group that is comparable over time. Definition Net finance costs for the Group and its share of equity accounted investments, excluding net interest income/expense on post-employment benefit obligations and fair value and foreign exchange adjustments on financial instruments. 2023 £m 2022 £m Net finance costs – Group (247) (395) (Deduct)/add back: Net interest (income)/expense on post-employment benefit obligations (41) 37 Fair value and foreign exchange adjustments on financial instruments 57 128 Underlying net finance costs – Group (231) (230) Net finance income/(costs) – equity accounted investments 14 (25) (Deduct)/add back: Net interest (income)/expense on post-employment benefit obligations (3) 1 Fair value and foreign exchange adjustments on financial instruments 9 8 Underlying net finance income/(costs) – equity accounted investments 20 (16) Total of Group and equity accounted investments’ underlying net finance costs (211) (246) Underlying effective tax rate Purpose Provides a measure of tax expense for the Group, excluding one-off items, that is comparable over time. During the year, the calculation of the underlying effective tax rate has been re-presented to better align to the underlying profit of the Group. This has not impacted the prior year effective tax rate. Definition Tax expense for the Group and its share ofequity accounted investments, excluding any one-off tax benefit/expense related to adjusting items and other items excluded from underlying EBIT, as a percentage of underlying profit before tax. Calculation of the underlying effective tax rate 2023 £m 2022 £m Underlying EBIT KPI (see reconciliation on page 228) 2,682 2,479 Group and equity accounted investments’ underlying net finance costs (see reconciliation on page 229) (211) (246) Underlying profit before tax 2,471 2,233 Group tax expense (386) (315) Tax expense of equity accounted investments (47) (50) Exclude: Tax expense in respect of taxable adjusting items 11 – Tax expense in respect of other items excluded from underlying profit (49) (54) Tax rate adjustment (1) (3) Underlying tax expense (472) (422) Underlying effective tax rate 19% 19% 229 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Financial statementsGovernance Additional informationStrategic report Alternative performance measures continued Free cash flow Purpose Provides a measure of cash generated by the Group’s operations after servicing debt and tax obligations, available for use in line with the Group’s capital allocation policy. Definition Net cash flow from operating activities, including dividends received from equity accounted investments, interest paid, net of interest received, net capital expenditure and financial investments, and principal elements of lease payments and receipts. Reconciliation from free cash flow to net cash flow from operating activities 2023 £m 2022 £m Free cash flow KPI 2,593 1,950 Add back: Interest paid, net of interest received 230 237 Net capital expenditure and financial investment 789 519 Principal element of lease payments and receipts 282 227 Deduct: Dividends received from equity accounted investments (134) (94) Net cash flow from operating activities 3,760 2,839 Operating business cash flow Purpose Provides a measure of cash generated by the Group’s operations, which is comparable across the Group, to service debt and meet tax obligations, and in turn available for use in line with the Group’s capital allocation policy. Definition Net cash flow from operating activities excluding tax paid net of research and development expenditure credits received and including net capital expenditure (net of proceeds from funding of assets) and lease principal amounts, financial investment and dividends from equity accounted investments. Reconciliation from operating business cash flow to net cash flow from operating activities 2023 £m 2022 £m Operating business cash flow 3,218 2,552 Add back: Net capital expenditure and financial investment 789 519 Principal element of lease payments and receipts 282 227 Deduct: Dividends received from equity accounted investments (134) (94) Tax paid net of research and development expenditure credits received (395) (365) Net cash flow from operating activities 3,760 2,839 Reconciliation of operating business cash flow tonet cash flow from operating activities by reporting segment Operating business cashflow Deduct: Dividends received fromequity accounted investments Add back: Net capital expenditure, lease principal amounts and financial investment Net cash flow from operating activities 2023 £m 2022 £m 2023 £m 2022 £m 2023 £m 2022 £m 2023 £m 2022 £m Electronic Systems 811 650 (8) (6) 158 216 961 860 Platforms & Services 426 525 – – 198 108 624 633 Air 1,669 1,140 (112) (84) 251 146 1,808 1,202 Maritime 291 235 (7) (4) 345 187 629 418 Cyber & Intelligence 204 154 – – 57 37 261 191 HQ (183) (152) (7) – 62 52 (128) (100) 3,218 2,552 (134) (94) 1,071 746 4,155 3,204 Tax paid net of research and development expenditure credits received (395) (365) Net cash flow from operating activities 3,760 2,839 230 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Alternative performance measures Net debt (excluding lease liabilities) Purpose Allows management to monitor indebtedness of theGroup, to ensure the Group’s capital structure isappropriate and capital allocation policy decisions aresuitably informed. Definition Cash and cash equivalents, less loans and overdrafts (including debt-related derivative financial instruments). Net debt does not include leaseliabilities. Components of net debt (excluding lease liabilities) 2023 £m 2022 £m Cash and cash equivalents 4,067 3,107 Debt-related derivative financial instruments (net) 22 112 Loans – non-current (4,432) (5,189) Loans and overdrafts – current (679) (53) Net debt (excluding lease liabilities) KPI (1,022) (2,023) Order intake Purpose Allows management to monitor the order intake of theGroup together with its equity accounted investments, providing insight into future years’ sales performance. Definition Funded orders received from customers including theGroup’s share of order intake of equity accountedinvestments. 2023 £bn 2022 £bn Order intake KPI 37.7 37.1 Order backlog Purpose Supports future years’ sales performance of the Group together with its equity accounted investments. Definition Funded and unfunded unexecuted customer ordersincluding the Group’s share of order backlog of equity accounted investments. Unfunded orders include the elements of US multi-year contracts forwhich funding has not been authorised by thecustomer. Reconciliation of order backlog, as defined by the Group, to order book 1 2023 £bn 2022 £bn Order backlog, as defined by the Group 69.8 58.9 Deduct: Unfunded order backlog (2.3) (2.3) Share of order backlog of equity accounted investments (13.5) (12.0) Add back: Order backlog in respect of orders from equity accounted investments 4.0 4.3 Order book 1 58.0 48.9 1. Order book represents the transaction price allocated to unsatisfied and partially satisfied performance obligations as defined by IFRS 15 Revenue from Contracts withCustomers. 231 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Financial statementsGovernance Additional informationStrategic report Other sustainability information Scenario planning – material climate-related risk and opportunity Physical risk Materiality of risk or opportunity/ timeframe 1 Short, medium and long term Description Unmitigated potential impact Business readiness We have assessed the future physical risk of extreme weather on 140 priority sites globally. We have operations in more than 40 countries, witha focus in the UK, US, the Kingdom of SaudiArabia and Australia; therefore our operational exposure to physical risks is diverseand varies by region. Risks have been quantified for seven hazards infuture periods to 2100 under three scenarios. Unmitigated damage and disruption losses have been financially quantified for 140priority sites. The impact of the physical risks of climate change, such as increasing frequency and severityof extreme weather events, will affect BAE Systems’ operations and vary depending onthe particular hazard and geography. Overall, extreme weather events are likely to result in repaircosts, adaptation investments and reductions inproductivity. Financial impact Low We currently assess the physical locations of ourglobal sites against physical risk of extreme weather events. This includes risk engineering reviews at site level and a quantification of current potential financial impacts. Any mitigation actions arising from these assessments are included within sector IBP. Our mitigation work is also supported by work underway and planned by central and local government departments within the countries and counties/states that we have facilities in. Transition risk – regulation Materiality of risk or opportunity/ timeframe 1 Medium term Description Unmitigated potential impact Business readiness We have assessed the transition risk of tightening environmental laws and regulations in relation tocarbon pricing globally. Carbon pricing is anapproach used to reduce carbon emissions through market mechanisms. It passes the societal cost of climate change from the emissions of GHGs back to the organisations responsible for emitting them. Asaresult, it hasthe purpose of discouraging the use of GHG-emitting activities in order toprotect theenvironment, address the causes ofclimate change, and meet national and international climate agreements. Carbon pricing instruments can take many forms, with the most common being carbon taxes, taxes on fuels, andtrading schemes/levies. The cost of carbon to 2050 was calculated usingScope 1 and 2 measured emissions. Thiswas performed using prices modelled inthree IEA transition scenarios: STEPS, APSandNZE (see page 233). The cost ofcarbonassumes a 100%passthrough fromenergy suppliers, and has been analysed under two pathways: (a) static emissions; and(b)decarbonisation tonet zero by 2050. Carbon pricing has the potential to increase operational costs via carbon taxes and levies tothe business for energy and fuel use; and indirect taxes which are passed to the Group through purchased energy. Financial impact Low Our decarbonisation strategy andoperational lowcarbon pathway will lower our exposure tocarbon taxes. We will continue to monitor environmental lawsand regulations in relation to carbon pricing,including any potential financial impactson theGroup. 1. Short- (less than two years), medium- (three to ten years) and long-term (beyond ten years) time horizons. Time horizons are linked to the IBP process. Climate scenario planning We use climate scenarios to assess the resilience of our business, decarbonisation strategy and our approach to managing climate-related risk and opportunities including the impact on our financial results. Climate scenarios demonstrate different possible futures, based on expert peer reviewed projections, but they are not forecasts. They are designed for companies totest their business resilience against a range of different future states to inform strategic decision-making. Scenario analysis isa necessary exercise to understand what parts of the business are exposed to and impacted by climate change. Climate change and nature-related risks andopportunities extend beyond normal business strategic planning cycles and have the potential to impact BAE Systems over short- (less than two years), medium- (threeto ten years) and long-term (beyondten years) time horizons. During 2022, we built upon our qualitative scenario planning work that we commenced during 2021, by progressing material physicalrisk and transition risks quantification and continuing qualitative analysis on transition opportunities. Materiality of risk and opportunities was based on the likelihood of occurrence and potential impact on the Group. For each area, we identified sub-risks and opportunities forquantification. Analysis of these risk and opportunity areas has helped BAE Systems tounderstand the scale of the unmitigated impact, through the development of a methodology and calculation of the possible financial impact. We anticipate revisiting our scenario planning as part of our next business review in 2025. 232 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Other sustainability information We have used the following key assumptions within our scenarios: Assumption Rationale No action is taken by BAE Systems to mitigate orlimit the impacts of each risk being assessed. Uncovers what the implications are if climate risks are left unmitigated to help facilitate a response plan. These results can be used by the business totest whether current mitigation is sufficient. Mutual exclusivity is applied to the scenarios andunderlying climate attributes (i.e. impacts are not aggregated or offset). Ensures that no impacts are cancelled out. We donot assess scenarios where both transitions risks and physical risks take place at the same time (although this is inevitable). Business activities are static over the future period (revenue streams, operating model, emissions, etc). Isolates the climate element of the risks to showimplications on strategy in a world wherebusiness as usual remains. For transition risks and opportunities, IEAscenario data has been used, due to its relevance to the Group’s decarbonisation strategy, global and regional coverage, timeframes considered and information on drivers and frequency of scenario updates. 1.5°C Net Zero Emissions scenario (NZE) Source: IEA Net Zero Economy by 2050 Announced Pledges Scenario (APS) Source: IEA Announced Pledges Scenario Stated Policies Scenario (STEPS) Source: IEA Stated Policies Scenario Transition risk – technology Materiality of risk or opportunity/ timeframe 1 Medium to long term Description Unmitigated potential impact Business readiness In the UK, nearly half of BAE Systems’ emissions come from heating buildings.To support the decarbonisation ofourheating systems over thelong term, wecould consider switching to lower-emissionsheating technology. The decarbonisation of energy for heating poses achallenge, as most cost-effective solutions are currently expensive and subscale. This could resultin increased costs arising from the need toreplace existing plant and equipment to incorporate lower-emissions technologies, suchasheat pumps. We have reviewed the roll-out of heat pumps asapotential option to replace current gas-fired heating systems and this was assessed under three IEApricing scenarios to 2050. Introducing alternative energy sources such asrenewable energy-powered heat pumps will lower our emissions, but at this point would require significant capital expenditure to retrofit our sites and install the devices. Due to the difficulties of switching fuels and maintaining legacy systems, installing heat pumps is considered one of the best transition solutions over the long term. This is because heat pumps are more efficient than other heating systems inproducing more heat energy than the amount of electricity consumed. Heat pump technology is currently expensive, asthe technology and market is still developing. Financial impact Low In the UK, we have considered the feasibility ofintroducing renewable energy-powered heatpumps over the long term, as part of thedecarbonisation strategy. We will continue to monitor the development oflower- emissions heating technology, over thelong term, as a way tosupport the delivery ofour net zero ambitions. Transition opportunity – products Materiality of risk or opportunity/ timeframe 1 Medium Description Unmitigated potential impact Business readiness The transition to a low carbon economy presents opportunities for BAE Systems and continued innovation will be required to provide solutions toexisting and new customer bases. Our ability to increase revenues will be dependent on applying advanced engineering capabilities to develop new products that support lower-emissions requirements, creating new business lines and enhancing competitive positions in order to retain and grow market share. Continued investment, both Group and customer, in research and development will be required. To decarbonise by 2050, we must ensure thatourproducts and services support a decarbonisation pathway. This will beachieved byadvancing the efficiency of our products andservices, in the short term, and transitioning to lower orzero emissions products and technology longer term. Thiswill require continued investment in our R&D activities. We have been engaging with our customers tounderstand their decarbonisation pathways including the challenges they face regarding operational effectiveness and availability. Many customers are setting targets and looking for lower carbon, sustainable products. We are working to understand and influence their futurerequirements to help inform and shape product innovation and development. Sustainable fuels will help facilitate our product and service decarbonisation pathway over the long term. BAE Systems can use the market presence and brand recognition for its electric and hybrid propulsion systems portfolio developed through the well-established urban transit bus products, by leveraging and transitioning this expertise toother, emerging and nascent markets such as aviation, maritime and heavy industrial transport vehicle markets. 233 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Financial statementsGovernance Additional informationStrategic report Other sustainability information continued Greenhouse gas (GHG) emissions data Absolute energy consumption 2023 1 2022 Global 2 kWh UK kWh Global kWh UK kWh Energy consumption Scope 1 and 2 1,315,552,368 534,961,834 1,469,387,190 594,930,180 GHG emissions data 2023 1 2022 Scope definition Global 2 tonnes CO 2 e UK tonnes CO 2 e Global tonnes CO 2 e UK tonnes CO 2 e 1 Emissions from activities which BAESystemsowns orcontrols (Scope 1) 107,360 54,204 113,089 55,686 2 Emissions from the electricity and steam purchased for BAESystems’ use(Scope 2 – location-based) 243,457 54,456 281,182 60,374 Total gross Scope 1 and 2 emissions 350,817 108,660 394,271 116,060 3 Emissions from employee business travel (Scope 3) 114,030 44,261 62,519 20,999 GHG emissions per employee 2023 1 2022 Global tonnes CO 2 e UK tonnes CO 2 e Global tonnes CO 2 e UK tonnes CO 2 e Per each full-time equivalent employee (Scope1 and 2) 4 3 4 3 1. Relevant reporting period 1 November 2022 to31 October 2023. 2. Deloitte has provided independent limited assurancein accordance with the International Standard for Assurance Engagements 3000 (ISAE3000) and Assurance Engagements on Greenhouse Gas Statements (ISAE 3410) issued bythe International Auditing and Assurance Standards Board (IAASB) over the selected metrics identified with a 2 . Deloitte’s full unqualified assurance opinion, which includes details of theselected metrics assured, can be found atbaesystems.com/annual-report To see our Basis of Reporting 2023 visit baesystems.com/annual-report 2023 key environment data 1 Water consumption 2 2023 cubic metres 2022 cubic metres Mains 2,135,695 2,409,896 Abstracted 2,925,651 5,968,417 Total 5,061,346 8,378,313 Recycled 884,906 728,911 Waste production 2 2023 tonnes 2022 tonnes Non-hazardous 58,482 42,413 Hazardous 9,308 5,072 Total 67,790 47,485 Recycled 3 32,870 33,167 Electricity consumption 2023 kWh 2022 kWh Grid 755,301,151 877,726,240 Renewable 2,083,735 5,951,873 Total 4 757,384,886 5 883,678,113 1. Relevant reporting period 1 November 2022 to 31 October 2023. 2. BAE Systems Internal Audit has reviewed the systems, processes and controls in place to collate, validate and report this data. Based on the procedures and the evidence obtained, nothing has come to its attention that indicates the disclosures have not been properly prepared in accordance with such systems, processes andcontrols. 3. For 2022, includes non-hazardous and hazardous waste recycling. 4. For 2022, estimates now reported in line with SECR requirements. 5. Deloitte has provided independent limited assurance in accordance with the International Standard for Assurance Engagements 3000 (ISAE3000) and Assurance Engagements on Greenhouse Gas Statements (ISAE 3410) issued bythe International Auditing and Assurance Standards Board (IAASB) over the selected metrics identified with a 5 . Deloitte’s full unqualified assurance opinion, which includes details of the selected metrics assured, can be found at baesystems.com/annual-report. Climate scenarios and data used For physical risk, TCFD scenario analysis guidance recommends analysing at least three different climate scenarios to ensure a broad range ofoutcomes are considered. Each scenario causes different levels of future physical risk, and resulting losses. This enables the user to draw comparisons between the scenarios and the level of risk and subsequent damage and disruption for future periods. We have focused on theworst-case scenario (SSP 5 – RCP 8.5) 1 in the analysis below, as this presents the most risk to our operations. Physical risk scenario Intergovernmental Panel on Climate Change trajectory alignment Scenario policy action >4°C SSP 5 – RCP 8.5 1 Temperature rise by 2100: 4.4°C No additional policy action 2–3°C SSP 2 – RCP 4.5 1 Temperature rise by 2100: 2.7°C Late policy action <2°C SSP 1 – RCP 2.6 1 Temperature rise by 2100: 1.8°C Early policy action 1. Shared Socioeconomic Pathway (SSP). Representative Concentration Pathway (RCP). 234 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Other sustainability information Methodology Greenhouse gas emissions data is reported in line with an operational control method, we use the Greenhouse Gas Protocol Corporate Accounting and Reporting Standard as guidance to support our approach to reporting. Our reporting boundary for Streamlined Energy and Carbon Reporting (SECR) is the same as our reporting boundary for the purposes of our financial statements. Unless otherwise stated data covers a12-month period between the 1 November 2022 to 31 October 2023. The GHG protocol allows participants to arrange their organisational boundaries using two different methodologies. One using the equity share or two the control approach. The business has chosen to use the control approach. Furthermore the control approach selected allows for two further methodologies to be applied to define control either a financial approach or operational approach. The business uses the latter. As a business we utilise a tool called the Global Property Database (GPD) to record and monitor locations which we either own or lease. Prior to this reporting period all locations listed in GPD wehad deemed were within our organisational boundary and we had operational control. In 2023 we reviewed our definition of operational control in order to ensure we are not accounting for emissions which are outside of our business control and where we don’t have the ability to influence. A review was undertaken to determine the combined effect of the changes we’ve introduced on the 2020 baseline. The changes tooperational control along with improvements such as the introduction of internal area being used as a multiplier for kWh consumption resulted in a 1% reduction to the baseline. Therefore we have not considered this change material requiring baseline recalculation. Emission factors for fuels and UK electricity arepublished at www.gov.uk/government/ collections/government-conversion-factors-for- company-reporting. Emission factors for US electricity are published at Download Data | USEPA, natural gas and other fuels are published at Simplified GHG Emissions Calculator | US EPA. Emissions factors for Australia (AUS) electricity and natural gas are published at National Greenhouse Accounts Factors: 2023 – DCCEEW. Emission factors for Sweden’s (SWE) natural gasare published at https://unfccc.int/ documents/224123 and electricity European Residual Mix | AIB (aib-net.org). Electricity emission factors for Saudi Arabia (KSA), and Restof World (ROW) are published at Emissions Factors 2023 – Data product – IEA. For this reporting cycle, the 2023 UK Government emissions factors published by the Department for Business, Energy and Industrial Strategy (BEIS) have been used for majority of scope 1 and 3 calculations, this covers businesses located in the UK, Australia, Kingdom of Saudi Arabia and rest of world. Inorder to improve the accuracy of reporting theInc. business in the US and Sweden are nowusing US EPA emissions factors. Scope 2 emissions factors are from a variety ofsources including country specific emissions factors such as, BEIS, Australian National Greenhouse Gas Accounts 2023 , US Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) and International Energy Agency (IEA). The most up-to-date Emissions and Generation Resource Integrated Database (eGRID) factors published byUS EPA are used for US electricity. For the 2023 reporting cycle, the most recent electricity US factors are from the year 2021. Emissions factors published by the UK Government department for Energy, Security andNet Zero – Business Energy and Industrial Strategy, are presented as CO 2 e, they cover all sixgreenhouses gases listed under the Kyoto Protocol. For further information on the inclusion of HFC’s in the reported inventory please refer tothe section on fugitive emissions. The principal record of the Group’s worldwide facilities is its legal department’s Global Property Database. The database holds records of all locations which are either wholly owned, leased or licensed sites. Greenhouse gas emissions are primarily calculated from energy consumption records e.g. invoiced data or meter reads. For the UK & ROW these are reported via the Group’s global environmental database (CR Desktop). Data related to the Inc. business is provided for internal use quarterly along with full annual data submission. Where consumption records are not available estimates may be used and these will be highlighted in thedatabase. Where actual usage data is not available forfacilities and residences within the Global Property Database, an estimated consumption isused based on the type and size of the building, if no information is available on the size of the building a default benchmark factor is used. Greenhouse gas emissions related to business travel include air travel data for the majority of the global business, rail data for business units operating in the UK and US, and vehicle (including hire car, company car and personal car) data for business units operating in the UK, US and Australia. These data sets are taken from suppliers’ procurement records. The property database details are taken in quarter3 of the financial reporting year (Jan–Dec), this means any properties acquired between quarter 4 of the previous year and quarter 3 ofthe reporting year are included within the reporting boundary. If a business is acquired within quarter 4 of the financial reporting year itwill included in the reporting boundary in the next full reporting year after the change. If a business or facility has closed between quarter 4 of the previous year and quarter 3 ofthe current year, it will not be included within the reporting boundary. Any locations which close in quarter 4 of the reporting year will be removed from reporting boundary in the next fullreporting year after the change. Emissions from non-wholly owned subsidiaries are included in the dataset if BAE Systems have operational control at the location. They are accurate as of 31 December 2023 and reflect locations in operation at that time. For the majority of these locations the joint venture either operates from one of our CR Desktop reporting locations or are included in benchmarked estimates. Some companies listed were previously described as dormant in 2022 and remain dormant in 2023. For the purposes of calculating emissions, we have excluded dormant companies as it has been assumed that they do not consume energy. Equity accounted investments and other investments detailed in the Annual Report are notincluded, these investments represent BAESystems scope 3 emissions. Emissions from pension scheme properties not occupied by the group are not included. Trading of emissions are not taken into account for the purposes of reporting, for example wherethe business has a requirement to maintain compliance with trading schemes e.g. UK ETS, the total energy consumed is reported regardless of emissions trading. The Scope 2 Greenhouse Gas Emissions associated with the GHG Protocol ‘Market-Based’ method have been calculated as 209,612 1 tCO 2 e. In line with the GHG Protocol Guidance, this figure has been calculated using residual-mix emission factors where available for our UK and US operations. In our other significant operating regions, residual mix emission factors are either unavailable or the resulting absolute emissions atgroup level are within the margin of error andtherefore country-specific emissions factors have been used in line with the GHG Protocol Guidance. If sites consume grid electricity backed by Renewable Energy Guarantee of Origin (REGOs), this has been taken into consideration within the calculations. 1. Deloitte has provided independent limited assurance in accordance with the International Standard for Assurance Engagements 3000 (ISAE3000) and AssuranceEngagements on Greenhouse Gas Statements (ISAE 3410) issued bythe International Auditing and Assurance Standards Board (IAASB) over theselectedmetrics identified with a 1 . Deloitte’s full unqualified assurance opinion, which includes details of the selected metrics assured, can be found atbaesystems.com/annual-report. 235 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Financial statementsGovernance Additional informationStrategic report Registered office 6 Carlton Gardens London SW1Y 5AD United Kingdom Telephone: +44 (0)1252 373232 Company website: baesystems.com Registered in England and Wales, No. 01470151 Registrars Equiniti Limited (0140) Aspect House Spencer Road Lancing West Sussex BN99 6DA United Kingdom If you have any queries regarding your shareholding or need to notify any changes to your personal details, please contact Equiniti. Equiniti’s website (help.shareview.co.uk) includes a comprehensive set of answers to many frequently asked questions relating to managing a shareholding. If you cannot find the answer to your question, there isan online email form, which will help to ensure your question is directed to the most appropriate team for a response. Alternatively, youcan call the BAE Systems Helpline on 0371 384 2044 or, from outside the UK, +44 121 415 7058. Lines are open from 8.30am to5.30pm Monday to Friday, excluding UK bank holidays. In addition, the following services are offered to shareholders: – Shareview – online access to your shareholding, including balancemovements, indicative share prices and information onrecent payments. – Dividend mandates – have your dividends paid directly into eitheryour UK bank/building society account or an overseas bankaccount. – Dividend reinvestment plan (DRIP) – A DRIP is provided by Equiniti Financial Services Limited. The DRIP enables the Company’s shareholders to elect to have their cash dividend payments used topurchase the Company’s shares. More information can be foundat shareview.co.uk/info/drip. More information on all these services can be found on Equiniti’s website (shareview.co.uk). American Depositary Receipts BAE Systems plc American Depositary Receipts (ADRs) are traded onthe over-the-counter market under the symbol BAESY. OneADR represents four BAE Systems plc ordinary shares. JP Morgan Chase Bank N.A. is the depositary. If you should have anyqueries please contact: JP Morgan Chase Bank N.A. PO Box 64504 St Paul MN 55164-0504, USA Email: [email protected] Telephone (toll free from within US and Canada): +1 800 990 1135 Telephone from outside US and Canada: +1 651 453 2128 ShareGift ShareGift, the share donation charity (registered charity number 1052686), accepts donations of small parcels of shares which may beuneconomic to sell. Details of the scheme are available from ShareGift at sharegift.org, by telephone on 020 7930 3737 orbyemail: [email protected] Share price information The middle market price of the Company’s ordinary shares on 31December 2023 was 1,111p and the range during the year was820pto1,129p. For more information Visit the Shareholder information section of our website: investors.baesystems.com Financial calendar Financial year end 31 December Annual General Meeting 9 May 2024 2023 final ordinary dividend payable 3 June 2024 2024 half-yearly results announcement 1 August 2024 2024 interim ordinary dividend payable 2 December 2024 2024 full-year results: – preliminary announcement – Annual Report February 2025 March 2025 2024 final ordinary dividend payable June 2025 Shareholder information Spot the warning signs Fraudsters will often: – contact you out of the blue; – apply pressure to invest quickly; – downplay the risks to your money; – promise tempting returns that sound too good to be true; and – say that they’re only making the offer available to you or evenaskyou to not tell anyone else about it. If you’re suspicious, report it You can report the firm or scam to the FCA by contacting theirConsumer Helpline on 0800 111 6768 or using the reportingform using the link shown below. If you’ve lost money in a scam, contact Action Fraud on03001232040 or www.actionfraud.police.uk How to avoid investment scams Reject unexpected offers Scammers usually cold call, but contact can also come byemail, post,word of mouth or at a seminar. If you’ve been offered an investment out of the blue, chances areit’s a high-risk investment orascam. Check the FCA Warning List Use the FCA Warning List to check the risks of a potential investment – you can also search to see if the firm is known to be operating without its authorisation. Get impartial advice Get impartial advice before investing – don’t use an adviser from thefirm that contacted you. Beware of share fraud Investment scams are often sophisticated and difficult to spot. Be ScamSmart and visit www.fca.org.uk/scamsmart 236 BAE Systems plc Annual Report 2023 Shareholder information Cautionary statement All statements other than statements of historical fact included in this document, including, without limitation, those regarding the financial condition, results, operations and businesses of BAE Systems plc and its strategy, plans and objectives and the markets and economies in which it operates, are forward-looking statements. Suchforward-looking statements, which reflect management’s assumptions made on the basis of information available to it at this time, appear in a number of places throughout this document and include statements regarding the intentions, beliefs or current expectations of BAE Systems plc concerning, amongst other things, itsresults in relation to operations, financial condition, liquidity, prospects, growth, commitments and targets (including environmental, social and governance commitments and targets), strategies and the industry in whichit operates. Forward-looking statements can be identified by the use of forward-looking terminology suchas “believes”, “expects”, “may”, “intends”, “will”, “will continue”, “should”, “would be”, “seeks”, “anticipates” or similar expressions or the negative thereof or other variations thereof or comparable terminology. By their nature, forward-looking statements involve risks and uncertainties because they relate toevents and depend on circumstances that may or may not occur in the future. Forward-looking statements are not guarantees of future performance and the actual results of operations, financial condition and liquidity of BAE Systems plc, the development of the industry in which it operates and theability of BAE Systems plc to meet its commitments and targets may differ materially from those made inorsuggested by the forward-looking statements contained in this document. In addition, even if results ofoperations, financial condition and liquidity of BAE Systems plc, the development of the industry in which itoperates and/or performance against commitments and targets are consistent with the forward-looking statements contained in this document, those results, developments or performance may not be indicative ofresults, developments or performance insubsequent periods. These forward-looking statements speak only as of the date of this document. Subject to the requirements of the Disclosure Guidance and Transparency Rules, the Market Abuse Regulation or applicable law, BAE Systems plc explicitly disclaims any intention or obligation or undertaking publicly to release the result of any revisions toany forward-looking statements in this document that may occur due to any change in its expectations or to reflect events or circumstances after the date of it. All subsequent written and oral forward-looking statements attributable to either BAE Systems plc or to persons acting on its behalf are expressly qualified in their entirety bythe cautionary statements referred to herein and contained elsewhere in this document. BAE Systems plc and its directors accept no liability to third parties in respect of this document save as would ariseunder English law. Accordingly, any liability to a person who has demonstrated reliance on any untrue or misleading statement or omission shall be determined in accordance with Schedule 10A of the Financial Services and Markets Act 2000. It should be noted that Schedule 10A and Section 463 of the Companies Act 2006 contain limits on the liability of the directors of BAE Systems plc so that their liability is solely to BAE Systems plc. Printed by Park Communications on FSC ® -certified paper. Park works to the EMAS standard and its Environmental Management Systemiscertified to ISO 14001. 100% of the inks used are vegetable oil based, 95% of press chemicals arerecycled for further use and, onaverage, 99% of any waste associated withthisproduction will be recycled. This document is printed on materialcontaining 100% recycled fibre. This is a certified climate neutral print product for which carbon emissions havebeen calculated and offset by supporting recognised carbon offset projects. The carbon offset projects are audited and certified according tointernational standards and demonstrably reduce emissions. The climate neutrallabel includes a unique ID number specific to this product which canbetracked at www.climatepartner.com, giving details of the carbon offsetting process including information on the emissions volume and thecarbon offset project being supported. Designed and produced by Radley Yeldar. BAE Systems plc 6 Carlton Gardens London SW1Y 5AD United Kingdom T +44 ( 0 ) 1252 373232 baesys tems.com Registered in England and Wales, No. 01470151 © BAE Systems plc 2024. All rights reserved BAE SYSTEMS is a registered trade mark of BAE Systems plc. Independent auditor’s reasonable assurance report to the Members of BAE Systems plc on the compliance of the Electronic Format Annual Financial Report with Financial Conduct Authority (FCA) Disclosure Guidance and Transparency Rule (DTR) 4.1.15R-DTR 4.1.18R Report on compliance with the requirements for iXBRL mark up (‘tagging’) of consolidated financial statements included in the Electronic Format Annual Financial Report We have undertaken a reasonable assurance engagement on the iXBRL mark up of consolidated financial statements for the year ended 31 December 2023 of BAE Systems plc (the “company”) included in the Electronic Format Annual Financial Report prepared by the company. Opinion In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements for the year ended 31 December 2023 of the company included in the Electronic Format Annual Financial Report, are marked up, in all material respects, in compliance with DTR 4.1.15R-DTR 4.1.18R. The directors’ responsibility for the Electronic Format Annual Financial Report prepared in compliance with DTR 4.1.15R-DTR 4.1.18R The directors are responsible for preparing the Electronic Format Annual Financial Report. This responsibility includes: • the selection and application of appropriate iXBRL tags using judgement where necessary; • ensuring consistency between digitised information and the consolidated financial statements presented in human-readable format; and • the design, implementation and maintenance of internal control relevant to the application of DTR 4.1.15R-DTR 4.1.18R. Our independence and quality control We have complied with the independence and other ethical requirements of Financial Reporting Council’s (the ‘FRC’s’) Ethical Standard as applied to listed public interest entities, and we have fulfilled our other ethical responsibilities in accordance with these requirements. We apply International Standard on Quality Control 1 and, accordingly, maintain a comprehensive system of quality control including documented policies and procedures regarding compliance with ethical requirements, professional standards and applicable legal and regulatory requirements. Our responsibility Our responsibility is to express an opinion on whether the iXBRL mark up of consolidated financial statements complies in all material respects with DTR 4.1.15R-DTR 4.1.18R based on the evidence we have obtained. We conducted our reasonable assurance engagement in accordance with International Standard on Assurance Engagements (UK) 3000, Assurance Engagements Other than Audits or Reviews of Historical Financial Information (‘ISAE (UK) 3000’) issued by the FRC. A reasonable assurance engagement in accordance with ISAE (UK) 3000 involves performing procedures to obtain reasonable assurance about the compliance of the mark up of the consolidated financial statements with the DTR 4.1.15R-DTR 4.1.18R. The nature, timing and extent of procedures selected depend on the practitioner's judgement, including the assessment of the risks of material departures from the requirements set out in DTR 4.1.15R-DTR 4.1.18R, whether due to fraud or error. Our reasonable assurance engagement consisted primarily of: • obtaining an understanding of the iXBRL mark up process, including internal control over the mark up process relevant to the engagement; • reconciling the marked up data with the audited consolidated financial statements of the company dated 31 December 2023; • evaluating the appropriateness of the company’s mark up of the consolidated financial statements using the iXBRL mark-up language; • evaluating the appropriateness of the company’s use of iXBRL elements selected from a generally accepted taxonomy and the creation of extension elements where no suitabl e element in the generally accepted taxonomy has been identified; and • evaluating the use of anchoring in relation to the extension elements. In this report we do not express an audit opinion, review conclusion or any other assurance conclusion on the consolidated financial statements. Our audit opinion relating to the consolidated financial statements of the company for the year ended 31 December 2023 is set out in our Independent Auditor’s Report dated 20 February 2024. Use of our report Our report is made solely to the company’s members, as a body, in accordance with ISAE (UK) 3000. Our work has been undertaken so that we might state to the company those matters we are required to state to them in this report and for no other purpose. To the fullest extent permitted by law, we do not accept or assume responsibility to anyone other than the company and the company’s members as a body for our work, this report, or for the conclusions we have formed. Claire Faulkner (Senior statutory auditor) For and on behalf of Deloitte LLP Statutory Auditor London, UK 6 March 2024
Building tools?
Free accounts include 100 API calls/year for testing.
Have a question? We'll get back to you promptly.